Revert "GDB: Document the unix::/path/to/socket of remote connection."
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration
545 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
546 Computer Laboratory under DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237
547 ("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH research programme.
548
549 Initial support for the FreeBSD/riscv target and native configuration
550 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
551 Computer Laboratory (Department of Computer Science and Technology)
552 under DARPA contract HR0011-18-C-0016 ("ECATS"), as part of the DARPA
553 SSITH research programme.
554
555 The original port to the OpenRISC 1000 is believed to be due to
556 Alessandro Forin and Per Bothner. More recent ports have been the work
557 of Jeremy Bennett, Franck Jullien, Stefan Wallentowitz and
558 Stafford Horne.
559
560 @node Sample Session
561 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
562
563 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
564 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
565 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
566
567 @iftex
568 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
569 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
570 @end iftex
571
572 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
573 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
574
575 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
576 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
577 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
578 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
579 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
580 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
581 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
582 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
583 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
584
585 @smallexample
586 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
587 $ @b{./m4}
588 @b{define(foo,0000)}
589
590 @b{foo}
591 0000
592 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
593
594 @b{bar}
595 0000
596 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
597
598 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
599 @b{baz}
600 @b{Ctrl-d}
601 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
602 @end smallexample
603
604 @noindent
605 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
606
607 @smallexample
608 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
609 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
610 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
611 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
612 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
613 the conditions.
614 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
615 for details.
616
617 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
618 (@value{GDBP})
619 @end smallexample
620
621 @noindent
622 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
623 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
624 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
625 that examples fit in this manual.
626
627 @smallexample
628 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
629 @end smallexample
630
631 @noindent
632 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
633 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
634 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
635 @code{break} command.
636
637 @smallexample
638 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
639 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
640 @end smallexample
641
642 @noindent
643 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
644 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
645 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
646
647 @smallexample
648 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
649 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
650 @b{define(foo,0000)}
651
652 @b{foo}
653 0000
654 @end smallexample
655
656 @noindent
657 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
658 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
659 context where it stops.
660
661 @smallexample
662 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
663
664 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
665 at builtin.c:879
666 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
667 @end smallexample
668
669 @noindent
670 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
671 the next line of the current function.
672
673 @smallexample
674 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
675 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
676 : nil,
677 @end smallexample
678
679 @noindent
680 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
681 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
682 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
683 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
684
685 @smallexample
686 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
687 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
688 at input.c:530
689 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
690 @end smallexample
691
692 @noindent
693 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
694 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
695 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
696 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
697 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
698 stack frame for each active subroutine.
699
700 @smallexample
701 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
702 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
703 at input.c:530
704 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
705 at builtin.c:882
706 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
707 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
708 at macro.c:71
709 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
710 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
711 @end smallexample
712
713 @noindent
714 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
715 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
716 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
717
718 @smallexample
719 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
720 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
721 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
722 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
723 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
725 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
726 : xstrdup(rq);
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
728 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
729 @end smallexample
730
731 @noindent
732 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
733 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
734 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
735 (@code{print}) to see their values.
736
737 @smallexample
738 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
739 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
740 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
741 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
742 @end smallexample
743
744 @noindent
745 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
746 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
747 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
748
749 @smallexample
750 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
751 533 xfree(rquote);
752 534
753 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
754 : xstrdup (lq);
755 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
756 : xstrdup (rq);
757 537
758 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
759 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
760 540 @}
761 541
762 542 void
763 @end smallexample
764
765 @noindent
766 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
767 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
768
769 @smallexample
770 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
771 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
772 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
773 540 @}
774 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
775 $3 = 9
776 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
777 $4 = 7
778 @end smallexample
779
780 @noindent
781 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
782 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
783 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
784 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
785 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
786 assignments.
787
788 @smallexample
789 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
790 $5 = 7
791 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
792 $6 = 9
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
797 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
798 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
799 example that caused trouble initially:
800
801 @smallexample
802 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
803 Continuing.
804
805 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
806
807 baz
808 0000
809 @end smallexample
810
811 @noindent
812 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
813 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
814 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
815
816 @smallexample
817 @b{Ctrl-d}
818 Program exited normally.
819 @end smallexample
820
821 @noindent
822 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
823 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
824 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
825
826 @smallexample
827 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
828 @end smallexample
829
830 @node Invocation
831 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
832
833 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
834 The essentials are:
835 @itemize @bullet
836 @item
837 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
838 @item
839 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
840 @end itemize
841
842 @menu
843 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
844 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
845 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
846 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
847 @end menu
848
849 @node Invoking GDB
850 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
851
852 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
853 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
854
855 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
856 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
857
858 The command-line options described here are designed
859 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
860 options may effectively be unavailable.
861
862 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
863 specifying an executable program:
864
865 @smallexample
866 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
867 @end smallexample
868
869 @noindent
870 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
871 specified:
872
873 @smallexample
874 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
875 @end smallexample
876
877 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
878 to debug a running process:
879
880 @smallexample
881 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
882 @end smallexample
883
884 @noindent
885 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
886 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
887
888 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
889 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
890 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
891 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
892 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
893
894 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
895 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
896 option processing.
897 @smallexample
898 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
899 @end smallexample
900 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
901 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
902
903 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
904 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
905 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
906
907 @smallexample
908 @value{GDBP} --silent
909 @end smallexample
910
911 @noindent
912 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
913 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
914
915 @noindent
916 Type
917
918 @smallexample
919 @value{GDBP} -help
920 @end smallexample
921
922 @noindent
923 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
924 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
925
926 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
927 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
928 @samp{-x} option is used.
929
930
931 @menu
932 * File Options:: Choosing files
933 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
934 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
935 @end menu
936
937 @node File Options
938 @subsection Choosing Files
939
940 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
941 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
942 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
943 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
944 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
945 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
946 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
947 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
948 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
949 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
950 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
951 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
952 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
953
954 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
955 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
956 argument and ignore it.
957
958 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
959 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
960 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
961 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
962 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
963
964 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
965 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
966 @c it.
967
968 @table @code
969 @item -symbols @var{file}
970 @itemx -s @var{file}
971 @cindex @code{--symbols}
972 @cindex @code{-s}
973 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
974
975 @item -exec @var{file}
976 @itemx -e @var{file}
977 @cindex @code{--exec}
978 @cindex @code{-e}
979 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
980 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
981
982 @item -se @var{file}
983 @cindex @code{--se}
984 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
985 file.
986
987 @item -core @var{file}
988 @itemx -c @var{file}
989 @cindex @code{--core}
990 @cindex @code{-c}
991 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
992
993 @item -pid @var{number}
994 @itemx -p @var{number}
995 @cindex @code{--pid}
996 @cindex @code{-p}
997 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
998
999 @item -command @var{file}
1000 @itemx -x @var{file}
1001 @cindex @code{--command}
1002 @cindex @code{-x}
1003 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
1004 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
1005 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
1006
1007 @item -eval-command @var{command}
1008 @itemx -ex @var{command}
1009 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
1010 @cindex @code{-ex}
1011 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
1012
1013 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
1014 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
1015
1016 @smallexample
1017 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1018 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1019 @end smallexample
1020
1021 @item -init-command @var{file}
1022 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1023 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1024 @cindex @code{-ix}
1025 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1026 after loading gdbinit files).
1027 @xref{Startup}.
1028
1029 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1030 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1031 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1032 @cindex @code{-iex}
1033 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1034 after loading gdbinit files).
1035 @xref{Startup}.
1036
1037 @item -directory @var{directory}
1038 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1039 @cindex @code{--directory}
1040 @cindex @code{-d}
1041 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1042
1043 @item -r
1044 @itemx -readnow
1045 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1046 @cindex @code{-r}
1047 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1048 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1049 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1050
1051 @item --readnever
1052 @anchor{--readnever}
1053 @cindex @code{--readnever}, command-line option
1054 Do not read each symbol file's symbolic debug information. This makes
1055 startup faster but at the expense of not being able to perform
1056 symbolic debugging. DWARF unwind information is also not read,
1057 meaning backtraces may become incomplete or inaccurate. One use of
1058 this is when a user simply wants to do the following sequence: attach,
1059 dump core, detach. Loading the debugging information in this case is
1060 an unnecessary cause of delay.
1061 @end table
1062
1063 @node Mode Options
1064 @subsection Choosing Modes
1065
1066 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1067 batch mode or quiet mode.
1068
1069 @table @code
1070 @anchor{-nx}
1071 @item -nx
1072 @itemx -n
1073 @cindex @code{--nx}
1074 @cindex @code{-n}
1075 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1076 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1077
1078 @table @code
1079 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1080 This is the system-wide init file.
1081 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1082 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1083 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1084 have been processed.
1085 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1086 This is the init file in your home directory.
1087 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1088 command options have been processed.
1089 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1090 This is the init file in the current directory.
1091 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1092 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1093 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1094 @end table
1095
1096 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1097 For documentation on how to write command files,
1098 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1099
1100 @anchor{-nh}
1101 @item -nh
1102 @cindex @code{--nh}
1103 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1104 in your home directory.
1105 @xref{Startup}.
1106
1107 @item -quiet
1108 @itemx -silent
1109 @itemx -q
1110 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1111 @cindex @code{--silent}
1112 @cindex @code{-q}
1113 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1114 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1115
1116 @item -batch
1117 @cindex @code{--batch}
1118 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1119 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1120 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1121 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1122 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1123 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1124 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1125
1126 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1127 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1128 make this more useful, the message
1129
1130 @smallexample
1131 Program exited normally.
1132 @end smallexample
1133
1134 @noindent
1135 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1136 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1137 mode.
1138
1139 @item -batch-silent
1140 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1141 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1142 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1143 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1144 for an interactive session.
1145
1146 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1147 messages, for example.
1148
1149 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1150 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1151
1152 @item -return-child-result
1153 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1154 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1155 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1156
1157 @itemize @bullet
1158 @item
1159 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1160 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1161 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1162 @item
1163 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1164 @item
1165 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1166 the exit code will be -1.
1167 @end itemize
1168
1169 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1170 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1171 interface.
1172
1173 @item -nowindows
1174 @itemx -nw
1175 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1176 @cindex @code{-nw}
1177 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1178 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1179 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1180
1181 @item -windows
1182 @itemx -w
1183 @cindex @code{--windows}
1184 @cindex @code{-w}
1185 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1186 used if possible.
1187
1188 @item -cd @var{directory}
1189 @cindex @code{--cd}
1190 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1191 instead of the current directory.
1192
1193 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1194 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1195 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1196 @cindex @code{-D}
1197 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1198 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1199 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1200
1201 @item -fullname
1202 @itemx -f
1203 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1204 @cindex @code{-f}
1205 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1206 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1207 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1208 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1209 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1210 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1211 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1212 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1213 frame.
1214
1215 @item -annotate @var{level}
1216 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1217 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1218 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1219 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1220 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1221 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1222 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1223 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1224 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1225
1226 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1227 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1228
1229 @item --args
1230 @cindex @code{--args}
1231 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1232 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1233 This option stops option processing.
1234
1235 @item -baud @var{bps}
1236 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1237 @cindex @code{--baud}
1238 @cindex @code{-b}
1239 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1240 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1241
1242 @item -l @var{timeout}
1243 @cindex @code{-l}
1244 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1245 for remote debugging.
1246
1247 @item -tty @var{device}
1248 @itemx -t @var{device}
1249 @cindex @code{--tty}
1250 @cindex @code{-t}
1251 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1252 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1253
1254 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1255 @item -tui
1256 @cindex @code{--tui}
1257 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1258 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1259 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1260 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1261 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1262 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1263
1264 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1265 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1266 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1267 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1268 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1269 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1270
1271 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1272 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1273 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1274 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1275 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1276 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1277
1278 @item -write
1279 @cindex @code{--write}
1280 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1281 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1282 (@pxref{Patching}).
1283
1284 @item -statistics
1285 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1286 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1287 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1288
1289 @item -version
1290 @cindex @code{--version}
1291 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1292 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1293
1294 @item -configuration
1295 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1296 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1297 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1298 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1299
1300 @end table
1301
1302 @node Startup
1303 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1304 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1305
1306 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1307
1308 @enumerate
1309 @item
1310 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1311 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1312
1313 @item
1314 @cindex init file
1315 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1316 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1317 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1318 that file.
1319
1320 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1321 @item
1322 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1323 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1324 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1325 that file.
1326
1327 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1328 @item
1329 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1330 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1331 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1332 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1333 gets loaded.
1334
1335 @item
1336 Processes command line options and operands.
1337
1338 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1339 @item
1340 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1341 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1342 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1343 This is only done if the current directory is
1344 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1345 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1346 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1347 @value{GDBN}.
1348
1349 @item
1350 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1351 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1352 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1353 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1354
1355 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1356 you must do something like the following:
1357
1358 @smallexample
1359 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1360 @end smallexample
1361
1362 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1363 off too late.
1364
1365 @item
1366 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1367 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1368 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1369
1370 @item
1371 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1372 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1373 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1374 @end enumerate
1375
1376 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1377 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1378 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1379 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1380 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1381 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1382
1383 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1384 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1385
1386 @cindex init file name
1387 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1388 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1389 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1390 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1391 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1392 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1393 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1394 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1395
1396
1397 @node Quitting GDB
1398 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1399 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1400 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1401
1402 @table @code
1403 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1404 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1405 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1406 @itemx q
1407 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1408 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1409 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1410 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1411 error code.
1412 @end table
1413
1414 @cindex interrupt
1415 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1416 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1417 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1418 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1419 until a time when it is safe.
1420
1421 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1422 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1423 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1424
1425 @node Shell Commands
1426 @section Shell Commands
1427
1428 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1429 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1430 just use the @code{shell} command.
1431
1432 @table @code
1433 @kindex shell
1434 @kindex !
1435 @cindex shell escape
1436 @item shell @var{command-string}
1437 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1438 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1439 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1440 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1441 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1442 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1443 @end table
1444
1445 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1446 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1447 @value{GDBN}:
1448
1449 @table @code
1450 @kindex make
1451 @cindex calling make
1452 @item make @var{make-args}
1453 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1454 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1455 @end table
1456
1457 @node Logging Output
1458 @section Logging Output
1459 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1460 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1461
1462 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1463 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1464
1465 @table @code
1466 @kindex set logging
1467 @item set logging on
1468 Enable logging.
1469 @item set logging off
1470 Disable logging.
1471 @cindex logging file name
1472 @item set logging file @var{file}
1473 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1474 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1475 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1476 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1477 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1478 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1479 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1480 @kindex show logging
1481 @item show logging
1482 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1483 @end table
1484
1485 @node Commands
1486 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1487
1488 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1489 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1490 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1491 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1492 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1493
1494 @menu
1495 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1496 * Completion:: Command completion
1497 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1498 @end menu
1499
1500 @node Command Syntax
1501 @section Command Syntax
1502
1503 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1504 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1505 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1506 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1507 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1508 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1509
1510 @cindex abbreviation
1511 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1512 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1513 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1514 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1515 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1516 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1517 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1518
1519 @cindex repeating commands
1520 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1521 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1522 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1523 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1524 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1525 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1526 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1527
1528 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1529 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1530 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1531
1532 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1533 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1534 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1535 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1536 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1537
1538 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1539 @cindex comment
1540 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1541 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1542 Files,,Command Files}).
1543
1544 @cindex repeating command sequences
1545 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1546 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1547 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1548 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1549 for editing.
1550
1551 @node Completion
1552 @section Command Completion
1553
1554 @cindex completion
1555 @cindex word completion
1556 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1557 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1558 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1559 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1560
1561 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1562 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1563 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1564 enter it). For example, if you type
1565
1566 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1567 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1568 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1569 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1570 @smallexample
1571 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1572 @end smallexample
1573
1574 @noindent
1575 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1576 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1577
1578 @smallexample
1579 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1580 @end smallexample
1581
1582 @noindent
1583 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1584 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1585 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1586 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1587 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1588 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1589
1590 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1591 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1592 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1593 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1594 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1595 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1596 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1597 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1598 example:
1599
1600 @smallexample
1601 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1602 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1603 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1604 make_abs_section make_function_type
1605 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1606 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1607 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1608 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1609 @end smallexample
1610
1611 @noindent
1612 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1613 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1614 command.
1615
1616 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1617 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1618 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1619 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1620 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1621
1622 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1623 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1624 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1625
1626 @smallexample
1627 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1628 main
1629 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1630 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1631 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1632 @end smallexample
1633
1634 @noindent
1635 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1636
1637 @table @code
1638 @kindex set max-completions
1639 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1640 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1641 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1642 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1643 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1644 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1645 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1646 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1647 completion slow.
1648 @kindex show max-completions
1649 @item show max-completions
1650 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1651 during completion.
1652 @end table
1653
1654 @cindex quotes in commands
1655 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1656 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1657 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1658 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1659 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1660 @value{GDBN} commands.
1661
1662 A likely situation where you might need this is in typing an
1663 expression that involves a C@t{++} symbol name with template
1664 parameters. This is because when completing expressions, GDB treats
1665 the @samp{<} character as word delimiter, assuming that it's the
1666 less-than comparison operator (@pxref{C Operators, , C and C@t{++}
1667 Operators}).
1668
1669 For example, when you want to call a C@t{++} template function
1670 interactively using the @code{print} or @code{call} commands, you may
1671 need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that
1672 was specialized for @code{int}, @code{name<int>()}, or the version
1673 that was specialized for @code{float}, @code{name<float>()}. To use
1674 the word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1675 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1676 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1677 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1678
1679 @smallexample
1680 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func< @kbd{M-?}
1681 func<int>() func<float>()
1682 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func<
1683 @end smallexample
1684
1685 When setting breakpoints however (@pxref{Specify Location}), you don't
1686 usually need to type a quote before the function name, because
1687 @value{GDBN} understands that you want to set a breakpoint on a
1688 function:
1689
1690 @smallexample
1691 (@value{GDBP}) b func< @kbd{M-?}
1692 func<int>() func<float>()
1693 (@value{GDBP}) b func<
1694 @end smallexample
1695
1696 This is true even in the case of typing the name of C@t{++} overloaded
1697 functions (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by
1698 argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1699 don't need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1700 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1701 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}.
1702
1703 @smallexample
1704 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1705 bubble(int) bubble(double)
1706 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble(dou @kbd{M-?}
1707 bubble(double)
1708 @end smallexample
1709
1710 See @ref{quoting names} for a description of other scenarios that
1711 require quoting.
1712
1713 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1714 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1715 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1716 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1717
1718 @cindex completion of structure field names
1719 @cindex structure field name completion
1720 @cindex completion of union field names
1721 @cindex union field name completion
1722 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1723 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1724 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1725 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1726 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1727 left-hand-side:
1728
1729 @smallexample
1730 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1731 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1732 to_data to_isatty to_write
1733 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1734 to_flush to_read
1735 @end smallexample
1736
1737 @noindent
1738 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1739 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1740 follows:
1741
1742 @smallexample
1743 struct ui_file
1744 @{
1745 int *magic;
1746 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1747 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1748 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1749 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1750 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1751 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1752 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1753 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1754 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1755 void *to_data;
1756 @}
1757 @end smallexample
1758
1759
1760 @node Help
1761 @section Getting Help
1762 @cindex online documentation
1763 @kindex help
1764
1765 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1766 using the command @code{help}.
1767
1768 @table @code
1769 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1770 @item help
1771 @itemx h
1772 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1773 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1774
1775 @smallexample
1776 (@value{GDBP}) help
1777 List of classes of commands:
1778
1779 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1780 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1781 data -- Examining data
1782 files -- Specifying and examining files
1783 internals -- Maintenance commands
1784 obscure -- Obscure features
1785 running -- Running the program
1786 stack -- Examining the stack
1787 status -- Status inquiries
1788 support -- Support facilities
1789 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1790 stopping the program
1791 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1792
1793 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1794 commands in that class.
1795 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1796 documentation.
1797 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1798 (@value{GDBP})
1799 @end smallexample
1800 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1801
1802 @item help @var{class}
1803 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1804 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1805 help display for the class @code{status}:
1806
1807 @smallexample
1808 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1809 Status inquiries.
1810
1811 List of commands:
1812
1813 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1814 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1815 info -- Generic command for showing things
1816 about the program being debugged
1817 show -- Generic command for showing things
1818 about the debugger
1819
1820 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1821 documentation.
1822 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1823 (@value{GDBP})
1824 @end smallexample
1825
1826 @item help @var{command}
1827 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1828 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1829
1830 @kindex apropos
1831 @item apropos @var{args}
1832 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1833 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1834 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1835
1836 @smallexample
1837 apropos alias
1838 @end smallexample
1839
1840 @noindent
1841 results in:
1842
1843 @smallexample
1844 @c @group
1845 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1846 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1847 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1848 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1849 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1850 @c @end group
1851 @end smallexample
1852
1853 @kindex complete
1854 @item complete @var{args}
1855 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1856 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1857 command you want completed. For example:
1858
1859 @smallexample
1860 complete i
1861 @end smallexample
1862
1863 @noindent results in:
1864
1865 @smallexample
1866 @group
1867 if
1868 ignore
1869 info
1870 inspect
1871 @end group
1872 @end smallexample
1873
1874 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1875 @end table
1876
1877 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1878 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1879 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1880 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1881 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1882 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1883 Index}.
1884
1885 @c @group
1886 @table @code
1887 @kindex info
1888 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1889 @item info
1890 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1891 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1892 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1893 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1894 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1895 @w{@code{help info}}.
1896
1897 @kindex set
1898 @item set
1899 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1900 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1901 @code{set prompt $}.
1902
1903 @kindex show
1904 @item show
1905 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1906 @value{GDBN} itself.
1907 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1908 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1909 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1910 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1911
1912 @kindex info set
1913 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1914 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1915 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1916 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1917 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1918 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1919 @end table
1920 @c @end group
1921
1922 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1923 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1924
1925 @table @code
1926 @kindex show version
1927 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1928 @item show version
1929 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1930 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1931 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1932 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1933 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1934 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1935 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1936 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1937 @value{GDBN}.
1938
1939 @kindex show copying
1940 @kindex info copying
1941 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1942 @item show copying
1943 @itemx info copying
1944 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1945
1946 @kindex show warranty
1947 @kindex info warranty
1948 @item show warranty
1949 @itemx info warranty
1950 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1951 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1952
1953 @kindex show configuration
1954 @item show configuration
1955 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1956 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1957 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1958 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1959 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1960 your report.
1961
1962 @end table
1963
1964 @node Running
1965 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1966
1967 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1968 debugging information when you compile it.
1969
1970 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1971 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1972 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1973 kill a child process.
1974
1975 @menu
1976 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1977 * Starting:: Starting your program
1978 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1979 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1980
1981 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1982 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1983 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1984 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1985
1986 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1987 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1988 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1989 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1990 @end menu
1991
1992 @node Compilation
1993 @section Compiling for Debugging
1994
1995 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1996 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1997 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1998 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1999 and addresses in the executable code.
2000
2001 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
2002 the compiler.
2003
2004 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
2005 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
2006 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
2007 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
2008 executables containing debugging information.
2009
2010 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
2011 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
2012 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
2013 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
2014 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
2015
2016 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
2017 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
2018 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
2019
2020 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
2021 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
2022 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
2023 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
2024 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
2025 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
2026
2027 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
2028 gcc, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
2029 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
2030
2031 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
2032 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
2033 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
2034 format in @value{GDBN}.
2035
2036 @need 2000
2037 @node Starting
2038 @section Starting your Program
2039 @cindex starting
2040 @cindex running
2041
2042 @table @code
2043 @kindex run
2044 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2045 @item run
2046 @itemx r
2047 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2048 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2049 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2050 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2051 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2052
2053 @end table
2054
2055 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2056 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2057 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2058 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2059 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2060 message like this one:
2061
2062 @smallexample
2063 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2064 Try "help target" or "continue".
2065 @end smallexample
2066
2067 @noindent
2068 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2069 first (@pxref{load}).
2070
2071 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2072 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2073 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2074 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2075 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2076 divided into four categories:
2077
2078 @table @asis
2079 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2080 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2081 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2082 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2083 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2084 the arguments.
2085 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2086 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2087 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2088 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2089 below for details).
2090
2091 @item The @emph{environment.}
2092 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2093 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2094 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2095 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2096
2097 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2098 You can set your program's working directory with the command
2099 @kbd{set cwd}. If you do not set any working directory with this
2100 command, your program will inherit @value{GDBN}'s working directory if
2101 native debugging, or the remote server's working directory if remote
2102 debugging. @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working
2103 Directory}.
2104
2105 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2106 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2107 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2108 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2109 set a different device for your program.
2110 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2111
2112 @cindex pipes
2113 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2114 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2115 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2116 wrong program.
2117 @end table
2118
2119 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2120 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2121 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2122 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2123 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2124
2125 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2126 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2127 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2128 your current breakpoints.
2129
2130 @table @code
2131 @kindex start
2132 @item start
2133 @cindex run to main procedure
2134 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2135 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2136 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2137 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2138 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2139 procedure, depending on the language used.
2140
2141 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2142 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2143 the @samp{run} command.
2144
2145 @cindex elaboration phase
2146 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2147 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2148 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2149 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2150 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2151 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2152 will remain to halt execution.
2153
2154 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2155 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2156 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2157 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2158 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2159
2160 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2161 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution
2162 of your program too late, as the program would have already completed
2163 the elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, either insert
2164 breakpoints in your elaboration code before running your program or
2165 use the @code{starti} command.
2166
2167 @kindex starti
2168 @item starti
2169 @cindex run to first instruction
2170 The @samp{starti} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2171 breakpoint at the first instruction of a program's execution and then
2172 invoking the @samp{run} command. For programs containing an
2173 elaboration phase, the @code{starti} command will stop execution at
2174 the start of the elaboration phase.
2175
2176 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2177 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2178 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2179 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2180 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2181 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2182 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2183 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2184 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2185 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2186 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2187 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2188
2189 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2190 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2191 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2192 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2193
2194 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2195 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2196 environment:
2197
2198 @smallexample
2199 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2200 (@value{GDBP}) run
2201 @end smallexample
2202
2203 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2204 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2205
2206 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2207 @anchor{set startup-with-shell}
2208 @item set startup-with-shell
2209 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2210 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2211 @itemx show startup-with-shell
2212 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2213 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2214 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2215 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2216 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2217 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2218 startup failures such as:
2219
2220 @smallexample
2221 (@value{GDBP}) run
2222 Starting program: ./a.out
2223 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2224 @end smallexample
2225
2226 @noindent
2227 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2228 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2229 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2230 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2231 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2232 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2233
2234 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2235 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2236 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2237 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2238 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2239 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2240
2241 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2242 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2243 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2244 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2245 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2246 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2247
2248 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2249 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2250 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2251
2252 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2253 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2254
2255 @smallexample
2256 (@value{GDBP}) run
2257 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2258 @end smallexample
2259
2260 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2261 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2262
2263 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2264 @code{target native} command. For example,
2265
2266 @smallexample
2267 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2268 (@value{GDBP}) run
2269 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2270 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2271 (@value{GDBP}) run
2272 Starting program: ./a.out
2273 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2274 @end smallexample
2275
2276 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2277 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2278 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2279 disconnect.
2280
2281 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2282 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2283 proc}, @code{info os}.
2284
2285 @kindex set disable-randomization
2286 @item set disable-randomization
2287 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2288 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2289 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2290 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2291 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2292
2293 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2294 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2295
2296 @smallexample
2297 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2298 @end smallexample
2299
2300 @item set disable-randomization off
2301 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2302 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2303 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2304 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2305 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2306 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2307
2308 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2309 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2310 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2311 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2312 a code at its expected addresses.
2313
2314 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2315 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2316 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2317 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2318 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2319 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2320 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2321 a randomly chosen address.
2322
2323 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2324 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2325 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2326 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2327 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2328
2329 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2330 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2331
2332 @item show disable-randomization
2333 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2334 the virtual address space of the started program.
2335
2336 @end table
2337
2338 @node Arguments
2339 @section Your Program's Arguments
2340
2341 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2342 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2343 @code{run} command.
2344 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2345 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2346 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2347 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2348 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2349
2350 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2351 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2352 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2353 the program, not by the shell.
2354
2355 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2356 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2357
2358 @table @code
2359 @kindex set args
2360 @item set args
2361 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2362 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2363 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2364 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2365 it again without arguments.
2366
2367 @kindex show args
2368 @item show args
2369 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2370 @end table
2371
2372 @node Environment
2373 @section Your Program's Environment
2374
2375 @cindex environment (of your program)
2376 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2377 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2378 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2379 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2380 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2381 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2382 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2383
2384 @table @code
2385 @kindex path
2386 @item path @var{directory}
2387 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2388 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2389 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2390 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2391 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2392 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2393 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2394
2395 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2396 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2397 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2398 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2399 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2400 @var{directory} to the search path.
2401 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2402 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2403
2404 @kindex show paths
2405 @item show paths
2406 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2407 environment variable).
2408
2409 @kindex show environment
2410 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2411 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2412 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2413 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2414 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2415
2416 @kindex set environment
2417 @anchor{set environment}
2418 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2419 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2420 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2421 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2422 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2423 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2424 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2425 null value.
2426 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2427 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2428
2429 For example, this command:
2430
2431 @smallexample
2432 set env USER = foo
2433 @end smallexample
2434
2435 @noindent
2436 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2437 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2438 are not actually required.)
2439
2440 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2441 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2442 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2443 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2444 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2445
2446 Environment variables that are set by the user are also transmitted to
2447 @command{gdbserver} to be used when starting the remote inferior.
2448 @pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}.
2449
2450 @kindex unset environment
2451 @anchor{unset environment}
2452 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2453 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2454 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2455 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2456 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2457
2458 Environment variables that are unset by the user are also unset on
2459 @command{gdbserver} when starting the remote inferior.
2460 @pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}.
2461 @end table
2462
2463 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2464 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2465 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2466 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2467 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2468 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2469 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2470 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2471 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2472 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2473
2474 @node Working Directory
2475 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2476
2477 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2478 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, the inferior will be
2479 initialized with the current working directory specified by the
2480 @kbd{set cwd} command. If no directory has been specified by this
2481 command, then the inferior will inherit @value{GDBN}'s current working
2482 directory as its working directory if native debugging, or it will
2483 inherit the remote server's current working directory if remote
2484 debugging.
2485
2486 @table @code
2487 @kindex set cwd
2488 @cindex change inferior's working directory
2489 @anchor{set cwd command}
2490 @item set cwd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2491 Set the inferior's working directory to @var{directory}, which will be
2492 @code{glob}-expanded in order to resolve tildes (@file{~}). If no
2493 argument has been specified, the command clears the setting and resets
2494 it to an empty state. This setting has no effect on @value{GDBN}'s
2495 working directory, and it only takes effect the next time you start
2496 the inferior. The @file{~} in @var{directory} is a short for the
2497 @dfn{home directory}, usually pointed to by the @env{HOME} environment
2498 variable. On MS-Windows, if @env{HOME} is not defined, @value{GDBN}
2499 uses the concatenation of @env{HOMEDRIVE} and @env{HOMEPATH} as
2500 fallback.
2501
2502 You can also change @value{GDBN}'s current working directory by using
2503 the @code{cd} command.
2504 @xref{cd command}.
2505
2506 @kindex show cwd
2507 @cindex show inferior's working directory
2508 @item show cwd
2509 Show the inferior's working directory. If no directory has been
2510 specified by @kbd{set cwd}, then the default inferior's working
2511 directory is the same as @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
2512
2513 @kindex cd
2514 @cindex change @value{GDBN}'s working directory
2515 @anchor{cd command}
2516 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2517 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2518 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2519
2520 The @value{GDBN} working directory serves as a default for the
2521 commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on.
2522 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
2523 @xref{set cwd command}.
2524
2525 @kindex pwd
2526 @item pwd
2527 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2528 @end table
2529
2530 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2531 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2532 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} supports
2533 the @code{info proc} command (@pxref{Process Information}), you can
2534 use the @code{info proc} command to find out the
2535 current working directory of the debuggee.
2536
2537 @node Input/Output
2538 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2539
2540 @cindex redirection
2541 @cindex i/o
2542 @cindex terminal
2543 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2544 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2545 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2546 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2547 running your program.
2548
2549 @table @code
2550 @kindex info terminal
2551 @item info terminal
2552 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2553 program is using.
2554 @end table
2555
2556 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2557 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2558
2559 @smallexample
2560 run > outfile
2561 @end smallexample
2562
2563 @noindent
2564 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2565
2566 @kindex tty
2567 @cindex controlling terminal
2568 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2569 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2570 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2571 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2572 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2573
2574 @smallexample
2575 tty /dev/ttyb
2576 @end smallexample
2577
2578 @noindent
2579 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2580 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2581 that as their controlling terminal.
2582
2583 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2584 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2585 terminal.
2586
2587 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2588 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2589 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2590 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2591
2592 @cindex inferior tty
2593 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2594 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2595 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2596 program.
2597
2598 @table @code
2599 @item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2600 @kindex set inferior-tty
2601 Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty}
2602 restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2603 @value{GDBN}.
2604
2605 @item show inferior-tty
2606 @kindex show inferior-tty
2607 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2608 @end table
2609
2610 @node Attach
2611 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2612 @kindex attach
2613 @cindex attach
2614
2615 @table @code
2616 @item attach @var{process-id}
2617 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2618 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2619 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2620 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2621 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2622
2623 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2624 executing the command.
2625 @end table
2626
2627 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2628 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2629 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2630 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2631
2632 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2633 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2634 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2635 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2636 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2637 Specify Files}.
2638
2639 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2640 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2641 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2642 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2643 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2644 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2645 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2646
2647 @table @code
2648 @kindex detach
2649 @item detach
2650 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2651 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2652 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2653 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2654 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2655 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2656 executing the command.
2657 @end table
2658
2659 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2660 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2661 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2662 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2663 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2664 Messages}).
2665
2666 @node Kill Process
2667 @section Killing the Child Process
2668
2669 @table @code
2670 @kindex kill
2671 @item kill
2672 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2673 @end table
2674
2675 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2676 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2677 is running.
2678
2679 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2680 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2681 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2682 outside the debugger.
2683
2684 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2685 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2686 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2687 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2688 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2689 breakpoint settings).
2690
2691 @node Inferiors and Programs
2692 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2693
2694 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2695 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2696 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2697 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2698 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2699 from multiple executables.
2700
2701 @cindex inferior
2702 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2703 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2704 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2705 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2706 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2707 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2708 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2709 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2710 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2711 threads running in it.
2712
2713 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2714 inferiors}}:
2715
2716 @table @code
2717 @kindex info inferiors [ @var{id}@dots{} ]
2718 @item info inferiors
2719 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2720 By default all inferiors are printed, but the argument @var{id}@dots{}
2721 -- a space separated list of inferior numbers -- can be used to limit
2722 the display to just the requested inferiors.
2723
2724 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2725
2726 @enumerate
2727 @item
2728 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2729
2730 @item
2731 the target system's inferior identifier
2732
2733 @item
2734 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2735
2736 @end enumerate
2737
2738 @noindent
2739 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2740 indicates the current inferior.
2741
2742 For example,
2743 @end table
2744 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2745
2746 @smallexample
2747 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2748 Num Description Executable
2749 2 process 2307 hello
2750 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2751 @end smallexample
2752
2753 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2754
2755 @table @code
2756 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2757 @item inferior @var{infno}
2758 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2759 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2760 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2761 @end table
2762
2763 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2764 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2765 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2766 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2767 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2768 information on convenience variables.
2769
2770 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2771 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2772 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2773 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2774 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2775 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2776
2777 @table @code
2778 @kindex add-inferior
2779 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2780 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2781 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2782 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2783 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2784 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2785
2786 @kindex clone-inferior
2787 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2788 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2789 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2790 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2791 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2792
2793 @smallexample
2794 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2795 Num Description Executable
2796 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2797 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2798 Added inferior 2.
2799 1 inferiors added.
2800 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2801 Num Description Executable
2802 2 <null> helloworld
2803 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2804 @end smallexample
2805
2806 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2807
2808 @kindex remove-inferiors
2809 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2810 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2811 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2812 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2813
2814 @end table
2815
2816 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2817 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2818 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2819 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2820
2821 @table @code
2822 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2823 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2824 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2825 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2826 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2827 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2828
2829 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2830 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2831 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2832 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2833 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2834 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2835 @end table
2836
2837 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2838 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2839 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2840 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2841
2842
2843 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2844 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2845
2846 @table @code
2847 @kindex set print inferior-events
2848 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2849 @item set print inferior-events
2850 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2851 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2852 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2853 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2854 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2855 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2856
2857 @kindex show print inferior-events
2858 @item show print inferior-events
2859 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2860 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2861 @end table
2862
2863 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2864 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2865 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2866
2867
2868 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2869 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2870 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2871 info program-spaces}} command.
2872
2873 @table @code
2874 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2875 @item maint info program-spaces
2876 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2877 @value{GDBN}.
2878
2879 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2880
2881 @enumerate
2882 @item
2883 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2884
2885 @item
2886 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2887 the @code{file} command.
2888
2889 @end enumerate
2890
2891 @noindent
2892 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2893 indicates the current program space.
2894
2895 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2896 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2897 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2898
2899 @smallexample
2900 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2901 Id Executable
2902 * 1 hello
2903 2 goodbye
2904 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2905 @end smallexample
2906
2907 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2908 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2909 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2910 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2911 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2912
2913 @smallexample
2914 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2915 Id Executable
2916 * 1 vfork-test
2917 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2918 @end smallexample
2919
2920 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2921 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2922 @end table
2923
2924 @node Threads
2925 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2926
2927 @cindex threads of execution
2928 @cindex multiple threads
2929 @cindex switching threads
2930 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2931 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2932 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2933 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2934 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2935 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2936 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2937
2938 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2939 programs:
2940
2941 @itemize @bullet
2942 @item automatic notification of new threads
2943 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2944 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2945 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all] @var{args}},
2946 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2947 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2948 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2949 messages on thread start and exit.
2950 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2951 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2952 isn't compatible with the program.
2953 @end itemize
2954
2955 @cindex focus of debugging
2956 @cindex current thread
2957 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2958 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2959 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2960 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2961 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2962
2963 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2964 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2965 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2966 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2967 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2968 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2969 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2970 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2971 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2972 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2973
2974 @smallexample
2975 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2976 @end smallexample
2977
2978 @noindent
2979 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2980 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2981 further qualifier.
2982
2983 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2984 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2985 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2986 @c program?
2987 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2988 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2989 @c threads ab initio?
2990
2991 @anchor{thread numbers}
2992 @cindex thread number, per inferior
2993 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2994 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2995 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2996 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2997 between threads of different inferiors.
2998
2999 @cindex qualified thread ID
3000 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
3001 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
3002 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
3003 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
3004 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
3005 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
3006 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
3007 inferior.
3008
3009 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
3010 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
3011 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
3012 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
3013
3014 @anchor{thread ID lists}
3015 @cindex thread ID lists
3016 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
3017 argument. A list element can be:
3018
3019 @enumerate
3020 @item
3021 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
3022 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
3023 @samp{1}.
3024
3025 @item
3026 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
3027 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
3028 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
3029
3030 @item
3031 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
3032 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
3033 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
3034 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
3035 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
3036
3037 @end enumerate
3038
3039 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
3040 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
3041 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
3042 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
3043 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
3044 7.1}.
3045
3046
3047 @anchor{global thread numbers}
3048 @cindex global thread number
3049 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
3050 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
3051 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
3052 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
3053 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
3054 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
3055
3056 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
3057 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
3058 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
3059
3060 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
3061 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
3062 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
3063 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
3064 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
3065 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
3066 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
3067 general information on convenience variables.
3068
3069 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
3070 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
3071 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
3072
3073 @smallexample
3074 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
3075 @end smallexample
3076
3077 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
3078
3079 @smallexample
3080 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
3081 @end smallexample
3082
3083 @table @code
3084 @kindex info threads
3085 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
3086
3087 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
3088 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
3089 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
3090 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
3091
3092 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
3093
3094 @enumerate
3095 @item
3096 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3097
3098 @item
3099 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3100 option was specified
3101
3102 @item
3103 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3104
3105 @item
3106 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3107 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3108 program itself.
3109
3110 @item
3111 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3112 @end enumerate
3113
3114 @noindent
3115 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3116 indicates the current thread.
3117
3118 For example,
3119 @end table
3120 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3121
3122 @smallexample
3123 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3124 Id Target Id Frame
3125 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3126 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3127 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3128 at threadtest.c:68
3129 @end smallexample
3130
3131 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3132 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3133 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3134
3135 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3136 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3137
3138 @smallexample
3139 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3140 Id GId Target Id Frame
3141 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3142 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3143 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3144 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3145 @end smallexample
3146
3147 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3148 Solaris-specific command:
3149
3150 @table @code
3151 @item maint info sol-threads
3152 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3153 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3154 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3155 @end table
3156
3157 @table @code
3158 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3159 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3160 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3161 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3162 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3163 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3164
3165 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3166 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3167
3168 @smallexample
3169 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3170 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3171 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3172 8 printf ("hello\n");
3173 @end smallexample
3174
3175 @noindent
3176 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3177 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3178 threads.
3179
3180 @kindex thread apply
3181 @cindex apply command to several threads
3182 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
3183 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3184 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3185 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3186 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3187 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3188 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3189 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3190
3191 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to handle
3192 errors raised when applying @var{command} to a thread. @var{flag}
3193 must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter in
3194 @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
3195 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
3196
3197 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some thread information before the
3198 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
3199 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{thread apply}. The
3200 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
3201
3202 @table @code
3203 @item -c
3204 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
3205 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
3206 @code{thread apply} then continues.
3207 @item -s
3208 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
3209 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
3210 That is, the execution continues, but the thread information and errors
3211 are not printed.
3212 @item -q
3213 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the thread
3214 information.
3215 @end table
3216
3217 Flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} cannot be used together.
3218
3219 @kindex taas
3220 @cindex apply command to all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3221 @item taas @var{command}
3222 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s @var{command}}.
3223 Applies @var{command} on all threads, ignoring errors and empty output.
3224
3225 @kindex tfaas
3226 @cindex apply a command to all frames of all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3227 @item tfaas @var{command}
3228 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s frame apply all -s @var{command}}.
3229 Applies @var{command} on all frames of all threads, ignoring errors
3230 and empty output. Note that the flag @code{-s} is specified twice:
3231 The first @code{-s} ensures that @code{thread apply} only shows the thread
3232 information of the threads for which @code{frame apply} produces
3233 some output. The second @code{-s} is needed to ensure that @code{frame
3234 apply} shows the frame information of a frame only if the
3235 @var{command} successfully produced some output.
3236
3237 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
3238 argument without knowing the thread or frame where this variable or argument
3239 is, using:
3240 @smallexample
3241 (@value{GDBP}) tfaas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
3242 @end smallexample
3243
3244
3245 @kindex thread name
3246 @cindex name a thread
3247 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3248 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3249 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3250 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3251
3252 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3253 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3254 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3255 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3256 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3257
3258 @kindex thread find
3259 @cindex search for a thread
3260 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3261 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3262 matches the supplied regular expression.
3263
3264 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3265 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3266 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3267 is the LWP id.
3268
3269 @smallexample
3270 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3271 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3272 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3273 Id Target Id Frame
3274 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3275 @end smallexample
3276
3277 @kindex set print thread-events
3278 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3279 @item set print thread-events
3280 @itemx set print thread-events on
3281 @itemx set print thread-events off
3282 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3283 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3284 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3285 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3286 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3287
3288 @kindex show print thread-events
3289 @item show print thread-events
3290 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3291 have started and exited.
3292 @end table
3293
3294 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3295 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3296 programs with multiple threads.
3297
3298 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3299 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3300
3301 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3302 @table @code
3303 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3304 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3305 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3306 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3307 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3308 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3309 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3310 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3311 macro.
3312
3313 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3314 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3315 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3316 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3317 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3318 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3319
3320 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3321 refers to the default system directories that are
3322 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3323 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3324 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3325
3326 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3327 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3328 was loaded in the inferior process.
3329
3330 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3331 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3332 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3333 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3334 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3335 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3336 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3337
3338 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3339 only on some platforms.
3340
3341 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3342 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3343 Display current libthread_db search path.
3344
3345 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3346 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3347 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3348 @item set debug libthread-db
3349 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3350 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3351 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3352 @end table
3353
3354 @node Forks
3355 @section Debugging Forks
3356
3357 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3358 @cindex multiple processes
3359 @cindex processes, multiple
3360 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3361 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3362 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3363 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3364 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3365 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3366 will cause it to terminate.
3367
3368 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3369 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3370 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3371 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3372 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3373 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3374 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3375 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3376 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3377 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3378
3379 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3380 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3381 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3382 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3383
3384 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3385 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3386 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3387
3388 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3389 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3390
3391 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3392 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3393
3394 @table @code
3395 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3396 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3397 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3398 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3399 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3400
3401 @table @code
3402 @item parent
3403 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3404 unimpeded. This is the default.
3405
3406 @item child
3407 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3408 unimpeded.
3409
3410 @end table
3411
3412 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3413 @item show follow-fork-mode
3414 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3415 @end table
3416
3417 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3418 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3419 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3420
3421 @table @code
3422 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3423 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3424 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3425 retain debugger control over them both.
3426
3427 @table @code
3428 @item on
3429 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3430 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3431 independently. This is the default.
3432
3433 @item off
3434 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3435 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3436 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3437 is held suspended.
3438
3439 @end table
3440
3441 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3442 @item show detach-on-fork
3443 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3444 @end table
3445
3446 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3447 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3448 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3449 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3450 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3451 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3452
3453 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3454 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3455 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3456 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3457 and Programs}.
3458
3459 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3460 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3461 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3462 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3463 the child process's @code{main}.
3464
3465 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3466 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3467
3468 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3469 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3470 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3471 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3472 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3473 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3474 command.
3475
3476 @table @code
3477 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3478 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3479
3480 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3481 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3482
3483 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3484
3485 @table @code
3486 @item new
3487 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3488 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3489 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3490 original inferior.
3491
3492 For example:
3493
3494 @smallexample
3495 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3496 (gdb) info inferior
3497 Id Description Executable
3498 * 1 <null> prog1
3499 (@value{GDBP}) run
3500 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3501 Program exited normally.
3502 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3503 Id Description Executable
3504 1 <null> prog1
3505 * 2 <null> prog2
3506 @end smallexample
3507
3508 @item same
3509 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3510 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3511 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3512 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3513 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3514
3515 For example:
3516
3517 @smallexample
3518 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3519 Id Description Executable
3520 * 1 <null> prog1
3521 (@value{GDBP}) run
3522 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3523 Program exited normally.
3524 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3525 Id Description Executable
3526 * 1 <null> prog2
3527 @end smallexample
3528
3529 @end table
3530 @end table
3531
3532 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3533 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3534
3535 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3536 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3537 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3538
3539 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3540 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3541
3542 @cindex checkpoint
3543 @cindex restart
3544 @cindex bookmark
3545 @cindex snapshot of a process
3546 @cindex rewind program state
3547
3548 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3549 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3550 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3551 later.
3552
3553 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3554 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3555 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3556 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3557 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3558
3559 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3560 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3561 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3562 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3563 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3564 start again from there.
3565
3566 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3567 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3568
3569 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3570
3571 @table @code
3572 @kindex checkpoint
3573 @item checkpoint
3574 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3575 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3576 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3577
3578 @kindex info checkpoints
3579 @item info checkpoints
3580 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3581 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3582 listed:
3583
3584 @table @code
3585 @item Checkpoint ID
3586 @item Process ID
3587 @item Code Address
3588 @item Source line, or label
3589 @end table
3590
3591 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3592 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3593 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3594 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3595 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3596 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3597 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3598
3599 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3600 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3601 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3602 the debugger.
3603
3604 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3605 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3606 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3607
3608 @end table
3609
3610 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3611 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3612 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3613 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3614 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3615 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3616 previously read data can be read again.
3617
3618 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3619 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3620 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3621 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3622 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3623 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3624
3625 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3626 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3627 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3628 different execution path this time.
3629
3630 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3631 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3632 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3633 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3634 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3635 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3636 potentially pose a problem.
3637
3638 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3639
3640 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3641 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3642 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3643 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3644 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3645 next.
3646
3647 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3648 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3649 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3650 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3651 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3652
3653 @node Stopping
3654 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3655
3656 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3657 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3658 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3659
3660 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3661 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3662 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3663 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3664 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3665 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3666 explicitly request this information at any time.
3667
3668 @table @code
3669 @kindex info program
3670 @item info program
3671 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3672 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3673 @end table
3674
3675 @menu
3676 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3677 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3678 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3679 Skipping over functions and files
3680 * Signals:: Signals
3681 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3682 @end menu
3683
3684 @node Breakpoints
3685 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3686
3687 @cindex breakpoints
3688 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3689 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3690 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3691 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3692 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3693 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3694 program.
3695
3696 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3697 the executable is run.
3698
3699 @cindex watchpoints
3700 @cindex data breakpoints
3701 @cindex memory tracing
3702 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3703 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3704 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3705 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3706 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3707 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3708 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3709 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3710 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3711 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3712 same commands.
3713
3714 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3715 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3716 Automatic Display}.
3717
3718 @cindex catchpoints
3719 @cindex breakpoint on events
3720 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3721 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3722 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3723 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3724 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3725 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3726 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3727
3728 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3729 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3730 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3731 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3732 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3733 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3734 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3735 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3736 enable it again.
3737
3738 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3739 @cindex breakpoint lists
3740 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3741 @cindex lists of breakpoints
3742 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a space-separated list of breakpoints
3743 on which to operate. A list element can be either a single breakpoint number,
3744 like @samp{5}, or a range of such numbers, like @samp{5-7}.
3745 When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list
3746 are operated on.
3747
3748 @menu
3749 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3750 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3751 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3752 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3753 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3754 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3755 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3756 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3757 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3758 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3759 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3760 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3761 @end menu
3762
3763 @node Set Breaks
3764 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3765
3766 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3767 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3768 @c
3769 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3770
3771 @kindex break
3772 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3773 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3774 @cindex latest breakpoint
3775 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3776 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3777 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3778 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3779 convenience variables.
3780
3781 @table @code
3782 @item break @var{location}
3783 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3784 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3785 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3786 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3787 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3788
3789 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3790 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3791 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3792 that situation.
3793
3794 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3795 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3796 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3797
3798 @item break
3799 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3800 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3801 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3802 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3803 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3804 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3805 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3806 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3807 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3808 inside loops.
3809
3810 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3811 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3812 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3813 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3814 existed when your program stopped.
3815
3816 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3817 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3818 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3819 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3820 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3821 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3822 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3823
3824 @kindex tbreak
3825 @item tbreak @var{args}
3826 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3827 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3828 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3829 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3830
3831 @kindex hbreak
3832 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3833 @item hbreak @var{args}
3834 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3835 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3836 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3837 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3838 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3839 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3840 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3841 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3842 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3843 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3844 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3845 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3846 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3847 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3848 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3849 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3850 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3851 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3852
3853 @kindex thbreak
3854 @item thbreak @var{args}
3855 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3856 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3857 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3858 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3859 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3860 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3861 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3862 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3863
3864 @kindex rbreak
3865 @cindex regular expression
3866 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3867 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3868 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3869 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3870 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3871 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3872 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3873 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3874 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3875
3876 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3877 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3878 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3879 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3880 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3881 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3882
3883 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3884 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3885 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3886 classes.
3887
3888 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3889 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3890 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3891
3892 @smallexample
3893 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3894 @end smallexample
3895
3896 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3897 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3898 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3899 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3900 every function in a given file:
3901
3902 @smallexample
3903 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3904 @end smallexample
3905
3906 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3907 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3908
3909 @kindex info breakpoints
3910 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3911 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3912 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3913 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3914 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3915 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3916 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3917
3918 @table @emph
3919 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3920 @item Type
3921 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3922 @item Disposition
3923 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3924 @item Enabled or Disabled
3925 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3926 that are not enabled.
3927 @item Address
3928 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3929 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3930 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3931 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3932 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3933 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3934 @item What
3935 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3936 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3937 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3938 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3939 @end table
3940
3941 @noindent
3942 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3943 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3944 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3945 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3946 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3947 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3948
3949 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3950 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3951 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3952 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3953
3954 @noindent
3955 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3956 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3957 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3958 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3959 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3960
3961 @noindent
3962 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3963 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3964 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3965 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3966 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3967 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3968
3969 @noindent
3970 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3971 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3972
3973 @end table
3974
3975 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3976 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3977 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3978 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3979
3980 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3981 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3982 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3983 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3984
3985 @itemize @bullet
3986 @item
3987 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3988
3989 @item
3990 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3991 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3992
3993 @item
3994 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3995 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3996
3997 @item
3998 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3999 several places where that function is inlined.
4000 @end itemize
4001
4002 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
4003 the relevant locations.
4004
4005 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
4006 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
4007 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
4008 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
4009 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
4010 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
4011 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
4012
4013 For example:
4014
4015 @smallexample
4016 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
4017 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
4018 stop only if i==1
4019 breakpoint already hit 1 time
4020 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
4021 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
4022 @end smallexample
4023
4024 You cannot delete the individual locations from a breakpoint. However,
4025 each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
4026 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
4027 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. It's also possible to
4028 @code{enable} and @code{disable} a range of @var{location-number}
4029 locations using a @var{breakpoint-number} and two @var{location-number}s,
4030 in increasing order, separated by a hyphen, like
4031 @kbd{@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number1}-@var{location-number2}},
4032 in which case @value{GDBN} acts on all the locations in the range (inclusive).
4033 Disabling or enabling the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects
4034 all of the locations that belong to that breakpoint.
4035
4036 @cindex pending breakpoints
4037 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
4038 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
4039 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
4040 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
4041 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
4042 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
4043 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
4044 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
4045 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
4046 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
4047 is not yet resolved.
4048
4049 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
4050 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
4051 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
4052 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
4053 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
4054 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
4055
4056 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
4057 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
4058 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
4059 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
4060
4061 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
4062 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
4063 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
4064
4065 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
4066 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
4067 address specification to an address:
4068
4069 @kindex set breakpoint pending
4070 @kindex show breakpoint pending
4071 @table @code
4072 @item set breakpoint pending auto
4073 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
4074 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
4075
4076 @item set breakpoint pending on
4077 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
4078 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
4079
4080 @item set breakpoint pending off
4081 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
4082 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
4083 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
4084
4085 @item show breakpoint pending
4086 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
4087 @end table
4088
4089 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
4090 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
4091 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
4092
4093 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
4094 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
4095 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
4096 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
4097 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
4098 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
4099 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
4100 breakpoints.
4101
4102 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:
4103
4104 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
4105 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
4106 @table @code
4107 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
4108 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
4109 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
4110 breakpoint must be used.
4111
4112 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
4113 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
4114 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
4115 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
4116 @end table
4117
4118 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
4119 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
4120 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
4121 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
4122 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
4123 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
4124 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
4125 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
4126 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
4127
4128 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
4129 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
4130 @table @code
4131 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
4132 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
4133 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
4134 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
4135
4136 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
4137 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
4138 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
4139 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
4140 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
4141 @end table
4142
4143 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
4144 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
4145 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
4146
4147 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
4148 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
4149
4150 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
4151
4152 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
4153 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
4154 @table @code
4155 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
4156 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4157 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4158 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4159 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4160
4161 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4162 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4163 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4164 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4165 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4166 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4167 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4168 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4169 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4170 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4171 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4172 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4173 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4174
4175 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4176 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4177 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4178 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4179 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4180 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4181 @end table
4182
4183
4184 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4185 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4186 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4187 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4188 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4189 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4190 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4191 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4192
4193
4194 @node Set Watchpoints
4195 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4196
4197 @cindex setting watchpoints
4198 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4199 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4200 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4201 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4202 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4203
4204 @itemize @bullet
4205 @item
4206 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4207
4208 @item
4209 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4210 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4211 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4212
4213 @item
4214 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4215 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4216 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4217 @end itemize
4218
4219 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4220 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4221 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4222 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4223 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4224 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4225 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4226 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4227 the expression changes.
4228
4229 @cindex software watchpoints
4230 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4231 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4232 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4233 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4234 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4235 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4236 culprit.)
4237
4238 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4239 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4240 slow down the running of your program.
4241
4242 @table @code
4243 @kindex watch
4244 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4245 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4246 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4247 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4248 to watch the value of a single variable:
4249
4250 @smallexample
4251 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4252 @end smallexample
4253
4254 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4255 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4256 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4257 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4258 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4259 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4260
4261 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4262 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4263 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4264 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4265 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4266 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4267 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4268 error.
4269
4270 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4271 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4272 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4273 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4274 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4275 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4276 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4277 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4278 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4279 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4280 Examples:
4281
4282 @smallexample
4283 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4284 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4285 @end smallexample
4286
4287 @kindex rwatch
4288 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4289 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4290 by the program.
4291
4292 @kindex awatch
4293 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4294 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4295 or written into by the program.
4296
4297 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4298 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4299 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4300 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4301 @end table
4302
4303 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4304 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4305 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4306 a never-changing value:
4307
4308 @smallexample
4309 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4310 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4311 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4312 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4313 @end smallexample
4314
4315 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4316 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4317 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4318 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4319 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4320 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4321
4322 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4323 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4324 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4325 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4326 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4327 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4328 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4329 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4330
4331 @table @code
4332 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4333 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4334 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4335
4336 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4337 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4338 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4339 @end table
4340
4341 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4342 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4343 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4344
4345 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4346
4347 @smallexample
4348 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4349 @end smallexample
4350
4351 @noindent
4352 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4353
4354 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4355 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4356 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4357 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4358 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4359 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4360 will print a message like this:
4361
4362 @smallexample
4363 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4364 @end smallexample
4365
4366 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4367 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4368 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4369 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4370 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4371 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4372 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4373 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4374
4375 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4376 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4377 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4378 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4379 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4380 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4381
4382 @smallexample
4383 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4384 @end smallexample
4385
4386 @noindent
4387 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4388
4389 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4390 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4391 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4392 expression with separately allocated resources.
4393
4394 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4395 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4396 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4397
4398 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4399 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4400 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4401 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4402 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4403 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4404 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4405 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4406 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4407
4408 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4409 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4410 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4411 watched expression from every thread.
4412
4413 @quotation
4414 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4415 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4416 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4417 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4418 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4419 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4420 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4421 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4422 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4423 @end quotation
4424
4425 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4426
4427 @node Set Catchpoints
4428 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4429 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4430 @cindex exception handlers
4431 @cindex event handling
4432
4433 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4434 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4435 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4436
4437 @table @code
4438 @kindex catch
4439 @item catch @var{event}
4440 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4441
4442 @table @code
4443 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4444 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4445 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4446 @kindex catch throw
4447 @kindex catch rethrow
4448 @kindex catch catch
4449 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4450 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4451
4452 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4453 regular expression will be caught.
4454
4455 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4456 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4457 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4458 exception being thrown.
4459
4460 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4461 @value{GDBN}:
4462
4463 @itemize @bullet
4464 @item
4465 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4466 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4467 supported.
4468
4469 @item
4470 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4471 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4472 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4473 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4474 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4475 built.
4476
4477 @item
4478 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4479 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4480
4481 @item
4482 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4483 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4484 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4485 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4486
4487 @item
4488 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4489 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4490 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4491 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4492 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4493 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4494 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4495 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4496 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4497
4498 @item
4499 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4500
4501 @item
4502 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4503 @end itemize
4504
4505 @item exception
4506 @kindex catch exception
4507 @cindex Ada exception catching
4508 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4509 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4510 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4511 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4512 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4513
4514 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4515 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4516 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4517 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4518 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4519 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4520 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4521 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4522
4523 @item handlers
4524 @kindex catch handlers
4525 @cindex Ada exception handlers catching
4526 @cindex catch Ada exceptions when handled
4527 An Ada exception being handled. If an exception name is
4528 specified at the end of the command
4529 (eg @kbd{catch handlers Program_Error}), the debugger will stop
4530 only when this specific exception is handled.
4531 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is handled.
4532
4533 When inserting a handlers catchpoint on a user-defined
4534 exception whose name is identical to one of the exceptions
4535 defined by the language, the fully qualified name must be used
4536 as the exception name. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will assume that it
4537 should stop on the pre-defined exception rather than the
4538 user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception called
4539 @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then the
4540 command to use to catch such exceptions handling is
4541 @kbd{catch handlers Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4542
4543 @item exception unhandled
4544 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4545 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4546
4547 @item assert
4548 @kindex catch assert
4549 A failed Ada assertion.
4550
4551 @item exec
4552 @kindex catch exec
4553 @cindex break on fork/exec
4554 A call to @code{exec}.
4555
4556 @item syscall
4557 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4558 @kindex catch syscall
4559 @cindex break on a system call.
4560 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4561 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4562 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4563 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4564 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4565 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4566 will be caught.
4567
4568 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4569 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4570 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4571 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4572
4573 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4574 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4575 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4576 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4577
4578 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4579 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4580 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4581 available choices.
4582
4583 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4584 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4585 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4586 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4587 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4588 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4589 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4590 behind the OS upgrades).
4591
4592 You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4593 the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
4594 instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4595 network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4596 to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
4597 available in every system. You can use the command completion
4598 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4599 syscall groups available on your environment.
4600
4601 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4602 arguments to it:
4603
4604 @smallexample
4605 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4606 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4607 (@value{GDBP}) r
4608 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4609
4610 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4611 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4612 (@value{GDBP}) c
4613 Continuing.
4614
4615 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4616 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4617 (@value{GDBP})
4618 @end smallexample
4619
4620 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4621
4622 @smallexample
4623 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4624 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4625 (@value{GDBP}) r
4626 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4627
4628 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4629 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4630 (@value{GDBP}) c
4631 Continuing.
4632
4633 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4634 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4635 (@value{GDBP})
4636 @end smallexample
4637
4638 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4639 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4640 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4641
4642 @smallexample
4643 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4644 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4645 (@value{GDBP}) r
4646 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4647
4648 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4649 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4650 (@value{GDBP}) c
4651 Continuing.
4652
4653 Program exited normally.
4654 (@value{GDBP})
4655 @end smallexample
4656
4657 Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4658
4659 @smallexample
4660 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4661 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4662 'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4663 'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4664 (@value{GDBP}) r
4665 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4666
4667 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4668 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4669
4670 (@value{GDBP}) c
4671 Continuing.
4672 @end smallexample
4673
4674 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4675 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4676 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4677 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4678
4679 @smallexample
4680 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4681 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4682 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4683 (@value{GDBP})
4684 @end smallexample
4685
4686 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4687 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4688 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4689 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4690 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4691 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4692
4693 @smallexample
4694 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4695 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4696 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4697 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4698 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4699 (@value{GDBP})
4700 @end smallexample
4701
4702 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4703
4704 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4705 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4706
4707 @smallexample
4708 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4709 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4710 @end smallexample
4711
4712 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4713
4714 @item fork
4715 @kindex catch fork
4716 A call to @code{fork}.
4717
4718 @item vfork
4719 @kindex catch vfork
4720 A call to @code{vfork}.
4721
4722 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4723 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4724 @kindex catch load
4725 @kindex catch unload
4726 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4727 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4728 matches one of the affected libraries.
4729
4730 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4731 @kindex catch signal
4732 The delivery of a signal.
4733
4734 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4735 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4736 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4737
4738 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4739 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4740 signal names.
4741
4742 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4743 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4744 will be caught.
4745
4746 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4747 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4748 catchpoint.
4749
4750 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4751 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4752 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4753 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4754 commands.
4755
4756 @end table
4757
4758 @item tcatch @var{event}
4759 @kindex tcatch
4760 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4761 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4762
4763 @end table
4764
4765 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4766
4767
4768 @node Delete Breaks
4769 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4770
4771 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4772 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4773 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4774 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4775 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4776 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4777
4778 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4779 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4780 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4781 their breakpoint numbers.
4782
4783 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4784 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4785 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4786
4787 @table @code
4788 @kindex clear
4789 @item clear
4790 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4791 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4792 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4793 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4794
4795 @item clear @var{location}
4796 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4797 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4798 most useful ones are listed below:
4799
4800 @table @code
4801 @item clear @var{function}
4802 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4803 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4804
4805 @item clear @var{linenum}
4806 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4807 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4808 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4809 @end table
4810
4811 @cindex delete breakpoints
4812 @kindex delete
4813 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4814 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4815 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4816 list specified as argument. If no argument is specified, delete all
4817 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4818 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4819 @end table
4820
4821 @node Disabling
4822 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4823
4824 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4825 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4826 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4827 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4828 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4829
4830 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4831 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4832 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4833 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4834 do not know which numbers to use.
4835
4836 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4837 affects all of its locations.
4838
4839 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4840 different states of enablement:
4841
4842 @itemize @bullet
4843 @item
4844 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4845 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4846 @item
4847 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4848 @item
4849 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4850 disabled.
4851 @item
4852 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4853 N times, then becomes disabled.
4854 @item
4855 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4856 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4857 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4858 @end itemize
4859
4860 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4861 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4862
4863 @table @code
4864 @kindex disable
4865 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4866 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4867 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4868 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4869 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4870 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4871 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4872
4873 @kindex enable
4874 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4875 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4876 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4877
4878 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{list}@dots{}
4879 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4880 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4881
4882 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{list}@dots{}
4883 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4884 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4885 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4886 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4887 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4888 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4889
4890 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{list}@dots{}
4891 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4892 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4893 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4894 @end table
4895
4896 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4897 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4898 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4899 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4900 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4901 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4902 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4903 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4904 Stepping}.)
4905
4906 @node Conditions
4907 @subsection Break Conditions
4908 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4909 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4910
4911 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4912 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4913 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4914 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4915 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4916 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4917 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4918 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4919
4920 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4921 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4922 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4923 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4924 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4925
4926 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4927 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4928 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4929 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4930 one.
4931
4932 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4933 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4934 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4935 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4936 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4937 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4938 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4939 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4940 conditions for the
4941 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4942 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4943
4944 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4945 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4946 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4947 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4948 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4949 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4950
4951 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4952 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4953 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4954 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4955 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4956
4957 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4958 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4959 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4960 with the @code{condition} command.
4961
4962 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4963 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4964 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4965 catchpoint.
4966
4967 @table @code
4968 @kindex condition
4969 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4970 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4971 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4972 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4973 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4974 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4975 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4976 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4977 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4978 prints an error message:
4979
4980 @smallexample
4981 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4982 @end smallexample
4983
4984 @noindent
4985 @value{GDBN} does
4986 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4987 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4988 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4989
4990 @item condition @var{bnum}
4991 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4992 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4993 @end table
4994
4995 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4996 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4997 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4998 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4999 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
5000 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
5001 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
5002 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
5003 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
5004 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
5005 your program reaches it.
5006
5007 @table @code
5008 @kindex ignore
5009 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
5010 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
5011 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
5012 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
5013 takes no action.
5014
5015 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
5016 a count of zero.
5017
5018 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
5019 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
5020 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
5021 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
5022
5023 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
5024 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
5025 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
5026
5027 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
5028 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
5029 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5030 Variables}.
5031 @end table
5032
5033 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
5034
5035
5036 @node Break Commands
5037 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
5038
5039 @cindex breakpoint commands
5040 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
5041 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
5042 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
5043 enable other breakpoints.
5044
5045 @table @code
5046 @kindex commands
5047 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
5048 @item commands @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5049 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
5050 @itemx end
5051 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
5052 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
5053 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
5054
5055 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
5056 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
5057
5058 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
5059 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
5060 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
5061 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
5062 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
5063 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
5064 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
5065 Expressions}).
5066 @end table
5067
5068 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
5069 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
5070
5071 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
5072 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
5073 that resumes execution.
5074
5075 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
5076 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
5077 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
5078 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
5079 ambiguities about which list to execute.
5080
5081 @kindex silent
5082 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
5083 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
5084 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
5085 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
5086 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
5087 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
5088
5089 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
5090 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
5091 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
5092
5093 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
5094 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
5095
5096 @smallexample
5097 break foo if x>0
5098 commands
5099 silent
5100 printf "x is %d\n",x
5101 cont
5102 end
5103 @end smallexample
5104
5105 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
5106 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
5107 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
5108 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
5109 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
5110 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
5111 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
5112
5113 @smallexample
5114 break 403
5115 commands
5116 silent
5117 set x = y + 4
5118 cont
5119 end
5120 @end smallexample
5121
5122 @node Dynamic Printf
5123 @subsection Dynamic Printf
5124
5125 @cindex dynamic printf
5126 @cindex dprintf
5127 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
5128 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
5129 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
5130 having to recompile it.
5131
5132 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
5133 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
5134 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
5135 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
5136 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
5137 redirects to files and so forth.
5138
5139 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
5140 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
5141 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
5142 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
5143 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
5144 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
5145 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
5146
5147 @table @code
5148 @kindex dprintf
5149 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
5150 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
5151 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
5152 To print several values, separate them with commas.
5153
5154 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
5155 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
5156 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
5157 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
5158 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
5159 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
5160
5161 @table @code
5162 @item gdb
5163 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
5164 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
5165
5166 @item call
5167 @kindex dprintf-style call
5168 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
5169 @code{printf}).
5170
5171 @item agent
5172 @kindex dprintf-style agent
5173 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
5174 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
5175 support running commands on the target.
5176 @end table
5177
5178 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5179 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
5180 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5181 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5182 command.
5183
5184 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5185 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5186 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5187 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5188 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5189 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5190
5191 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5192 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5193 you could do the following:
5194
5195 @example
5196 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
5197 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5198 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5199 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5200 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5201 (gdb) info break
5202 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5203 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5204 continue
5205 (gdb)
5206 @end example
5207
5208 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5209 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5210 the variable settings.
5211
5212 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5213 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5214 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5215 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5216 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5217 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5218
5219 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5220 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5221 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5222
5223 @end table
5224
5225 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5226 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5227 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5228 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5229 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5230 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5231
5232 @node Save Breakpoints
5233 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5234
5235 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5236 breakpoints}} command.
5237
5238 @table @code
5239 @kindex save breakpoints
5240 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5241 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5242 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5243 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5244 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5245 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5246 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5247 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5248 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5249 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5250 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5251 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5252 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5253 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5254 that can no longer be recreated.
5255 @end table
5256
5257 @node Static Probe Points
5258 @subsection Static Probe Points
5259
5260 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5261 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5262 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5263 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5264 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5265
5266 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5267 ELF-compatible systems:
5268
5269 @itemize @bullet
5270
5271 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5272 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5273 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5274 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5275 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5276 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5277 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5278 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5279
5280 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5281 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5282 C@t{++} languages.
5283 @end itemize
5284
5285 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5286 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5287 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5288 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5289 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5290 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5291 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5292 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5293 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5294
5295 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5296 probes}, with optional arguments:
5297
5298 @table @code
5299 @kindex info probes
5300 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5301 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5302 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5303 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5304
5305 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5306 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5307 probes from all providers are listed.
5308
5309 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5310 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5311 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5312
5313 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5314 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5315 given, all object files are considered.
5316
5317 @item info probes all
5318 List the available static probes, from all types.
5319 @end table
5320
5321 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5322 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5323 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5324 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5325 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5326
5327 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5328 commands, with optional arguments:
5329
5330 @table @code
5331 @kindex enable probes
5332 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5333 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5334 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5335 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5336
5337 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5338 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5339 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5340
5341 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5342 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5343 given, all object files are considered.
5344
5345 @kindex disable probes
5346 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5347 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5348 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5349 @end table
5350
5351 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5352 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5353 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5354 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5355 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5356 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5357 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5358 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5359 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5360 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5361 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5362 at the current probe point.
5363
5364 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5365 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5366 an error message.
5367
5368
5369 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5370 @node Error in Breakpoints
5371 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5372
5373 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5374 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5375
5376 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5377 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5378 @smallexample
5379 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5380 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5381 @end smallexample
5382
5383 @noindent
5384 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5385 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5386 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5387
5388 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5389 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5390
5391 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5392 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5393 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5394
5395 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5396 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5397 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5398 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5399
5400 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5401 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5402 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5403 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5404 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5405 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5406 first in the bundle.
5407
5408 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5409 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5410 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5411 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5412 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5413 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5414 is hit.
5415
5416 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5417 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5418
5419 @smallexample
5420 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5421 @end smallexample
5422
5423 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5424 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5425 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5426 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5427 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5428 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5429 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5430 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5431
5432 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5433 adjusted breakpoints:
5434
5435 @smallexample
5436 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5437 to 0x00010410.
5438 @end smallexample
5439
5440 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5441 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5442 frequently than expected.
5443
5444 @node Continuing and Stepping
5445 @section Continuing and Stepping
5446
5447 @cindex stepping
5448 @cindex continuing
5449 @cindex resuming execution
5450 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5451 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5452 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5453 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5454 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5455 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5456 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5457 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5458 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5459 handlers}).)
5460
5461 @table @code
5462 @kindex continue
5463 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5464 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5465 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5466 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5467 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5468 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5469 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5470 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5471 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5472 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5473
5474 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5475 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5476 @code{continue} is ignored.
5477
5478 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5479 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5480 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5481 @code{continue}.
5482 @end table
5483
5484 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5485 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5486 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5487 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5488
5489 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5490 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5491 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5492 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5493 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5494 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5495
5496 @table @code
5497 @kindex step
5498 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5499 @item step
5500 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5501 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5502 abbreviated @code{s}.
5503
5504 @quotation
5505 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5506 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5507 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5508 @c distinction here.
5509 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5510 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5511 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5512 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5513 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5514 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5515 below.
5516 @end quotation
5517
5518 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5519 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5520 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5521 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5522 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5523 called within the line.
5524
5525 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5526 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5527 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5528 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5529 was any debugging information about the routine.
5530
5531 @item step @var{count}
5532 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5533 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5534 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5535
5536 @kindex next
5537 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5538 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5539 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5540 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5541 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5542 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5543 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5544 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5545
5546 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5547
5548
5549 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5550 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5551 @c
5552 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5553 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5554 @c function are executed without stopping.
5555
5556 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5557 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5558 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5559
5560 @kindex set step-mode
5561 @item set step-mode
5562 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5563 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5564 @itemx set step-mode on
5565 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5566 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5567 information rather than stepping over it.
5568
5569 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5570 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5571 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5572
5573 @item set step-mode off
5574 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5575 debug information. This is the default.
5576
5577 @item show step-mode
5578 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5579 source line debug information.
5580
5581 @kindex finish
5582 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5583 @item finish
5584 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5585 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5586 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5587
5588 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5589 ,Returning from a Function}).
5590
5591 @kindex until
5592 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5593 @cindex run until specified location
5594 @item until
5595 @itemx u
5596 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5597 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5598 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5599 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5600 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5601 than the address of the jump.
5602
5603 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5604 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5605 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5606 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5607 through the next iteration.
5608
5609 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5610 stack frame.
5611
5612 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5613 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5614 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5615 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5616 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5617
5618 @smallexample
5619 (@value{GDBP}) f
5620 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5621 206 expand_input();
5622 (@value{GDBP}) until
5623 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5624 @end smallexample
5625
5626 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5627 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5628 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5629 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5630 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5631 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5632 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5633
5634 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5635 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5636 argument.
5637
5638 @item until @var{location}
5639 @itemx u @var{location}
5640 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5641 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5642 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5643 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5644 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5645 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5646 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5647 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5648 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5649 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5650 invocations have returned.
5651
5652 @smallexample
5653 94 int factorial (int value)
5654 95 @{
5655 96 if (value > 1) @{
5656 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5657 98 @}
5658 99 return (value);
5659 100 @}
5660 @end smallexample
5661
5662
5663 @kindex advance @var{location}
5664 @item advance @var{location}
5665 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5666 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5667 @ref{Specify Location}.
5668 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5669 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5670 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5671 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5672
5673
5674 @kindex stepi
5675 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5676 @item stepi
5677 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5678 @itemx si
5679 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5680
5681 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5682 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5683 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5684 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5685
5686 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5687
5688 @need 750
5689 @kindex nexti
5690 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5691 @item nexti
5692 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5693 @itemx ni
5694 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5695 proceed until the function returns.
5696
5697 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5698
5699 @end table
5700
5701 @anchor{range stepping}
5702 @cindex range stepping
5703 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5704 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5705 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5706 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5707 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5708 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5709 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5710 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5711 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5712 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5713 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5714 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5715 if necessary:
5716
5717 @table @code
5718 @kindex set range-stepping
5719 @kindex show range-stepping
5720 @item set range-stepping
5721 @itemx show range-stepping
5722 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5723
5724 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5725 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5726 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5727 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5728 default is @code{on}.
5729
5730 @end table
5731
5732 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5733 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5734 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5735
5736 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5737 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5738 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5739 a particular file when stepping.
5740
5741 For example, consider the following C function:
5742
5743 @smallexample
5744 101 int func()
5745 102 @{
5746 103 foo(boring());
5747 104 bar(boring());
5748 105 @}
5749 @end smallexample
5750
5751 @noindent
5752 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5753 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5754 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5755 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5756
5757 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5758 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5759 is called from many places.
5760
5761 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5762 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5763 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5764 @code{foo}.
5765
5766 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5767 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5768 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5769
5770 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5771 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5772 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5773 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5774 the underlying system.
5775 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5776 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5777
5778 @table @code
5779 @kindex skip
5780 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5781 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5782 that specify what to skip.
5783 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5784
5785 @table @code
5786 @item -file @var{file}
5787 @itemx -fi @var{file}
5788 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5789
5790 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5791 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5792 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5793 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5794 over when stepping.
5795
5796 @smallexample
5797 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5798 @end smallexample
5799
5800 @item -function @var{linespec}
5801 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5802 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5803 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5804 @xref{Specify Location}.
5805
5806 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5807 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5808 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5809 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5810
5811 This form is useful for complex function names.
5812 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5813 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5814 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5815 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5816 regular expression makes this easier.
5817
5818 @smallexample
5819 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5820 @end smallexample
5821
5822 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5823 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5824
5825 @smallexample
5826 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5827 @end smallexample
5828 @end table
5829
5830 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5831 will be skipped.
5832
5833 @kindex skip function
5834 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5835 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5836 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5837 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5838
5839 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5840 will be skipped.
5841
5842 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5843 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5844
5845 @kindex skip file
5846 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5847 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5848 will be skipped over when stepping.
5849
5850 @smallexample
5851 (gdb) skip file boring.c
5852 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5853 @end smallexample
5854
5855 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5856 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5857 @end table
5858
5859 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5860 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5861
5862 @table @code
5863 @kindex info skip
5864 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5865 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5866 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5867 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5868
5869 @table @emph
5870 @item Identifier
5871 A number identifying this skip.
5872 @item Enabled or Disabled
5873 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5874 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5875 @item Glob
5876 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5877 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5878 @item File
5879 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5880 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5881 @item RE
5882 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5883 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5884 @item Function
5885 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5886 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5887 @end table
5888
5889 @kindex skip delete
5890 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5891 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5892 skips.
5893
5894 @kindex skip enable
5895 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5896 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5897 skips.
5898
5899 @kindex skip disable
5900 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5901 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5902 skips.
5903
5904 @kindex set debug skip
5905 @item set debug skip @r{[}on|off@r{]}
5906 Set whether to print the debug output about skipping files and functions.
5907
5908 @kindex show debug skip
5909 @item show debug skip
5910 Show whether the debug output about skipping files and functions is printed.
5911
5912 @end table
5913
5914 @node Signals
5915 @section Signals
5916 @cindex signals
5917
5918 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5919 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5920 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5921 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5922 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5923 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5924 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5925 requested an alarm).
5926
5927 @cindex fatal signals
5928 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5929 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5930 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5931 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5932 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5933 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5934
5935 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5936 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5937 signal.
5938
5939 @cindex handling signals
5940 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5941 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5942 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5943 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5944 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5945
5946 @table @code
5947 @kindex info signals
5948 @kindex info handle
5949 @item info signals
5950 @itemx info handle
5951 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5952 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5953 the defined types of signals.
5954
5955 @item info signals @var{sig}
5956 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5957
5958 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5959
5960 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5961 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5962 for details about this command.
5963
5964 @kindex handle
5965 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5966 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5967 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5968 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5969 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5970 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5971 say what change to make.
5972 @end table
5973
5974 @c @group
5975 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5976 Their full names are:
5977
5978 @table @code
5979 @item nostop
5980 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5981 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5982
5983 @item stop
5984 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5985 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5986
5987 @item print
5988 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5989
5990 @item noprint
5991 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5992 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5993
5994 @item pass
5995 @itemx noignore
5996 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5997 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5998 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5999
6000 @item nopass
6001 @itemx ignore
6002 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
6003 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
6004 @end table
6005 @c @end group
6006
6007 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
6008 program until you
6009 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
6010 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
6011 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
6012 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
6013 program sees that signal when you continue.
6014
6015 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
6016 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
6017 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
6018 erroneous signals.
6019
6020 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
6021 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
6022 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
6023 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
6024 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
6025 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
6026 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
6027 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
6028 Program a Signal}.
6029
6030 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
6031 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
6032
6033 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
6034 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
6035 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
6036 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
6037 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
6038 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
6039 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
6040 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
6041 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
6042 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
6043 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
6044 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
6045 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
6046
6047 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
6048
6049 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
6050 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
6051 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
6052 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
6053
6054 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
6055 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
6056 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
6057 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
6058
6059 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
6060 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
6061
6062 @smallexample
6063 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
6064 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
6065 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
6066 (@value{GDBP}) c
6067 Continuing.
6068
6069 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
6070 main () sigusr1.c:28
6071 28 p = 0;
6072 (@value{GDBP}) si
6073 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6074 9 @{
6075 @end smallexample
6076
6077 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
6078 program to receive the signal first:
6079
6080 @smallexample
6081 (@value{GDBP}) n
6082 28 p = 0;
6083 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
6084 (@value{GDBP}) si
6085 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6086 9 @{
6087 (@value{GDBP})
6088 @end smallexample
6089
6090 @cindex extra signal information
6091 @anchor{extra signal information}
6092
6093 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
6094 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
6095 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
6096 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
6097 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
6098 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
6099 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
6100 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
6101 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
6102 system header.
6103
6104 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
6105 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
6106
6107 @smallexample
6108 @group
6109 (@value{GDBP}) continue
6110 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
6111 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
6112 69 *(int *)p = 0;
6113 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
6114 type = struct @{
6115 int si_signo;
6116 int si_errno;
6117 int si_code;
6118 union @{
6119 int _pad[28];
6120 struct @{...@} _kill;
6121 struct @{...@} _timer;
6122 struct @{...@} _rt;
6123 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
6124 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
6125 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
6126 @} _sifields;
6127 @}
6128 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
6129 type = struct @{
6130 void *si_addr;
6131 @}
6132 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
6133 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
6134 @end group
6135 @end smallexample
6136
6137 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
6138
6139 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
6140 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
6141 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
6142 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
6143 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
6144 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
6145 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
6146 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
6147 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
6148 information is displayed.
6149
6150 The usual output of a segfault is:
6151 @smallexample
6152 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6153 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6154 68 value = *(p + len);
6155 @end smallexample
6156
6157 While a bound violation is presented as:
6158 @smallexample
6159 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6160 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
6161 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
6162 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6163 68 value = *(p + len);
6164 @end smallexample
6165
6166 @node Thread Stops
6167 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
6168
6169 @cindex stopped threads
6170 @cindex threads, stopped
6171
6172 @cindex continuing threads
6173 @cindex threads, continuing
6174
6175 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
6176 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
6177 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
6178 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
6179 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
6180 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
6181 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
6182 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
6183 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
6184
6185 @menu
6186 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
6187 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
6188 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6189 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6190 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6191 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6192 @end menu
6193
6194 @node All-Stop Mode
6195 @subsection All-Stop Mode
6196
6197 @cindex all-stop mode
6198
6199 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6200 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
6201 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6202 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6203 underfoot.
6204
6205 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6206 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6207 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6208
6209 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6210 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6211 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6212 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6213 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6214 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6215 stops.
6216
6217 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6218 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6219 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6220 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6221
6222 @cindex automatic thread selection
6223 @cindex switching threads automatically
6224 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6225 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6226 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6227 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6228 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6229 thread.
6230
6231 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6232 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6233
6234 @table @code
6235 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6236 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6237 @cindex lock scheduler
6238 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6239 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6240 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6241 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6242 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6243 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6244 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6245 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6246 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6247 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6248 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6249 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6250 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6251 @code{on} in replay mode.
6252
6253 @item show scheduler-locking
6254 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6255 @end table
6256
6257 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6258 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6259 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6260 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6261 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6262 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6263 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6264 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6265 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6266 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6267 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6268 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6269 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6270 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6271
6272 @table @code
6273 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6274 @item set schedule-multiple
6275 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6276 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6277 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6278 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6279 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6280 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6281
6282 @item show schedule-multiple
6283 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6284 multiple processes.
6285 @end table
6286
6287 @node Non-Stop Mode
6288 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6289
6290 @cindex non-stop mode
6291
6292 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6293 @c with more details.
6294
6295 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6296 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6297 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6298 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6299 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6300 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6301
6302 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6303 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6304 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6305 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6306 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6307 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6308 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6309 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6310 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6311 independently and simultaneously.
6312
6313 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6314 or attach to your program:
6315
6316 @smallexample
6317 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6318 set pagination off
6319
6320 # Finally, turn it on!
6321 set non-stop on
6322 @end smallexample
6323
6324 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6325
6326 @table @code
6327 @kindex set non-stop
6328 @item set non-stop on
6329 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6330 @item set non-stop off
6331 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6332 @kindex show non-stop
6333 @item show non-stop
6334 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6335 @end table
6336
6337 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6338 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6339 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6340 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6341 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6342 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6343 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6344 default.
6345
6346 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6347 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6348 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6349
6350 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6351 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6352 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6353 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6354 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6355
6356 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6357 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6358 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6359 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6360 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6361
6362 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6363
6364 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6365 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6366 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6367 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6368 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6369 previously current thread.
6370
6371 @node Background Execution
6372 @subsection Background Execution
6373
6374 @cindex foreground execution
6375 @cindex background execution
6376 @cindex asynchronous execution
6377 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6378
6379 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6380 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6381 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6382 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6383 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6384 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6385
6386 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6387 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6388
6389 @cindex @code{&}, background execution of commands
6390 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6391 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6392 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6393 are:
6394
6395 @table @code
6396 @kindex run&
6397 @item run
6398 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6399
6400 @item attach
6401 @kindex attach&
6402 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6403
6404 @item step
6405 @kindex step&
6406 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6407
6408 @item stepi
6409 @kindex stepi&
6410 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6411
6412 @item next
6413 @kindex next&
6414 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6415
6416 @item nexti
6417 @kindex nexti&
6418 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6419
6420 @item continue
6421 @kindex continue&
6422 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6423
6424 @item finish
6425 @kindex finish&
6426 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6427
6428 @item until
6429 @kindex until&
6430 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6431
6432 @end table
6433
6434 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6435 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6436 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6437 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6438 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6439 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6440
6441 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6442 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6443
6444 @table @code
6445 @kindex interrupt
6446 @item interrupt
6447 @itemx interrupt -a
6448
6449 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6450 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6451 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6452 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6453 @end table
6454
6455 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6456 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6457
6458 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6459 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6460 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6461
6462 @table @code
6463 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6464 @cindex thread breakpoints
6465 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6466 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6467 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6468 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6469 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6470 specify some source line.
6471
6472 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6473 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6474 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6475 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6476 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6477
6478 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6479 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6480 program.
6481
6482 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6483 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6484 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6485
6486 @smallexample
6487 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6488 @end smallexample
6489
6490 @end table
6491
6492 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6493 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6494 thread list. For example:
6495
6496 @smallexample
6497 (@value{GDBP}) c
6498 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6499 @end smallexample
6500
6501 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6502 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6503 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6504 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6505 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6506 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6507 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6508 command.
6509
6510 @node Interrupted System Calls
6511 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6512
6513 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6514 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6515 @cindex premature return from system calls
6516 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6517 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6518 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6519 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6520 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6521 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6522 stop execution.
6523
6524 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6525 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6526 style anyways.
6527
6528 For example, do not write code like this:
6529
6530 @smallexample
6531 sleep (10);
6532 @end smallexample
6533
6534 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6535 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6536
6537 Instead, write this:
6538
6539 @smallexample
6540 int unslept = 10;
6541 while (unslept > 0)
6542 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6543 @end smallexample
6544
6545 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6546 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6547 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6548 @value{GDBN}.
6549
6550 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6551 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6552 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6553 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6554
6555 @node Observer Mode
6556 @subsection Observer Mode
6557
6558 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6559 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6560 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6561 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6562 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6563
6564 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6565 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6566 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6567 mode.
6568
6569 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6570 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6571 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6572 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6573 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6574
6575 @table @code
6576
6577 @kindex observer
6578 @item set observer on
6579 @itemx set observer off
6580 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6581 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6582 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6583 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6584
6585 @item show observer
6586 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6587
6588 @kindex may-write-registers
6589 @item set may-write-registers on
6590 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6591 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6592 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6593 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6594
6595 @item show may-write-registers
6596 Show the current permission to write registers.
6597
6598 @kindex may-write-memory
6599 @item set may-write-memory on
6600 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6601 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6602 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6603 defaults to @code{on}.
6604
6605 @item show may-write-memory
6606 Show the current permission to write memory.
6607
6608 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6609 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6610 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6611 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6612 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6613 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6614
6615 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6616 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6617
6618 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6619 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6620 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6621 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6622 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6623 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6624 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6625
6626 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6627 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6628
6629 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6630 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6631 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6632 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6633 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6634 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6635 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6636
6637 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6638 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6639
6640 @kindex may-interrupt
6641 @item set may-interrupt on
6642 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6643 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6644 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6645 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6646 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6647
6648 @item show may-interrupt
6649 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6650
6651 @end table
6652
6653 @node Reverse Execution
6654 @chapter Running programs backward
6655 @cindex reverse execution
6656 @cindex running programs backward
6657
6658 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6659 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6660 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6661 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6662
6663 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6664 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6665 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6666 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6667 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6668 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6669
6670 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6671 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6672 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6673 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6674 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6675 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6676 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6677 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6678 prior values@footnote{
6679 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6680 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6681 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6682
6683 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6684 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6685 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6686 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6687 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6688 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6689 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6690 }.
6691
6692 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6693 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6694
6695 @table @code
6696 @kindex reverse-continue
6697 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6698 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6699 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6700 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6701 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6702 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6703 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6704
6705 @kindex reverse-step
6706 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6707 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6708 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6709 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6710
6711 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6712 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6713 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6714 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6715 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6716 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6717
6718 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6719 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6720
6721 @kindex reverse-stepi
6722 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6723 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6724 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6725 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6726 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6727 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6728 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6729
6730 @kindex reverse-next
6731 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6732 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6733 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6734 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6735 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6736 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6737 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6738 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6739 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6740 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6741
6742 @kindex reverse-nexti
6743 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6744 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6745 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6746 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6747 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6748 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6749 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6750 frame) is reached.
6751
6752 @kindex reverse-finish
6753 @item reverse-finish
6754 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6755 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6756 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6757 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6758
6759 @kindex set exec-direction
6760 @item set exec-direction
6761 Set the direction of target execution.
6762 @item set exec-direction reverse
6763 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6764 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6765 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6766 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6767 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6768 @item set exec-direction forward
6769 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6770 This is the default.
6771 @end table
6772
6773
6774 @node Process Record and Replay
6775 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6776 @cindex process record and replay
6777 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6778
6779 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6780 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6781 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6782
6783 @cindex replay mode
6784 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6785 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6786 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6787 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6788 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6789 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6790 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6791 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6792 execution log.
6793
6794 @cindex record mode
6795 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6796 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6797 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6798 for future replay.
6799
6800 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6801 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6802 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6803 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6804 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6805 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6806
6807 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6808 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6809 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6810 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6811
6812 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6813 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6814
6815 @table @code
6816 @kindex target record
6817 @kindex target record-full
6818 @kindex target record-btrace
6819 @kindex record
6820 @kindex record full
6821 @kindex record btrace
6822 @kindex record btrace bts
6823 @kindex record btrace pt
6824 @kindex record bts
6825 @kindex record pt
6826 @kindex rec
6827 @kindex rec full
6828 @kindex rec btrace
6829 @kindex rec btrace bts
6830 @kindex rec btrace pt
6831 @kindex rec bts
6832 @kindex rec pt
6833 @item record @var{method}
6834 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6835 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6836 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6837 recording methods are available:
6838
6839 @table @code
6840 @item full
6841 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6842 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6843 execution.
6844
6845 @item btrace @var{format}
6846 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6847 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6848 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6849 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6850 execution. In remote debugging, recording continues on disconnect.
6851 Recorded data can be inspected after reconnecting. The recording may
6852 be stopped using @code{record stop}.
6853
6854 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6855 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6856 formats are available:
6857
6858 @table @code
6859 @item bts
6860 @cindex branch trace store
6861 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6862 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6863 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6864
6865 @item pt
6866 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6867 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6868 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6869 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6870
6871 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6872 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6873 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6874
6875 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6876 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6877 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6878 buffer-size with care.
6879 @end table
6880
6881 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6882 @end table
6883
6884 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6885 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6886 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6887 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6888
6889 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6890 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6891 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6892 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6893 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6894
6895 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6896 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6897 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6898 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6899 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6900 does not support these two modes.
6901
6902 @kindex record stop
6903 @kindex rec s
6904 @item record stop
6905 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6906 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6907 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6908
6909 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6910 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6911 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6912 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6913 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6914
6915 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6916 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6917 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6918 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6919 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6920
6921 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6922 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6923
6924 @kindex record goto
6925 @item record goto
6926 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6927 ways to specify the location to go to:
6928
6929 @table @code
6930 @item record goto begin
6931 @itemx record goto start
6932 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6933
6934 @item record goto end
6935 Go to the end of the execution log.
6936
6937 @item record goto @var{n}
6938 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6939 @end table
6940
6941 @kindex record save
6942 @item record save @var{filename}
6943 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6944 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6945 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6946
6947 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6948
6949 @kindex record restore
6950 @item record restore @var{filename}
6951 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6952 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6953
6954 @kindex set record full
6955 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6956 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6957 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6958 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6959
6960 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6961 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6962 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6963 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6964 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6965 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6966 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6967 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6968
6969 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6970 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6971 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6972
6973 @kindex show record full
6974 @item show record full insn-number-max
6975 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6976 recording method.
6977
6978 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6979 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6980 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6981 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6982 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6983 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6984 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6985 oldest one to be deleted.
6986
6987 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6988 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6989
6990 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6991 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6992
6993 @item set record full memory-query
6994 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6995 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6996 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6997 case.
6998
6999 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
7000 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
7001 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
7002 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
7003 results.
7004
7005 @item show record full memory-query
7006 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
7007
7008 @kindex set record btrace
7009 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
7010 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
7011 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
7012 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
7013 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
7014 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
7015 You can use the following command for that:
7016
7017 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
7018 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
7019 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
7020 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
7021 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
7022 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
7023 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
7024 position.
7025
7026 @item set record btrace cpu @var{identifier}
7027 Set the processor to be used for enabling workarounds for processor
7028 errata when decoding the trace.
7029
7030 Processor errata are defects in processor operation, caused by its
7031 design or manufacture. They can cause a trace not to match the
7032 specification. This, in turn, may cause trace decode to fail.
7033 @value{GDBN} can detect erroneous trace packets and correct them, thus
7034 avoiding the decoding failures. These corrections are known as
7035 @dfn{errata workarounds}, and are enabled based on the processor on
7036 which the trace was recorded.
7037
7038 By default, @value{GDBN} attempts to detect the processor
7039 automatically, and apply the necessary workarounds for it. However,
7040 you may need to specify the processor if @value{GDBN} does not yet
7041 support it. This command allows you to do that, and also allows to
7042 disable the workarounds.
7043
7044 The argument @var{identifier} identifies the @sc{cpu} and is of the
7045 form: @code{@var{vendor}:@var{procesor identifier}}. In addition,
7046 there are two special identifiers, @code{none} and @code{auto}
7047 (default).
7048
7049 The following vendor identifiers and corresponding processor
7050 identifiers are currently supported:
7051
7052 @multitable @columnfractions .1 .9
7053
7054 @item @code{intel}
7055 @tab @var{family}/@var{model}[/@var{stepping}]
7056
7057 @end multitable
7058
7059 On GNU/Linux systems, the processor @var{family}, @var{model}, and
7060 @var{stepping} can be obtained from @code{/proc/cpuinfo}.
7061
7062 If @var{identifier} is @code{auto}, enable errata workarounds for the
7063 processor on which the trace was recorded. If @var{identifier} is
7064 @code{none}, errata workarounds are disabled.
7065
7066 For example, when using an old @value{GDBN} on a new system, decode
7067 may fail because @value{GDBN} does not support the new processor. It
7068 often suffices to specify an older processor that @value{GDBN}
7069 supports.
7070
7071 @smallexample
7072 (gdb) info record
7073 Active record target: record-btrace
7074 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7075 Buffer size: 16kB.
7076 Failed to configure the Intel Processor Trace decoder: unknown cpu.
7077 (gdb) set record btrace cpu intel:6/158
7078 (gdb) info record
7079 Active record target: record-btrace
7080 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7081 Buffer size: 16kB.
7082 Recorded 84872 instructions in 3189 functions (0 gaps) for thread 1 (...).
7083 @end smallexample
7084
7085 @kindex show record btrace
7086 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
7087 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
7088
7089 @item show record btrace cpu
7090 Show the processor to be used for enabling trace decode errata
7091 workarounds.
7092
7093 @kindex set record btrace bts
7094 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7095 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
7096 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
7097 format. Default is 64KB.
7098
7099 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7100 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7101 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
7102 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
7103 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
7104 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
7105 the @acronym{BTS} format.
7106
7107 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7108 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7109
7110 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7111 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7112
7113 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7114 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7115 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
7116
7117 @kindex set record btrace pt
7118 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7119 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
7120 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
7121 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
7122
7123 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7124 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7125 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
7126 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
7127 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
7128 actual buffer size for each thread.
7129
7130 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7131 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7132
7133 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7134 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7135
7136 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7137 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7138 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
7139
7140 @kindex info record
7141 @item info record
7142 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
7143 method:
7144
7145 @table @code
7146 @item full
7147 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
7148 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
7149
7150 @itemize @bullet
7151 @item
7152 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7153 @item
7154 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
7155 @item
7156 Highest recorded instruction number.
7157 @item
7158 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
7159 @item
7160 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
7161 @item
7162 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
7163 @end itemize
7164
7165 @item btrace
7166 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
7167
7168 @itemize @bullet
7169 @item
7170 Recording format.
7171 @item
7172 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
7173 @item
7174 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
7175 instructions.
7176 @item
7177 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7178 @end itemize
7179
7180 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
7181 @itemize @bullet
7182 @item
7183 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7184 @end itemize
7185
7186 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
7187 @itemize @bullet
7188 @item
7189 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7190 @end itemize
7191 @end table
7192
7193 @kindex record delete
7194 @kindex rec del
7195 @item record delete
7196 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
7197 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
7198 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
7199 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
7200
7201 @kindex record instruction-history
7202 @kindex rec instruction-history
7203 @item record instruction-history
7204 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
7205 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
7206 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
7207 are printed in execution order.
7208
7209 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
7210 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
7211 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
7212
7213 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
7214 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
7215 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
7216 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
7217 @code{/p} modifier.
7218
7219 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
7220 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
7221 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
7222
7223 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
7224 feature is not available for all recording formats.
7225
7226 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
7227 disassemble:
7228
7229 @table @code
7230 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
7231 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
7232 @var{insn}.
7233
7234 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
7235 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
7236 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
7237 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
7238 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
7239 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
7240
7241 @item record instruction-history
7242 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
7243
7244 @item record instruction-history -
7245 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
7246
7247 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7248 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
7249 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
7250 number @var{end} is included.
7251 @end table
7252
7253 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7254
7255 @kindex set record
7256 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7257 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7258 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7259 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
7260 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7261
7262 @kindex show record
7263 @item show record instruction-history-size
7264 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7265 instruction-history} command.
7266
7267 @kindex record function-call-history
7268 @kindex rec function-call-history
7269 @item record function-call-history
7270 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7271 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7272 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7273 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7274 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7275 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
7276 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7277 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7278 given together.
7279
7280 @smallexample
7281 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7282 1 void foo (void)
7283 2 @{
7284 3 @}
7285 4
7286 5 void bar (void)
7287 6 @{
7288 7 ...
7289 8 foo ();
7290 9 ...
7291 10 @}
7292 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7293 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7294 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7295 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7296 @end smallexample
7297
7298 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7299 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7300 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7301 to print:
7302
7303 @table @code
7304 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7305 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7306
7307 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7308 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7309 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7310 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7311 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7312
7313 @item record function-call-history
7314 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7315
7316 @item record function-call-history -
7317 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7318
7319 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7320 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7321 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7322 @end table
7323
7324 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7325
7326 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7327 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7328 Define how many lines to print in the
7329 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7330 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7331
7332 @item show record function-call-history-size
7333 Show how many lines to print in the
7334 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7335 @end table
7336
7337
7338 @node Stack
7339 @chapter Examining the Stack
7340
7341 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7342 stopped and how it got there.
7343
7344 @cindex call stack
7345 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7346 is generated.
7347 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7348 the arguments of the call,
7349 and the local variables of the function being called.
7350 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7351 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7352 stack}.
7353
7354 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7355 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7356
7357 @cindex selected frame
7358 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7359 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7360 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7361 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7362 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7363 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7364
7365 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7366 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7367 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7368
7369 @menu
7370 * Frames:: Stack frames
7371 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7372 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7373 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7374 * Frame Apply:: Applying a command to several frames
7375 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7376
7377 @end menu
7378
7379 @node Frames
7380 @section Stack Frames
7381
7382 @cindex frame, definition
7383 @cindex stack frame
7384 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7385 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7386 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7387 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7388 which the function is executing.
7389
7390 @cindex initial frame
7391 @cindex outermost frame
7392 @cindex innermost frame
7393 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7394 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7395 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7396 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7397 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7398 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7399 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7400 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7401
7402 @cindex frame pointer
7403 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7404 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7405 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7406 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7407 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7408 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7409
7410 @cindex frame level
7411 @cindex frame number
7412 @value{GDBN} labels each existing stack frame with a @dfn{level}, a
7413 number that is zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that
7414 called it, and so on upward. These level numbers give you a way of
7415 designating stack frames in @value{GDBN} commands. The terms
7416 @dfn{frame number} and @dfn{frame level} can be used interchangeably to
7417 describe this number.
7418
7419 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7420 @c underflow problems.
7421 @cindex frameless execution
7422 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7423 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7424 @smallexample
7425 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7426 @end smallexample
7427 generates functions without a frame.)
7428 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7429 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7430 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7431 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7432 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7433 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7434 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7435
7436 @node Backtrace
7437 @section Backtraces
7438
7439 @cindex traceback
7440 @cindex call stack traces
7441 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7442 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7443 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7444 stack.
7445
7446 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7447 @kindex backtrace
7448 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7449 To print a backtrace of the entire stack, use the @code{backtrace}
7450 command, or its alias @code{bt}. This command will print one line per
7451 frame for frames in the stack. By default, all stack frames are
7452 printed. You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system
7453 interrupt character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7454
7455 @table @code
7456 @item backtrace [@var{args}@dots{}]
7457 @itemx bt [@var{args}@dots{}]
7458 Print the backtrace of the entire stack. The optional @var{args} can
7459 be one of the following:
7460
7461 @table @code
7462 @item @var{n}
7463 @itemx @var{n}
7464 Print only the innermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7465 number.
7466
7467 @item -@var{n}
7468 @itemx -@var{n}
7469 Print only the outermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7470 number.
7471
7472 @item full
7473 Print the values of the local variables also. This can be combined
7474 with a number to limit the number of frames shown.
7475
7476 @item no-filters
7477 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7478 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7479 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7480 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7481 support.
7482
7483 @item hide
7484 A Python frame filter might decide to ``elide'' some frames. Normally
7485 such elided frames are still printed, but they are indented relative
7486 to the filtered frames that cause them to be elided. The @code{hide}
7487 option causes elided frames to not be printed at all.
7488 @end table
7489 @end table
7490
7491 @kindex where
7492 @kindex info stack
7493 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7494 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7495
7496 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7497 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7498 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7499 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7500 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7501 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7502 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7503 multi-threaded program.
7504
7505 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7506 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7507 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7508 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7509 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7510 line number.
7511
7512 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7513 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7514
7515 @smallexample
7516 @group
7517 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7518 at builtin.c:993
7519 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7520 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7521 at macro.c:71
7522 (More stack frames follow...)
7523 @end group
7524 @end smallexample
7525
7526 @noindent
7527 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7528 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7529 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7530
7531 @noindent
7532 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7533 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7534 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7535 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7536 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7537
7538 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7539 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7540 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7541 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7542 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7543 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7544 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7545 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7546 such a backtrace might look like:
7547
7548 @smallexample
7549 @group
7550 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7551 at builtin.c:993
7552 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7553 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7554 at macro.c:71
7555 (More stack frames follow...)
7556 @end group
7557 @end smallexample
7558
7559 @noindent
7560 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7561 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7562
7563 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7564 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7565 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7566
7567 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7568 @cindex program entry point
7569 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7570 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7571 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7572 @code{main}@footnote{
7573 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7574 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7575 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7576 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7577 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7578 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7579
7580 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7581 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7582
7583 @table @code
7584 @item set backtrace past-main
7585 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7586 @kindex set backtrace
7587 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7588
7589 @item set backtrace past-main off
7590 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7591 default.
7592
7593 @item show backtrace past-main
7594 @kindex show backtrace
7595 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7596
7597 @item set backtrace past-entry
7598 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7599 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7600 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7601 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7602
7603 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7604 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7605 application. This is the default.
7606
7607 @item show backtrace past-entry
7608 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7609
7610 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7611 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7612 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7613 @cindex backtrace limit
7614 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7615 or zero means unlimited levels.
7616
7617 @item show backtrace limit
7618 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7619 @end table
7620
7621 You can control how file names are displayed.
7622
7623 @table @code
7624 @item set filename-display
7625 @itemx set filename-display relative
7626 @cindex filename-display
7627 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7628
7629 @item set filename-display basename
7630 Display only basename of a filename.
7631
7632 @item set filename-display absolute
7633 Display an absolute filename.
7634
7635 @item show filename-display
7636 Show the current way to display filenames.
7637 @end table
7638
7639 @node Selection
7640 @section Selecting a Frame
7641
7642 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7643 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7644 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7645 of the stack frame just selected.
7646
7647 @table @code
7648 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7649 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7650 @item frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7651 @item f @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7652 The @command{frame} command allows different stack frames to be
7653 selected. The @var{frame-selection-spec} can be any of the following:
7654
7655 @table @code
7656 @kindex frame level
7657 @item @var{num}
7658 @item level @var{num}
7659 Select frame level @var{num}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7660 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7661 innermost one, and so on. The highest level frame is usually the one
7662 for @code{main}.
7663
7664 As this is the most common method of navigating the frame stack, the
7665 string @command{level} can be omitted. For example, the following two
7666 commands are equivalent:
7667
7668 @smallexample
7669 (@value{GDBP}) frame 3
7670 (@value{GDBP}) frame level 3
7671 @end smallexample
7672
7673 @kindex frame address
7674 @item address @var{stack-address}
7675 Select the frame with stack address @var{stack-address}. The
7676 @var{stack-address} for a frame can be seen in the output of
7677 @command{info frame}, for example:
7678
7679 @smallexample
7680 (gdb) info frame
7681 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
7682 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
7683 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
7684 source language c++.
7685 Arglist at unknown address.
7686 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
7687 @end smallexample
7688
7689 The @var{stack-address} for this frame is @code{0x7fffffffda30} as
7690 indicated by the line:
7691
7692 @smallexample
7693 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
7694 @end smallexample
7695
7696 @kindex frame function
7697 @item function @var{function-name}
7698 Select the stack frame for function @var{function-name}. If there are
7699 multiple stack frames for function @var{function-name} then the inner
7700 most stack frame is selected.
7701
7702 @kindex frame view
7703 @item view @var{stack-address} @r{[} @var{pc-addr} @r{]}
7704 View a frame that is not part of @value{GDBN}'s backtrace. The frame
7705 viewed has stack address @var{stack-addr}, and optionally, a program
7706 counter address of @var{pc-addr}.
7707
7708 This is useful mainly if the chaining of stack frames has been
7709 damaged by a bug, making it impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign
7710 numbers properly to all frames. In addition, this can be useful
7711 when your program has multiple stacks and switches between them.
7712
7713 When viewing a frame outside the current backtrace using
7714 @command{frame view} then you can always return to the original
7715 stack using one of the previous stack frame selection instructions,
7716 for example @command{frame level 0}.
7717
7718 @end table
7719
7720 @kindex up
7721 @item up @var{n}
7722 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7723 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7724 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7725
7726 @kindex down
7727 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7728 @item down @var{n}
7729 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7730 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7731 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7732 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7733 @end table
7734
7735 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7736 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7737 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7738 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7739
7740 @need 1000
7741 For example:
7742
7743 @smallexample
7744 @group
7745 (@value{GDBP}) up
7746 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7747 at env.c:10
7748 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7749 @end group
7750 @end smallexample
7751
7752 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7753 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7754 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7755 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7756 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7757 for details.
7758
7759 @table @code
7760 @kindex select-frame
7761 @item select-frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7762 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7763 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7764 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7765 output might be unnecessary and distracting. The
7766 @var{frame-selection-spec} is as for the @command{frame} command
7767 described in @ref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7768
7769 @kindex down-silently
7770 @kindex up-silently
7771 @item up-silently @var{n}
7772 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7773 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7774 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7775 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7776 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7777 distracting.
7778 @end table
7779
7780 @node Frame Info
7781 @section Information About a Frame
7782
7783 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7784 stack frame.
7785
7786 @table @code
7787 @item frame
7788 @itemx f
7789 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7790 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7791 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7792 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7793 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7794
7795 @kindex info frame
7796 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7797 @item info frame
7798 @itemx info f
7799 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7800 including:
7801
7802 @itemize @bullet
7803 @item
7804 the address of the frame
7805 @item
7806 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7807 @item
7808 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7809 @item
7810 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7811 @item
7812 the address of the frame's arguments
7813 @item
7814 the address of the frame's local variables
7815 @item
7816 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7817 @item
7818 which registers were saved in the frame
7819 @end itemize
7820
7821 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7822 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7823 the usual conventions.
7824
7825 @item info frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7826 @itemx info f @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7827 Print a verbose description of the frame selected by
7828 @var{frame-selection-spec}. The @var{frame-selection-spec} is the
7829 same as for the @command{frame} command (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting
7830 a Frame}). The selected frame remains unchanged by this command.
7831
7832 @kindex info args
7833 @item info args [-q]
7834 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7835
7836 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
7837 printing header information and messages explaining why no argument
7838 have been printed.
7839
7840 @item info args [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
7841 Like @kbd{info args}, but only print the arguments selected
7842 with the provided regexp(s).
7843
7844 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the arguments whose names
7845 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
7846
7847 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the arguments whose
7848 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
7849 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
7850 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
7851 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
7852 of special characters or quotes.
7853
7854 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, an argument
7855 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
7856 @var{type_regexp}.
7857
7858 @item info locals [-q]
7859 @kindex info locals
7860 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7861 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7862 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7863
7864 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
7865 printing header information and messages explaining why no local variables
7866 have been printed.
7867
7868 @item info locals [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
7869 Like @kbd{info locals}, but only print the local variables selected
7870 with the provided regexp(s).
7871
7872 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the local variables whose names
7873 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
7874
7875 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the local variables whose
7876 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
7877 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
7878 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
7879 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
7880 of special characters or quotes.
7881
7882 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, a local variable
7883 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
7884 @var{type_regexp}.
7885
7886 The command @kbd{info locals -q -t @var{type_regexp}} can usefully be
7887 combined with the commands @kbd{frame apply} and @kbd{thread apply}.
7888 For example, your program might use Resource Acquisition Is
7889 Initialization types (RAII) such as @code{lock_something_t}: each
7890 local variable of type @code{lock_something_t} automatically places a
7891 lock that is destroyed when the variable goes out of scope. You can
7892 then list all acquired locks in your program by doing
7893 @smallexample
7894 thread apply all -s frame apply all -s info locals -q -t lock_something_t
7895 @end smallexample
7896 @noindent
7897 or the equivalent shorter form
7898 @smallexample
7899 tfaas i lo -q -t lock_something_t
7900 @end smallexample
7901
7902 @end table
7903
7904 @node Frame Apply
7905 @section Applying a Command to Several Frames.
7906 @kindex frame apply
7907 @cindex apply command to several frames
7908 @table @code
7909 @item frame apply [all | @var{count} | @var{-count} | level @var{level}@dots{}] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
7910 The @code{frame apply} command allows you to apply the named
7911 @var{command} to one or more frames.
7912
7913 @table @code
7914 @item @code{all}
7915 Specify @code{all} to apply @var{command} to all frames.
7916
7917 @item @var{count}
7918 Use @var{count} to apply @var{command} to the innermost @var{count}
7919 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
7920
7921 @item @var{-count}
7922 Use @var{-count} to apply @var{command} to the outermost @var{count}
7923 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
7924
7925 @item @code{level}
7926 Use @code{level} to apply @var{command} to the set of frames identified
7927 by the @var{level} list. @var{level} is a frame level or a range of frame
7928 levels as @var{level1}-@var{level2}. The frame level is the number shown
7929 in the first field of the @samp{backtrace} command output.
7930 E.g., @samp{2-4 6-8 3} indicates to apply @var{command} for the frames
7931 at levels 2, 3, 4, 6, 7, 8, and then again on frame at level 3.
7932
7933 @end table
7934
7935 @end table
7936
7937 Note that the frames on which @code{frame apply} applies a command are
7938 also influenced by the @code{set backtrace} settings such as @code{set
7939 backtrace past-main} and @code{set backtrace limit N}. See
7940 @xref{Backtrace,,Backtraces}.
7941
7942 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to handle
7943 errors raised when applying @var{command} to a frame. @var{flag}
7944 must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter in
7945 @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
7946 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
7947
7948 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some frame information before the
7949 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
7950 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{frame apply}. The
7951 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
7952
7953 @table @code
7954 @item -c
7955 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
7956 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
7957 @code{frame apply} then continues.
7958 @item -s
7959 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
7960 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
7961 That is, the execution continues, but the frame information and errors
7962 are not printed.
7963 @item -q
7964 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the frame
7965 information.
7966 @end table
7967
7968 The following example shows how the flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} are
7969 working when applying the command @code{p j} to all frames, where
7970 variable @code{j} can only be successfully printed in the outermost
7971 @code{#1 main} frame.
7972
7973 @smallexample
7974 @group
7975 (gdb) frame apply all p j
7976 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7977 No symbol "j" in current context.
7978 (gdb) frame apply all -c p j
7979 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7980 No symbol "j" in current context.
7981 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7982 $1 = 5
7983 (gdb) frame apply all -s p j
7984 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7985 $2 = 5
7986 (gdb)
7987 @end group
7988 @end smallexample
7989
7990 By default, @samp{frame apply}, prints the frame location
7991 information before the command output:
7992
7993 @smallexample
7994 @group
7995 (gdb) frame apply all p $sp
7996 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7997 $4 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
7998 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7999 $5 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
8000 (gdb)
8001 @end group
8002 @end smallexample
8003
8004 If flag @code{-q} is given, no frame information is printed:
8005 @smallexample
8006 @group
8007 (gdb) frame apply all -q p $sp
8008 $12 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
8009 $13 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
8010 (gdb)
8011 @end group
8012 @end smallexample
8013
8014 @table @code
8015
8016 @kindex faas
8017 @cindex apply a command to all frames (ignoring errors and empty output)
8018 @item faas @var{command}
8019 Shortcut for @code{frame apply all -s @var{command}}.
8020 Applies @var{command} on all frames, ignoring errors and empty output.
8021
8022 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
8023 argument without knowing the frame where this variable or argument
8024 is, using:
8025 @smallexample
8026 (@value{GDBP}) faas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
8027 @end smallexample
8028
8029 Note that the command @code{tfaas @var{command}} applies @var{command}
8030 on all frames of all threads. See @xref{Threads,,Threads}.
8031 @end table
8032
8033
8034 @node Frame Filter Management
8035 @section Management of Frame Filters.
8036 @cindex managing frame filters
8037
8038 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
8039 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
8040
8041 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
8042 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
8043
8044 @table @code
8045 @kindex info frame-filter
8046 @item info frame-filter
8047 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
8048 their name, priority and enabled status.
8049
8050 @kindex disable frame-filter
8051 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
8052 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8053 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8054 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
8055 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
8056 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8057 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
8058 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
8059 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
8060 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
8061 may be enabled again later.
8062
8063 @kindex enable frame-filter
8064 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8065 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8066 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
8067 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
8068 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8069 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
8070 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
8071 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
8072 @var{filter-dictionary}.
8073
8074 Example:
8075
8076 @smallexample
8077 (gdb) info frame-filter
8078
8079 global frame-filters:
8080 Priority Enabled Name
8081 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
8082 100 Yes Reverse
8083
8084 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8085 Priority Enabled Name
8086 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8087
8088 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8089 Priority Enabled Name
8090 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
8091
8092 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
8093 (gdb) info frame-filter
8094
8095 global frame-filters:
8096 Priority Enabled Name
8097 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
8098 100 Yes Reverse
8099
8100 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8101 Priority Enabled Name
8102 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8103
8104 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8105 Priority Enabled Name
8106 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8107
8108 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
8109 (gdb) info frame-filter
8110
8111 global frame-filters:
8112 Priority Enabled Name
8113 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8114 100 Yes Reverse
8115
8116 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8117 Priority Enabled Name
8118 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8119
8120 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8121 Priority Enabled Name
8122 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8123 @end smallexample
8124
8125 @kindex set frame-filter priority
8126 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
8127 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8128 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8129 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8130 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8131 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
8132
8133 @kindex show frame-filter priority
8134 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8135 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8136 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8137 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8138 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8139 dictionary resides.
8140
8141 Example:
8142
8143 @smallexample
8144 (gdb) info frame-filter
8145
8146 global frame-filters:
8147 Priority Enabled Name
8148 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8149 100 Yes Reverse
8150
8151 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8152 Priority Enabled Name
8153 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8154
8155 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8156 Priority Enabled Name
8157 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8158
8159 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
8160 (gdb) info frame-filter
8161
8162 global frame-filters:
8163 Priority Enabled Name
8164 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8165 50 Yes Reverse
8166
8167 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8168 Priority Enabled Name
8169 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8170
8171 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8172 Priority Enabled Name
8173 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8174 @end smallexample
8175 @end table
8176
8177 @node Source
8178 @chapter Examining Source Files
8179
8180 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
8181 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
8182 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
8183 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
8184 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
8185 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
8186 source files by explicit command.
8187
8188 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
8189 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
8190 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
8191
8192 @menu
8193 * List:: Printing source lines
8194 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
8195 * Edit:: Editing source files
8196 * Search:: Searching source files
8197 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
8198 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
8199 @end menu
8200
8201 @node List
8202 @section Printing Source Lines
8203
8204 @kindex list
8205 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
8206 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
8207 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
8208 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
8209 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
8210
8211 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
8212
8213 @table @code
8214 @item list @var{linenum}
8215 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
8216 current source file.
8217
8218 @item list @var{function}
8219 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
8220 @var{function}.
8221
8222 @item list
8223 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
8224 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
8225 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
8226 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
8227 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
8228
8229 @item list -
8230 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8231 @end table
8232
8233 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
8234 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
8235 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
8236
8237 @table @code
8238 @kindex set listsize
8239 @item set listsize @var{count}
8240 @itemx set listsize unlimited
8241 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
8242 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
8243 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
8244
8245 @kindex show listsize
8246 @item show listsize
8247 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
8248 @end table
8249
8250 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
8251 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
8252 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
8253 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
8254 each repetition moves up in the source file.
8255
8256 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
8257 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
8258 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
8259 to specify some source line.
8260
8261 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
8262
8263 @table @code
8264 @item list @var{location}
8265 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
8266
8267 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
8268 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
8269 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
8270 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
8271 the same source file as the first location.
8272
8273 @item list ,@var{last}
8274 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
8275
8276 @item list @var{first},
8277 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
8278
8279 @item list +
8280 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
8281
8282 @item list -
8283 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8284
8285 @item list
8286 As described in the preceding table.
8287 @end table
8288
8289 @node Specify Location
8290 @section Specifying a Location
8291 @cindex specifying location
8292 @cindex location
8293 @cindex source location
8294
8295 @menu
8296 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
8297 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
8298 * Address Locations:: Address locations
8299 @end menu
8300
8301 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
8302 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
8303 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
8304 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
8305 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
8306
8307 @node Linespec Locations
8308 @subsection Linespec Locations
8309 @cindex linespec locations
8310
8311 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
8312 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
8313 specifying a linespec:
8314
8315 @table @code
8316 @item @var{linenum}
8317 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
8318
8319 @item -@var{offset}
8320 @itemx +@var{offset}
8321 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
8322 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
8323 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
8324 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
8325 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
8326 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
8327 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
8328 linespec.
8329
8330 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
8331 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
8332 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
8333 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
8334 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
8335 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
8336 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
8337
8338 @item @var{function}
8339 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
8340 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
8341
8342 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8343 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8344 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8345 means in all packages.
8346
8347 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8348 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8349 func}} and @w{@kbd{break B::func}} set a breakpoint on both symbols.
8350
8351 Commands that accept a linespec let you override this with the
8352 @code{-qualified} option. For example, @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8353 func}} sets a breakpoint on a free-function named @code{func} ignoring
8354 any C@t{++} class methods and namespace functions called @code{func}.
8355
8356 @xref{Explicit Locations}.
8357
8358 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
8359 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
8360
8361 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
8362 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
8363 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
8364 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
8365 functions in different source files.
8366
8367 @item @var{label}
8368 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
8369 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
8370 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
8371 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
8372
8373 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
8374 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
8375 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
8376 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
8377 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
8378 specifies the location of such a static probe.
8379
8380 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
8381 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
8382 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
8383 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
8384 each one of those probes.
8385 @end table
8386
8387 @node Explicit Locations
8388 @subsection Explicit Locations
8389 @cindex explicit locations
8390
8391 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
8392 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
8393
8394 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
8395 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
8396 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
8397 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
8398 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
8399
8400 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
8401 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
8402 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
8403 the symbol table to know.
8404
8405 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
8406 following table:
8407
8408 @table @code
8409 @item -source @var{filename}
8410 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
8411 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
8412 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
8413 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
8414 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
8415
8416 @item -function @var{function}
8417 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
8418 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
8419 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
8420 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
8421
8422 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8423 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8424 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8425 means in all packages.
8426
8427 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8428 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8429 -function func}} and @w{@kbd{break -function B::func}} set a
8430 breakpoint on both symbols.
8431
8432 You can use the @kbd{-qualified} flag to override this (see below).
8433
8434 @item -qualified
8435
8436 This flag makes @value{GDBN} interpret a function name specified with
8437 @kbd{-function} as a complete fully-qualified name.
8438
8439 For example, assuming a C@t{++} program with symbols named
8440 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, the @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8441 -function B::func}} command sets a breakpoint on @code{B::func}, only.
8442
8443 (Note: the @kbd{-qualified} option can precede a linespec as well
8444 (@pxref{Linespec Locations}), so the particular example above could be
8445 simplified as @w{@kbd{break -qualified B::func}}.)
8446
8447 @item -label @var{label}
8448 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
8449 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
8450 selected stack frame.
8451
8452 @item -line @var{number}
8453 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
8454 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
8455 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
8456 relative to the current line.
8457 @end table
8458
8459 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
8460 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @w{@kbd{break -s main.c -li 3}}.
8461
8462 @node Address Locations
8463 @subsection Address Locations
8464 @cindex address locations
8465
8466 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
8467 the generalized form *@var{address}.
8468
8469 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
8470 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
8471 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
8472 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
8473 source files.
8474
8475 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
8476 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
8477 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
8478 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
8479 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
8480 of @var{address}:
8481
8482 @table @code
8483 @item @var{expression}
8484 Any expression valid in the current working language.
8485
8486 @item @var{funcaddr}
8487 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
8488 C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
8489 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
8490 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
8491 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
8492 (although the Pascal form also works).
8493
8494 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
8495 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
8496
8497 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
8498 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
8499 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
8500 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
8501 functions with identical names in different source files.
8502 @end table
8503
8504 @node Edit
8505 @section Editing Source Files
8506 @cindex editing source files
8507
8508 @kindex edit
8509 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
8510 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
8511 The editing program of your choice
8512 is invoked with the current line set to
8513 the active line in the program.
8514 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
8515 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
8516
8517 @table @code
8518 @item edit @var{location}
8519 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
8520 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
8521 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
8522 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
8523 command most commonly used:
8524
8525 @table @code
8526 @item edit @var{number}
8527 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
8528
8529 @item edit @var{function}
8530 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
8531 @end table
8532
8533 @end table
8534
8535 @subsection Choosing your Editor
8536 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
8537 @footnote{
8538 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
8539 following command-line syntax:
8540 @smallexample
8541 ex +@var{number} file
8542 @end smallexample
8543 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
8544 the file where to start editing.}.
8545 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
8546 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
8547 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8548 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8549 @smallexample
8550 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8551 export EDITOR
8552 gdb @dots{}
8553 @end smallexample
8554 or in the @code{csh} shell,
8555 @smallexample
8556 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8557 gdb @dots{}
8558 @end smallexample
8559
8560 @node Search
8561 @section Searching Source Files
8562 @cindex searching source files
8563
8564 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8565 regular expression.
8566
8567 @table @code
8568 @kindex search
8569 @kindex forward-search
8570 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8571 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
8572 @itemx search @var{regexp}
8573 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8574 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8575 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8576 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8577 @code{fo}.
8578
8579 @kindex reverse-search
8580 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8581 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8582 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8583 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8584 this command as @code{rev}.
8585 @end table
8586
8587 @node Source Path
8588 @section Specifying Source Directories
8589
8590 @cindex source path
8591 @cindex directories for source files
8592 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8593 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8594 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8595 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8596 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8597 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8598 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8599
8600 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8601 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8602 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
8603 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8604 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8605 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8606 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8607 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8608 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8609 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8610 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8611
8612 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8613 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8614 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8615 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8616 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8617 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8618
8619 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8620 source files.
8621
8622 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8623 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8624 each line is in the file.
8625
8626 @kindex directory
8627 @kindex dir
8628 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8629 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8630 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8631
8632 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8633 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8634
8635 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8636 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
8637 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8638 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8639 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
8640 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8641 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8642 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8643 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8644 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8645 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8646 name to look up the sources.
8647
8648 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8649 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8650 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8651 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
8652 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8653 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
8654 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8655 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8656
8657 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8658 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8659 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
8660 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8661 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
8662 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8663 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8664
8665 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8666 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8667 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8668 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8669 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
8670 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8671 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8672 command.
8673
8674 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8675 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8676 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8677 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
8678 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8679 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8680 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8681
8682 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8683 @cindex default source path substitution
8684 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8685 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8686 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8687 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8688 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8689 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8690 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8691 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8692 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8693 together.
8694
8695 @table @code
8696 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8697 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8698 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8699 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8700 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8701 part of absolute file names) or
8702 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8703 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8704
8705 @kindex cdir
8706 @kindex cwd
8707 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8708 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8709 @cindex compilation directory
8710 @cindex current directory
8711 @cindex working directory
8712 @cindex directory, current
8713 @cindex directory, compilation
8714 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8715 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8716 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8717 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8718 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8719 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8720
8721 @item directory
8722 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8723
8724 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8725 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8726
8727 @item set directories @var{path-list}
8728 @kindex set directories
8729 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8730 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8731
8732 @item show directories
8733 @kindex show directories
8734 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8735
8736 @anchor{set substitute-path}
8737 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8738 @kindex set substitute-path
8739 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8740 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8741 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8742
8743 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8744 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8745
8746 @smallexample
8747 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8748 @end smallexample
8749
8750 @noindent
8751 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8752 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8753 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8754
8755 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8756 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8757 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8758 the substitution.
8759
8760 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8761
8762 @smallexample
8763 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8764 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8765 @end smallexample
8766
8767 @noindent
8768 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8769 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8770 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8771 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8772
8773
8774 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8775 @kindex unset substitute-path
8776 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8777 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8778 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8779
8780 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8781
8782 @item show substitute-path [path]
8783 @kindex show substitute-path
8784 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8785 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8786
8787 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8788 rules.
8789
8790 @end table
8791
8792 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8793 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8794 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8795
8796 @enumerate
8797 @item
8798 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8799
8800 @item
8801 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8802 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8803 directories in one command.
8804 @end enumerate
8805
8806 @node Machine Code
8807 @section Source and Machine Code
8808 @cindex source line and its code address
8809
8810 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8811 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8812 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8813 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8814 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8815 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8816 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8817 well as hex.
8818
8819 @table @code
8820 @kindex info line
8821 @item info line
8822 @itemx info line @var{location}
8823 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8824 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8825 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}. With no @var{location}
8826 information about the current source line is printed.
8827 @end table
8828
8829 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8830 the object code for the first line of function
8831 @code{m4_changequote}:
8832
8833 @smallexample
8834 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8835 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c <m4_changequote> and \
8836 ends at 0x6350 <m4_changequote+4>.
8837 @end smallexample
8838
8839 @noindent
8840 @cindex code address and its source line
8841 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8842 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8843 @smallexample
8844 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8845 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 <m4_changequote+152> and \
8846 ends at 0x6404 <m4_changequote+184>.
8847 @end smallexample
8848
8849 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8850 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8851 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8852 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8853 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8854 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8855 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8856 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8857 Variables}).
8858
8859 @cindex info line, repeated calls
8860 After @code{info line}, using @code{info line} again without
8861 specifying a location will display information about the next source
8862 line.
8863
8864 @table @code
8865 @kindex disassemble
8866 @cindex assembly instructions
8867 @cindex instructions, assembly
8868 @cindex machine instructions
8869 @cindex listing machine instructions
8870 @item disassemble
8871 @itemx disassemble /m
8872 @itemx disassemble /s
8873 @itemx disassemble /r
8874 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8875 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8876 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8877 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8878 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8879 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8880 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8881 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8882 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8883 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8884
8885 @table @code
8886 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8887 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8888 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8889 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8890 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8891 @end table
8892
8893 @noindent
8894 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8895 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8896
8897 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8898 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8899
8900 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8901 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8902 @end table
8903
8904 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8905 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8906
8907 @smallexample
8908 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8909 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8910 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8911 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8912 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8913 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8914 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8915 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8916 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8917 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8918 End of assembler dump.
8919 @end smallexample
8920
8921 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8922 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8923 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8924
8925 @smallexample
8926 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8927 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8928 5 @{
8929 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8930 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8931 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8932 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8933 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8934
8935 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8936 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8937 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8938
8939 7 return 0;
8940 8 @}
8941 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8942 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8943 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8944
8945 End of assembler dump.
8946 @end smallexample
8947
8948 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8949 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8950 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8951 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8952 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8953 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8954 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8955 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8956 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8957
8958 @file{foo.h}:
8959
8960 @smallexample
8961 int
8962 foo (int a)
8963 @{
8964 if (a < 0)
8965 return a * 2;
8966 if (a == 0)
8967 return 1;
8968 return a + 10;
8969 @}
8970 @end smallexample
8971
8972 @file{foo.c}:
8973
8974 @smallexample
8975 #include "foo.h"
8976 volatile int x, y;
8977 int
8978 main ()
8979 @{
8980 x = foo (y);
8981 return 0;
8982 @}
8983 @end smallexample
8984
8985 @smallexample
8986 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8987 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8988 5 @{
8989
8990 6 x = foo (y);
8991 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8992 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8993
8994 7 return 0;
8995 8 @}
8996 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8997 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8998 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8999 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
9000
9001 End of assembler dump.
9002 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
9003 Dump of assembler code for function main:
9004 foo.c:
9005 5 @{
9006 6 x = foo (y);
9007 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
9008
9009 foo.h:
9010 4 if (a < 0)
9011 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
9012 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
9013
9014 6 if (a == 0)
9015 7 return 1;
9016 8 return a + 10;
9017 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
9018 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
9019 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
9020 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
9021
9022 foo.c:
9023 6 x = foo (y);
9024 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
9025
9026 7 return 0;
9027 8 @}
9028 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
9029 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
9030
9031 foo.h:
9032 5 return a * 2;
9033 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
9034 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
9035 End of assembler dump.
9036 @end smallexample
9037
9038 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
9039
9040 @smallexample
9041 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
9042 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
9043 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
9044 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
9045 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
9046 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
9047 End of assembler dump.
9048 @end smallexample
9049
9050 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
9051 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
9052 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
9053 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
9054
9055 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
9056 mnemonics or other syntax.
9057
9058 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
9059 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
9060 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
9061 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
9062 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
9063
9064 @table @code
9065 @kindex set disassembler-options
9066 @cindex disassembler options
9067 @item set disassembler-options @var{option1}[,@var{option2}@dots{}]
9068 This command controls the passing of target specific information to
9069 the disassembler. For a list of valid options, please refer to the
9070 @code{-M}/@code{--disassembler-options} section of the @samp{objdump}
9071 manual and/or the output of @kbd{objdump --help}
9072 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils,The GNU Binary Utilities}).
9073 The default value is the empty string.
9074
9075 If it is necessary to specify more than one disassembler option, then
9076 multiple options can be placed together into a comma separated list.
9077 Currently this command is only supported on targets ARM, MIPS, PowerPC
9078 and S/390.
9079
9080 @kindex show disassembler-options
9081 @item show disassembler-options
9082 Show the current setting of the disassembler options.
9083 @end table
9084
9085 @table @code
9086 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
9087 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
9088 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
9089 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
9090 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
9091 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
9092
9093 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
9094 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
9095 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
9096 assemblers for x86-based targets.
9097
9098 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
9099 @item show disassembly-flavor
9100 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
9101 @end table
9102
9103 @table @code
9104 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
9105 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
9106 @item set disassemble-next-line
9107 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
9108 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
9109 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
9110 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
9111 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
9112 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
9113 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
9114 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
9115 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
9116 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
9117 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
9118 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
9119 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
9120 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
9121 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
9122 instruction.
9123 @end table
9124
9125
9126 @node Data
9127 @chapter Examining Data
9128
9129 @cindex printing data
9130 @cindex examining data
9131 @kindex print
9132 @kindex inspect
9133 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
9134 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
9135 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
9136 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
9137 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
9138 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
9139
9140 @table @code
9141 @item print @var{expr}
9142 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
9143 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
9144 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
9145 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
9146 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
9147 Formats}.
9148
9149 @item print
9150 @itemx print /@var{f}
9151 @cindex reprint the last value
9152 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
9153 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
9154 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
9155 @end table
9156
9157 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
9158 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
9159 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9160
9161 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
9162 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
9163 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
9164 Table}.
9165
9166 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
9167 @kindex explore
9168 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
9169 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
9170 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
9171 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
9172 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
9173 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
9174 embedded in the higher level data types.
9175
9176 @table @code
9177 @item explore @var{arg}
9178 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
9179 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
9180 @end table
9181
9182 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
9183 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
9184 C program as
9185
9186 @smallexample
9187 struct SimpleStruct
9188 @{
9189 int i;
9190 double d;
9191 @};
9192
9193 struct ComplexStruct
9194 @{
9195 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
9196 int arr[10];
9197 @};
9198 @end smallexample
9199
9200 @noindent
9201 followed by variable declarations as
9202
9203 @smallexample
9204 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
9205 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
9206 @end smallexample
9207
9208 @noindent
9209 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
9210 @code{explore} command as follows.
9211
9212 @smallexample
9213 (gdb) explore cs
9214 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
9215 the following fields:
9216
9217 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
9218 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
9219
9220 Enter the field number of choice:
9221 @end smallexample
9222
9223 @noindent
9224 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
9225 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
9226 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
9227 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
9228 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
9229 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
9230 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
9231 field will be explored as if it were an array.
9232
9233 @smallexample
9234 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
9235 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
9236 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
9237 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
9238
9239 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
9240 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
9241
9242 Press enter to return to parent value:
9243 @end smallexample
9244
9245 @noindent
9246 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
9247 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
9248 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
9249 to explore.
9250
9251 @smallexample
9252 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
9253 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
9254
9255 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
9256
9257 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
9258
9259 Press enter to return to parent value:
9260 @end smallexample
9261
9262 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
9263 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
9264 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
9265 level data structure).
9266
9267 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
9268 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
9269 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
9270 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
9271 same example as above, your can explore the type
9272 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
9273 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
9274
9275 @smallexample
9276 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
9277 @end smallexample
9278
9279 @noindent
9280 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
9281 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
9282 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
9283 example.
9284
9285 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
9286 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
9287 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
9288 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
9289 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
9290
9291 @table @code
9292 @item explore value @var{expr}
9293 @cindex explore value
9294 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
9295 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
9296 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
9297 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
9298 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
9299
9300 @item explore type @var{arg}
9301 @cindex explore type
9302 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
9303 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
9304 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
9305 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
9306 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
9307 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
9308 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
9309 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
9310 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
9311 @end table
9312
9313 @menu
9314 * Expressions:: Expressions
9315 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
9316 * Variables:: Program variables
9317 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
9318 * Output Formats:: Output formats
9319 * Memory:: Examining memory
9320 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
9321 * Print Settings:: Print settings
9322 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
9323 * Value History:: Value history
9324 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
9325 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
9326 * Registers:: Registers
9327 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
9328 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
9329 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
9330 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
9331 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
9332 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
9333 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
9334 character set than GDB does
9335 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
9336 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
9337 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
9338 @end menu
9339
9340 @node Expressions
9341 @section Expressions
9342
9343 @cindex expressions
9344 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
9345 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
9346 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
9347 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
9348 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
9349 you compiled your program to include this information; see
9350 @ref{Compilation}.
9351
9352 @cindex arrays in expressions
9353 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
9354 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
9355 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
9356 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
9357 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
9358 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
9359
9360 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
9361 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
9362 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
9363 languages.
9364
9365 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
9366 expressions regardless of your programming language.
9367
9368 @cindex casts, in expressions
9369 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
9370 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
9371 at that address in memory.
9372 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
9373
9374 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
9375 to programming languages:
9376
9377 @table @code
9378 @item @@
9379 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
9380 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
9381
9382 @item ::
9383 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
9384 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
9385
9386 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
9387 @cindex type casting memory
9388 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
9389 @cindex casts, to view memory
9390 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
9391 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
9392 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
9393 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
9394 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
9395 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
9396 @end table
9397
9398 @node Ambiguous Expressions
9399 @section Ambiguous Expressions
9400 @cindex ambiguous expressions
9401
9402 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
9403 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
9404 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
9405 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
9406 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
9407 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
9408 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
9409
9410 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
9411 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
9412 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
9413 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
9414 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
9415 as well.
9416
9417 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
9418 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
9419 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
9420 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
9421 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
9422 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
9423 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
9424 choices.
9425
9426 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
9427 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
9428 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
9429
9430 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
9431 @smallexample
9432 @group
9433 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
9434 [0] cancel
9435 [1] all
9436 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
9437 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
9438 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
9439 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
9440 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
9441 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
9442 > 2 4 6
9443 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
9444 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
9445 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
9446 Multiple breakpoints were set.
9447 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
9448 breakpoints.
9449 (@value{GDBP})
9450 @end group
9451 @end smallexample
9452
9453 @table @code
9454 @kindex set multiple-symbols
9455 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
9456 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
9457
9458 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
9459 is ambiguous.
9460
9461 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
9462 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
9463 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
9464 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
9465 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
9466 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
9467 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
9468 in the use of the menu.
9469
9470 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
9471 when an ambiguity is detected.
9472
9473 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
9474 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
9475
9476 @kindex show multiple-symbols
9477 @item show multiple-symbols
9478 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
9479 @end table
9480
9481 @node Variables
9482 @section Program Variables
9483
9484 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
9485 in your program.
9486
9487 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
9488 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
9489
9490 @itemize @bullet
9491 @item
9492 global (or file-static)
9493 @end itemize
9494
9495 @noindent or
9496
9497 @itemize @bullet
9498 @item
9499 visible according to the scope rules of the
9500 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
9501 @end itemize
9502
9503 @noindent This means that in the function
9504
9505 @smallexample
9506 foo (a)
9507 int a;
9508 @{
9509 bar (a);
9510 @{
9511 int b = test ();
9512 bar (b);
9513 @}
9514 @}
9515 @end smallexample
9516
9517 @noindent
9518 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
9519 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
9520 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
9521 the block where @code{b} is declared.
9522
9523 @cindex variable name conflict
9524 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
9525 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
9526 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
9527 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
9528 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
9529 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
9530 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
9531
9532 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
9533 @ifnotinfo
9534 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
9535 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
9536 @end ifnotinfo
9537 @smallexample
9538 @var{file}::@var{variable}
9539 @var{function}::@var{variable}
9540 @end smallexample
9541
9542 @noindent
9543 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
9544 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
9545 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
9546 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
9547
9548 @smallexample
9549 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
9550 @end smallexample
9551
9552 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
9553 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
9554 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
9555 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
9556 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
9557
9558 @smallexample
9559 void
9560 foo (int a)
9561 @{
9562 if (a < 10)
9563 bar (a);
9564 else
9565 process (a); /* Stop here */
9566 @}
9567
9568 int
9569 bar (int a)
9570 @{
9571 foo (a + 5);
9572 @}
9573 @end smallexample
9574
9575 @noindent
9576 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
9577 here is what you might see
9578 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
9579
9580 @smallexample
9581 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9582 $1 = 10
9583 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9584 $2 = 5
9585 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
9586 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
9587 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9588 $3 = 5
9589 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9590 $4 = 0
9591 @end smallexample
9592
9593 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
9594 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
9595 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
9596 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
9597 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
9598
9599 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
9600 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
9601 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9602 @code{some_global}.
9603
9604 @smallexample
9605 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9606 $1 = 23
9607 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9608 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9609 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9610 $2 = 27
9611 @end smallexample
9612
9613 @cindex wrong values
9614 @cindex variable values, wrong
9615 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9616 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9617 @quotation
9618 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9619 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9620 scope, and just before exit.
9621 @end quotation
9622 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9623 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9624 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9625 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9626 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
9627 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9628 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9629 variable definitions may be gone.
9630
9631 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9632 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9633 when compiling.
9634
9635 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9636 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9637 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9638 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
9639 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9640 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
9641 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9642
9643 @smallexample
9644 No symbol "foo" in current context.
9645 @end smallexample
9646
9647 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9648 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9649 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9650 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9651 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9652
9653 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9654 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9655 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9656 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9657
9658 @cindex no debug info variables
9659 If you try to examine or use the value of a (global) variable for
9660 which @value{GDBN} has no type information, e.g., because the program
9661 includes no debug information, @value{GDBN} displays an error message.
9662 @xref{Symbols, unknown type}, for more about unknown types. If you
9663 cast the variable to its declared type, @value{GDBN} gets the
9664 variable's value using the cast-to type as the variable's type. For
9665 example, in a C program:
9666
9667 @smallexample
9668 (@value{GDBP}) p var
9669 'var' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
9670 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) var
9671 $1 = 3.14
9672 @end smallexample
9673
9674 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9675 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
9676 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9677 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9678 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9679
9680 @smallexample
9681 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
9682 29 i++;
9683 (gdb) next
9684 30 e (i);
9685 (gdb) print i
9686 $1 = 31
9687 (gdb) print i@@entry
9688 $2 = 30
9689 @end smallexample
9690
9691 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9692 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9693 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
9694 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9695 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9696 For program code
9697
9698 @smallexample
9699 char var0[] = "A";
9700 signed char var1[] = "A";
9701 @end smallexample
9702
9703 You get during debugging
9704 @smallexample
9705 (gdb) print var0
9706 $1 = "A"
9707 (gdb) print var1
9708 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9709 @end smallexample
9710
9711 @node Arrays
9712 @section Artificial Arrays
9713
9714 @cindex artificial array
9715 @cindex arrays
9716 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9717 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9718 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9719 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9720 program.
9721
9722 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9723 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
9724 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9725 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
9726 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9727 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
9728 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9729 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9730 example. If a program says
9731
9732 @smallexample
9733 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9734 @end smallexample
9735
9736 @noindent
9737 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9738
9739 @smallexample
9740 p *array@@len
9741 @end smallexample
9742
9743 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9744 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9745 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9746 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9747 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9748
9749 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9750 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9751 The value need not be in memory:
9752 @smallexample
9753 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9754 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9755 @end smallexample
9756
9757 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9758 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9759 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9760 @smallexample
9761 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9762 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9763 @end smallexample
9764
9765 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9766 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9767 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9768 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9769 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9770 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9771 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9772 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9773 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9774 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9775
9776 @smallexample
9777 set $i = 0
9778 p dtab[$i++]->fv
9779 @key{RET}
9780 @key{RET}
9781 @dots{}
9782 @end smallexample
9783
9784 @node Output Formats
9785 @section Output Formats
9786
9787 @cindex formatted output
9788 @cindex output formats
9789 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9790 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9791 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9792 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9793 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9794
9795 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9796 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9797 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9798 letters supported are:
9799
9800 @table @code
9801 @item x
9802 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9803 hexadecimal.
9804
9805 @item d
9806 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9807
9808 @item u
9809 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9810
9811 @item o
9812 Print as integer in octal.
9813
9814 @item t
9815 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9816 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9817 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9818 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9819
9820 @item a
9821 @cindex unknown address, locating
9822 @cindex locate address
9823 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9824 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9825 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9826
9827 @smallexample
9828 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9829 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9830 @end smallexample
9831
9832 @noindent
9833 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9834 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9835
9836 @item c
9837 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9838 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9839 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9840 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9841
9842 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9843 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9844 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9845 data.
9846
9847 @item f
9848 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9849 using typical floating point syntax.
9850
9851 @item s
9852 @cindex printing strings
9853 @cindex printing byte arrays
9854 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9855 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9856 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9857 natural types.
9858
9859 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9860 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9861 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9862 array.
9863
9864 @item z
9865 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9866 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9867 to the size of the integer type.
9868
9869 @item r
9870 @cindex raw printing
9871 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9872 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9873 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9874 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9875 pretty-printer which might exist.
9876 @end table
9877
9878 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9879
9880 @smallexample
9881 p/x $pc
9882 @end smallexample
9883
9884 @noindent
9885 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9886 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9887
9888 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9889 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9890 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9891
9892 @node Memory
9893 @section Examining Memory
9894
9895 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9896 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9897
9898 @cindex examining memory
9899 @table @code
9900 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9901 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9902 @itemx x @var{addr}
9903 @itemx x
9904 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9905 @end table
9906
9907 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9908 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9909 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9910 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9911 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9912
9913 @table @r
9914 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9915 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9916 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
9917 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
9918 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9919 @c 4.1.2.
9920
9921 @item @var{f}, the display format
9922 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9923 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9924 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9925 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9926 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9927
9928 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9929 The unit size is any of
9930
9931 @table @code
9932 @item b
9933 Bytes.
9934 @item h
9935 Halfwords (two bytes).
9936 @item w
9937 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9938 @item g
9939 Giant words (eight bytes).
9940 @end table
9941
9942 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9943 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9944 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9945 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9946 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9947 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9948 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9949 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9950 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9951 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9952 be altered.
9953
9954 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9955 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9956 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9957 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9958 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9959 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9960 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9961 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9962 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9963 a value from memory).
9964 @end table
9965
9966 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9967 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9968 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9969 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9970 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9971
9972 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
9973 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
9974 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
9975
9976 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9977 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9978 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9979 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9980 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9981
9982 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9983 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9984 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9985 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9986 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9987 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9988 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9989 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9990 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9991
9992 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
9993 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
9994 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
9995 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
9996 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
9997 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
9998
9999 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
10000 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
10001 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
10002 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
10003 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
10004 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
10005 for successive uses of @code{x}.
10006
10007 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
10008 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
10009
10010 @smallexample
10011 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
10012 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
10013 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
10014 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
10015 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
10016 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
10017 @end smallexample
10018
10019 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
10020 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
10021 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
10022 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
10023 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
10024 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
10025 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
10026 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
10027 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
10028
10029 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
10030 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
10031 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
10032
10033 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
10034 @cindex addressable memory unit
10035 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
10036 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
10037 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
10038 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
10039 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
10040 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
10041 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
10042 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
10043 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
10044
10045 @cindex remote memory comparison
10046 @cindex target memory comparison
10047 @cindex verify remote memory image
10048 @cindex verify target memory image
10049 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
10050 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
10051 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
10052 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
10053 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
10054 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
10055
10056 @table @code
10057 @kindex compare-sections
10058 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
10059 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
10060 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
10061 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
10062 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
10063 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
10064
10065 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
10066 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
10067 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
10068 @end table
10069
10070 @node Auto Display
10071 @section Automatic Display
10072 @cindex automatic display
10073 @cindex display of expressions
10074
10075 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
10076 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
10077 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
10078 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
10079 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
10080 The automatic display looks like this:
10081
10082 @smallexample
10083 2: foo = 38
10084 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
10085 @end smallexample
10086
10087 @noindent
10088 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
10089 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
10090 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
10091 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
10092 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
10093 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
10094
10095 @table @code
10096 @kindex display
10097 @item display @var{expr}
10098 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
10099 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10100
10101 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
10102
10103 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
10104 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
10105 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
10106 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
10107 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
10108
10109 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
10110 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
10111 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
10112 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
10113 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
10114 @end table
10115
10116 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
10117 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
10118 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10119
10120 @table @code
10121 @kindex delete display
10122 @kindex undisplay
10123 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
10124 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10125 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
10126 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
10127 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
10128 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
10129 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10130
10131 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
10132 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
10133
10134 @kindex disable display
10135 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10136 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
10137 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
10138 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
10139 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
10140 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
10141 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
10142 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10143
10144 @kindex enable display
10145 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10146 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
10147 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
10148 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
10149 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
10150 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
10151 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10152
10153 @item display
10154 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
10155 done when your program stops.
10156
10157 @kindex info display
10158 @item info display
10159 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
10160 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
10161 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
10162 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
10163 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
10164 @end table
10165
10166 @cindex display disabled out of scope
10167 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
10168 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
10169 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
10170 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
10171 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
10172 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
10173 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
10174 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
10175 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
10176 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
10177
10178 @node Print Settings
10179 @section Print Settings
10180
10181 @cindex format options
10182 @cindex print settings
10183 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
10184 and symbols are printed.
10185
10186 @noindent
10187 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
10188
10189 @table @code
10190 @kindex set print
10191 @item set print address
10192 @itemx set print address on
10193 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
10194 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
10195 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
10196 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
10197 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
10198 @code{set print address on}:
10199
10200 @smallexample
10201 @group
10202 (@value{GDBP}) f
10203 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
10204 at input.c:530
10205 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10206 @end group
10207 @end smallexample
10208
10209 @item set print address off
10210 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
10211 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
10212
10213 @smallexample
10214 @group
10215 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
10216 (@value{GDBP}) f
10217 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
10218 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10219 @end group
10220 @end smallexample
10221
10222 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
10223 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
10224 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
10225 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
10226
10227 @kindex show print
10228 @item show print address
10229 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
10230 @end table
10231
10232 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
10233 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
10234 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
10235 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
10236 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
10237 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
10238 it prints a symbolic address:
10239
10240 @table @code
10241 @item set print symbol-filename on
10242 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
10243 @cindex symbol, source file and line
10244 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
10245 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10246
10247 @item set print symbol-filename off
10248 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
10249 default.
10250
10251 @item show print symbol-filename
10252 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
10253 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10254 @end table
10255
10256 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
10257 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
10258 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
10259
10260 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
10261 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
10262
10263 @table @code
10264 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
10265 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
10266 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
10267 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
10268 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
10269 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
10270 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
10271 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
10272
10273 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
10274 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
10275 symbolic address.
10276 @end table
10277
10278 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
10279 @cindex pointer, finding referent
10280 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
10281 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
10282 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
10283 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
10284 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
10285 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
10286
10287 @smallexample
10288 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
10289 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
10290 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
10291 @end smallexample
10292
10293 @quotation
10294 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
10295 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
10296 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
10297 @end quotation
10298
10299 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
10300 @samp{set print symbol on}:
10301
10302 @table @code
10303 @item set print symbol on
10304 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
10305 one exists.
10306
10307 @item set print symbol off
10308 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
10309 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
10310 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
10311
10312 @item show print symbol
10313 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
10314 address.
10315 @end table
10316
10317 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
10318
10319 @table @code
10320 @item set print array
10321 @itemx set print array on
10322 @cindex pretty print arrays
10323 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
10324 but uses more space. The default is off.
10325
10326 @item set print array off
10327 Return to compressed format for arrays.
10328
10329 @item show print array
10330 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
10331 arrays.
10332
10333 @cindex print array indexes
10334 @item set print array-indexes
10335 @itemx set print array-indexes on
10336 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
10337 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
10338 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
10339
10340 @item set print array-indexes off
10341 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
10342
10343 @item show print array-indexes
10344 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
10345 arrays.
10346
10347 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
10348 @itemx set print elements unlimited
10349 @cindex number of array elements to print
10350 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
10351 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
10352 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
10353 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
10354 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
10355 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
10356 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
10357 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
10358
10359 @item show print elements
10360 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
10361 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
10362
10363 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
10364 @kindex set print frame-arguments
10365 @cindex printing frame argument values
10366 @cindex print all frame argument values
10367 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
10368 @cindex do not print frame argument values
10369 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
10370 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
10371 values are:
10372
10373 @table @code
10374 @item all
10375 The values of all arguments are printed.
10376
10377 @item scalars
10378 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
10379 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
10380 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
10381 only scalar arguments are shown:
10382
10383 @smallexample
10384 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
10385 at frame-args.c:23
10386 @end smallexample
10387
10388 @item none
10389 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
10390 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
10391
10392 @smallexample
10393 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
10394 at frame-args.c:23
10395 @end smallexample
10396 @end table
10397
10398 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
10399 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
10400 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
10401 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
10402 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
10403 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
10404 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
10405 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
10406 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
10407 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
10408
10409 @item show print frame-arguments
10410 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
10411
10412 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
10413 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
10414
10415 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
10416 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
10417 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
10418 otherwise print the value in raw form.
10419 This is the default.
10420
10421 @item show print raw frame-arguments
10422 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
10423
10424 @anchor{set print entry-values}
10425 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
10426 @kindex set print entry-values
10427 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
10428 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
10429 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
10430 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
10431 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
10432
10433 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
10434 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
10435 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
10436 @code{no} setting.
10437
10438 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
10439 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
10440 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
10441 this information.
10442
10443 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
10444
10445 @table @code
10446 @item no
10447 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
10448 point.
10449 @smallexample
10450 #0 equal (val=5)
10451 #0 different (val=6)
10452 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
10453 #0 born (val=10)
10454 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10455 @end smallexample
10456
10457 @item only
10458 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
10459 values are never printed.
10460 @smallexample
10461 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10462 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10463 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10464 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10465 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10466 @end smallexample
10467
10468 @item preferred
10469 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
10470 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
10471 value for such parameter.
10472 @smallexample
10473 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10474 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10475 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10476 #0 born (val=10)
10477 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10478 @end smallexample
10479
10480 @item if-needed
10481 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
10482 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
10483 parameter.
10484 @smallexample
10485 #0 equal (val=5)
10486 #0 different (val=6)
10487 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10488 #0 born (val=10)
10489 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10490 @end smallexample
10491
10492 @item both
10493 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
10494 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
10495 optimizations.
10496 @smallexample
10497 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
10498 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10499 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10500 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10501 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10502 @end smallexample
10503
10504 @item compact
10505 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
10506 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
10507 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
10508 values are known and identical, print the shortened
10509 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10510 @smallexample
10511 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10512 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10513 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10514 #0 born (val=10)
10515 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10516 @end smallexample
10517
10518 @item default
10519 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
10520 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
10521 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
10522 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10523 @smallexample
10524 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10525 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10526 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10527 #0 born (val=10)
10528 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10529 @end smallexample
10530 @end table
10531
10532 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
10533 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
10534
10535 @item show print entry-values
10536 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
10537 entry.
10538
10539 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
10540 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
10541 @cindex repeated array elements
10542 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
10543 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
10544 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
10545 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
10546 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
10547 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
10548 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
10549 is 10.
10550
10551 @item show print repeats
10552 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
10553 elements.
10554
10555 @item set print null-stop
10556 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
10557 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
10558 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
10559 contain only short strings.
10560 The default is off.
10561
10562 @item show print null-stop
10563 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
10564 @sc{null} character.
10565
10566 @item set print pretty on
10567 @cindex print structures in indented form
10568 @cindex indentation in structure display
10569 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
10570 per line, like this:
10571
10572 @smallexample
10573 @group
10574 $1 = @{
10575 next = 0x0,
10576 flags = @{
10577 sweet = 1,
10578 sour = 1
10579 @},
10580 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
10581 @}
10582 @end group
10583 @end smallexample
10584
10585 @item set print pretty off
10586 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
10587
10588 @smallexample
10589 @group
10590 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
10591 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
10592 @end group
10593 @end smallexample
10594
10595 @noindent
10596 This is the default format.
10597
10598 @item show print pretty
10599 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
10600
10601 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
10602 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
10603 @cindex octal escapes in strings
10604 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
10605 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
10606 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
10607 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
10608 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
10609
10610 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
10611 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
10612 international character sets, and is the default.
10613
10614 @item show print sevenbit-strings
10615 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
10616
10617 @item set print union on
10618 @cindex unions in structures, printing
10619 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
10620 and other unions. This is the default setting.
10621
10622 @item set print union off
10623 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
10624 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
10625 instead.
10626
10627 @item show print union
10628 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
10629 structures and other unions.
10630
10631 For example, given the declarations
10632
10633 @smallexample
10634 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10635 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10636 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10637 Bug_forms;
10638
10639 struct thing @{
10640 Species it;
10641 union @{
10642 Tree_forms tree;
10643 Bug_forms bug;
10644 @} form;
10645 @};
10646
10647 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10648 @end smallexample
10649
10650 @noindent
10651 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10652
10653 @smallexample
10654 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10655 @end smallexample
10656
10657 @noindent
10658 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10659
10660 @smallexample
10661 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10662 @end smallexample
10663
10664 @noindent
10665 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10666 and in Pascal.
10667 @end table
10668
10669 @need 1000
10670 @noindent
10671 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10672
10673 @table @code
10674 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10675 @item set print demangle
10676 @itemx set print demangle on
10677 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10678 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10679 linkage. The default is on.
10680
10681 @item show print demangle
10682 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10683
10684 @item set print asm-demangle
10685 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
10686 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10687 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10688 The default is off.
10689
10690 @item show print asm-demangle
10691 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10692 or demangled form.
10693
10694 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10695 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10696 @kindex set demangle-style
10697 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
10698 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
10699 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
10700
10701 @table @code
10702 @item auto
10703 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
10704 This is the default.
10705
10706 @item gnu
10707 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
10708
10709 @item hp
10710 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
10711
10712 @item lucid
10713 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
10714
10715 @item arm
10716 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
10717 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
10718 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
10719 require further enhancement to permit that.
10720
10721 @end table
10722 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
10723
10724 @item show demangle-style
10725 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10726
10727 @item set print object
10728 @itemx set print object on
10729 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
10730 @cindex display derived types
10731 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10732 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10733 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
10734 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10735 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10736 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10737 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10738
10739 @item set print object off
10740 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10741 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10742
10743 @item show print object
10744 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10745
10746 @item set print static-members
10747 @itemx set print static-members on
10748 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10749 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10750
10751 @item set print static-members off
10752 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10753
10754 @item show print static-members
10755 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10756
10757 @item set print pascal_static-members
10758 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10759 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
10760 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10761 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10762
10763 @item set print pascal_static-members off
10764 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10765
10766 @item show print pascal_static-members
10767 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10768
10769 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10770 @item set print vtbl
10771 @itemx set print vtbl on
10772 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10773 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10774 @cindex VTBL display
10775 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10776 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10777 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10778
10779 @item set print vtbl off
10780 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10781
10782 @item show print vtbl
10783 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10784 @end table
10785
10786 @node Pretty Printing
10787 @section Pretty Printing
10788
10789 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10790 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10791 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10792
10793 @menu
10794 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10795 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10796 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10797 @end menu
10798
10799 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10800 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10801
10802 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10803 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10804 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10805
10806 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10807 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10808 pretty-printers with their names.
10809 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10810 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10811 Each such subprinter has its own name.
10812 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10813
10814 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10815 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10816 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10817 do anything special.
10818
10819 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10820
10821 @itemize @bullet
10822 @item
10823 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10824 all inferiors.
10825
10826 @item
10827 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10828 when debugging that program.
10829 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10830
10831 @item
10832 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10833 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10834 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10835 @end itemize
10836
10837 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10838 pretty-printers are selected,
10839
10840 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10841 for new types.
10842
10843 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10844 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10845
10846 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10847
10848 @smallexample
10849 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10850 $1 = @{
10851 static npos = 4294967295,
10852 _M_dataplus = @{
10853 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10854 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10855 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10856 @},
10857 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10858 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10859 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10860 @}
10861 @}
10862 @end smallexample
10863
10864 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10865
10866 @smallexample
10867 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10868 $2 = "abcd"
10869 @end smallexample
10870
10871 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10872 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10873 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10874
10875 @table @code
10876 @kindex info pretty-printer
10877 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10878 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10879 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10880
10881 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10882 whose pretty-printers to list.
10883 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10884 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10885 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10886 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10887 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10888
10889 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10890 to list.
10891
10892 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10893 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10894 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10895 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10896
10897 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10898 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10899 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10900 @end table
10901
10902 Example:
10903
10904 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10905 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10906 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10907 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10908
10909 @smallexample
10910 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10911 library1.so:
10912 foo
10913 library2.so:
10914 bar
10915 bar1
10916 bar2
10917 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10918 library2.so:
10919 bar
10920 bar1
10921 bar2
10922 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10923 1 printer disabled
10924 2 of 3 printers enabled
10925 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10926 library1.so:
10927 foo [disabled]
10928 library2.so:
10929 bar
10930 bar1
10931 bar2
10932 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar;bar1
10933 1 printer disabled
10934 1 of 3 printers enabled
10935 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10936 library1.so:
10937 foo [disabled]
10938 library2.so:
10939 bar
10940 bar1 [disabled]
10941 bar2
10942 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10943 1 printer disabled
10944 0 of 3 printers enabled
10945 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10946 library1.so:
10947 foo [disabled]
10948 library2.so:
10949 bar [disabled]
10950 bar1 [disabled]
10951 bar2
10952 @end smallexample
10953
10954 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10955 as can each individual subprinter.
10956
10957 @node Value History
10958 @section Value History
10959
10960 @cindex value history
10961 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10962 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10963 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10964 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10965 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10966 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10967 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10968 symbol table.
10969
10970 @cindex @code{$}
10971 @cindex @code{$$}
10972 @cindex history number
10973 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10974 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10975 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10976 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10977 history number.
10978
10979 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10980 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10981 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10982 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10983 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10984 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10985 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10986
10987 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10988 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10989
10990 @smallexample
10991 p *$
10992 @end smallexample
10993
10994 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10995 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10996
10997 @smallexample
10998 p *$.next
10999 @end smallexample
11000
11001 @noindent
11002 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
11003 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
11004
11005 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
11006 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
11007
11008 @smallexample
11009 print x
11010 set x=5
11011 @end smallexample
11012
11013 @noindent
11014 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
11015 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
11016
11017 @table @code
11018 @kindex show values
11019 @item show values
11020 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
11021 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
11022 values} does not change the history.
11023
11024 @item show values @var{n}
11025 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
11026
11027 @item show values +
11028 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
11029 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
11030 @end table
11031
11032 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
11033 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
11034
11035 @node Convenience Vars
11036 @section Convenience Variables
11037
11038 @cindex convenience variables
11039 @cindex user-defined variables
11040 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
11041 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
11042 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
11043 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
11044 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
11045
11046 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
11047 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
11048 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
11049 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
11050 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
11051
11052 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
11053 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
11054 For example:
11055
11056 @smallexample
11057 set $foo = *object_ptr
11058 @end smallexample
11059
11060 @noindent
11061 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
11062 @code{object_ptr}.
11063
11064 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
11065 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
11066 value with another assignment at any time.
11067
11068 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
11069 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
11070 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
11071 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
11072
11073 @table @code
11074 @kindex show convenience
11075 @cindex show all user variables and functions
11076 @item show convenience
11077 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
11078 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
11079 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
11080
11081 @kindex init-if-undefined
11082 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
11083 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
11084 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
11085 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
11086 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
11087 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
11088 override default values used in a command script.
11089
11090 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
11091 any side-effects do not occur.
11092 @end table
11093
11094 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
11095 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
11096 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
11097
11098 @smallexample
11099 set $i = 0
11100 print bar[$i++]->contents
11101 @end smallexample
11102
11103 @noindent
11104 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
11105
11106 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
11107 values likely to be useful.
11108
11109 @table @code
11110 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
11111 @item $_
11112 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
11113 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
11114 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
11115 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
11116 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
11117 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
11118 to the type of @code{$__}.
11119
11120 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
11121 @item $__
11122 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
11123 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
11124 to match the format in which the data was printed.
11125
11126 @item $_exitcode
11127 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
11128 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
11129 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
11130 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
11131
11132 @item $_exitsignal
11133 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
11134 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
11135 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
11136 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
11137
11138 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
11139 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
11140 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
11141 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
11142 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
11143
11144 @smallexample
11145 #include <signal.h>
11146
11147 int
11148 main (int argc, char *argv[])
11149 @{
11150 raise (SIGALRM);
11151 return 0;
11152 @}
11153 @end smallexample
11154
11155 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
11156 or signalled would be:
11157
11158 @smallexample
11159 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
11160 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
11161 End with a line saying just ``end''.
11162 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
11163 >echo The program has exited\n
11164 >else
11165 >echo The program has signalled\n
11166 >end
11167 >end
11168 (@value{GDBP}) run
11169 Starting program:
11170
11171 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
11172 The program no longer exists.
11173 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11174 The program has signalled
11175 @end smallexample
11176
11177 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
11178 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
11179 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
11180 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
11181
11182 @smallexample
11183 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11184 The program has exited
11185 @end smallexample
11186
11187 @item $_exception
11188 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
11189 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
11190
11191 @item $_probe_argc
11192 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
11193 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
11194
11195 @item $_sdata
11196 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
11197 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
11198 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
11199 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
11200 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
11201
11202 @item $_siginfo
11203 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
11204 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
11205 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
11206 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
11207 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
11208
11209 @item $_tlb
11210 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
11211 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
11212 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
11213 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
11214 @xref{General Query Packets}.
11215 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
11216
11217 @item $_inferior
11218 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
11219 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
11220
11221 @item $_thread
11222 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
11223
11224 @item $_gthread
11225 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
11226
11227 @end table
11228
11229 @node Convenience Funs
11230 @section Convenience Functions
11231
11232 @cindex convenience functions
11233 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
11234 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
11235 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
11236 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
11237 @value{GDBN}.
11238
11239 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11240 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
11241
11242 @table @code
11243
11244 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
11245 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
11246 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
11247 returns zero.
11248
11249 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
11250 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
11251 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
11252 it is @code{void}:
11253
11254 @smallexample
11255 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11256 $1 = void
11257 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11258 $2 = 1
11259 (@value{GDBP}) run
11260 Starting program: ./a.out
11261 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
11262 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11263 $3 = 0
11264 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11265 $4 = 0
11266 @end smallexample
11267
11268 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
11269 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
11270 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
11271 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
11272 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
11273 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
11274 anymore.
11275
11276 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
11277 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
11278
11279 @smallexample
11280 void
11281 foo (void)
11282 @{
11283 @}
11284 @end smallexample
11285
11286 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
11287
11288 @smallexample
11289 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
11290 $1 = void
11291 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
11292 $2 = 1
11293 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
11294 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
11295 $3 = void
11296 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
11297 $4 = 1
11298 @end smallexample
11299
11300 @end table
11301
11302 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11303 @code{Python} support.
11304
11305 @table @code
11306
11307 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
11308 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
11309 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
11310 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
11311 Otherwise it returns zero.
11312
11313 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
11314 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
11315 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
11316 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11317 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
11318 regular expression support.
11319
11320 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
11321 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
11322 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
11323 Otherwise it returns zero.
11324
11325 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
11326 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
11327 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
11328
11329 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11330 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
11331 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
11332 Otherwise it returns zero.
11333
11334 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11335 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11336 The default is 1.
11337
11338 Example:
11339
11340 @smallexample
11341 (gdb) backtrace
11342 #0 bottom_func ()
11343 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
11344 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
11345 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
11346 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
11347 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
11348 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
11349 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
11350 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
11351 $1 = 1
11352 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
11353 $1 = 1
11354 @end smallexample
11355
11356 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11357 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
11358 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
11359 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11360
11361 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11362 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11363 The default is 1.
11364
11365 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11366 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
11367 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
11368 Otherwise it returns zero.
11369
11370 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11371 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11372 The default is 1.
11373
11374 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
11375 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
11376 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
11377 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
11378
11379 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11380 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
11381 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
11382 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11383
11384 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11385 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11386 The default is 1.
11387
11388 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
11389 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
11390 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
11391 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
11392
11393 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
11394 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
11395 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
11396
11397 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
11398 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
11399 an enumerated type:
11400
11401 @smallexample
11402 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
11403 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
11404 @end smallexample
11405
11406 @end table
11407
11408 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
11409 convenience functions.
11410
11411 @table @code
11412 @item help function
11413 @kindex help function
11414 @cindex show all convenience functions
11415 Print a list of all convenience functions.
11416 @end table
11417
11418 @node Registers
11419 @section Registers
11420
11421 @cindex registers
11422 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
11423 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
11424 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
11425 your machine.
11426
11427 @table @code
11428 @kindex info registers
11429 @item info registers
11430 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
11431 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11432
11433 @kindex info all-registers
11434 @cindex floating point registers
11435 @item info all-registers
11436 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
11437 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11438
11439 @item info registers @var{reggroup} @dots{}
11440 Print the name and value of the registers in each of the specified
11441 @var{reggroup}s. The @var{reggoup} can be any of those returned by
11442 @code{maint print reggroups} (@pxref{Maintenance Commands}).
11443
11444 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
11445 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
11446 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
11447 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
11448 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
11449 @end table
11450
11451 @anchor{standard registers}
11452 @cindex stack pointer register
11453 @cindex program counter register
11454 @cindex process status register
11455 @cindex frame pointer register
11456 @cindex standard registers
11457 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
11458 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
11459 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
11460 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
11461 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
11462 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
11463 register that contains the processor status. For example,
11464 you could print the program counter in hex with
11465
11466 @smallexample
11467 p/x $pc
11468 @end smallexample
11469
11470 @noindent
11471 or print the instruction to be executed next with
11472
11473 @smallexample
11474 x/i $pc
11475 @end smallexample
11476
11477 @noindent
11478 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
11479 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
11480 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
11481 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
11482 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
11483 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
11484 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
11485
11486 @smallexample
11487 set $sp += 4
11488 @end smallexample
11489
11490 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
11491 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
11492 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
11493 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
11494 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
11495 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
11496 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
11497
11498 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
11499 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
11500 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
11501 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
11502 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
11503 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
11504 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
11505
11506 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
11507 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
11508 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
11509 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
11510 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
11511 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
11512 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
11513 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
11514 prints the data in both formats.
11515
11516 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
11517 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
11518 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
11519 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
11520 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
11521 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
11522 registers in @code{struct} notation:
11523
11524 @smallexample
11525 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
11526 $1 = @{
11527 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
11528 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
11529 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
11530 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
11531 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
11532 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
11533 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
11534 @}
11535 @end smallexample
11536
11537 @noindent
11538 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
11539 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
11540 value to a @code{struct} member:
11541
11542 @smallexample
11543 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
11544 @end smallexample
11545
11546 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
11547 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
11548 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
11549 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
11550 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
11551 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
11552
11553 @cindex caller-saved registers
11554 @cindex call-clobbered registers
11555 @cindex volatile registers
11556 @cindex <not saved> values
11557 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
11558 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
11559 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
11560 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
11561 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
11562 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
11563 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
11564 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
11565 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
11566 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
11567 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
11568 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
11569 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
11570 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
11571 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
11572 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
11573 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
11574 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
11575 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
11576 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
11577 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
11578 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
11579 represent the value the register had just before the call.
11580
11581 @node Floating Point Hardware
11582 @section Floating Point Hardware
11583 @cindex floating point
11584
11585 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
11586 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
11587
11588 @table @code
11589 @kindex info float
11590 @item info float
11591 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
11592 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
11593 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
11594 the ARM and x86 machines.
11595 @end table
11596
11597 @node Vector Unit
11598 @section Vector Unit
11599 @cindex vector unit
11600
11601 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
11602 more information about the status of the vector unit.
11603
11604 @table @code
11605 @kindex info vector
11606 @item info vector
11607 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
11608 layout vary depending on the hardware.
11609 @end table
11610
11611 @node OS Information
11612 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
11613 @cindex OS information
11614
11615 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
11616 you debug your program.
11617
11618 @cindex auxiliary vector
11619 @cindex vector, auxiliary
11620 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
11621 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
11622 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
11623 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
11624 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
11625 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
11626 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
11627 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
11628 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
11629 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
11630 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
11631
11632 @table @code
11633 @kindex info auxv
11634 @item info auxv
11635 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11636 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11637 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11638 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11639 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11640 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11641 an unrecognized tag.
11642 @end table
11643
11644 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11645 information and show it to you. The types of information available
11646 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11647 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11648 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
11649 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11650 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11651
11652 @table @code
11653 @kindex info os
11654 @item info os @var{infotype}
11655
11656 Display OS information of the requested type.
11657
11658 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11659
11660 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11661 @table @code
11662 @kindex info os cpus
11663 @item cpus
11664 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11665 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11666 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11667 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11668 kernel initialization.
11669
11670 @kindex info os files
11671 @item files
11672 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
11673 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11674 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11675 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11676
11677 @kindex info os modules
11678 @item modules
11679 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
11680 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11681 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11682 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11683 in memory.
11684
11685 @kindex info os msg
11686 @item msg
11687 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
11688 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11689 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11690 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11691 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11692 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11693 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11694 the message queue was last changed.
11695
11696 @kindex info os processes
11697 @item processes
11698 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
11699 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11700 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11701 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
11702 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11703 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11704
11705 @kindex info os procgroups
11706 @item procgroups
11707 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
11708 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11709 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11710 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
11711 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11712 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11713 and the process group leader is listed first.
11714
11715 @kindex info os semaphores
11716 @item semaphores
11717 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
11718 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11719 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11720 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11721 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11722
11723 @kindex info os shm
11724 @item shm
11725 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11726 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11727 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11728 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11729 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11730 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11731 attached to, detach from, and changed.
11732
11733 @kindex info os sockets
11734 @item sockets
11735 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
11736 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11737 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11738 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11739 connection.
11740
11741 @kindex info os threads
11742 @item threads
11743 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
11744 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11745 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11746 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
11747 process is not listed.
11748 @end table
11749
11750 @item info os
11751 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11752 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11753 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
11754 types, this command will report an error.
11755 @end table
11756
11757 @node Memory Region Attributes
11758 @section Memory Region Attributes
11759 @cindex memory region attributes
11760
11761 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11762 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11763 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11764 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11765 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11766 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11767 user can override the fetched regions.
11768
11769 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11770 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11771 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11772 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11773 all memory.
11774
11775 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11776 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11777
11778 @table @code
11779 @kindex mem
11780 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11781 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11782 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11783 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11784 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11785 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11786
11787 @item mem auto
11788 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11789 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11790
11791 @kindex delete mem
11792 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11793 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11794 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11795
11796 @kindex disable mem
11797 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11798 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11799 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11800 It may be enabled again later.
11801
11802 @kindex enable mem
11803 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11804 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11805
11806 @kindex info mem
11807 @item info mem
11808 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11809 for each region:
11810
11811 @table @emph
11812 @item Memory Region Number
11813 @item Enabled or Disabled.
11814 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11815 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11816
11817 @item Lo Address
11818 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11819
11820 @item Hi Address
11821 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11822
11823 @item Attributes
11824 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11825 @end table
11826 @end table
11827
11828
11829 @subsection Attributes
11830
11831 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11832 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11833 write accesses to a memory region.
11834
11835 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11836 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11837 etc.@: from accessing memory.
11838
11839 @table @code
11840 @item ro
11841 Memory is read only.
11842 @item wo
11843 Memory is write only.
11844 @item rw
11845 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11846 @end table
11847
11848 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11849 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11850 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11851 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11852 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11853
11854 @table @code
11855 @item 8
11856 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11857 @item 16
11858 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11859 @item 32
11860 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11861 @item 64
11862 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11863 @end table
11864
11865 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11866 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11867 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11868 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11869 @c
11870 @c @table @code
11871 @c @item hwbreak
11872 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11873 @c @item swbreak (default)
11874 @c @end table
11875
11876 @subsubsection Data Cache
11877 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11878 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11879 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11880 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11881 registers.
11882
11883 @table @code
11884 @item cache
11885 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11886 @item nocache
11887 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11888 @end table
11889
11890 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11891 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11892 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11893 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11894 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11895
11896 @table @code
11897 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11898 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11899 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11900 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11901 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11902 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11903 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11904 The default value is @code{on}.
11905 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11906 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11907 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11908 @end table
11909
11910
11911 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11912 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11913 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11914 @c
11915 @c @table @code
11916 @c @item verify
11917 @c @item noverify (default)
11918 @c @end table
11919
11920 @node Dump/Restore Files
11921 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11922 @cindex dump/restore files
11923 @cindex append data to a file
11924 @cindex dump data to a file
11925 @cindex restore data from a file
11926
11927 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11928 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11929 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11930 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11931 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11932 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11933 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11934
11935 @table @code
11936
11937 @kindex dump
11938 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11939 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11940 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11941 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11942
11943 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11944 @table @code
11945 @item binary
11946 Raw binary form.
11947 @item ihex
11948 Intel hex format.
11949 @item srec
11950 Motorola S-record format.
11951 @item tekhex
11952 Tektronix Hex format.
11953 @item verilog
11954 Verilog Hex format.
11955 @end table
11956
11957 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11958 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11959 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11960 form.
11961
11962 @kindex append
11963 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11964 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11965 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11966 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11967 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11968
11969 @kindex restore
11970 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11971 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11972 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11973 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11974 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11975
11976 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11977 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11978 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11979 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11980 from that location.
11981
11982 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11983 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11984 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11985 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11986
11987 @end table
11988
11989 @node Core File Generation
11990 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11991 @cindex dump core from inferior
11992
11993 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11994 image of a running process and its process status (register values
11995 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11996 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11997 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11998 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11999 the post-mortem debugging mode.
12000
12001 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
12002 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
12003 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
12004
12005 @table @code
12006 @kindex gcore
12007 @kindex generate-core-file
12008 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
12009 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
12010 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
12011 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
12012 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
12013 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
12014
12015 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
12016 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
12017
12018 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
12019 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
12020 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}), and by default honors the
12021 @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag for mappings where it is present in the file
12022 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} (@pxref{set dump-excluded-mappings}).
12023
12024 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
12025 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
12026 @item set use-coredump-filter on
12027 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
12028 Enable or disable the use of the file
12029 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
12030 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
12031 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
12032 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
12033
12034 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
12035 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
12036 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
12037 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
12038 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
12039 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
12040 about the bits that can be set in the
12041 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
12042 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
12043
12044 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
12045 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
12046 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
12047 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
12048 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
12049 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
12050 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
12051 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
12052
12053 @kindex set dump-excluded-mappings
12054 @anchor{set dump-excluded-mappings}
12055 @item set dump-excluded-mappings on
12056 @itemx set dump-excluded-mappings off
12057 If @code{on} is specified, @value{GDBN} will dump memory mappings
12058 marked with the @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag. This flag is represented in
12059 the file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} with the acronym @code{dd}.
12060
12061 The default value is @code{off}.
12062 @end table
12063
12064 @node Character Sets
12065 @section Character Sets
12066 @cindex character sets
12067 @cindex charset
12068 @cindex translating between character sets
12069 @cindex host character set
12070 @cindex target character set
12071
12072 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
12073 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
12074 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
12075 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
12076 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
12077 @dfn{target character set}.
12078
12079 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
12080 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
12081 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
12082 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
12083 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
12084 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
12085 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
12086 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
12087 character and string literals in expressions.
12088
12089 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
12090 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
12091 target-charset} command, described below.
12092
12093 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
12094 support:
12095
12096 @table @code
12097 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
12098 @kindex set target-charset
12099 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
12100 list of supported target character sets, type
12101 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
12102
12103 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
12104 @kindex set host-charset
12105 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
12106
12107 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
12108 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
12109 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
12110 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
12111 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
12112
12113 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
12114 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
12115 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
12116
12117 @item set charset @var{charset}
12118 @kindex set charset
12119 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
12120 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
12121 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
12122 for both host and target.
12123
12124 @item show charset
12125 @kindex show charset
12126 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
12127
12128 @item show host-charset
12129 @kindex show host-charset
12130 Show the name of the current host character set.
12131
12132 @item show target-charset
12133 @kindex show target-charset
12134 Show the name of the current target character set.
12135
12136 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
12137 @kindex set target-wide-charset
12138 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
12139 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
12140 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
12141 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
12142
12143 @item show target-wide-charset
12144 @kindex show target-wide-charset
12145 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
12146 @end table
12147
12148 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
12149 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
12150 @file{charset-test.c}:
12151
12152 @smallexample
12153 #include <stdio.h>
12154
12155 char ascii_hello[]
12156 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
12157 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
12158 char ibm1047_hello[]
12159 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
12160 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
12161
12162 main ()
12163 @{
12164 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12165 @}
12166 @end smallexample
12167
12168 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
12169 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
12170 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
12171
12172 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
12173
12174 @smallexample
12175 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
12176 $ gdb -nw charset-test
12177 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
12178 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12179 @dots{}
12180 (@value{GDBP})
12181 @end smallexample
12182
12183 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
12184 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
12185 strings:
12186
12187 @smallexample
12188 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12189 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
12190 (@value{GDBP})
12191 @end smallexample
12192
12193 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
12194 initial character set:
12195 @smallexample
12196 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
12197 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12198 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
12199 (@value{GDBP})
12200 @end smallexample
12201
12202 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
12203 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
12204 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
12205 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
12206 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
12207
12208 @smallexample
12209 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12210 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
12211 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12212 $2 = 72 'H'
12213 (@value{GDBP})
12214 @end smallexample
12215
12216 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
12217 literals you use in expressions:
12218
12219 @smallexample
12220 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12221 $3 = 43 '+'
12222 (@value{GDBP})
12223 @end smallexample
12224
12225 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
12226 character.
12227
12228 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
12229 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
12230 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
12231
12232 @smallexample
12233 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12234 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
12235 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12236 $5 = 200 '\310'
12237 (@value{GDBP})
12238 @end smallexample
12239
12240 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
12241 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
12242
12243 @smallexample
12244 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12245 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
12246 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12247 @end smallexample
12248
12249 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
12250 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
12251 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
12252 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
12253 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
12254
12255 @smallexample
12256 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
12257 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12258 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
12259 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
12260 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12261 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
12262 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12263 $7 = 72 '\110'
12264 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12265 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
12266 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12267 $9 = 200 'H'
12268 (@value{GDBP})
12269 @end smallexample
12270
12271 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
12272 string literals you use in expressions:
12273
12274 @smallexample
12275 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12276 $10 = 78 '+'
12277 (@value{GDBP})
12278 @end smallexample
12279
12280 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
12281 character.
12282
12283 @node Caching Target Data
12284 @section Caching Data of Targets
12285 @cindex caching data of targets
12286
12287 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
12288 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
12289 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
12290 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
12291 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
12292 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
12293 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
12294 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
12295 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
12296 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
12297 is executing.
12298 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
12299 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
12300 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
12301 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
12302 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
12303 in the code segment.
12304 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
12305 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
12306
12307 @table @code
12308 @kindex set remotecache
12309 @item set remotecache on
12310 @itemx set remotecache off
12311 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
12312 with old scripts.
12313
12314 @kindex show remotecache
12315 @item show remotecache
12316 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
12317
12318 @kindex set stack-cache
12319 @item set stack-cache on
12320 @itemx set stack-cache off
12321 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
12322 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
12323
12324 @kindex show stack-cache
12325 @item show stack-cache
12326 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
12327
12328 @kindex set code-cache
12329 @item set code-cache on
12330 @itemx set code-cache off
12331 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
12332 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
12333 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
12334
12335 @kindex show code-cache
12336 @item show code-cache
12337 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
12338 accesses.
12339
12340 @kindex info dcache
12341 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
12342 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
12343 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
12344 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
12345 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
12346 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
12347
12348 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
12349 printed in hex.
12350
12351 @item set dcache size @var{size}
12352 @cindex dcache size
12353 @kindex set dcache size
12354 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
12355
12356 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
12357 @cindex dcache line-size
12358 @kindex set dcache line-size
12359 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
12360 Must be a power of 2.
12361
12362 @item show dcache size
12363 @kindex show dcache size
12364 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
12365
12366 @item show dcache line-size
12367 @kindex show dcache line-size
12368 Show default size of dcache lines.
12369
12370 @end table
12371
12372 @node Searching Memory
12373 @section Search Memory
12374 @cindex searching memory
12375
12376 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
12377 @code{find} command.
12378
12379 @table @code
12380 @kindex find
12381 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
12382 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
12383 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
12384 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
12385 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
12386 @end table
12387
12388 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
12389 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
12390
12391 @table @r
12392 @item @var{s}, search query size
12393 The size of each search query value.
12394
12395 @table @code
12396 @item b
12397 bytes
12398 @item h
12399 halfwords (two bytes)
12400 @item w
12401 words (four bytes)
12402 @item g
12403 giant words (eight bytes)
12404 @end table
12405
12406 All values are interpreted in the current language.
12407 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
12408 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
12409 The null terminator can be removed from searching by using casts,
12410 e.g.: @samp{@{char[5]@}"hello"}.
12411
12412 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
12413 value's type in the current language.
12414 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
12415 pattern as a mixture of types.
12416 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
12417 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
12418 which is typically four bytes.
12419
12420 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
12421 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
12422 @end table
12423
12424 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
12425 (@code{"}).
12426 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
12427 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
12428
12429 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
12430 number of matches found.
12431
12432 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
12433 @samp{$_}.
12434 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
12435
12436 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
12437
12438 @smallexample
12439 void
12440 hello ()
12441 @{
12442 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
12443 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
12444 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
12445 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
12446 printf ("%s\n", hello);
12447 @}
12448 @end smallexample
12449
12450 @noindent
12451 you get during debugging:
12452
12453 @smallexample
12454 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
12455 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12456 1 pattern found
12457 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
12458 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12459 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12460 2 patterns found.
12461 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), @{char[5]@}"hello"
12462 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12463 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12464 2 patterns found.
12465 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
12466 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12467 1 pattern found
12468 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
12469 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
12470 1 pattern found
12471 (gdb) print $numfound
12472 $1 = 1
12473 (gdb) print $_
12474 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
12475 @end smallexample
12476
12477 @node Value Sizes
12478 @section Value Sizes
12479
12480 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
12481 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
12482 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
12483 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
12484 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
12485
12486 @table @code
12487 @kindex set max-value-size
12488 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
12489 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
12490 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
12491 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
12492 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
12493
12494 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
12495 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
12496
12497 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
12498 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
12499 currently 16 bytes.
12500
12501 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
12502 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
12503 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
12504 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
12505 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
12506 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
12507 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
12508 size is less than @var{bytes}.
12509
12510 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
12511
12512 @kindex show max-value-size
12513 @item show max-value-size
12514 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
12515 allocate for the contents of a value.
12516 @end table
12517
12518 @node Optimized Code
12519 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
12520 @cindex optimized code, debugging
12521 @cindex debugging optimized code
12522
12523 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
12524 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
12525 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
12526 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
12527 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
12528 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
12529 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
12530
12531 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
12532 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
12533 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
12534 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
12535
12536 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
12537 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
12538 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
12539 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
12540 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
12541 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
12542
12543 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
12544 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
12545 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
12546 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
12547 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
12548
12549 @menu
12550 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
12551 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
12552 @end menu
12553
12554 @node Inline Functions
12555 @section Inline Functions
12556 @cindex inline functions, debugging
12557
12558 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
12559 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
12560 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
12561 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
12562 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
12563 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
12564 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
12565 @code{info frame} command.
12566
12567 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
12568 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
12569 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
12570 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
12571 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
12572 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
12573 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
12574 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
12575 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
12576 local variables in the caller.
12577
12578 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
12579 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
12580 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
12581 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
12582 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
12583 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
12584 instructions are executed.
12585
12586 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
12587 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
12588 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
12589 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
12590
12591 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
12592 function calls are the same as normal calls:
12593
12594 @itemize @bullet
12595 @item
12596 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
12597 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
12598 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
12599 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
12600 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
12601 or inside the inlined function instead.
12602
12603 @item
12604 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
12605 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
12606 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
12607 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
12608
12609 @end itemize
12610
12611 @node Tail Call Frames
12612 @section Tail Call Frames
12613 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
12614
12615 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
12616 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
12617 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
12618 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
12619 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
12620
12621 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
12622 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
12623 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
12624 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
12625 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
12626 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
12627 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
12628
12629 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
12630 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
12631 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
12632 this information.
12633
12634 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
12635 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
12636
12637 @smallexample
12638 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
12639 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
12640 (gdb) info frame
12641 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
12642 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
12643 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
12644 source language c++.
12645 Arglist at unknown address.
12646 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
12647 @end smallexample
12648
12649 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
12650 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
12651 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
12652 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
12653 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12654 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12655
12656 @table @code
12657 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
12658 @item set debug entry-values
12659 @kindex set debug entry-values
12660 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12661 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
12662 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
12663 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12664 result.
12665
12666 @item show debug entry-values
12667 @kindex show debug entry-values
12668 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12669 values at function entry and tail calls.
12670 @end table
12671
12672 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12673 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12674 reference by variable @code{x}):
12675
12676 @smallexample
12677 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12678 void (*x) (void) = c;
12679 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12680 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12681 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12682
12683 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_entry_value resolving cannot find
12684 DW_TAG_call_site 0x40039a in main
12685 a () at t.c:3
12686 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12687 (gdb) bt
12688 #0 a () at t.c:3
12689 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12690 @end smallexample
12691
12692 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12693
12694 @smallexample
12695 int i;
12696 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12697 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12698 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12699 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12700 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12701 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12702 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12703 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12704
12705 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12706 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12707 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12708 (gdb) bt
12709 #0 f () at t.c:2
12710 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12711 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12712 @end smallexample
12713
12714 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12715 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12716
12717 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12718 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12719 @set ARROW @click{}
12720 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12721 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12722 @end ifset
12723 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12724 @set ARROW ->
12725 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12726 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12727 @end ifclear
12728
12729 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12730 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12731 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12732
12733 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12734 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12735 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12736 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
12737 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12738 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12739
12740 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12741 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12742 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12743 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12744 omitted.
12745
12746 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12747 entry may fail:
12748
12749 @smallexample
12750 int v;
12751 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12752 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12753 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12754 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12755 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12756 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12757
12758 (gdb) bt
12759 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12760 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found
12761 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12762 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12763 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12764 @end smallexample
12765
12766 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12767 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12768 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12769 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12770 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12771
12772 @node Macros
12773 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12774
12775 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12776 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12777 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12778 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12779 where it was defined.
12780
12781 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12782 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
12783 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12784 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
12785
12786 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12787 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
12788 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12789 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12790 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
12791 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12792 see @ref{List}.
12793
12794 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12795 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
12796 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12797
12798 @table @code
12799
12800 @kindex macro expand
12801 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12802 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12803 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12804 @item macro expand @var{expression}
12805 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12806 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12807 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12808 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12809 it can be any string of tokens.
12810
12811 @kindex macro exp1
12812 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12813 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12814 @cindex expand macro once
12815 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
12816 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12817 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12818 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12819 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12820 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12821 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12822 can be any string of tokens.
12823
12824 @kindex info macro
12825 @cindex macro definition, showing
12826 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
12827 @cindex macros, from debug info
12828 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12829 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12830 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12831 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12832 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12833 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12834
12835 @kindex info macros
12836 @item info macros @var{location}
12837 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12838 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12839 command-line where those definitions were established.
12840
12841 @kindex macro define
12842 @cindex user-defined macros
12843 @cindex defining macros interactively
12844 @cindex macros, user-defined
12845 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12846 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12847 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12848 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12849 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12850 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12851 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12852 @var{arglist}.
12853
12854 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12855 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12856 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12857 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12858 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12859
12860 @kindex macro undef
12861 @item macro undef @var{macro}
12862 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12863 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12864 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12865 in the program being debugged.
12866
12867 @kindex macro list
12868 @item macro list
12869 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12870 @end table
12871
12872 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
12873 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12874 show our source files:
12875
12876 @smallexample
12877 $ cat sample.c
12878 #include <stdio.h>
12879 #include "sample.h"
12880
12881 #define M 42
12882 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12883
12884 main ()
12885 @{
12886 #define N 28
12887 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12888 #undef N
12889 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12890 #define N 1729
12891 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12892 @}
12893 $ cat sample.h
12894 #define Q <
12895 $
12896 @end smallexample
12897
12898 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12899 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12900 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12901 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12902 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12903 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12904 information.
12905
12906 @smallexample
12907 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12908 $
12909 @end smallexample
12910
12911 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12912
12913 @smallexample
12914 $ gdb -nw sample
12915 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12916 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12917 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12918 (@value{GDBP})
12919 @end smallexample
12920
12921 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12922 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12923 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12924
12925 @smallexample
12926 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12927 3
12928 4 #define M 42
12929 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12930 6
12931 7 main ()
12932 8 @{
12933 9 #define N 28
12934 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12935 11 #undef N
12936 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12937 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12938 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12939 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12940 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12941 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12942 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12943 #define Q <
12944 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12945 expands to: (42 + 1)
12946 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12947 expands to: once (M + 1)
12948 (@value{GDBP})
12949 @end smallexample
12950
12951 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12952 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12953 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12954 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12955
12956 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12957 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12958
12959 @smallexample
12960 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12961 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12962 (@value{GDBP}) run
12963 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12964
12965 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12966 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12967 (@value{GDBP})
12968 @end smallexample
12969
12970 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12971
12972 @smallexample
12973 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12974 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12975 #define N 28
12976 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12977 expands to: 28 < 42
12978 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12979 $1 = 1
12980 (@value{GDBP})
12981 @end smallexample
12982
12983 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12984 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12985 thereof) in force at each point:
12986
12987 @smallexample
12988 (@value{GDBP}) next
12989 Hello, world!
12990 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12991 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12992 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12993 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12994 (@value{GDBP}) next
12995 We're so creative.
12996 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12997 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12998 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12999 #define N 1729
13000 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
13001 expands to: 1729 < 42
13002 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
13003 $2 = 0
13004 (@value{GDBP})
13005 @end smallexample
13006
13007 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
13008 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
13009 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
13010 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
13011
13012 @smallexample
13013 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
13014 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
13015 -D__STDC__=1
13016 (@value{GDBP})
13017 @end smallexample
13018
13019
13020 @node Tracepoints
13021 @chapter Tracepoints
13022 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
13023 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
13024
13025 @cindex tracepoints
13026 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
13027 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
13028 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
13029 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
13030 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
13031 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
13032 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
13033
13034 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
13035 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
13036 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
13037 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
13038 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
13039 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
13040 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
13041 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
13042 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
13043 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
13044 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
13045
13046 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
13047 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
13048 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
13049 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
13050 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
13051 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
13052 Packets}.
13053
13054 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
13055 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
13056 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
13057
13058 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
13059
13060 @menu
13061 * Set Tracepoints::
13062 * Analyze Collected Data::
13063 * Tracepoint Variables::
13064 * Trace Files::
13065 @end menu
13066
13067 @node Set Tracepoints
13068 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
13069
13070 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
13071 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
13072 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
13073 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
13074 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
13075 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
13076 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
13077
13078 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
13079 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
13080 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
13081 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
13082 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
13083 tracepoint was hit.
13084
13085 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
13086 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
13087 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
13088 either.
13089
13090 @cindex fast tracepoints
13091 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
13092 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
13093 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
13094
13095 @cindex static tracepoints
13096 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
13097 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
13098 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
13099 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
13100 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
13101 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
13102 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
13103 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
13104 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
13105 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
13106 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
13107 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
13108 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
13109 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
13110 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
13111 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
13112 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
13113 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
13114 static tracepoint marker.
13115
13116 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
13117 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
13118
13119 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
13120 conditions and actions.
13121
13122 @menu
13123 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
13124 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
13125 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
13126 * Tracepoint Conditions::
13127 * Trace State Variables::
13128 * Tracepoint Actions::
13129 * Listing Tracepoints::
13130 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
13131 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
13132 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
13133 @end menu
13134
13135 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
13136 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
13137
13138 @table @code
13139 @cindex set tracepoint
13140 @kindex trace
13141 @item trace @var{location}
13142 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
13143 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
13144 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
13145 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
13146 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
13147 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
13148 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
13149 in tracing}).
13150 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
13151 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
13152 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
13153 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
13154 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
13155 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
13156 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
13157 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
13158 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
13159 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
13160 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
13161 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
13162
13163 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
13164
13165 @smallexample
13166 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
13167
13168 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
13169
13170 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
13171
13172 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
13173
13174 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
13175 @end smallexample
13176
13177 @noindent
13178 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
13179
13180 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
13181 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
13182 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
13183 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
13184 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
13185 information on tracepoint conditions.
13186
13187 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13188 @cindex set fast tracepoint
13189 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
13190 @kindex ftrace
13191 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
13192 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
13193 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
13194 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
13195 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
13196 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
13197 message.
13198
13199 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
13200 @code{trace}.
13201
13202 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
13203 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
13204 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
13205 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
13206 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
13207 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
13208 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
13209 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
13210
13211 @example
13212 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
13213 @end example
13214
13215 @noindent
13216 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
13217 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
13218
13219 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13220 @cindex set static tracepoint
13221 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
13222 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
13223 @kindex strace
13224 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
13225 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
13226 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
13227 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
13228 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
13229
13230 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
13231 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
13232 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
13233 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
13234 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
13235 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
13236 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
13237 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
13238 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
13239 tracing engine:
13240
13241 @smallexample
13242 main ()
13243 @{
13244 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
13245 @}
13246 @end smallexample
13247
13248 @noindent
13249 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
13250 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
13251
13252 @smallexample
13253 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13254 Cnt Enb ID Address What
13255 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
13256 Data: "str %s"
13257 [etc...]
13258 @end smallexample
13259
13260 @noindent
13261 so you may probe the marker above with:
13262
13263 @smallexample
13264 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
13265 @end smallexample
13266
13267 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
13268 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
13269 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
13270 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
13271 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
13272 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
13273 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
13274 the @samp{Data:} field.
13275
13276 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
13277 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
13278 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
13279
13280 @vindex $tpnum
13281 @cindex last tracepoint number
13282 @cindex recent tracepoint number
13283 @cindex tracepoint number
13284 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
13285 of the most recently set tracepoint.
13286
13287 @kindex delete tracepoint
13288 @cindex tracepoint deletion
13289 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13290 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
13291 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
13292 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
13293
13294 Examples:
13295
13296 @smallexample
13297 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
13298
13299 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
13300 @end smallexample
13301
13302 @noindent
13303 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
13304 @end table
13305
13306 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13307 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13308
13309 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
13310
13311 @table @code
13312 @kindex disable tracepoint
13313 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13314 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
13315 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
13316 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
13317 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
13318 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
13319 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
13320 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
13321 next trace experiment.
13322
13323 @kindex enable tracepoint
13324 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13325 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
13326 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
13327 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
13328 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
13329 next time a trace experiment is run.
13330 @end table
13331
13332 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
13333 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
13334
13335 @table @code
13336 @kindex passcount
13337 @cindex tracepoint pass count
13338 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
13339 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
13340 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
13341 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
13342 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
13343 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
13344 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
13345 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
13346 user.
13347
13348 Examples:
13349
13350 @smallexample
13351 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
13352 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
13353
13354 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
13355 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
13356 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13357 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
13358 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
13359 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
13360 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
13361 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
13362 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
13363 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
13364 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
13365 @end smallexample
13366 @end table
13367
13368 @node Tracepoint Conditions
13369 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
13370 @cindex conditional tracepoints
13371 @cindex tracepoint conditions
13372
13373 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
13374 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
13375 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
13376 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
13377 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
13378 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
13379 is true.
13380
13381 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
13382 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
13383 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
13384 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
13385 just as with breakpoints.
13386
13387 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
13388 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
13389 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
13390 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
13391 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
13392 accesses, and so forth.
13393
13394 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
13395 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
13396 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
13397 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
13398 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
13399 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
13400 search through.
13401
13402 @smallexample
13403 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
13404 @end smallexample
13405
13406 @node Trace State Variables
13407 @subsection Trace State Variables
13408 @cindex trace state variables
13409
13410 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
13411 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
13412 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
13413 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
13414 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
13415 integers.
13416
13417 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
13418 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
13419 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
13420 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
13421
13422 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
13423 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
13424 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
13425 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
13426 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
13427 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
13428 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
13429 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
13430 variable with the same name.
13431
13432 @table @code
13433
13434 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
13435 @kindex tvariable
13436 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
13437 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
13438 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
13439 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
13440 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
13441 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
13442 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
13443 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
13444 value. The default initial value is 0.
13445
13446 @item info tvariables
13447 @kindex info tvariables
13448 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
13449 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
13450 currently running.
13451
13452 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
13453 @kindex delete tvariable
13454 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
13455 are specified.
13456
13457 @end table
13458
13459 @node Tracepoint Actions
13460 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
13461
13462 @table @code
13463 @kindex actions
13464 @cindex tracepoint actions
13465 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13466 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
13467 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
13468 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
13469 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
13470 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
13471 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
13472 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
13473 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
13474 @code{while-stepping}.
13475
13476 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
13477 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
13478 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
13479
13480 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
13481 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
13482 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
13483
13484 @smallexample
13485 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
13486
13487 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
13488
13489 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
13490 @end smallexample
13491
13492 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
13493 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
13494 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
13495 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
13496 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
13497 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
13498 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
13499 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
13500
13501 @smallexample
13502 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13503 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13504 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
13505 > collect bar,baz
13506 > collect $regs
13507 > while-stepping 12
13508 > collect $pc, arr[i]
13509 > end
13510 end
13511 @end smallexample
13512
13513 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
13514 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13515 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
13516 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
13517 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
13518 special arguments are supported:
13519
13520 @table @code
13521 @item $regs
13522 Collect all registers.
13523
13524 @item $args
13525 Collect all function arguments.
13526
13527 @item $locals
13528 Collect all local variables.
13529
13530 @item $_ret
13531 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
13532 of a backtrace.
13533
13534 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
13535 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
13536 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
13537 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
13538 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
13539 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
13540
13541 @item $_probe_argc
13542 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
13543 tracepoint is located.
13544 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13545
13546 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
13547 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
13548 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
13549 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13550
13551 @item $_sdata
13552 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
13553 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
13554 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
13555 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
13556 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
13557 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
13558 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
13559 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
13560 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
13561
13562 @smallexample
13563 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
13564 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
13565 @end smallexample
13566
13567 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
13568 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
13569 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
13570 @value{GDBN}.
13571 @end table
13572
13573 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
13574 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
13575 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
13576
13577 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
13578 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
13579 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
13580 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
13581 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
13582 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
13583 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
13584 @samp{mystr}.
13585
13586 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
13587 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
13588
13589 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
13590 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13591 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
13592 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
13593 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
13594 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
13595 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
13596 action were used.
13597
13598 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
13599 @item while-stepping @var{n}
13600 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
13601 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
13602 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
13603 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
13604
13605 @smallexample
13606 > while-stepping 12
13607 > collect $regs, myglobal
13608 > end
13609 >
13610 @end smallexample
13611
13612 @noindent
13613 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
13614 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
13615 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
13616 @code{stepping}.
13617
13618 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13619 @kindex set default-collect
13620 @cindex default collection action
13621 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
13622 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
13623 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
13624 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
13625 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
13626 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
13627
13628 @item show default-collect
13629 @kindex show default-collect
13630 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
13631 tracepoint hit.
13632
13633 @end table
13634
13635 @node Listing Tracepoints
13636 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
13637
13638 @table @code
13639 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13640 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13641 @cindex information about tracepoints
13642 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
13643 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
13644 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
13645 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
13646 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
13647 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
13648
13649 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
13650 tracing:
13651
13652 @itemize @bullet
13653 @item
13654 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
13655
13656 @item
13657 the state about installed on target of each location
13658 @end itemize
13659
13660 @smallexample
13661 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13662 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
13663 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13664 while-stepping 20
13665 collect globfoo, $regs
13666 end
13667 collect globfoo2
13668 end
13669 pass count 1200
13670 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
13671 collect $eip
13672 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13673 installed on target
13674 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13675 installed on target
13676 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
13677 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13678 not installed on target
13679 (@value{GDBP})
13680 @end smallexample
13681
13682 @noindent
13683 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13684 @end table
13685
13686 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13687 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13688
13689 @table @code
13690 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13691 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13692 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
13693 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13694 program.
13695
13696 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13697
13698 @table @emph
13699 @item Count
13700 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
13701 stable identifier.
13702 @item ID
13703 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13704 @item Enabled or Disabled
13705 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
13706 that are not enabled.
13707 @item Address
13708 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13709 @item What
13710 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13711 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
13712 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13713 will be left blank.
13714 @end table
13715
13716 @noindent
13717 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13718
13719 @table @emph
13720 @item Data
13721 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
13722 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13723 marker call.
13724 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13725 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13726 @end table
13727
13728 @smallexample
13729 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13730 Cnt ID Enb Address What
13731 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13732 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13733 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
13734 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13735 Data: str %s
13736 (@value{GDBP})
13737 @end smallexample
13738 @end table
13739
13740 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13741 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13742
13743 @table @code
13744 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13745 @cindex start a new trace experiment
13746 @cindex collected data discarded
13747 @item tstart
13748 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13749 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13750 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
13751 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13752 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13753 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13754 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13755 information, and so forth.
13756
13757 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13758 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
13759 @item tstop
13760 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
13761 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
13762 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13763 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13764 needs to be stopped quickly.
13765
13766 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13767 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13768 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13769
13770 @kindex tstatus
13771 @cindex status of trace data collection
13772 @cindex trace experiment, status of
13773 @item tstatus
13774 This command displays the status of the current trace data
13775 collection.
13776 @end table
13777
13778 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13779
13780 @smallexample
13781 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13782 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13783 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13784 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
13785 > while-stepping 11
13786 > collect $regs
13787 > end
13788 > end
13789 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13790 [time passes @dots{}]
13791 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13792 @end smallexample
13793
13794 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
13795 @cindex disconnected tracing
13796 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13797 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13798 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13799 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
13800 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13801 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13802 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13803 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13804
13805 @table @code
13806 @item set disconnected-tracing on
13807 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13808 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
13809 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13810 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
13811 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13812 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13813 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13814
13815 @item show disconnected-tracing
13816 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
13817 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13818
13819 @end table
13820
13821 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13822 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13823 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
13824 it will continue after reconnection.
13825
13826 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13827 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13828 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13829 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13830 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13831 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13832 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13833 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13834 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13835 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13836
13837 @cindex circular trace buffer
13838 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13839 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13840 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13841 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13842 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13843 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13844 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13845 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13846 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13847 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13848 the next run.
13849
13850 @table @code
13851 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
13852 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13853 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13854 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13855 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13856 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13857 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13858
13859 @item show circular-trace-buffer
13860 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13861 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13862 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13863 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13864 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13865
13866 @end table
13867
13868 @table @code
13869 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13870 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13871 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
13872 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13873 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13874 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13875 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13876 likes. This is also the default.
13877
13878 @item show trace-buffer-size
13879 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
13880 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13881 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13882 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13883 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13884 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13885 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13886 @end table
13887
13888 @table @code
13889 @item set trace-user @var{text}
13890 @kindex set trace-user
13891
13892 @item show trace-user
13893 @kindex show trace-user
13894
13895 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
13896 @kindex set trace-notes
13897 Set the trace run's notes.
13898
13899 @item show trace-notes
13900 @kindex show trace-notes
13901 Show the trace run's notes.
13902
13903 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13904 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13905 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13906 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13907 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13908
13909 @item show trace-stop-notes
13910 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13911 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13912
13913 @end table
13914
13915 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13916 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13917
13918 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13919 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13920 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13921 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13922 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13923 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13924 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13925 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13926 mentioned here.
13927
13928 @itemize @bullet
13929
13930 @item
13931 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13932 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13933 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13934 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13935 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13936 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13937 cannot be collected either.
13938
13939 @item
13940 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13941 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13942 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13943 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13944 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13945 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13946 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13947 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13948 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13949 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13950
13951 @item
13952 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13953 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13954 in a misleading way.
13955
13956 @item
13957 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13958 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13959 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13960 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13961 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13962 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13963 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13964 by @code{ptr}.
13965
13966 @item
13967 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13968 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13969 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13970 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13971 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13972 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13973 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13974 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13975 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13976 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13977 invalid address.
13978
13979 @item
13980 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13981 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13982 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13983 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13984 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13985 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13986 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13987 it to zero.
13988
13989 @end itemize
13990
13991 @node Analyze Collected Data
13992 @section Using the Collected Data
13993
13994 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13995 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13996 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13997 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13998 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13999 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
14000 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
14001 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
14002 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
14003 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
14004 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
14005 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
14006 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
14007 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
14008 the buffer will fail.
14009
14010 @menu
14011 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
14012 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
14013 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
14014 @end menu
14015
14016 @node tfind
14017 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
14018
14019 @kindex tfind
14020 @cindex select trace snapshot
14021 @cindex find trace snapshot
14022 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
14023 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
14024 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
14025 snapshot is selected.
14026
14027 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
14028
14029 @table @code
14030 @item tfind start
14031 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
14032 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
14033
14034 @item tfind none
14035 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
14036
14037 @item tfind end
14038 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
14039
14040 @item tfind
14041 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
14042 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
14043
14044 @item tfind -
14045 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
14046 retracing earlier steps.
14047
14048 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
14049 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
14050 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
14051 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
14052 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
14053
14054 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
14055 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
14056 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
14057 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
14058 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
14059
14060 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
14061 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
14062 addresses (exclusive).
14063
14064 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
14065 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
14066 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
14067
14068 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
14069 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
14070 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
14071 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
14072 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
14073 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
14074 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
14075 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
14076 @end table
14077
14078 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
14079 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
14080 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
14081 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
14082 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
14083 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
14084 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
14085 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
14086 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
14087 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
14088 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
14089 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
14090 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
14091 tracepoint as the current one.
14092
14093 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
14094 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
14095 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
14096 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
14097 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
14098
14099 @smallexample
14100 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14101 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
14102 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
14103 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
14104 > tfind
14105 > end
14106
14107 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
14108 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
14109 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
14110 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
14111 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
14112 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
14113 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
14114 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
14115 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
14116 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
14117 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
14118 @end smallexample
14119
14120 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
14121 the buffer:
14122
14123 @smallexample
14124 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14125 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
14126 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
14127 > tfind line
14128 > end
14129
14130 Frame 0, X = 1
14131 Frame 7, X = 2
14132 Frame 13, X = 255
14133 @end smallexample
14134
14135 @node tdump
14136 @subsection @code{tdump}
14137 @kindex tdump
14138 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
14139 @cindex tracepoint data, display
14140
14141 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
14142 the current trace snapshot.
14143
14144 @smallexample
14145 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
14146 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
14147 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
14148 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
14149 > end
14150
14151 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
14152
14153 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
14154 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
14155 at gdb_test.c:444
14156 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
14157
14158 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
14159 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
14160 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
14161 d1 0x18 24
14162 d2 0x80 128
14163 d3 0x33 51
14164 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
14165 d5 0x22 34
14166 d6 0xe0 224
14167 d7 0x380035 3670069
14168 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
14169 a1 0x3000668 50333288
14170 a2 0x100 256
14171 a3 0x322000 3284992
14172 a4 0x3000698 50333336
14173 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
14174 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
14175 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
14176 ps 0x0 0
14177 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
14178 fpcontrol 0x0 0
14179 fpstatus 0x0 0
14180 fpiaddr 0x0 0
14181 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
14182 p1 = (void *) 0x11
14183 p2 = (void *) 0x22
14184 p3 = (void *) 0x33
14185 p4 = (void *) 0x44
14186 p5 = (void *) 0x55
14187 p6 = (void *) 0x66
14188 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
14189
14190 (@value{GDBP})
14191 @end smallexample
14192
14193 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
14194 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
14195 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
14196 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
14197
14198 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
14199 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
14200 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
14201 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
14202 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
14203 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
14204 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
14205 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
14206 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
14207 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
14208
14209 @node save tracepoints
14210 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
14211 @kindex save tracepoints
14212 @kindex save-tracepoints
14213 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
14214
14215 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
14216 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
14217 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
14218 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
14219 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
14220 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
14221
14222 @node Tracepoint Variables
14223 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
14224 @cindex tracepoint variables
14225 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
14226
14227 @table @code
14228 @vindex $trace_frame
14229 @item (int) $trace_frame
14230 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
14231 snapshot is selected.
14232
14233 @vindex $tracepoint
14234 @item (int) $tracepoint
14235 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
14236
14237 @vindex $trace_line
14238 @item (int) $trace_line
14239 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
14240
14241 @vindex $trace_file
14242 @item (char []) $trace_file
14243 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
14244
14245 @vindex $trace_func
14246 @item (char []) $trace_func
14247 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
14248 @end table
14249
14250 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
14251 use @code{output} instead.
14252
14253 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
14254 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
14255 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
14256 which are managed by the target.
14257
14258 @smallexample
14259 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14260
14261 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
14262 > output $trace_file
14263 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
14264 > tfind
14265 > end
14266 @end smallexample
14267
14268 @node Trace Files
14269 @section Using Trace Files
14270 @cindex trace files
14271
14272 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
14273 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
14274 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
14275 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
14276 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
14277
14278 @table @code
14279
14280 @kindex tsave
14281 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
14282 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
14283 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
14284 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
14285 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
14286 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
14287 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
14288 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
14289 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
14290 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
14291 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
14292 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
14293 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
14294 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
14295 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
14296
14297 @kindex target tfile
14298 @kindex tfile
14299 @kindex target ctf
14300 @kindex ctf
14301 @item target tfile @var{filename}
14302 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
14303 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
14304 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
14305 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
14306 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
14307 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
14308 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
14309 the host.
14310
14311 @smallexample
14312 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
14313 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
14314 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
14315 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
14316 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
14317 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
14318 i = 0
14319 a = 0
14320 b = 1 '\001'
14321 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
14322 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
14323 (@value{GDBP}) p b
14324 $1 = 1
14325 @end smallexample
14326
14327 @end table
14328
14329 @node Overlays
14330 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
14331 @cindex overlays
14332
14333 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
14334 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
14335 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
14336 use overlays.
14337
14338 @menu
14339 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
14340 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
14341 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
14342 mapped by asking the inferior.
14343 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
14344 @end menu
14345
14346 @node How Overlays Work
14347 @section How Overlays Work
14348 @cindex mapped overlays
14349 @cindex unmapped overlays
14350 @cindex load address, overlay's
14351 @cindex mapped address
14352 @cindex overlay area
14353
14354 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
14355 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
14356 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
14357 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
14358 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
14359
14360 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
14361 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
14362 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
14363 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
14364 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
14365 largest overlay as well.
14366
14367 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
14368 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
14369 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
14370 there.
14371
14372 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
14373 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
14374 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
14375
14376 @smallexample
14377 @group
14378 Data Instruction Larger
14379 Address Space Address Space Address Space
14380 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
14381 | | | | | |
14382 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
14383 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
14384 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
14385 | and heap | | | | | |
14386 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
14387 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
14388 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
14389 | | | | | |
14390 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
14391 address | | | | | |
14392 | overlay | <-' | | |
14393 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
14394 | | <---. | | load address
14395 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
14396 | | | |
14397 +-----------+ | |
14398 +-----------+
14399 | |
14400 +-----------+
14401
14402 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
14403 @end group
14404 @end smallexample
14405
14406 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
14407 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
14408 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
14409 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
14410 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
14411 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
14412 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
14413 program and the overlay area.
14414
14415 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
14416 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
14417 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
14418 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
14419 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
14420 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
14421 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
14422
14423 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
14424 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
14425 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
14426
14427 @itemize @bullet
14428
14429 @item
14430 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
14431 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
14432 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
14433 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
14434
14435 @item
14436 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
14437 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
14438 your program's performance.
14439
14440 @item
14441 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
14442 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
14443 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
14444 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
14445 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
14446 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
14447 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
14448
14449 @item
14450 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
14451 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
14452 instruction and data spaces.
14453
14454 @end itemize
14455
14456 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
14457 improved in many ways:
14458
14459 @itemize @bullet
14460
14461 @item
14462 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
14463 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
14464 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
14465 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
14466 area in the usual way.
14467
14468 @item
14469 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
14470 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
14471
14472 @item
14473 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
14474 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
14475 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
14476 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
14477 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
14478 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
14479 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
14480
14481 @end itemize
14482
14483
14484 @node Overlay Commands
14485 @section Overlay Commands
14486
14487 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
14488 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
14489 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
14490 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
14491 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
14492 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
14493
14494 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
14495 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
14496
14497 @table @code
14498 @item overlay off
14499 @kindex overlay
14500 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
14501 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
14502 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
14503 overlay support is disabled.
14504
14505 @item overlay manual
14506 @cindex manual overlay debugging
14507 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14508 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
14509 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
14510 commands described below.
14511
14512 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
14513 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
14514 @cindex map an overlay
14515 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
14516 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
14517 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
14518 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
14519 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
14520 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
14521
14522 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
14523 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
14524 @cindex unmap an overlay
14525 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
14526 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
14527 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
14528 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
14529
14530 @item overlay auto
14531 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14532 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
14533 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
14534 Overlay Debugging}.
14535
14536 @item overlay load-target
14537 @itemx overlay load
14538 @cindex reloading the overlay table
14539 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
14540 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
14541 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
14542 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
14543 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
14544
14545 @item overlay list-overlays
14546 @itemx overlay list
14547 @cindex listing mapped overlays
14548 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
14549 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
14550
14551 @end table
14552
14553 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
14554 of the function the address falls in:
14555
14556 @smallexample
14557 (@value{GDBP}) print main
14558 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
14559 @end smallexample
14560 @noindent
14561 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
14562 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
14563 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
14564 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
14565
14566 @smallexample
14567 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14568 No sections are mapped.
14569 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14570 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
14571 @end smallexample
14572 @noindent
14573 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
14574 name normally:
14575
14576 @smallexample
14577 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14578 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
14579 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
14580 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14581 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
14582 @end smallexample
14583
14584 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
14585 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
14586 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
14587 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
14588 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
14589
14590 @itemize @bullet
14591 @item
14592 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
14593 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
14594 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
14595 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
14596 @item
14597 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
14598 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
14599 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
14600 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
14601 breakpoints properly.
14602 @end itemize
14603
14604
14605 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
14606 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
14607 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
14608
14609 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
14610 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
14611 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
14612 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
14613 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
14614 current state of the overlays.
14615
14616 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
14617 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
14618
14619 @table @asis
14620
14621 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
14622 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
14623
14624 @smallexample
14625 struct
14626 @{
14627 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
14628 unsigned long vma;
14629
14630 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
14631 unsigned long size;
14632
14633 /* The overlay's load address. */
14634 unsigned long lma;
14635
14636 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
14637 zero otherwise. */
14638 unsigned long mapped;
14639 @}
14640 @end smallexample
14641
14642 @item @code{_novlys}:
14643 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
14644 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
14645
14646 @end table
14647
14648 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
14649 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
14650 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
14651 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
14652 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
14653 currently mapped.
14654
14655 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
14656 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
14657 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
14658 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
14659 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
14660 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14661 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14662 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14663 are not being executed.
14664
14665 @node Overlay Sample Program
14666 @section Overlay Sample Program
14667 @cindex overlay example program
14668
14669 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14670 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14671 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14672 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
14673 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14674 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14675 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14676
14677 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14678 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14679 suite. The program consists of the following files from
14680 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14681
14682 @table @file
14683 @item overlays.c
14684 The main program file.
14685 @item ovlymgr.c
14686 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14687 @item foo.c
14688 @itemx bar.c
14689 @itemx baz.c
14690 @itemx grbx.c
14691 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14692 @item d10v.ld
14693 @itemx m32r.ld
14694 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14695 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14696 @end table
14697
14698 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14699 cross-compiler like this:
14700
14701 @smallexample
14702 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14703 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14704 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14705 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14706 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14707 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14708 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14709 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14710 @end smallexample
14711
14712 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14713 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14714 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14715
14716
14717 @node Languages
14718 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14719 @cindex languages
14720
14721 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14722 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
14723 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14724 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
14725 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
14726 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14727
14728 @cindex working language
14729 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14730 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14731 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14732 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
14733 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14734 language}.
14735
14736 @menu
14737 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
14738 * Show:: Displaying the language
14739 * Checks:: Type and range checks
14740 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
14741 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
14742 @end menu
14743
14744 @node Setting
14745 @section Switching Between Source Languages
14746
14747 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14748 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
14749 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
14750 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
14751 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14752 are printed, etc.
14753
14754 In addition to the working language, every source file that
14755 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
14756 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14757 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14758 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
14759 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14760 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
14761 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14762 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
14763 Displaying the Language}.
14764
14765 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14766 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14767 another language. In that case, make the
14768 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14769 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14770 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14771
14772 @menu
14773 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
14774 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
14775 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14776 @end menu
14777
14778 @node Filenames
14779 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14780
14781 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14782 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14783
14784 @table @file
14785 @item .ada
14786 @itemx .ads
14787 @itemx .adb
14788 @itemx .a
14789 Ada source file.
14790
14791 @item .c
14792 C source file
14793
14794 @item .C
14795 @itemx .cc
14796 @itemx .cp
14797 @itemx .cpp
14798 @itemx .cxx
14799 @itemx .c++
14800 C@t{++} source file
14801
14802 @item .d
14803 D source file
14804
14805 @item .m
14806 Objective-C source file
14807
14808 @item .f
14809 @itemx .F
14810 Fortran source file
14811
14812 @item .mod
14813 Modula-2 source file
14814
14815 @item .s
14816 @itemx .S
14817 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
14818 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14819 @end table
14820
14821 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14822 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14823
14824 @node Manually
14825 @subsection Setting the Working Language
14826
14827 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14828 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14829 your program.
14830
14831 @kindex set language
14832 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14833 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14834 a language, such as
14835 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14836 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14837
14838 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14839 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14840 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14841 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14842 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14843 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14844 command such as:
14845
14846 @smallexample
14847 print a = b + c
14848 @end smallexample
14849
14850 @noindent
14851 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14852 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14853 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14854 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14855
14856 @node Automatically
14857 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14858
14859 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14860 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14861 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14862 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14863 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14864 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14865 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14866 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14867 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14868
14869 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14870 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14871 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14872 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14873 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14874
14875 @node Show
14876 @section Displaying the Language
14877
14878 The following commands help you find out which language is the
14879 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14880
14881 @table @code
14882 @item show language
14883 @anchor{show language}
14884 @kindex show language
14885 Display the current working language. This is the
14886 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14887 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14888
14889 @item info frame
14890 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14891 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14892 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14893 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14894 information listed here.
14895
14896 @item info source
14897 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14898 Display the source language of this source file.
14899 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14900 information listed here.
14901 @end table
14902
14903 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14904 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14905 with a language explicitly:
14906
14907 @table @code
14908 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14909 @kindex set extension-language
14910 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14911 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14912
14913 @item info extensions
14914 @kindex info extensions
14915 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14916 @end table
14917
14918 @node Checks
14919 @section Type and Range Checking
14920
14921 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14922 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14923 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14924 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14925 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14926 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14927 errors when your program is running.
14928
14929 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14930 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14931 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14932 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14933
14934 @menu
14935 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14936 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14937 @end menu
14938
14939 @cindex type checking
14940 @cindex checks, type
14941 @node Type Checking
14942 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14943
14944 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14945 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14946 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14947 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14948
14949 @smallexample
14950 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14951
14952 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14953 $1 = 2
14954 @exdent but
14955 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14956 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14957 @end smallexample
14958
14959 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14960 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14961
14962 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14963 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14964 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14965 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14966 expressions like the second example above.
14967
14968 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14969 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14970 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14971 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14972 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14973 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14974
14975 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14976
14977 @kindex set check type
14978 @kindex show check type
14979 @table @code
14980 @item set check type on
14981 @itemx set check type off
14982 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14983 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14984 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14985
14986 @item show check type
14987 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14988 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14989 @end table
14990
14991 @cindex range checking
14992 @cindex checks, range
14993 @node Range Checking
14994 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14995
14996 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14997 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14998 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14999 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
15000 not exceed the bounds of the array.
15001
15002 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
15003 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
15004 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
15005 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
15006
15007 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
15008 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
15009 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
15010 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
15011 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
15012 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
15013
15014 @smallexample
15015 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
15016 @end smallexample
15017
15018 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
15019 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
15020 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
15021
15022 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
15023
15024 @kindex set check range
15025 @kindex show check range
15026 @table @code
15027 @item set check range auto
15028 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
15029 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
15030 each language.
15031
15032 @item set check range on
15033 @itemx set check range off
15034 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
15035 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
15036 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
15037 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
15038
15039 @item set check range warn
15040 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
15041 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
15042 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
15043 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
15044 systems).
15045
15046 @item show range
15047 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
15048 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
15049 @end table
15050
15051 @node Supported Languages
15052 @section Supported Languages
15053
15054 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
15055 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
15056 @c This is false ...
15057 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
15058 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
15059 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
15060 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
15061 language.
15062
15063 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
15064 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
15065 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
15066 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
15067 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
15068 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
15069 language reference or tutorial.
15070
15071 @menu
15072 * C:: C and C@t{++}
15073 * D:: D
15074 * Go:: Go
15075 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
15076 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
15077 * Fortran:: Fortran
15078 * Pascal:: Pascal
15079 * Rust:: Rust
15080 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
15081 * Ada:: Ada
15082 @end menu
15083
15084 @node C
15085 @subsection C and C@t{++}
15086
15087 @cindex C and C@t{++}
15088 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
15089
15090 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
15091 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
15092 together.
15093
15094 @cindex C@t{++}
15095 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
15096 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
15097 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
15098 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
15099 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
15100 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
15101 compiler (@code{aCC}).
15102
15103 @menu
15104 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
15105 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
15106 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
15107 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
15108 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
15109 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
15110 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
15111 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
15112 @end menu
15113
15114 @node C Operators
15115 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
15116
15117 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
15118
15119 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15120 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15121 often defined on groups of types.
15122
15123 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
15124
15125 @itemize @bullet
15126
15127 @item
15128 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
15129 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
15130
15131 @item
15132 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
15133 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
15134
15135 @item
15136 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
15137
15138 @item
15139 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
15140
15141 @end itemize
15142
15143 @noindent
15144 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
15145 in order of increasing precedence:
15146
15147 @table @code
15148 @item ,
15149 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
15150 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
15151 expression being the last expression evaluated.
15152
15153 @item =
15154 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
15155 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
15156
15157 @item @var{op}=
15158 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
15159 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
15160 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
15161 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
15162 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
15163
15164 @item ?:
15165 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
15166 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
15167 should be of an integral type.
15168
15169 @item ||
15170 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15171
15172 @item &&
15173 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15174
15175 @item |
15176 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15177
15178 @item ^
15179 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15180
15181 @item &
15182 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15183
15184 @item ==@r{, }!=
15185 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
15186 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
15187
15188 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
15189 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
15190 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
15191 and non-zero for true.
15192
15193 @item <<@r{, }>>
15194 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
15195
15196 @item @@
15197 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15198
15199 @item +@r{, }-
15200 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
15201 pointer types.
15202
15203 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
15204 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
15205 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
15206 integral types.
15207
15208 @item ++@r{, }--
15209 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
15210 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
15211 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
15212 operation takes place.
15213
15214 @item *
15215 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
15216 @code{++}.
15217
15218 @item &
15219 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
15220
15221 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
15222 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
15223 to examine the address
15224 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
15225 stored.
15226
15227 @item -
15228 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
15229 precedence as @code{++}.
15230
15231 @item !
15232 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15233 @code{++}.
15234
15235 @item ~
15236 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15237 @code{++}.
15238
15239
15240 @item .@r{, }->
15241 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
15242 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
15243 pointer based on the stored type information.
15244 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
15245
15246 @item .*@r{, }->*
15247 Dereferences of pointers to members.
15248
15249 @item []
15250 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
15251 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15252
15253 @item ()
15254 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15255
15256 @item ::
15257 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
15258 and @code{class} types.
15259
15260 @item ::
15261 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
15262 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
15263 above.
15264 @end table
15265
15266 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
15267 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
15268 predefined meaning.
15269
15270 @node C Constants
15271 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
15272
15273 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
15274
15275 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
15276 following ways:
15277
15278 @itemize @bullet
15279 @item
15280 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
15281 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
15282 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
15283 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
15284 @code{long} value.
15285
15286 @item
15287 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
15288 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
15289 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
15290 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
15291 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
15292 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
15293 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
15294 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
15295 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
15296 constant.
15297
15298 @item
15299 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
15300 integral equivalents.
15301
15302 @item
15303 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
15304 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
15305 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
15306 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
15307 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
15308 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
15309 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
15310 @samp{\n} for newline.
15311
15312 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
15313 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
15314 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
15315 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15316
15317 @item
15318 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
15319 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
15320 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
15321 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
15322 characters.
15323
15324 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
15325 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
15326 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15327
15328 @item
15329 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
15330 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
15331
15332 @item
15333 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
15334 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
15335 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
15336 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
15337 @end itemize
15338
15339 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
15340 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
15341
15342 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
15343 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
15344
15345 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
15346 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
15347 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
15348 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
15349 @quotation
15350 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
15351 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
15352 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
15353 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
15354 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
15355 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
15356 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
15357 code. @xref{Compilation}.
15358 @end quotation
15359
15360 @enumerate
15361
15362 @cindex member functions
15363 @item
15364 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
15365
15366 @smallexample
15367 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
15368 @end smallexample
15369
15370 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
15371 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
15372 @item
15373 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
15374 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
15375 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
15376 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
15377 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
15378
15379 @cindex call overloaded functions
15380 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
15381 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
15382 @item
15383 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
15384 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
15385 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
15386 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
15387 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
15388 default arguments.
15389
15390 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
15391 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
15392 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
15393 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
15394 number of function arguments.
15395
15396 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
15397 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
15398 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
15399
15400 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
15401 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
15402 @smallexample
15403 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
15404 @end smallexample
15405
15406 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
15407 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
15408
15409 @cindex reference declarations
15410 @item
15411 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} lvalue or rvalue
15412 references; you can use them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++}
15413 source---they are automatically dereferenced.
15414
15415 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
15416 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
15417 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
15418 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
15419 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
15420
15421 @item
15422 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
15423 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
15424 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
15425 necessary, for example in an expression like
15426 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
15427 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
15428 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
15429
15430 @item
15431 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
15432 specification.
15433 @end enumerate
15434
15435 @node C Defaults
15436 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
15437
15438 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
15439
15440 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
15441 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
15442 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15443 selects the working language.
15444
15445 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
15446 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
15447 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
15448 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
15449 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
15450 for further details.
15451
15452 @node C Checks
15453 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
15454
15455 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
15456
15457 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
15458 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
15459 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
15460 constants to pointers.
15461
15462 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
15463 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
15464 that is not itself an array.
15465
15466 @node Debugging C
15467 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
15468
15469 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
15470 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
15471 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
15472 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
15473
15474 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
15475 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
15476 ,Expressions}.
15477
15478 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
15479 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
15480
15481 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
15482
15483 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
15484 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
15485
15486 @table @code
15487 @cindex break in overloaded functions
15488 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
15489 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
15490 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
15491 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
15492 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
15493
15494 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
15495 @item rbreak @var{regex}
15496 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
15497 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
15498 classes.
15499 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
15500
15501 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
15502 @item catch throw
15503 @itemx catch rethrow
15504 @itemx catch catch
15505 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
15506 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
15507
15508 @cindex inheritance
15509 @item ptype @var{typename}
15510 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
15511 @var{typename}.
15512 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
15513
15514 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
15515 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
15516 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
15517 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
15518 multiple inheritance is in use.
15519
15520 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
15521 @item demangle @var{name}
15522 Demangle @var{name}.
15523 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
15524
15525 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
15526 @item set print demangle
15527 @itemx show print demangle
15528 @itemx set print asm-demangle
15529 @itemx show print asm-demangle
15530 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
15531 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
15532 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15533
15534 @item set print object
15535 @itemx show print object
15536 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
15537 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15538
15539 @item set print vtbl
15540 @itemx show print vtbl
15541 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
15542 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15543 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
15544 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
15545
15546 @kindex set overload-resolution
15547 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
15548 @item set overload-resolution on
15549 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
15550 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
15551 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
15552 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
15553 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
15554 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
15555
15556 @item set overload-resolution off
15557 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
15558 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15559 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
15560 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
15561 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15562 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
15563 argument types.
15564
15565 @kindex show overload-resolution
15566 @item show overload-resolution
15567 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
15568
15569 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
15570 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
15571 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
15572 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
15573 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
15574 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
15575 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
15576
15577 @item @r{Breakpoints in functions with ABI tags}
15578
15579 The GNU C@t{++} compiler introduced the notion of ABI ``tags'', which
15580 correspond to changes in the ABI of a type, function, or variable that
15581 would not otherwise be reflected in a mangled name. See
15582 @url{https://developers.redhat.com/blog/2015/02/05/gcc5-and-the-c11-abi/}
15583 for more detail.
15584
15585 The ABI tags are visible in C@t{++} demangled names. For example, a
15586 function that returns a std::string:
15587
15588 @smallexample
15589 std::string function(int);
15590 @end smallexample
15591
15592 @noindent
15593 when compiled for the C++11 ABI is marked with the @code{cxx11} ABI
15594 tag, and @value{GDBN} displays the symbol like this:
15595
15596 @smallexample
15597 function[abi:cxx11](int)
15598 @end smallexample
15599
15600 You can set a breakpoint on such functions simply as if they had no
15601 tag. For example:
15602
15603 @smallexample
15604 (gdb) b function(int)
15605 Breakpoint 2 at 0x40060d: file main.cc, line 10.
15606 (gdb) info breakpoints
15607 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
15608 1 breakpoint keep y 0x0040060d in function[abi:cxx11](int)
15609 at main.cc:10
15610 @end smallexample
15611
15612 On the rare occasion you need to disambiguate between different ABI
15613 tags, you can do so by simply including the ABI tag in the function
15614 name, like:
15615
15616 @smallexample
15617 (@value{GDBP}) b ambiguous[abi:other_tag](int)
15618 @end smallexample
15619 @end table
15620
15621 @node Decimal Floating Point
15622 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
15623 @cindex decimal floating point format
15624
15625 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
15626 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
15627 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
15628 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
15629
15630 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
15631 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
15632 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
15633 configured target.
15634
15635 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
15636 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
15637 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
15638
15639 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
15640 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
15641 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
15642
15643 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
15644 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
15645 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
15646
15647 @node D
15648 @subsection D
15649
15650 @cindex D
15651 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
15652 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
15653 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
15654
15655 @node Go
15656 @subsection Go
15657
15658 @cindex Go (programming language)
15659 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
15660 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
15661
15662 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
15663
15664 @table @code
15665 @cindex current Go package
15666 @item The current Go package
15667 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
15668 specifying global variables and functions.
15669
15670 For example, given the program:
15671
15672 @example
15673 package main
15674 var myglob = "Shall we?"
15675 func main () @{
15676 // ...
15677 @}
15678 @end example
15679
15680 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
15681
15682 @example
15683 (gdb) p myglob
15684 (gdb) p main.myglob
15685 @end example
15686
15687 @cindex builtin Go types
15688 @item Builtin Go types
15689 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
15690 as a string.
15691
15692 @cindex builtin Go functions
15693 @item Builtin Go functions
15694 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
15695 function and handles it internally.
15696
15697 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
15698 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
15699 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
15700 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
15701 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15702 @end table
15703
15704 @node Objective-C
15705 @subsection Objective-C
15706
15707 @cindex Objective-C
15708 This section provides information about some commands and command
15709 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
15710 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15711 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15712
15713 @menu
15714 * Method Names in Commands::
15715 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
15716 @end menu
15717
15718 @node Method Names in Commands
15719 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15720
15721 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15722 names as line specifications:
15723
15724 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15725 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15726 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15727 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15728 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15729 @itemize
15730 @item @code{clear}
15731 @item @code{break}
15732 @item @code{info line}
15733 @item @code{jump}
15734 @item @code{list}
15735 @end itemize
15736
15737 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15738
15739 @smallexample
15740 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15741 @end smallexample
15742
15743 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15744 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
15745 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15746 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15747 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15748 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15749 debugged, enter:
15750
15751 @smallexample
15752 break -[Fruit create]
15753 @end smallexample
15754
15755 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15756 enter:
15757
15758 @smallexample
15759 list +[NSText initialize]
15760 @end smallexample
15761
15762 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15763 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15764 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
15765 is also possible to specify just a method name:
15766
15767 @smallexample
15768 break create
15769 @end smallexample
15770
15771 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
15772 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15773 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15774 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15775 none apply.
15776
15777 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15778 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15779
15780 @smallexample
15781 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15782 @end smallexample
15783
15784 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
15785 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15786 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
15787 @kindex print-object
15788 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15789
15790 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
15791
15792 @smallexample
15793 print -[@var{object} hash]
15794 @end smallexample
15795
15796 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
15797 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15798 @noindent
15799 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15800 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
15801 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15802 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
15803 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15804 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15805
15806 @node OpenCL C
15807 @subsection OpenCL C
15808
15809 @cindex OpenCL C
15810 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15811
15812 @menu
15813 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
15814 * OpenCL C Expressions::
15815 * OpenCL C Operators::
15816 @end menu
15817
15818 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
15819 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15820
15821 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15822 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15823 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15824 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15825 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15826
15827 @node OpenCL C Expressions
15828 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15829
15830 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15831 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15832 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15833 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15834
15835 @node OpenCL C Operators
15836 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15837
15838 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
15839 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15840 vector data types.
15841
15842 @node Fortran
15843 @subsection Fortran
15844 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15845
15846 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15847 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15848
15849 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15850 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15851 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15852 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15853 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15854 underscore.
15855
15856 @menu
15857 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
15858 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
15859 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15860 @end menu
15861
15862 @node Fortran Operators
15863 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15864
15865 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15866
15867 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15868 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15869 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15870
15871 @table @code
15872 @item **
15873 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15874 of the second one.
15875
15876 @item :
15877 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15878 represent a section of array.
15879
15880 @item %
15881 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15882 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15883 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15884 union type.
15885 @end table
15886
15887 @node Fortran Defaults
15888 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15889
15890 @cindex Fortran Defaults
15891
15892 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15893 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15894 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15895 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15896
15897 @node Special Fortran Commands
15898 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15899
15900 @cindex Special Fortran commands
15901
15902 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15903 such as displaying common blocks.
15904
15905 @table @code
15906 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15907 @kindex info common
15908 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15909 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15910 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15911 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15912 printed.
15913 @end table
15914
15915 @node Pascal
15916 @subsection Pascal
15917
15918 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15919 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15920 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
15921 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15922 syntax.
15923
15924 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15925 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15926 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15927
15928 @node Rust
15929 @subsection Rust
15930
15931 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
15932 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
15933 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
15934 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
15935
15936 @itemize @bullet
15937 @item
15938 Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
15939 crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
15940 crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
15941
15942 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
15943 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
15944 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
15945 @samp{B}.
15946
15947 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
15948 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
15949
15950 @item
15951 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
15952 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
15953 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
15954 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
15955 @samp{K::x::y}.
15956
15957 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
15958 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
15959 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
15960 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
15961 scope.
15962
15963 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
15964 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
15965
15966 @item
15967 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
15968 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
15969
15970 @item
15971 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
15972
15973 @item
15974 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
15975 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
15976 never be destroyed.
15977
15978 @item
15979 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
15980 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
15981 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
15982
15983 @item
15984 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
15985 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
15986 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
15987 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
15988 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
15989 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
15990 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
15991 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
15992
15993 @item
15994 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
15995 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
15996 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
15997 @itemize @bullet
15998
15999 @item
16000 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
16001
16002 @item
16003 Operator overloading is not implemented.
16004
16005 @item
16006 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
16007 type names.
16008
16009 @item
16010 The type @code{Self} is not available.
16011
16012 @item
16013 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
16014 available in the crate.
16015 @end itemize
16016 @end itemize
16017
16018 @node Modula-2
16019 @subsection Modula-2
16020
16021 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
16022
16023 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
16024 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
16025 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
16026 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16027 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
16028 table.
16029
16030 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
16031 @menu
16032 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
16033 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
16034 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
16035 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
16036 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
16037 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
16038 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
16039 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
16040 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
16041 @end menu
16042
16043 @node M2 Operators
16044 @subsubsection Operators
16045 @cindex Modula-2 operators
16046
16047 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
16048 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
16049 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
16050 following definitions hold:
16051
16052 @itemize @bullet
16053
16054 @item
16055 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
16056 their subranges.
16057
16058 @item
16059 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
16060
16061 @item
16062 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
16063
16064 @item
16065 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
16066 @var{type}}.
16067
16068 @item
16069 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
16070
16071 @item
16072 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
16073
16074 @item
16075 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
16076 @end itemize
16077
16078 @noindent
16079 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
16080 increasing precedence:
16081
16082 @table @code
16083 @item ,
16084 Function argument or array index separator.
16085
16086 @item :=
16087 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
16088 @var{value}.
16089
16090 @item <@r{, }>
16091 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
16092 types.
16093
16094 @item <=@r{, }>=
16095 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
16096 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
16097 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
16098
16099 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
16100 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
16101 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
16102 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
16103 comment character.
16104
16105 @item IN
16106 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
16107 Same precedence as @code{<}.
16108
16109 @item OR
16110 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
16111
16112 @item AND@r{, }&
16113 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
16114
16115 @item @@
16116 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
16117
16118 @item +@r{, }-
16119 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
16120 and difference on set types.
16121
16122 @item *
16123 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
16124 on set types.
16125
16126 @item /
16127 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
16128 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
16129
16130 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
16131 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
16132 precedence as @code{*}.
16133
16134 @item -
16135 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
16136
16137 @item ^
16138 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
16139
16140 @item NOT
16141 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
16142 @code{^}.
16143
16144 @item .
16145 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
16146 precedence as @code{^}.
16147
16148 @item []
16149 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
16150
16151 @item ()
16152 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
16153 as @code{^}.
16154
16155 @item ::@r{, }.
16156 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
16157 @end table
16158
16159 @quotation
16160 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
16161 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
16162 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
16163 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
16164 @end quotation
16165
16166
16167 @node Built-In Func/Proc
16168 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
16169 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
16170
16171 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
16172 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
16173
16174 @table @var
16175
16176 @item a
16177 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
16178
16179 @item c
16180 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
16181
16182 @item i
16183 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
16184
16185 @item m
16186 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
16187 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
16188 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
16189
16190 @item n
16191 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
16192
16193 @item r
16194 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
16195
16196 @item t
16197 represents a type.
16198
16199 @item v
16200 represents a variable.
16201
16202 @item x
16203 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
16204 explanation of the function for details.
16205 @end table
16206
16207 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
16208
16209 @table @code
16210 @item ABS(@var{n})
16211 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
16212
16213 @item CAP(@var{c})
16214 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
16215 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
16216
16217 @item CHR(@var{i})
16218 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16219
16220 @item DEC(@var{v})
16221 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16222
16223 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
16224 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16225 new value.
16226
16227 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16228 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
16229 set.
16230
16231 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
16232 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
16233
16234 @item HIGH(@var{a})
16235 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
16236
16237 @item INC(@var{v})
16238 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16239
16240 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
16241 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16242 new value.
16243
16244 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16245 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
16246 there. Returns the new set.
16247
16248 @item MAX(@var{t})
16249 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
16250
16251 @item MIN(@var{t})
16252 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
16253
16254 @item ODD(@var{i})
16255 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
16256
16257 @item ORD(@var{x})
16258 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
16259 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
16260 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
16261 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
16262
16263 @item SIZE(@var{x})
16264 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16265 variable or a type.
16266
16267 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
16268 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
16269
16270 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
16271 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16272 variable or a type.
16273
16274 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
16275 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16276 @end table
16277
16278 @quotation
16279 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
16280 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
16281 an error.
16282 @end quotation
16283
16284 @cindex Modula-2 constants
16285 @node M2 Constants
16286 @subsubsection Constants
16287
16288 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
16289 ways:
16290
16291 @itemize @bullet
16292
16293 @item
16294 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
16295 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
16296 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
16297 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
16298
16299 @item
16300 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
16301 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
16302 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
16303 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
16304 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
16305 digits.
16306
16307 @item
16308 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
16309 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
16310 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
16311 followed by a @samp{C}.
16312
16313 @item
16314 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
16315 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
16316 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
16317 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
16318 sequences.
16319
16320 @item
16321 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
16322
16323 @item
16324 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
16325 @code{FALSE}.
16326
16327 @item
16328 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
16329
16330 @item
16331 Set constants are not yet supported.
16332 @end itemize
16333
16334 @node M2 Types
16335 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
16336 @cindex Modula-2 types
16337
16338 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
16339 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
16340 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
16341 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
16342 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
16343 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
16344
16345 The first example contains the following section of code:
16346
16347 @smallexample
16348 VAR
16349 s: SET OF CHAR ;
16350 r: [20..40] ;
16351 @end smallexample
16352
16353 @noindent
16354 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
16355 @code{r} and @code{s}.
16356
16357 @smallexample
16358 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16359 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
16360 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16361 SET OF CHAR
16362 (@value{GDBP}) print r
16363 21
16364 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
16365 [20..40]
16366 @end smallexample
16367
16368 @noindent
16369 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
16370
16371 @smallexample
16372 VAR
16373 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
16374 @end smallexample
16375
16376 @noindent
16377 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
16378
16379 @smallexample
16380 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16381 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
16382 @end smallexample
16383
16384 @noindent
16385 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
16386 expressions using the debugger.
16387
16388 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
16389 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
16390
16391 @smallexample
16392 VAR
16393 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
16394 @end smallexample
16395
16396 @smallexample
16397 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16398 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
16399 @end smallexample
16400
16401 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
16402 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
16403 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
16404 above.
16405
16406 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
16407
16408 @smallexample
16409 TYPE
16410 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
16411 t = [blue..yellow] ;
16412 VAR
16413 s: t ;
16414 BEGIN
16415 s := blue ;
16416 @end smallexample
16417
16418 @noindent
16419 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
16420 and value of a variable.
16421
16422 @smallexample
16423 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16424 $1 = blue
16425 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
16426 type = [blue..yellow]
16427 @end smallexample
16428
16429 @noindent
16430 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
16431 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
16432 their @code{C} counterparts.
16433
16434 @smallexample
16435 VAR
16436 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16437 BEGIN
16438 s[1] := 1 ;
16439 @end smallexample
16440
16441 @smallexample
16442 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16443 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
16444 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16445 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16446 @end smallexample
16447
16448 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
16449 pointer types as shown in this example:
16450
16451 @smallexample
16452 VAR
16453 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16454 BEGIN
16455 NEW(s) ;
16456 s^[1] := 1 ;
16457 @end smallexample
16458
16459 @noindent
16460 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
16461
16462 @smallexample
16463 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16464 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16465 @end smallexample
16466
16467 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
16468 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
16469 types:
16470
16471 @smallexample
16472 TYPE
16473 foo = RECORD
16474 f1: CARDINAL ;
16475 f2: CHAR ;
16476 f3: myarray ;
16477 END ;
16478
16479 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
16480 myrange = [-2..2] ;
16481 VAR
16482 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
16483 @end smallexample
16484
16485 @noindent
16486 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
16487 below.
16488
16489 @smallexample
16490 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16491 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
16492 f1 : CARDINAL;
16493 f2 : CHAR;
16494 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
16495 END
16496 @end smallexample
16497
16498 @node M2 Defaults
16499 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
16500 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
16501
16502 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
16503 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
16504 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
16505 selected the working language.
16506
16507 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
16508 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
16509 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
16510 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
16511
16512 @node Deviations
16513 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
16514 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
16515
16516 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
16517 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
16518
16519 @itemize @bullet
16520 @item
16521 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
16522 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
16523 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
16524 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
16525 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
16526 returned a pointer.)
16527
16528 @item
16529 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
16530 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
16531 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
16532 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
16533
16534 @item
16535 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
16536 argument.
16537
16538 @item
16539 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
16540 @end itemize
16541
16542 @node M2 Checks
16543 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
16544 @cindex Modula-2 checks
16545
16546 @quotation
16547 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
16548 range checking.
16549 @end quotation
16550 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
16551
16552 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
16553
16554 @itemize @bullet
16555 @item
16556 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
16557 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
16558
16559 @item
16560 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
16561 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
16562 @end itemize
16563
16564 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
16565 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
16566
16567 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
16568 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
16569
16570 @node M2 Scope
16571 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
16572 @cindex scope
16573 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
16574 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
16575 @ifinfo
16576 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
16577 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
16578 @end ifinfo
16579 @ifnotinfo
16580 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
16581 @end ifnotinfo
16582
16583 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
16584 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
16585 similar syntax:
16586
16587 @smallexample
16588
16589 @var{module} . @var{id}
16590 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
16591 @end smallexample
16592
16593 @noindent
16594 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
16595 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
16596 identifier within your program, except another module.
16597
16598 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
16599 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
16600 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
16601 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
16602
16603 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
16604 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
16605 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
16606 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
16607 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
16608 @var{module}.
16609
16610 @node GDB/M2
16611 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
16612
16613 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
16614 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
16615 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
16616 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
16617 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
16618 analogue in Modula-2.
16619
16620 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
16621 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
16622 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
16623 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
16624 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
16625 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
16626
16627 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
16628 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
16629 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
16630
16631 @node Ada
16632 @subsection Ada
16633 @cindex Ada
16634
16635 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
16636 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
16637 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
16638 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16639 to be difficult.
16640
16641
16642 @cindex expressions in Ada
16643 @menu
16644 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
16645 and semantics supported by Ada mode
16646 in @value{GDBN}.
16647 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
16648 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
16649 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
16650 subprograms.
16651 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
16652 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
16653 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
16654 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16655 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
16656 Profile
16657 * Ada Settings:: New settable GDB parameters for Ada.
16658 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
16659 @end menu
16660
16661 @node Ada Mode Intro
16662 @subsubsection Introduction
16663 @cindex Ada mode, general
16664
16665 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
16666 syntax, with some extensions.
16667 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
16668
16669 @itemize @bullet
16670 @item
16671 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
16672 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
16673 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
16674 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
16675
16676 @item
16677 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
16678 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16679
16680 @item
16681 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16682 @end itemize
16683
16684 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
16685 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
16686 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
16687 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
16688 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
16689
16690 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
16691 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
16692 was translated from an Ada source file.
16693
16694 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
16695 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
16696 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
16697 middle (to allow based literals).
16698
16699 @node Omissions from Ada
16700 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
16701 @cindex Ada, omissions from
16702
16703 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
16704
16705 @itemize @bullet
16706 @item
16707 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
16708
16709 @itemize @minus
16710 @item
16711 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
16712 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
16713
16714 @item
16715 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
16716
16717 @item
16718 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
16719
16720 @item
16721 @t{'Tag}.
16722
16723 @item
16724 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
16725 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
16726
16727 @item
16728 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
16729 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
16730
16731 @item
16732 @t{'Address}.
16733 @end itemize
16734
16735 @item
16736 The names in
16737 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
16738 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
16739 not currently available.
16740
16741 @item
16742 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
16743 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
16744 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
16745 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
16746 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
16747 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
16748 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
16749 indeterminate values.
16750
16751 @item
16752 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
16753 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
16754 are not implemented.
16755
16756 @item
16757 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
16758 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
16759 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
16760 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
16761 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
16762
16763 @smallexample
16764 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
16765 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
16766 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
16767 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
16768 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
16769 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
16770 @end smallexample
16771
16772 Changing a
16773 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
16774 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
16775 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
16776 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
16777 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
16778 declared to have a type such as:
16779
16780 @smallexample
16781 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
16782 Id : Integer;
16783 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
16784 end record;
16785 @end smallexample
16786
16787 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
16788 assignments:
16789
16790 @smallexample
16791 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
16792 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
16793 @end smallexample
16794
16795 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16796 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
16797 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16798 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16799 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
16800 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
16801 redundant component associations, although which component values are
16802 assigned in such cases is not defined.
16803
16804 @item
16805 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16806
16807 @item
16808 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16809 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
16810 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16811 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
16812 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16813 the proper resolution.
16814
16815 @item
16816 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16817
16818 @item
16819 Entry calls are not implemented.
16820
16821 @item
16822 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16823 formats are not supported.
16824
16825 @item
16826 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16827
16828 @item
16829 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16830 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16831 context.
16832 Should your program
16833 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16834 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16835 @end itemize
16836
16837 @node Additions to Ada
16838 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
16839 @cindex Ada, deviations from
16840
16841 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16842 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16843
16844 @itemize @bullet
16845 @item
16846 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16847 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16848 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16849 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
16850 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16851 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16852 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16853 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16854
16855 @item
16856 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16857 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
16858 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16859
16860 @item
16861 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16862 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16863
16864 @item
16865 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16866 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16867 @end itemize
16868
16869 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16870 additions specific to Ada:
16871
16872 @itemize @bullet
16873 @item
16874 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16875 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
16876
16877 @smallexample
16878 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16879 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16880 @end smallexample
16881
16882 @item
16883 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
16884 the value of its right-hand operand.
16885 This allows, for example,
16886 complex conditional breaks:
16887
16888 @smallexample
16889 (@value{GDBP}) break f
16890 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16891 @end smallexample
16892
16893 @item
16894 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16895 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16896 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
16897 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16898 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
16899 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16900 in strings. For example,
16901 @smallexample
16902 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16903 @end smallexample
16904 @noindent
16905 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16906 after each period.
16907
16908 @item
16909 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16910 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
16911 to write
16912
16913 @smallexample
16914 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16915 @end smallexample
16916
16917 @item
16918 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16919 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16920 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16921 of 3 might print as
16922
16923 @smallexample
16924 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
16925 @end smallexample
16926
16927 @noindent
16928 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16929 clause.
16930
16931 @item
16932 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16933 multi-character subsequence of
16934 their names (an exact match gets preference).
16935 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16936 in place of @t{a'length}.
16937
16938 @item
16939 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16940 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16941 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16942 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16943 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16944 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16945 For example,
16946 @smallexample
16947 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16948 @end smallexample
16949
16950 @item
16951 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16952 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16953 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
16954 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16955 object.
16956
16957 @end itemize
16958
16959 @node Overloading support for Ada
16960 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16961 @cindex overloading, Ada
16962
16963 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
16964 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16965 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16966 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16967 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16968 functions to procedures elsewhere.
16969
16970 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16971 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16972 use, for instance:
16973
16974 @smallexample
16975 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16976 Multiple matches for f
16977 [0] cancel
16978 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16979 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16980 >
16981 @end smallexample
16982
16983 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16984 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16985 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16986
16987 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16988 case:
16989
16990 @table @code
16991
16992 @kindex set ada print-signatures
16993 @item set ada print-signatures
16994 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
16995 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
16996 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16997
16998 @kindex show ada print-signatures
16999 @item show ada print-signatures
17000 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
17001 overloads selection menu.
17002 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
17003
17004 @end table
17005
17006 @node Stopping Before Main Program
17007 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
17008
17009 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
17010 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
17011 before reaching the main procedure.
17012 As defined in the Ada Reference
17013 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
17014 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
17015 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
17016 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
17017
17018 @node Ada Exceptions
17019 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
17020
17021 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
17022
17023 @table @code
17024 @kindex info exceptions
17025 @item info exceptions
17026 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
17027 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
17028 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
17029 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
17030 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
17031 @end table
17032
17033 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
17034 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
17035 argument.
17036
17037 @smallexample
17038 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
17039 All defined Ada exceptions:
17040 constraint_error: 0x613da0
17041 program_error: 0x613d20
17042 storage_error: 0x613ce0
17043 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
17044 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
17045 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
17046 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
17047 constraint_error: 0x613da0
17048 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
17049 @end smallexample
17050
17051 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
17052 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
17053
17054 @node Ada Tasks
17055 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
17056 @cindex Ada, tasking
17057
17058 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
17059 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
17060
17061 @table @code
17062 @kindex info tasks
17063 @item info tasks
17064 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
17065
17066
17067 @smallexample
17068 @iftex
17069 @leftskip=0.5cm
17070 @end iftex
17071 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17072 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17073 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17074 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
17075 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
17076 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
17077
17078 @end smallexample
17079
17080 @noindent
17081 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
17082 task currently being inspected.
17083
17084 @table @asis
17085 @item ID
17086 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
17087
17088 @item TID
17089 The Ada task ID.
17090
17091 @item P-ID
17092 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
17093
17094 @item Pri
17095 The base priority of the task.
17096
17097 @item State
17098 Current state of the task.
17099
17100 @table @code
17101 @item Unactivated
17102 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
17103 executing.
17104
17105 @item Runnable
17106 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
17107 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
17108
17109 @item Terminated
17110 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
17111 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
17112 terminated themselves.
17113
17114 @item Child Activation Wait
17115 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
17116
17117 @item Accept Statement
17118 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
17119
17120 @item Waiting on entry call
17121 The task is waiting on an entry call.
17122
17123 @item Async Select Wait
17124 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
17125 select statement.
17126
17127 @item Delay Sleep
17128 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
17129 alternative open.
17130
17131 @item Child Termination Wait
17132 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
17133 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
17134 waiting on a terminate Phase.
17135
17136 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
17137 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
17138 finish terminating.
17139
17140 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
17141 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
17142 @end table
17143
17144 @item Name
17145 Name of the task in the program.
17146
17147 @end table
17148
17149 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
17150 @item info task @var{taskno}
17151 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
17152 the following example:
17153 @smallexample
17154 @iftex
17155 @leftskip=0.5cm
17156 @end iftex
17157 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17158 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17159 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17160 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
17161 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
17162 Ada Task: 0x807c468
17163 Name: task_1
17164 Thread: 0x807f378
17165 Parent: 1 (main_task)
17166 Base Priority: 15
17167 State: Runnable
17168 @end smallexample
17169
17170 @item task
17171 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
17172 @cindex current Ada task ID
17173 This command prints the ID of the current task.
17174
17175 @smallexample
17176 @iftex
17177 @leftskip=0.5cm
17178 @end iftex
17179 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17180 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17181 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17182 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
17183 (@value{GDBP}) task
17184 [Current task is 2]
17185 @end smallexample
17186
17187 @item task @var{taskno}
17188 @cindex Ada task switching
17189 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
17190 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
17191 from the current task to the given task.
17192
17193 @smallexample
17194 @iftex
17195 @leftskip=0.5cm
17196 @end iftex
17197 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17198 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17199 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17200 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
17201 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
17202 [Switching to task 1]
17203 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17204 (@value{GDBP}) bt
17205 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17206 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
17207 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
17208 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
17209 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
17210 @end smallexample
17211
17212 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
17213 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
17214 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
17215 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
17216 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
17217 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
17218 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
17219 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
17220 in @ref{Specify Location}.
17221
17222 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
17223 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
17224 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
17225 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
17226 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
17227
17228 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
17229 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
17230 program.
17231
17232 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
17233 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
17234 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
17235
17236 For example,
17237
17238 @smallexample
17239 @iftex
17240 @leftskip=0.5cm
17241 @end iftex
17242 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17243 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17244 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17245 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
17246 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17247 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
17248 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
17249 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
17250 (@value{GDBP}) cont
17251 Continuing.
17252 task # 1 running
17253 task # 2 running
17254
17255 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
17256 15 flush;
17257 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17258 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17259 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17260 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
17261 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17262 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
17263 @end smallexample
17264 @end table
17265
17266 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
17267 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
17268 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
17269
17270 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
17271 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
17272 the platform being used.
17273 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
17274 switching is not supported.
17275
17276 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
17277 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
17278 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
17279 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
17280 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
17281 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
17282
17283 @node Ravenscar Profile
17284 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
17285 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
17286
17287 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
17288 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
17289 requirements.
17290
17291 @table @code
17292 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
17293 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
17294 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
17295 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17296 Profile. This is the default.
17297
17298 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
17299 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
17300 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17301 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
17302 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
17303 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
17304 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
17305
17306 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
17307 @item show ravenscar task-switching
17308 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
17309 using the Ravenscar Profile.
17310
17311 @end table
17312
17313 @node Ada Settings
17314 @subsubsection Ada Settings
17315 @cindex Ada settings
17316
17317 @table @code
17318 @kindex set varsize-limit
17319 @item set varsize-limit @var{size}
17320 Prevent @value{GDBN} from attempting to evaluate objects whose size
17321 is above the given limit (@var{size}) when those sizes are computed
17322 from run-time quantities. This is typically the case when the object
17323 has a variable size, such as an array whose bounds are not known at
17324 compile time for example. Setting @var{size} to @code{unlimited}
17325 removes the size limitation. By default, the limit is about 65KB.
17326
17327 The purpose of having such a limit is to prevent @value{GDBN} from
17328 trying to grab enormous chunks of virtual memory when asked to evaluate
17329 a quantity whose bounds have been corrupted or have not yet been fully
17330 initialized. The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions
17331 as well as to complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting
17332 a simple integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
17333 @code{x.y} is variable and exceeds @code{size}. On the other hand,
17334 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A(i)}, where
17335 @code{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
17336 succeed regardless of the bounds on @code{A}, as long as the component
17337 size is less than @var{size}.
17338
17339 @kindex show varsize-limit
17340 @item show varsize-limit
17341 Show the limit on types whose size is determined by run-time quantities.
17342 @end table
17343
17344 @node Ada Glitches
17345 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
17346 @cindex Ada, problems
17347
17348 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
17349 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
17350 @value{GDBN},
17351 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
17352 and the GNU Ada compiler.
17353
17354 @itemize @bullet
17355 @item
17356 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
17357 storage are invisible to the debugger.
17358
17359 @item
17360 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
17361 argument lists are treated as positional).
17362
17363 @item
17364 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
17365
17366 @item
17367 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
17368 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
17369 the host machine.
17370
17371 @item
17372 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
17373 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
17374 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
17375 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
17376 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
17377 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
17378 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
17379 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
17380 you can usually resolve the confusion
17381 by qualifying the problematic names with package
17382 @code{Standard} explicitly.
17383 @end itemize
17384
17385 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
17386 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
17387 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
17388 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
17389 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
17390 enabled.
17391
17392 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
17393 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
17394 @table @code
17395
17396 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
17397 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
17398 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
17399 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
17400 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
17401 This is the default.
17402
17403 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
17404 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
17405 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
17406 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
17407 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
17408 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
17409 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
17410
17411 @end table
17412
17413 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
17414 @cindex GNAT encoding
17415 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
17416 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
17417 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
17418 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
17419 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
17420 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
17421
17422 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
17423 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
17424 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
17425 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
17426 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
17427 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
17428 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
17429 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
17430
17431 @table @code
17432
17433 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
17434 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
17435 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
17436 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
17437
17438 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
17439 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
17440 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
17441
17442 @end table
17443
17444 @node Unsupported Languages
17445 @section Unsupported Languages
17446
17447 @cindex unsupported languages
17448 @cindex minimal language
17449 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
17450 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
17451 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
17452 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
17453 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
17454 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
17455
17456 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
17457 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
17458 language.
17459
17460 @node Symbols
17461 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
17462
17463 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
17464 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
17465 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
17466 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
17467 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
17468 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
17469 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
17470
17471 @cindex symbol names
17472 @cindex names of symbols
17473 @cindex quoting names
17474 @anchor{quoting names}
17475 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
17476 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
17477 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
17478 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
17479 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
17480 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
17481 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
17482 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
17483
17484 @smallexample
17485 p 'foo.c'::x
17486 @end smallexample
17487
17488 @noindent
17489 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
17490
17491 @table @code
17492 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
17493 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
17494 @kindex set case-sensitive
17495 @item set case-sensitive on
17496 @itemx set case-sensitive off
17497 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
17498 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
17499 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
17500 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
17501 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
17502 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
17503 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
17504 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
17505 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
17506 case-insensitive matches.
17507
17508 @kindex show case-sensitive
17509 @item show case-sensitive
17510 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
17511 lookups.
17512
17513 @kindex set print type methods
17514 @item set print type methods
17515 @itemx set print type methods on
17516 @itemx set print type methods off
17517 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
17518 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17519 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17520 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17521 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
17522 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
17523
17524 @kindex show print type methods
17525 @item show print type methods
17526 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
17527 classes.
17528
17529 @kindex set print type nested-type-limit
17530 @item set print type nested-type-limit @var{limit}
17531 @itemx set print type nested-type-limit unlimited
17532 Set the limit of displayed nested types that the type printer will
17533 show. A @var{limit} of @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} will show all
17534 nested definitions. By default, the type printer will not show any nested
17535 types defined in classes.
17536
17537 @kindex show print type nested-type-limit
17538 @item show print type nested-type-limit
17539 This command shows the current display limit of nested types when
17540 printing classes.
17541
17542 @kindex set print type typedefs
17543 @item set print type typedefs
17544 @itemx set print type typedefs on
17545 @itemx set print type typedefs off
17546
17547 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
17548 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17549 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17550 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17551 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
17552 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
17553 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
17554 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
17555 types.
17556
17557 @kindex show print type typedefs
17558 @item show print type typedefs
17559 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
17560 printing classes.
17561
17562 @kindex info address
17563 @cindex address of a symbol
17564 @item info address @var{symbol}
17565 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
17566 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
17567 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
17568 is always stored.
17569
17570 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
17571 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
17572 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
17573
17574 @kindex info symbol
17575 @cindex symbol from address
17576 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
17577 @item info symbol @var{addr}
17578 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
17579 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
17580 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
17581
17582 @smallexample
17583 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
17584 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
17585 @end smallexample
17586
17587 @noindent
17588 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
17589 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
17590
17591 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
17592 library containing the symbol is also printed:
17593
17594 @smallexample
17595 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
17596 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
17597 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
17598 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
17599 @end smallexample
17600
17601 @kindex demangle
17602 @cindex demangle
17603 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
17604 Demangle @var{name}.
17605 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
17606 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
17607
17608 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
17609 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
17610
17611 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
17612 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
17613
17614 @kindex whatis
17615 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17616 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
17617 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
17618 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17619
17620 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
17621 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
17622 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
17623
17624 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
17625 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
17626 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
17627 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
17628 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
17629 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
17630 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
17631 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
17632 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
17633
17634 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
17635 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
17636 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
17637 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
17638 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
17639 unroll it.
17640
17641 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
17642 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
17643 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
17644
17645 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
17646 Available flags are:
17647
17648 @table @code
17649 @item r
17650 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
17651 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
17652 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
17653
17654 @item m
17655 Do not print methods defined in the class.
17656
17657 @item M
17658 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17659 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
17660
17661 @item t
17662 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
17663 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
17664 names are substituted when printing other types.
17665
17666 @item T
17667 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17668 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
17669
17670 @item o
17671 Print the offsets and sizes of fields in a struct, similar to what the
17672 @command{pahole} tool does. This option implies the @code{/tm} flags.
17673
17674 For example, given the following declarations:
17675
17676 @smallexample
17677 struct tuv
17678 @{
17679 int a1;
17680 char *a2;
17681 int a3;
17682 @};
17683
17684 struct xyz
17685 @{
17686 int f1;
17687 char f2;
17688 void *f3;
17689 struct tuv f4;
17690 @};
17691
17692 union qwe
17693 @{
17694 struct tuv fff1;
17695 struct xyz fff2;
17696 @};
17697
17698 struct tyu
17699 @{
17700 int a1 : 1;
17701 int a2 : 3;
17702 int a3 : 23;
17703 char a4 : 2;
17704 int64_t a5;
17705 int a6 : 5;
17706 int64_t a7 : 3;
17707 @};
17708 @end smallexample
17709
17710 Issuing a @kbd{ptype /o struct tuv} command would print:
17711
17712 @smallexample
17713 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tuv
17714 /* offset | size */ type = struct tuv @{
17715 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
17716 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17717 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
17718 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
17719
17720 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17721 @}
17722 @end smallexample
17723
17724 Notice the format of the first column of comments. There, you can
17725 find two parts separated by the @samp{|} character: the @emph{offset},
17726 which indicates where the field is located inside the struct, in
17727 bytes, and the @emph{size} of the field. Another interesting line is
17728 the marker of a @emph{hole} in the struct, indicating that it may be
17729 possible to pack the struct and make it use less space by reorganizing
17730 its fields.
17731
17732 It is also possible to print offsets inside an union:
17733
17734 @smallexample
17735 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o union qwe
17736 /* offset | size */ type = union qwe @{
17737 /* 24 */ struct tuv @{
17738 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
17739 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17740 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
17741 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
17742
17743 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17744 @} fff1;
17745 /* 40 */ struct xyz @{
17746 /* 0 | 4 */ int f1;
17747 /* 4 | 1 */ char f2;
17748 /* XXX 3-byte hole */
17749 /* 8 | 8 */ void *f3;
17750 /* 16 | 24 */ struct tuv @{
17751 /* 16 | 4 */ int a1;
17752 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17753 /* 24 | 8 */ char *a2;
17754 /* 32 | 4 */ int a3;
17755
17756 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17757 @} f4;
17758
17759 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
17760 @} fff2;
17761
17762 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
17763 @}
17764 @end smallexample
17765
17766 In this case, since @code{struct tuv} and @code{struct xyz} occupy the
17767 same space (because we are dealing with an union), the offset is not
17768 printed for them. However, you can still examine the offset of each
17769 of these structures' fields.
17770
17771 Another useful scenario is printing the offsets of a struct containing
17772 bitfields:
17773
17774 @smallexample
17775 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tyu
17776 /* offset | size */ type = struct tyu @{
17777 /* 0:31 | 4 */ int a1 : 1;
17778 /* 0:28 | 4 */ int a2 : 3;
17779 /* 0: 5 | 4 */ int a3 : 23;
17780 /* 3: 3 | 1 */ signed char a4 : 2;
17781 /* XXX 3-bit hole */
17782 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17783 /* 8 | 8 */ int64_t a5;
17784 /* 16:27 | 4 */ int a6 : 5;
17785 /* 16:56 | 8 */ int64_t a7 : 3;
17786
17787 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17788 @}
17789 @end smallexample
17790
17791 Note how the offset information is now extended to also include how
17792 many bits are left to be used in each bitfield.
17793 @end table
17794
17795 @kindex ptype
17796 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17797 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
17798 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
17799 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
17800
17801 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
17802 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
17803 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
17804 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
17805 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
17806 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
17807 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
17808 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
17809
17810 For example, for this variable declaration:
17811
17812 @smallexample
17813 typedef double real_t;
17814 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
17815 typedef struct complex complex_t;
17816 complex_t var;
17817 real_t *real_pointer_var;
17818 @end smallexample
17819
17820 @noindent
17821 the two commands give this output:
17822
17823 @smallexample
17824 @group
17825 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
17826 type = complex_t
17827 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17828 type = struct complex @{
17829 real_t real;
17830 double imag;
17831 @}
17832 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
17833 type = struct complex
17834 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
17835 type = struct complex
17836 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
17837 type = struct complex @{
17838 real_t real;
17839 double imag;
17840 @}
17841 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
17842 type = real_t *
17843 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
17844 type = double *
17845 @end group
17846 @end smallexample
17847
17848 @noindent
17849 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
17850 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17851
17852 @cindex incomplete type
17853 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
17854 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
17855 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
17856 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
17857 given these declarations:
17858
17859 @smallexample
17860 struct foo;
17861 struct foo *fooptr;
17862 @end smallexample
17863
17864 @noindent
17865 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
17866
17867 @smallexample
17868 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
17869 $1 = <incomplete type>
17870 @end smallexample
17871
17872 @noindent
17873 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
17874 completely specified.
17875
17876 @cindex unknown type
17877 Othertimes, information about a variable's type is completely absent
17878 from the debug information included in the program. This most often
17879 happens when the program or library where the variable is defined
17880 includes no debug information at all. @value{GDBN} knows the variable
17881 exists from inspecting the linker/loader symbol table (e.g., the ELF
17882 dynamic symbol table), but such symbols do not contain type
17883 information. Inspecting the type of a (global) variable for which
17884 @value{GDBN} has no type information shows:
17885
17886 @smallexample
17887 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17888 type = <data variable, no debug info>
17889 @end smallexample
17890
17891 @xref{Variables, no debug info variables}, for how to print the values
17892 of such variables.
17893
17894 @kindex info types
17895 @item info types @var{regexp}
17896 @itemx info types
17897 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
17898 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
17899 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
17900 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
17901 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
17902 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
17903 name is @code{value}.
17904
17905 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
17906 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
17907 lists all source files and line numbers where a type is defined.
17908
17909 @kindex info type-printers
17910 @item info type-printers
17911 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
17912 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
17913 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
17914 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
17915 type printers.
17916
17917 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
17918
17919 @kindex enable type-printer
17920 @kindex disable type-printer
17921 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17922 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17923 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
17924
17925 @kindex info scope
17926 @cindex local variables
17927 @item info scope @var{location}
17928 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
17929 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
17930 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
17931 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
17932 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
17933
17934 @smallexample
17935 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
17936 Scope for command_line_handler:
17937 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
17938 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
17939 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
17940 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
17941 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
17942 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
17943 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
17944 @end smallexample
17945
17946 @noindent
17947 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
17948 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
17949 collect}.
17950
17951 @kindex info source
17952 @item info source
17953 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
17954 the function containing the current point of execution:
17955 @itemize @bullet
17956 @item
17957 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
17958 @item
17959 the directory it was compiled in,
17960 @item
17961 its length, in lines,
17962 @item
17963 which programming language it is written in,
17964 @item
17965 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
17966 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
17967 @item
17968 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
17969 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
17970 @item
17971 whether the debugging information includes information about
17972 preprocessor macros.
17973 @end itemize
17974
17975
17976 @kindex info sources
17977 @item info sources
17978 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
17979 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
17980 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
17981
17982 @kindex info functions
17983 @item info functions [-q]
17984 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
17985 Similarly to @samp{info types}, this command groups its output by source
17986 files and annotates each function definition with its source line
17987 number.
17988
17989 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
17990 printing header information and messages explaining why no functions
17991 have been printed.
17992
17993 @item info functions [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
17994 Like @samp{info functions}, but only print the names and data types
17995 of the functions selected with the provided regexp(s).
17996
17997 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the functions whose names
17998 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
17999 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose
18000 names include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
18001 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters that
18002 conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
18003 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
18004
18005 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the functions whose
18006 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
18007 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
18008 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
18009 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
18010 of special characters or quotes.
18011 Thus, @samp{info fun -t '^int ('} finds the functions that return
18012 an integer; @samp{info fun -t '(.*int.*'} finds the functions that
18013 have an argument type containing int; @samp{info fun -t '^int (' ^step}
18014 finds the functions whose names start with @code{step} and that return
18015 int.
18016
18017 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, a function
18018 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
18019 @var{type_regexp}.
18020
18021
18022 @kindex info variables
18023 @item info variables [-q]
18024 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
18025 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
18026 The printed variables are grouped by source files and annotated with
18027 their respective source line numbers.
18028
18029 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
18030 printing header information and messages explaining why no variables
18031 have been printed.
18032
18033 @item info variables [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
18034 Like @kbd{info variables}, but only print the variables selected
18035 with the provided regexp(s).
18036
18037 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the variables whose names
18038 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
18039
18040 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the variables whose
18041 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
18042 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
18043 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
18044 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
18045 of special characters or quotes.
18046
18047 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, an argument
18048 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
18049 @var{type_regexp}.
18050
18051 @kindex info classes
18052 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
18053 @item info classes
18054 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
18055 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
18056 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
18057 expression.
18058
18059 @kindex info selectors
18060 @item info selectors
18061 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
18062 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
18063 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
18064 expression.
18065
18066 @ignore
18067 This was never implemented.
18068 @kindex info methods
18069 @item info methods
18070 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
18071 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
18072 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
18073 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
18074 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
18075 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
18076 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
18077 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
18078 @end ignore
18079
18080 @cindex opaque data types
18081 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
18082 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
18083 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
18084 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
18085 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
18086 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
18087 another source file. The default is on.
18088
18089 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
18090 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
18091
18092 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
18093 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
18094 is printed as follows:
18095 @smallexample
18096 @{<no data fields>@}
18097 @end smallexample
18098
18099 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
18100 @item show opaque-type-resolution
18101 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
18102
18103 @kindex set print symbol-loading
18104 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
18105 @item set print symbol-loading
18106 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
18107 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
18108 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
18109 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
18110 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
18111 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
18112 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
18113 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
18114 can be annoying.
18115 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
18116 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
18117 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
18118 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
18119
18120 @kindex show print symbol-loading
18121 @item show print symbol-loading
18122 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
18123 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
18124
18125 @kindex maint print symbols
18126 @cindex symbol dump
18127 @kindex maint print psymbols
18128 @cindex partial symbol dump
18129 @kindex maint print msymbols
18130 @cindex minimal symbol dump
18131 @item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18132 @itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18133 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18134 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18135 @itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18136 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or
18137 the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified.
18138 If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for
18139 that objfile.
18140 If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file
18141 with code at that address. Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like
18142 @code{main}.
18143 If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that
18144 source file.
18145
18146 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.
18147 These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore
18148 @samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol
18149 tables.
18150 You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.
18151 If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information
18152 about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols
18153 defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.
18154 Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g.,
18155 ``ELF symbols''.
18156
18157 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
18158 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
18159
18160 @kindex maint info symtabs
18161 @kindex maint info psymtabs
18162 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
18163 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18164 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18165 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18166 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18167 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18168
18169 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
18170 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
18171 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
18172 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
18173 structure in more detail. For example:
18174
18175 @smallexample
18176 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
18177 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18178 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18179 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18180 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
18181 readin no
18182 fullname (null)
18183 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
18184 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
18185 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
18186 dependencies (none)
18187 @}
18188 @}
18189 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18190 (@value{GDBP})
18191 @end smallexample
18192 @noindent
18193 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
18194 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
18195 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
18196 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
18197 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
18198
18199 @smallexample
18200 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
18201 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
18202 line 1574.
18203 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18204 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18205 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18206 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18207 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
18208 dirname (null)
18209 fullname (null)
18210 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
18211 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
18212 debugformat DWARF 2
18213 @}
18214 @}
18215 (@value{GDBP})
18216 @end smallexample
18217
18218 @kindex maint info line-table
18219 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
18220 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18221 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18222
18223 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
18224 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
18225 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
18226
18227 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
18228 @cindex symbol cache size
18229 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
18230 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
18231 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
18232 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
18233 with different sizes.
18234
18235 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
18236 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
18237 Show the size of the symbol cache.
18238
18239 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
18240 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
18241 @item maint print symbol-cache
18242 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
18243 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
18244
18245 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18246 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
18247 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18248 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
18249 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
18250
18251 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
18252 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
18253 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
18254 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
18255 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
18256 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
18257
18258 @end table
18259
18260 @node Altering
18261 @chapter Altering Execution
18262
18263 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
18264 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
18265 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
18266 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
18267 program.
18268
18269 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
18270 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
18271 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
18272
18273 @menu
18274 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
18275 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
18276 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
18277 * Returning:: Returning from a function
18278 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
18279 * Patching:: Patching your program
18280 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18281 @end menu
18282
18283 @node Assignment
18284 @section Assignment to Variables
18285
18286 @cindex assignment
18287 @cindex setting variables
18288 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
18289 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
18290
18291 @smallexample
18292 print x=4
18293 @end smallexample
18294
18295 @noindent
18296 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
18297 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
18298 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
18299 information on operators in supported languages.
18300
18301 @kindex set variable
18302 @cindex variables, setting
18303 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
18304 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
18305 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
18306 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
18307 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
18308
18309 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
18310 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
18311 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
18312 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
18313 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
18314 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
18315 command @code{set width}:
18316
18317 @smallexample
18318 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
18319 type = double
18320 (@value{GDBP}) p width
18321 $4 = 13
18322 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
18323 Invalid syntax in expression.
18324 @end smallexample
18325
18326 @noindent
18327 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
18328 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
18329
18330 @smallexample
18331 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
18332 @end smallexample
18333
18334 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
18335 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
18336 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
18337 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
18338 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
18339 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
18340
18341 @smallexample
18342 @group
18343 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
18344 type = double
18345 (@value{GDBP}) p g
18346 $1 = 1
18347 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
18348 (@value{GDBP}) p g
18349 $2 = 1
18350 (@value{GDBP}) r
18351 The program being debugged has been started already.
18352 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
18353 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
18354 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
18355 Invalid bfd target.
18356 (@value{GDBP}) show g
18357 The current BFD target is "=4".
18358 @end group
18359 @end smallexample
18360
18361 @noindent
18362 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
18363 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
18364 @code{g}, use
18365
18366 @smallexample
18367 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
18368 @end smallexample
18369
18370 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
18371 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
18372 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
18373 same length or shorter.
18374 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
18375 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
18376
18377 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
18378 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
18379 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
18380 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
18381 and representation in memory), and
18382
18383 @smallexample
18384 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
18385 @end smallexample
18386
18387 @noindent
18388 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
18389
18390 @node Jumping
18391 @section Continuing at a Different Address
18392
18393 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
18394 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
18395 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
18396
18397 @table @code
18398 @kindex jump
18399 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
18400 @item jump @var{location}
18401 @itemx j @var{location}
18402 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
18403 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
18404 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
18405 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
18406 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
18407
18408 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
18409 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
18410 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
18411 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
18412 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
18413 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
18414 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
18415 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
18416 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
18417 @end table
18418
18419 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
18420 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
18421 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
18422 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
18423 example,
18424
18425 @smallexample
18426 set $pc = 0x485
18427 @end smallexample
18428
18429 @noindent
18430 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
18431 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
18432 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
18433
18434 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
18435 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
18436 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
18437 detail.
18438
18439 @c @group
18440 @node Signaling
18441 @section Giving your Program a Signal
18442 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
18443
18444 @table @code
18445 @kindex signal
18446 @item signal @var{signal}
18447 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
18448 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
18449 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
18450 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
18451
18452 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
18453 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
18454 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
18455 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
18456 signal.
18457
18458 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
18459 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
18460 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
18461 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
18462 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
18463 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
18464 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
18465 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
18466
18467 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
18468 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
18469 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
18470 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
18471 passes the signal directly to your program.
18472
18473 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
18474 after executing the command.
18475
18476 @kindex queue-signal
18477 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
18478 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
18479 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
18480 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
18481 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
18482 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
18483 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
18484 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
18485 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
18486
18487 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
18488 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
18489 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
18490 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
18491 @code{continue} command.
18492
18493 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
18494 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
18495 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
18496 (@pxref{Signals}).
18497 @end table
18498 @c @end group
18499
18500 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
18501 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
18502
18503 @node Returning
18504 @section Returning from a Function
18505
18506 @table @code
18507 @cindex returning from a function
18508 @kindex return
18509 @item return
18510 @itemx return @var{expression}
18511 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
18512 command. If you give an
18513 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
18514 value.
18515 @end table
18516
18517 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
18518 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
18519 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
18520 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
18521
18522 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
18523 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
18524 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
18525 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
18526 of functions.
18527
18528 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
18529 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
18530 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
18531 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
18532 selected stack frame returns naturally.
18533
18534 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
18535 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
18536 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
18537 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
18538 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
18539 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
18540 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
18541 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
18542 assignment into the right register(s).
18543
18544 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
18545 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
18546 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
18547 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
18548 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
18549 into a @code{long long int}:
18550
18551 @smallexample
18552 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
18553 29 return 31;
18554 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
18555 Make func return now? (y or n) y
18556 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
18557 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
18558 (@value{GDBP})
18559 @end smallexample
18560
18561 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
18562 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
18563 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
18564 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
18565 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
18566 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
18567 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
18568 an appropriate cast explicitly:
18569
18570 @smallexample
18571 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
18572 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
18573 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
18574 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
18575 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
18576 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
18577 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
18578 (@value{GDBP})
18579 @end smallexample
18580
18581 @node Calling
18582 @section Calling Program Functions
18583
18584 @table @code
18585 @cindex calling functions
18586 @cindex inferior functions, calling
18587 @item print @var{expr}
18588 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
18589 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
18590 debugged.
18591
18592 @kindex call
18593 @item call @var{expr}
18594 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
18595 returned values.
18596
18597 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
18598 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
18599 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
18600 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
18601 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
18602 value history.
18603 @end table
18604
18605 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
18606 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
18607 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
18608 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
18609
18610 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
18611 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
18612 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
18613 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
18614 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
18615 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
18616 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
18617 in that case is controlled by the
18618 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
18619
18620 @table @code
18621 @item set unwindonsignal
18622 @kindex set unwindonsignal
18623 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
18624 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
18625 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
18626 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
18627 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
18628 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
18629 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
18630 received.
18631
18632 @item show unwindonsignal
18633 @kindex show unwindonsignal
18634 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
18635 @value{GDBN}.
18636
18637 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18638 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18639 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
18640 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
18641 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
18642 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
18643 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
18644 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
18645 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
18646 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
18647
18648 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18649 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18650 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
18651 @value{GDBN}.
18652
18653 @end table
18654
18655 @subsection Calling functions with no debug info
18656
18657 @cindex no debug info functions
18658 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is missing debug information.
18659 In such case, @value{GDBN} does not know the type of the function,
18660 including the types of the function's parameters. To avoid calling
18661 the inferior function incorrectly, which could result in the called
18662 function functioning erroneously and even crash, @value{GDBN} refuses
18663 to call the function unless you tell it the type of the function.
18664
18665 For prototyped (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) functions, there are two ways
18666 to do that. The simplest is to cast the call to the function's
18667 declared return type. For example:
18668
18669 @smallexample
18670 (@value{GDBP}) p getenv ("PATH")
18671 'getenv' has unknown return type; cast the call to its declared return type
18672 (@value{GDBP}) p (char *) getenv ("PATH")
18673 $1 = 0x7fffffffe7ba "/usr/local/bin:/"...
18674 @end smallexample
18675
18676 Casting the return type of a no-debug function is equivalent to
18677 casting the function to a pointer to a prototyped function that has a
18678 prototype that matches the types of the passed-in arguments, and
18679 calling that. I.e., the call above is equivalent to:
18680
18681 @smallexample
18682 (@value{GDBP}) p ((char * (*) (const char *)) getenv) ("PATH")
18683 @end smallexample
18684
18685 @noindent
18686 and given this prototyped C or C++ function with float parameters:
18687
18688 @smallexample
18689 float multiply (float v1, float v2) @{ return v1 * v2; @}
18690 @end smallexample
18691
18692 @noindent
18693 these calls are equivalent:
18694
18695 @smallexample
18696 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) multiply (2.0f, 3.0f)
18697 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) (float, float)) multiply) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18698 @end smallexample
18699
18700 If the function you wish to call is declared as unprototyped (i.e.@:
18701 old K&R style), you must use the cast-to-function-pointer syntax, so
18702 that @value{GDBN} knows that it needs to apply default argument
18703 promotions (promote float arguments to double). @xref{ABI, float
18704 promotion}. For example, given this unprototyped C function with
18705 float parameters, and no debug info:
18706
18707 @smallexample
18708 float
18709 multiply_noproto (v1, v2)
18710 float v1, v2;
18711 @{
18712 return v1 * v2;
18713 @}
18714 @end smallexample
18715
18716 @noindent
18717 you call it like this:
18718
18719 @smallexample
18720 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) ()) multiply_noproto) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18721 @end smallexample
18722
18723 @node Patching
18724 @section Patching Programs
18725
18726 @cindex patching binaries
18727 @cindex writing into executables
18728 @cindex writing into corefiles
18729
18730 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
18731 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
18732 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
18733 patching your program's binary.
18734
18735 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
18736 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
18737 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
18738 repairs.
18739
18740 @table @code
18741 @kindex set write
18742 @item set write on
18743 @itemx set write off
18744 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
18745 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
18746 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
18747
18748 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
18749 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
18750 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
18751
18752 @item show write
18753 @kindex show write
18754 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
18755 as well as reading.
18756 @end table
18757
18758 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
18759 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18760 @cindex injecting code
18761 @cindex writing into executables
18762 @cindex compiling code
18763
18764 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
18765 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
18766 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
18767 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
18768
18769 @table @code
18770 @kindex compile code
18771 @item compile code @var{source-code}
18772 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
18773 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
18774 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
18775 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
18776 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
18777 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
18778 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
18779 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
18780 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
18781 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
18782 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
18783
18784 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
18785 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
18786 E.g.:
18787
18788 @smallexample
18789 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
18790 @end smallexample
18791
18792 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
18793 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
18794 from actual source code. E.g.:
18795
18796 @smallexample
18797 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
18798 @end smallexample
18799
18800 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
18801 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
18802 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
18803 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
18804 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
18805 editor.
18806
18807 @smallexample
18808 compile code
18809 >printf ("hello\n");
18810 >printf ("world\n");
18811 >end
18812 @end smallexample
18813
18814 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
18815 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
18816 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
18817 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
18818 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
18819 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
18820 inferior symbols otherwise.
18821
18822 @kindex compile file
18823 @item compile file @var{filename}
18824 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
18825 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
18826
18827 @smallexample
18828 compile file /home/user/example.c
18829 @end smallexample
18830 @end table
18831
18832 @table @code
18833 @item compile print @var{expr}
18834 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
18835 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
18836 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
18837 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
18838 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
18839 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
18840 Formats}.
18841
18842 @item compile print
18843 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
18844 @cindex reprint the last value
18845 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
18846 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
18847 command without any text following the command. This will start the
18848 multiple-line editor.
18849 @end table
18850
18851 @noindent
18852 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
18853
18854 @table @code
18855 @anchor{set debug compile}
18856 @item set debug compile
18857 @cindex compile command debugging info
18858 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
18859 injecting the code. The default is off.
18860
18861 @item show debug compile
18862 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
18863 compiling and injecting the code.
18864
18865 @anchor{set debug compile-cplus-types}
18866 @item set debug compile-cplus-types
18867 @cindex compile C@t{++} type conversion
18868 Turns on or off the display of C@t{++} type conversion debugging information.
18869 The default is off.
18870
18871 @item show debug compile-cplus-types
18872 Displays the current state of displaying debugging information for
18873 C@t{++} type conversion.
18874 @end table
18875
18876 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
18877
18878 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
18879 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
18880 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
18881 injecting process.
18882
18883 @noindent
18884 The options used, in increasing precedence:
18885
18886 @table @asis
18887 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
18888 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
18889 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
18890 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
18891
18892 @item compilation options recorded in the target
18893 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
18894 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
18895 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
18896 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
18897 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
18898 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
18899 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
18900
18901 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
18902 @end table
18903
18904 @noindent
18905 You can override compilation options using the following command:
18906
18907 @table @code
18908 @item set compile-args
18909 @cindex compile command options override
18910 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
18911 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
18912 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
18913 compilation.
18914
18915 @item show compile-args
18916 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
18917 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
18918 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
18919 @end table
18920
18921 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
18922
18923 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
18924 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
18925 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
18926
18927 @table @asis
18928 @item C code examples and caveats
18929 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
18930 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
18931 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
18932 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
18933 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
18934
18935 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
18936 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
18937 much like any other normal debugging session.
18938
18939 @smallexample
18940 void function1 (void)
18941 @{
18942 int i = 42;
18943 printf ("function 1\n");
18944 @}
18945
18946 void function2 (void)
18947 @{
18948 int j = 12;
18949 function1 ();
18950 @}
18951
18952 int main(void)
18953 @{
18954 int k = 6;
18955 int *p;
18956 function2 ();
18957 return 0;
18958 @}
18959 @end smallexample
18960
18961 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
18962 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
18963 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
18964
18965 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
18966 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
18967 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
18968 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
18969 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
18970
18971 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
18972 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
18973 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
18974 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
18975 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
18976 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
18977 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
18978 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
18979 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
18980 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
18981
18982 @smallexample
18983 compile code k = 3;
18984 @end smallexample
18985
18986 @noindent
18987 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
18988 something else in the example program changes it, or another
18989 @code{compile} command changes it.
18990
18991 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
18992 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
18993 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
18994 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
18995 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
18996
18997 @smallexample
18998 compile code j = 3;
18999 @end smallexample
19000
19001 @noindent
19002 will result in a compilation error message.
19003
19004 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
19005 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
19006 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
19007
19008 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
19009 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
19010 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
19011 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
19012
19013 @smallexample
19014 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
19015 @end smallexample
19016
19017 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
19018 command has completed:
19019
19020 @smallexample
19021 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
19022 @end smallexample
19023
19024 @noindent
19025 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
19026 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
19027 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
19028 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
19029 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
19030
19031 @smallexample
19032 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
19033 @end smallexample
19034
19035 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
19036 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
19037 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
19038 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
19039 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
19040 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
19041 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
19042 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
19043
19044 @smallexample
19045 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
19046 @end smallexample
19047
19048 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
19049 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
19050 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
19051 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
19052 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
19053 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
19054 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
19055
19056 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
19057 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
19058 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
19059 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
19060 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
19061 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
19062
19063 @smallexample
19064 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
19065 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
19066 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
19067 Compilation failed.
19068 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
19069 42
19070 @end smallexample
19071
19072 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
19073 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
19074 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
19075 will print to the console.
19076 @end table
19077
19078 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
19079
19080 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged
19081 which may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture
19082 than where @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} on
19083 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
19084 target architecture and operating system. This search can be overriden
19085 by @code{set compile-gcc} @value{GDBN} command below. @code{PATH} is
19086 taken from shell that executed @value{GDBN}, it is not the value set by
19087 @value{GDBN} command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}.
19088
19089
19090 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
19091 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
19092 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
19093 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
19094 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
19095 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
19096 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
19097
19098 On Posix hosts the compiler driver @value{GDBN} needs to find also
19099 shared library @file{libcc1.so} from the compiler. It is searched in
19100 default shared library search path (overridable with usual environment
19101 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}), unrelated to @code{PATH} or @code{set
19102 compile-gcc} settings. Contrary to it @file{libcc1plugin.so} is found
19103 according to the installation of the found compiler --- as possibly
19104 specified by the @code{set compile-gcc} command.
19105
19106 @table @code
19107 @item set compile-gcc
19108 @cindex compile command driver filename override
19109 Set compilation command used for compiling and injecting code with the
19110 @code{compile} commands. If this option is not set (it is set to
19111 an empty string), the search described above will occur --- that is the
19112 default.
19113
19114 @item show compile-gcc
19115 Displays the current compile command @value{NGCC} driver filename.
19116 If set, it is the main command @command{gcc}, found usually for example
19117 under name @file{x86_64-linux-gnu-gcc}.
19118 @end table
19119
19120 @node GDB Files
19121 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
19122
19123 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
19124 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
19125 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
19126 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
19127
19128 @menu
19129 * Files:: Commands to specify files
19130 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
19131 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
19132 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
19133 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
19134 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
19135 * Data Files:: GDB data files
19136 @end menu
19137
19138 @node Files
19139 @section Commands to Specify Files
19140
19141 @cindex symbol table
19142 @cindex core dump file
19143
19144 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
19145 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
19146 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
19147 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
19148
19149 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
19150 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
19151 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
19152 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
19153 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
19154 new files are useful.
19155
19156 @table @code
19157 @cindex executable file
19158 @kindex file
19159 @item file @var{filename}
19160 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
19161 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
19162 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
19163 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
19164 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
19165 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
19166 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
19167 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
19168
19169 @cindex unlinked object files
19170 @cindex patching object files
19171 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
19172 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
19173 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
19174 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
19175 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
19176 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
19177 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
19178 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
19179
19180 @item file
19181 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
19182 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
19183
19184 @kindex exec-file
19185 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
19186 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
19187 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
19188 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
19189 discard information on the executable file.
19190
19191 @kindex symbol-file
19192 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]]}
19193 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
19194 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
19195 table and program to run from the same file.
19196
19197 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
19198 address of each section in the symbol file. This is useful if the
19199 program is relocated at runtime, such as the Linux kernel with kASLR
19200 enabled.
19201
19202 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
19203 program's symbol table.
19204
19205 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
19206 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
19207 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
19208 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
19209 @value{GDBN}.
19210
19211 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
19212 executing it once.
19213
19214 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
19215 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
19216 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
19217 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
19218 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
19219 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
19220 optimized code.
19221
19222 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
19223 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
19224 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
19225 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
19226 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
19227
19228 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
19229 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
19230 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
19231 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
19232 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
19233 Warnings and Messages}.)
19234
19235 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
19236 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
19237 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
19238 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
19239 in stabs format.
19240
19241 @kindex readnow
19242 @cindex reading symbols immediately
19243 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
19244 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
19245 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
19246 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
19247 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
19248 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
19249 entire symbol table available.
19250
19251 @cindex @code{-readnever}, option for symbol-file command
19252 @cindex never read symbols
19253 @cindex symbols, never read
19254 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
19255 @itemx file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
19256 You can instruct @value{GDBN} to never read the symbolic information
19257 contained in @var{filename} by using the @samp{-readnever} option.
19258 @xref{--readnever}.
19259
19260 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
19261 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
19262 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
19263 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
19264 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
19265 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
19266 @c files.
19267
19268 @kindex core-file
19269 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
19270 @itemx core
19271 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
19272 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
19273 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
19274 executable file itself for other parts.
19275
19276 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
19277 to be used.
19278
19279 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
19280 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
19281 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
19282 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
19283 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
19284
19285 @kindex add-symbol-file
19286 @cindex dynamic linking
19287 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{|} -readnever @r{]} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]} @r{[} @var{textaddress} @r{]} @r{[} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{} @r{]}
19288 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
19289 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
19290 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
19291 into the program that is running. The @var{textaddress} parameter gives
19292 the memory address at which the file's text section has been loaded.
19293 You can additionally specify the base address of other sections using
19294 an arbitrary number of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs.
19295 If a section is omitted, @value{GDBN} will use its default addresses
19296 as found in @var{filename}. Any @var{address} or @var{textaddress}
19297 can be given as an expression.
19298
19299 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
19300 address of each section, except those for which the address was
19301 specified explicitly.
19302
19303 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
19304 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
19305 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
19306 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
19307
19308 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
19309
19310 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
19311 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
19312 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
19313 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
19314 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
19315 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
19316 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
19317 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
19318 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
19319
19320 @itemize @bullet
19321 @item
19322 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
19323 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
19324 @item
19325 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
19326 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
19327 @item
19328 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
19329 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19330 @end itemize
19331
19332 @noindent
19333 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
19334 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
19335 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
19336 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
19337 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
19338 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
19339 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
19340 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
19341 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
19342 way.
19343
19344 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
19345
19346 @kindex remove-symbol-file
19347 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
19348 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
19349 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
19350 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
19351 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
19352
19353 @smallexample
19354 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
19355 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
19356 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
19357 (y or n) y
19358 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
19359 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
19360 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
19361 (gdb)
19362 @end smallexample
19363
19364
19365 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
19366
19367 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
19368 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
19369 @cindex load symbols from memory
19370 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
19371 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
19372 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
19373 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
19374 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
19375 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
19376 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
19377 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
19378 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
19379
19380 @kindex section
19381 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
19382 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
19383 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
19384 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
19385 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
19386 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
19387 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
19388 their addresses.
19389
19390 @kindex info files
19391 @kindex info target
19392 @item info files
19393 @itemx info target
19394 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
19395 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
19396 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
19397 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
19398 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
19399 current ones.
19400
19401 @kindex maint info sections
19402 @item maint info sections
19403 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
19404 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
19405 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
19406 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
19407 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
19408 may be arbitrarily combined):
19409
19410 @table @code
19411 @item ALLOBJ
19412 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
19413 @item @var{sections}
19414 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
19415 @item @var{section-flags}
19416 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
19417 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
19418 @table @code
19419 @item ALLOC
19420 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
19421 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
19422 @item LOAD
19423 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
19424 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
19425 @item RELOC
19426 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
19427 @item READONLY
19428 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
19429 @item CODE
19430 Section contains executable code only.
19431 @item DATA
19432 Section contains data only (no executable code).
19433 @item ROM
19434 Section will reside in ROM.
19435 @item CONSTRUCTOR
19436 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
19437 @item HAS_CONTENTS
19438 Section is not empty.
19439 @item NEVER_LOAD
19440 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
19441 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
19442 A notification to the linker that the section contains
19443 COFF shared library information.
19444 @item IS_COMMON
19445 Section contains common symbols.
19446 @end table
19447 @end table
19448 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
19449 @cindex read-only sections
19450 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
19451 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
19452 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
19453 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
19454 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
19455 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
19456 enhancement to debugging performance.
19457
19458 The default is off.
19459
19460 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
19461 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
19462 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
19463 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
19464
19465 @item show trust-readonly-sections
19466 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
19467 @end table
19468
19469 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
19470 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
19471 name and remembers it that way.
19472
19473 @cindex shared libraries
19474 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
19475 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
19476 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
19477 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
19478
19479 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
19480 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
19481
19482 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
19483 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
19484 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
19485 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
19486 debugging a core file).
19487
19488 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
19489 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
19490 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
19491
19492 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
19493 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
19494 particularly large or there are many of them.
19495
19496 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
19497 commands:
19498
19499 @table @code
19500 @kindex set auto-solib-add
19501 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
19502 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
19503 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
19504 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
19505 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
19506 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
19507 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
19508
19509 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
19510 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
19511 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
19512 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
19513 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
19514 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
19515 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
19516 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
19517 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
19518
19519 @kindex show auto-solib-add
19520 @item show auto-solib-add
19521 Display the current autoloading mode.
19522 @end table
19523
19524 @cindex load shared library
19525 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
19526 command:
19527
19528 @table @code
19529 @kindex info sharedlibrary
19530 @kindex info share
19531 @item info share @var{regex}
19532 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
19533 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
19534 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
19535 all shared libraries that are loaded.
19536
19537 @kindex info dll
19538 @item info dll @var{regex}
19539 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
19540
19541 @kindex sharedlibrary
19542 @kindex share
19543 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
19544 @itemx share @var{regex}
19545 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
19546 Unix regular expression.
19547 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
19548 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
19549 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
19550 loaded.
19551
19552 @item nosharedlibrary
19553 @kindex nosharedlibrary
19554 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
19555 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
19556 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
19557 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
19558 discarded.
19559 @end table
19560
19561 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
19562 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
19563 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
19564 Catchpoints}).
19565
19566 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
19567 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
19568 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
19569 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
19570
19571 @table @code
19572 @item set stop-on-solib-events
19573 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
19574 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
19575 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
19576 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
19577 shared library.
19578
19579 @item show stop-on-solib-events
19580 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
19581 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
19582 library events happen.
19583 @end table
19584
19585 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
19586 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
19587 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
19588 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
19589 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
19590 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
19591 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
19592 not.
19593
19594 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
19595 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
19596 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
19597 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
19598 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
19599
19600 @table @code
19601 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
19602 @cindex system root, alternate
19603 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
19604 @kindex set sysroot
19605 @item set sysroot @var{path}
19606 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
19607 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
19608 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
19609 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
19610 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
19611 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
19612 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
19613 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
19614 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
19615 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
19616 @var{path}.
19617
19618 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
19619 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
19620 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
19621 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
19622 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
19623 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
19624 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
19625 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
19626 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
19627 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
19628 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
19629 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
19630 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
19631 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
19632
19633 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
19634 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
19635 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
19636 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
19637 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
19638
19639 @smallexample
19640 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
19641 @end smallexample
19642
19643 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
19644 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
19645 system:
19646
19647 @smallexample
19648 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
19649 @end smallexample
19650
19651 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
19652 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
19653 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
19654 colons:
19655
19656 @smallexample
19657 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
19658 @end smallexample
19659
19660 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
19661 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
19662 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
19663 @samp{z}):
19664
19665 @smallexample
19666 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
19667 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19668 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19669 @end smallexample
19670
19671 @noindent
19672 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
19673 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
19674 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
19675
19676 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
19677 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
19678
19679 @smallexample
19680 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
19681 @end smallexample
19682
19683 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
19684 if you don't want or need to.
19685
19686 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
19687 sysroot}.
19688
19689 @cindex default system root
19690 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
19691 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
19692 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
19693 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19694 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
19695 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19696 location.
19697
19698 @kindex show sysroot
19699 @item show sysroot
19700 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
19701
19702 @kindex set solib-search-path
19703 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
19704 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
19705 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
19706 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
19707 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
19708 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
19709 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
19710 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
19711 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
19712 of shared library symbols.
19713
19714 @kindex show solib-search-path
19715 @item show solib-search-path
19716 Display the current shared library search path.
19717
19718 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
19719 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
19720 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
19721 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
19722 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
19723
19724 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
19725 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
19726 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
19727 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
19728 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
19729 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
19730 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
19731 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
19732 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
19733 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
19734 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
19735 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
19736 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
19737 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
19738 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
19739 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
19740 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
19741 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
19742 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
19743 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
19744 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
19745 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
19746
19747 @table @code
19748 @item unix
19749 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
19750 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
19751 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
19752 the forward slash.
19753
19754 @item dos-based
19755 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
19756 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
19757 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
19758 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
19759 considered directory separators.
19760
19761 @item auto
19762 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
19763 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
19764 This is the default.
19765 @end table
19766 @end table
19767
19768 @cindex file name canonicalization
19769 @cindex base name differences
19770 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
19771 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
19772 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
19773 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
19774 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
19775 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
19776 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
19777 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
19778 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
19779 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
19780 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
19781 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
19782 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
19783 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
19784 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
19785
19786 @table @code
19787 @item set basenames-may-differ
19788 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
19789 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19790
19791 @item show basenames-may-differ
19792 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
19793 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19794 @end table
19795
19796 @node File Caching
19797 @section File Caching
19798 @cindex caching of opened files
19799 @cindex caching of bfd objects
19800
19801 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
19802 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
19803 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
19804 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
19805
19806 @table @code
19807 @kindex maint info bfds
19808 @item maint info bfds
19809 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
19810 @value{GDBN}.
19811
19812 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
19813 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
19814 @kindex bfd caching
19815 @item maint set bfd-sharing
19816 @item maint show bfd-sharing
19817 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
19818 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
19819 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
19820 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
19821 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
19822 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
19823 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
19824
19825 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19826 @kindex bfd caching
19827 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19828 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
19829
19830 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
19831 @kindex bfd caching
19832 @item show debug bfd-cache
19833 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
19834 @end table
19835
19836 @node Separate Debug Files
19837 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
19838 @cindex separate debugging information files
19839 @cindex debugging information in separate files
19840 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
19841 @cindex debugging information directory, global
19842 @cindex global debugging information directories
19843 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
19844 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
19845
19846 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
19847 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
19848 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
19849 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
19850 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
19851 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
19852 install only when they need to debug a problem.
19853
19854 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
19855 file:
19856
19857 @itemize @bullet
19858 @item
19859 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
19860 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
19861 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
19862 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
19863 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
19864 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
19865 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
19866 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
19867
19868 @item
19869 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
19870 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
19871 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
19872 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
19873 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
19874 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld,
19875 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
19876 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
19877 below.
19878 @end itemize
19879
19880 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
19881 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
19882
19883 @itemize @bullet
19884 @item
19885 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
19886 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
19887 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
19888 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
19889 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
19890
19891 @item
19892 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
19893 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
19894 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
19895 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
19896 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
19897 hex characters, not 10.)
19898 @end itemize
19899
19900 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
19901 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
19902 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
19903 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
19904 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
19905 debug information files, in the indicated order:
19906
19907 @itemize @minus
19908 @item
19909 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
19910 @item
19911 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
19912 @item
19913 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
19914 @item
19915 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
19916 @end itemize
19917
19918 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
19919 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
19920 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
19921 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
19922 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
19923
19924 @table @code
19925
19926 @kindex set debug-file-directory
19927 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
19928 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19929 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
19930 concatenating them by a path separator.
19931
19932 @kindex show debug-file-directory
19933 @item show debug-file-directory
19934 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19935 information files.
19936
19937 @end table
19938
19939 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
19940 @cindex debug link sections
19941 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
19942 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
19943
19944 @itemize
19945 @item
19946 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
19947 a zero byte,
19948 @item
19949 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
19950 boundary within the section, and
19951 @item
19952 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
19953 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
19954 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
19955 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
19956 @end itemize
19957
19958 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
19959 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
19960 described above.
19961
19962 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
19963 @cindex build ID sections
19964 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
19965 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
19966 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
19967 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
19968 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
19969 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
19970 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
19971 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
19972 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
19973
19974 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
19975 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
19976 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
19977 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
19978 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
19979 in an ordinary executable.
19980
19981 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
19982 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
19983 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
19984 following commands:
19985
19986 @smallexample
19987 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
19988 @kbd{strip -g foo}
19989 @end smallexample
19990
19991 @noindent
19992 These commands remove the debugging
19993 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
19994 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
19995 two files:
19996
19997 @itemize @bullet
19998 @item
19999 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
20000 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
20001
20002 @smallexample
20003 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
20004 @end smallexample
20005
20006 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
20007 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
20008 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
20009 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
20010
20011 @item
20012 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
20013 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
20014 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
20015 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
20016 @end itemize
20017
20018 @noindent
20019
20020 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
20021 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
20022 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
20023
20024 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
20025 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
20026 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
20027 @c different ways!
20028 @ifhtml
20029 @display
20030 @html
20031 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
20032 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
20033 @end html
20034 @end display
20035 @end ifhtml
20036 @ifnothtml
20037 @display
20038 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
20039 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
20040 @end display
20041 @end ifnothtml
20042
20043 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
20044 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
20045 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
20046 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
20047 CRC.
20048
20049 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
20050 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
20051 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
20052 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
20053 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
20054
20055 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
20056 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
20057 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
20058 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
20059 @code{0xffffffff}.
20060
20061 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
20062 @smallexample
20063 unsigned long
20064 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
20065 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
20066 @{
20067 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
20068 @{
20069 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
20070 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
20071 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
20072 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
20073 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
20074 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
20075 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
20076 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
20077 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
20078 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
20079 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
20080 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
20081 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
20082 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
20083 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
20084 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
20085 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
20086 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
20087 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
20088 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
20089 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
20090 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
20091 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
20092 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
20093 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
20094 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
20095 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
20096 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
20097 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
20098 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
20099 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
20100 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
20101 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
20102 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
20103 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
20104 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
20105 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
20106 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
20107 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
20108 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
20109 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
20110 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
20111 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
20112 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
20113 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
20114 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
20115 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
20116 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
20117 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
20118 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
20119 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
20120 0x2d02ef8d
20121 @};
20122 unsigned char *end;
20123
20124 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
20125 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
20126 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
20127 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
20128 @}
20129 @end smallexample
20130
20131 @noindent
20132 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
20133
20134 @node MiniDebugInfo
20135 @section Debugging information in a special section
20136 @cindex separate debug sections
20137 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
20138
20139 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
20140 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
20141 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
20142 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
20143
20144 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
20145 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
20146 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
20147 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
20148 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
20149 debugging information might be included in the section.
20150
20151 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
20152 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
20153 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
20154
20155 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
20156 standard utilities:
20157
20158 @smallexample
20159 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
20160 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
20161 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
20162 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
20163
20164 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
20165 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
20166 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
20167 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
20168 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
20169 | sort > funcsyms
20170
20171 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
20172 # table.
20173 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
20174
20175 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
20176 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
20177
20178 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
20179 # removing some unnecessary sections.
20180 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
20181 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
20182
20183 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
20184 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
20185
20186 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
20187 # original binary.
20188 xz mini_debuginfo
20189 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
20190 @end smallexample
20191
20192 @node Index Files
20193 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
20194 @cindex index files
20195 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
20196
20197 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
20198 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
20199 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
20200 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
20201 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
20202 startup.
20203
20204 For convenience, @value{GDBN} comes with a program,
20205 @command{gdb-add-index}, which can be used to add the index to a
20206 symbol file. It takes the symbol file as its only argument:
20207
20208 @smallexample
20209 $ gdb-add-index symfile
20210 @end smallexample
20211
20212 @xref{gdb-add-index}.
20213
20214 It is also possible to do the work manually. Here is what
20215 @command{gdb-add-index} does behind the curtains.
20216
20217 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
20218 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
20219 using @command{objcopy}.
20220
20221 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
20222
20223 @table @code
20224 @item save gdb-index [-dwarf-5] @var{directory}
20225 @kindex save gdb-index
20226 Create index files for all symbol files currently known by
20227 @value{GDBN}. For each known @var{symbol-file}, this command by
20228 default creates it produces a single file
20229 @file{@var{symbol-file}.gdb-index}. If you invoke this command with
20230 the @option{-dwarf-5} option, it produces 2 files:
20231 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_names} and
20232 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_str}. The files are created in the
20233 given @var{directory}.
20234 @end table
20235
20236 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
20237 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
20238
20239 @smallexample
20240 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
20241 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
20242 @end smallexample
20243
20244 Or for @code{-dwarf-5}:
20245
20246 @smallexample
20247 $ objcopy --dump-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile
20248 $ cat symfile.debug_str >>symfile.debug_str.new
20249 $ objcopy --add-section .debug_names=symfile.gdb-index \
20250 --set-section-flags .debug_names=readonly \
20251 --update-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile symfile
20252 @end smallexample
20253
20254 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
20255 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
20256 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
20257 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
20258 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
20259 The default is @code{off}.
20260 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
20261 @xref{Index Section Format}.
20262
20263 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
20264 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
20265
20266 @smallexample
20267 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
20268 @end smallexample
20269
20270 Instead you must do, for example,
20271
20272 @smallexample
20273 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
20274 @end smallexample
20275
20276 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
20277 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
20278 currently work for programs using Ada.
20279
20280 @subsection Automatic symbol index cache
20281
20282 It is possible for @value{GDBN} to automatically save a copy of this index in a
20283 cache on disk and retrieve it from there when loading the same binary in the
20284 future. This feature can be turned on with @kbd{set index-cache on}. The
20285 following commands can be used to tweak the behavior of the index cache.
20286
20287 @table @code
20288
20289 @item set index-cache on
20290 @itemx set index-cache off
20291 Enable or disable the use of the symbol index cache.
20292
20293 @item set index-cache directory @var{directory}
20294 @itemx show index-cache directory
20295 Set/show the directory where index files will be saved.
20296
20297 The default value for this directory depends on the host platform. On
20298 most systems, the index is cached in the @file{gdb} subdirectory of
20299 the directory pointed to by the @env{XDG_CACHE_HOME} environment
20300 variable, if it is defined, else in the @file{.cache/gdb} subdirectory
20301 of your home directory. However, on some systems, the default may
20302 differ according to local convention.
20303
20304 There is no limit on the disk space used by index cache. It is perfectly safe
20305 to delete the content of that directory to free up disk space.
20306
20307 @item show index-cache stats
20308 Print the number of cache hits and misses since the launch of @value{GDBN}.
20309
20310 @end table
20311
20312 @node Symbol Errors
20313 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
20314
20315 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
20316 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
20317 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
20318 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
20319 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
20320 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
20321 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
20322 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
20323 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
20324 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
20325 Messages}).
20326
20327 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
20328
20329 @table @code
20330 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
20331
20332 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
20333 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
20334 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
20335 in its outer scope blocks.
20336
20337 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
20338 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
20339 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
20340 function.
20341
20342 @item block at @var{address} out of order
20343
20344 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
20345 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
20346 do so.
20347
20348 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
20349 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
20350 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
20351 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
20352 Messages}.)
20353
20354 @item bad block start address patched
20355
20356 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
20357 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
20358 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
20359
20360 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
20361 starting on the previous source line.
20362
20363 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
20364
20365 @cindex foo
20366 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
20367 larger than the size of the string table.
20368
20369 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
20370 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
20371 with this name.
20372
20373 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
20374
20375 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
20376 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
20377 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
20378
20379 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
20380 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
20381 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
20382 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
20383 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
20384 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
20385
20386 @item stub type has NULL name
20387
20388 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
20389
20390 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
20391 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
20392 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
20393 it.
20394
20395 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
20396
20397 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
20398
20399 @end table
20400
20401 @node Data Files
20402 @section GDB Data Files
20403
20404 @cindex prefix for data files
20405 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
20406 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
20407
20408 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
20409 is currently using.
20410
20411 @table @code
20412 @kindex set data-directory
20413 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
20414 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
20415 to @var{directory}.
20416
20417 @kindex show data-directory
20418 @item show data-directory
20419 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
20420 @end table
20421
20422 @cindex default data directory
20423 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
20424 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
20425 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
20426 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
20427 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
20428 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
20429 location.
20430
20431 The data directory may also be specified with the
20432 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
20433 @xref{Mode Options}.
20434
20435 @node Targets
20436 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
20437
20438 @cindex debugging target
20439 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
20440
20441 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
20442 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
20443 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
20444 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
20445 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
20446 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
20447 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
20448 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
20449
20450 @cindex target architecture
20451 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
20452 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
20453 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
20454 command.
20455
20456 @table @code
20457 @kindex set architecture
20458 @kindex show architecture
20459 @item set architecture @var{arch}
20460 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
20461 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
20462 supported architectures.
20463
20464 @item show architecture
20465 Show the current target architecture.
20466
20467 @item set processor
20468 @itemx processor
20469 @kindex set processor
20470 @kindex show processor
20471 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
20472 and @code{show architecture}.
20473 @end table
20474
20475 @menu
20476 * Active Targets:: Active targets
20477 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
20478 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
20479 @end menu
20480
20481 @node Active Targets
20482 @section Active Targets
20483
20484 @cindex stacking targets
20485 @cindex active targets
20486 @cindex multiple targets
20487
20488 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
20489 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
20490 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
20491 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
20492 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
20493 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
20494 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
20495 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
20496 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
20497
20498 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
20499 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
20500 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
20501 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
20502
20503 @node Target Commands
20504 @section Commands for Managing Targets
20505
20506 @table @code
20507 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
20508 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
20509 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
20510 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
20511 protocol of the target machine.
20512
20513 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
20514 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
20515 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
20516
20517 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
20518 after executing the command.
20519
20520 @kindex help target
20521 @item help target
20522 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
20523 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
20524 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
20525
20526 @item help target @var{name}
20527 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
20528 select it.
20529
20530 @kindex set gnutarget
20531 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
20532 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
20533 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
20534 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
20535 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
20536 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
20537
20538 @quotation
20539 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
20540 you must know the actual BFD name.
20541 @end quotation
20542
20543 @noindent
20544 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
20545
20546 @kindex show gnutarget
20547 @item show gnutarget
20548 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
20549 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
20550 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
20551 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
20552 @end table
20553
20554 @cindex common targets
20555 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
20556 configuration):
20557
20558 @table @code
20559 @kindex target
20560 @item target exec @var{program}
20561 @cindex executable file target
20562 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
20563 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
20564
20565 @item target core @var{filename}
20566 @cindex core dump file target
20567 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
20568 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
20569
20570 @item target remote @var{medium}
20571 @cindex remote target
20572 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
20573 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
20574 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
20575
20576 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
20577 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
20578
20579 @smallexample
20580 target remote /dev/ttya
20581 @end smallexample
20582
20583 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
20584 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
20585 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
20586 clobbered by the download.
20587
20588 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
20589 @cindex built-in simulator target
20590 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
20591 In general,
20592 @smallexample
20593 target sim
20594 load
20595 run
20596 @end smallexample
20597 @noindent
20598 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
20599 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
20600 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
20601 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
20602 Processors}.
20603
20604 @item target native
20605 @cindex native target
20606 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
20607 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
20608 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
20609 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
20610
20611 @end table
20612
20613 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
20614 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
20615
20616 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
20617 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
20618 various aspects of this process.
20619
20620 @table @code
20621
20622 @item set hash
20623 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
20624 @cindex hash mark while downloading
20625 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
20626 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
20627 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
20628 monitor.
20629
20630 @item show hash
20631 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
20632 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
20633
20634 @item set debug monitor
20635 @kindex set debug monitor
20636 @cindex display remote monitor communications
20637 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
20638 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
20639
20640 @item show debug monitor
20641 @kindex show debug monitor
20642 Show the current status of displaying communications between
20643 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
20644 @end table
20645
20646 @table @code
20647
20648 @kindex load @var{filename} @var{offset}
20649 @item load @var{filename} @var{offset}
20650 @anchor{load}
20651 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
20652 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
20653 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
20654 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
20655 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
20656 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
20657
20658 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
20659 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
20660 target is @dots{}}''
20661
20662 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
20663 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
20664 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
20665 specifies a fixed address.
20666 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
20667
20668 It is also possible to tell @value{GDBN} to load the executable file at a
20669 specific offset described by the optional argument @var{offset}. When
20670 @var{offset} is provided, @var{filename} must also be provided.
20671
20672 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
20673 load programs into flash memory.
20674
20675 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
20676 @end table
20677
20678 @table @code
20679
20680 @kindex flash-erase
20681 @item flash-erase
20682 @anchor{flash-erase}
20683
20684 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
20685
20686 @end table
20687
20688 @node Byte Order
20689 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
20690
20691 @cindex choosing target byte order
20692 @cindex target byte order
20693
20694 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
20695 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
20696 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
20697 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
20698 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
20699 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
20700
20701 @table @code
20702 @kindex set endian
20703 @item set endian big
20704 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
20705
20706 @item set endian little
20707 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
20708
20709 @item set endian auto
20710 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
20711 executable.
20712
20713 @item show endian
20714 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
20715
20716 @end table
20717
20718 If the @code{set endian auto} mode is in effect and no executable has
20719 been selected, then the endianness used is the last one chosen either
20720 by one of the @code{set endian big} and @code{set endian little}
20721 commands or by inferring from the last executable used. If no
20722 endianness has been previously chosen, then the default for this mode
20723 is inferred from the target @value{GDBN} has been built for, and is
20724 @code{little} if the name of the target CPU has an @code{el} suffix
20725 and @code{big} otherwise.
20726
20727 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
20728 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
20729 target system.
20730
20731
20732 @node Remote Debugging
20733 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
20734 @cindex remote debugging
20735
20736 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
20737 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
20738 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
20739 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
20740 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
20741
20742 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
20743 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
20744 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
20745 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
20746 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
20747 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
20748
20749 Other remote targets may be available in your
20750 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
20751
20752 @menu
20753 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
20754 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
20755 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
20756 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
20757 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
20758 @end menu
20759
20760 @node Connecting
20761 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
20762 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
20763 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
20764 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
20765 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
20766 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
20767 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
20768
20769 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
20770 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
20771 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
20772 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
20773
20774 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
20775
20776 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
20777 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
20778 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
20779 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
20780
20781 @table @asis
20782
20783 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
20784 @item Result of detach or program exit
20785 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
20786 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
20787 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
20788
20789 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
20790 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
20791 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
20792 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
20793
20794 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
20795 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
20796 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
20797 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
20798
20799 @item Specifying the program to debug
20800 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
20801 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
20802 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
20803 target.
20804
20805 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
20806 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
20807 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
20808
20809 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
20810 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
20811 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
20812 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
20813
20814 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
20815 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
20816 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
20817 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
20818 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
20819 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
20820 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
20821 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
20822 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
20823
20824 @item The @code{run} command
20825 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
20826 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
20827 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
20828 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
20829 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
20830
20831 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
20832 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
20833 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
20834 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
20835 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
20836
20837 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
20838 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
20839 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
20840 @code{target remote} mode.
20841
20842 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
20843 @item Attaching
20844 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
20845 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
20846 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20847
20848 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
20849 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
20850 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
20851 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
20852 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20853
20854 @end table
20855
20856 @anchor{Host and target files}
20857 @subsection Host and Target Files
20858 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
20859 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
20860
20861 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
20862 information for your program running on the target. This requires
20863 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
20864 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
20865 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
20866
20867 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
20868 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
20869 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
20870 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
20871 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
20872
20873 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
20874 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
20875 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
20876 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
20877 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
20878 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
20879 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
20880 target libraries.
20881
20882 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
20883 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
20884 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
20885 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
20886 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
20887 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
20888 programs.
20889
20890 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
20891 @cindex remote connection commands
20892 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, a
20893 local Unix domain socket, or
20894 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
20895 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
20896 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
20897 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
20898 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
20899 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
20900
20901 @table @code
20902
20903 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
20904 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
20905 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
20906 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
20907 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
20908
20909 @smallexample
20910 target remote /dev/ttyb
20911 @end smallexample
20912
20913 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
20914 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
20915 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
20916 @code{target} command.
20917
20918 @item target remote @var{local-socket}
20919 @itemx target extended-remote @var{local-socket}
20920 @cindex local socket, @code{target remote}
20921 @cindex Unix domain socket
20922 Use @var{local-socket} to communicate with the target. For example,
20923 to use a local Unix domain socket bound to the file system entry @file{/tmp/gdb-socket0}:
20924
20925 @smallexample
20926 target remote /tmp/gdb-socket0
20927 @end smallexample
20928
20929 Note that this command has the same form as the command to connect
20930 to a serial line. @value{GDBN} will automatically determine which
20931 kind of file you have specified and will make the appropriate kind
20932 of connection.
20933 This feature is not available if the host system does not support
20934 Unix domain sockets.
20935
20936 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20937 @itemx target remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20938 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20939 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20940 @itemx target remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20941 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20942 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20943 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20944 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20945 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20946 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20947 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20948 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20949 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20950 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
20951 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
20952 The @var{host} may be either a host name, a numeric @acronym{IPv4}
20953 address, or a numeric @acronym{IPv6} address (with or without the
20954 square brackets to separate the address from the port); @var{port}
20955 must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be the target machine
20956 itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or it might be a
20957 terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the target.
20958
20959 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
20960 @code{manyfarms}:
20961
20962 @smallexample
20963 target remote manyfarms:2828
20964 @end smallexample
20965
20966 To connect to port 2828 on a terminal server whose address is
20967 @code{2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334}, you can either use the
20968 square bracket syntax:
20969
20970 @smallexample
20971 target remote [2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334]:2828
20972 @end smallexample
20973
20974 @noindent
20975 or explicitly specify the @acronym{IPv6} protocol:
20976
20977 @smallexample
20978 target remote tcp6:2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334:2828
20979 @end smallexample
20980
20981 This last example may be confusing to the reader, because there is no
20982 visible separation between the hostname and the port number.
20983 Therefore, we recommend the user to provide @acronym{IPv6} addresses
20984 using square brackets for clarity. However, it is important to
20985 mention that for @value{GDBN} there is no ambiguity: the number after
20986 the last colon is considered to be the port number.
20987
20988 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
20989 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
20990 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
20991 port 1234 on your local machine:
20992
20993 @smallexample
20994 target remote :1234
20995 @end smallexample
20996 @noindent
20997
20998 Note that the colon is still required here.
20999
21000 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21001 @itemx target remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21002 @itemx target remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21003 @itemx target remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21004 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21005 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21006 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21007 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21008 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21009 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21010 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
21011 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
21012 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
21013
21014 @smallexample
21015 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
21016 @end smallexample
21017
21018 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
21019 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
21020 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
21021 cause havoc with your debugging session.
21022
21023 @item target remote | @var{command}
21024 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
21025 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
21026 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
21027 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
21028 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
21029 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
21030 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
21031 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
21032 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
21033
21034 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
21035 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
21036 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
21037
21038 @end table
21039
21040 @cindex interrupting remote programs
21041 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
21042 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
21043 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
21044 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
21045 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
21046 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
21047
21048 @smallexample
21049 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
21050 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
21051 @end smallexample
21052
21053 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
21054 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
21055 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
21056 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
21057
21058 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
21059 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
21060
21061 @table @code
21062 @kindex detach (remote)
21063 @item detach
21064 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
21065 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
21066 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
21067 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
21068 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
21069 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
21070 still connected to the target.
21071
21072 @kindex disconnect
21073 @item disconnect
21074 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
21075 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
21076 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
21077 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
21078 another target.
21079
21080 @cindex send command to remote monitor
21081 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
21082 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
21083 @kindex monitor
21084 @item monitor @var{cmd}
21085 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
21086 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
21087 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
21088 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
21089 and implement.
21090 @end table
21091
21092 @node File Transfer
21093 @section Sending files to a remote system
21094 @cindex remote target, file transfer
21095 @cindex file transfer
21096 @cindex sending files to remote systems
21097
21098 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
21099 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
21100 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
21101 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
21102 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
21103 the only way to upload or download files.
21104
21105 Not all remote targets support these commands.
21106
21107 @table @code
21108 @kindex remote put
21109 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
21110 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
21111 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
21112
21113 @kindex remote get
21114 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
21115 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
21116 on the host system.
21117
21118 @kindex remote delete
21119 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
21120 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
21121
21122 @end table
21123
21124 @node Server
21125 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
21126
21127 @kindex gdbserver
21128 @cindex remote connection without stubs
21129 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
21130 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
21131 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
21132 linking in the usual debugging stub.
21133
21134 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
21135 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
21136 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
21137 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
21138 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
21139 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
21140 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
21141 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
21142 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
21143 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
21144 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
21145 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
21146 choice for debugging.
21147
21148 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
21149 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
21150 protocol.
21151
21152 @quotation
21153 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
21154 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
21155 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
21156 target system with the same privileges as the user running
21157 @code{gdbserver}.
21158 @end quotation
21159
21160 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
21161 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
21162 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
21163 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
21164
21165 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
21166 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
21167 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
21168 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
21169 system does all the symbol handling.
21170
21171 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
21172 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
21173 syntax is:
21174
21175 @smallexample
21176 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
21177 @end smallexample
21178
21179 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
21180 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
21181 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
21182 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
21183 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
21184 @file{/dev/com1}:
21185
21186 @smallexample
21187 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
21188 @end smallexample
21189
21190 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
21191 with it.
21192
21193 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
21194
21195 @smallexample
21196 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
21197 @end smallexample
21198
21199 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
21200 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
21201 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
21202 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
21203 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
21204 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
21205 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
21206 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
21207 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
21208 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
21209 @code{target remote} command.
21210
21211 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
21212 with ssh:
21213
21214 @smallexample
21215 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
21216 @end smallexample
21217
21218 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
21219 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
21220 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
21221 You could elide it if you want to.
21222
21223 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
21224 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
21225 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
21226 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
21227
21228 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
21229 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
21230 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
21231 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
21232
21233 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
21234 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
21235
21236 @smallexample
21237 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
21238 @end smallexample
21239
21240 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
21241 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
21242
21243 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
21244 @value{GDBN} attach command
21245 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
21246
21247 @pindex pidof
21248 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
21249 @code{pidof} utility:
21250
21251 @smallexample
21252 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
21253 @end smallexample
21254
21255 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
21256 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
21257 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
21258
21259 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
21260
21261 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
21262 port.
21263
21264 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
21265 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
21266 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
21267 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
21268 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
21269 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
21270 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
21271 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
21272
21273 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
21274 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
21275 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
21276
21277 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
21278 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
21279 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
21280 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
21281 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
21282 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
21283 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
21284 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
21285 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
21286 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
21287 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
21288 instance closes its port after the first connection.
21289
21290 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
21291 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
21292
21293 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
21294 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
21295 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
21296 program. For more information,
21297 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
21298
21299 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
21300 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
21301 status information about the debugging process.
21302 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
21303 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
21304 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
21305 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
21306
21307 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
21308 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
21309 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
21310 Possible options are:
21311
21312 @table @code
21313 @item none
21314 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
21315 @item all
21316 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
21317 @item timestamps
21318 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
21319 @end table
21320
21321 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
21322 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
21323
21324 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
21325 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
21326 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
21327 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
21328 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
21329
21330 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
21331 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
21332 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
21333 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
21334
21335 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
21336 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
21337 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
21338 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
21339
21340 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
21341 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
21342 environment:
21343
21344 @smallexample
21345 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
21346 @end smallexample
21347
21348 @cindex @option{--selftest}
21349 The @option{--selftest} option runs the self tests in @code{gdbserver}:
21350
21351 @smallexample
21352 $ gdbserver --selftest
21353 Ran 2 unit tests, 0 failed
21354 @end smallexample
21355
21356 These tests are disabled in release.
21357 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
21358
21359 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
21360 @itemize
21361
21362 @item
21363 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
21364
21365 @item
21366 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
21367 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
21368 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
21369 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
21370 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
21371 @code{--with-sysroot}).
21372
21373 @item
21374 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
21375 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
21376 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
21377 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
21378 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
21379 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
21380 program is already on the target.
21381
21382 @end itemize
21383
21384 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
21385 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
21386 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
21387
21388 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
21389 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
21390 Here are the available commands.
21391
21392 @table @code
21393 @item monitor help
21394 List the available monitor commands.
21395
21396 @item monitor set debug 0
21397 @itemx monitor set debug 1
21398 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
21399
21400 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
21401 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
21402 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
21403 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
21404
21405 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
21406 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
21407 Possible options are:
21408
21409 @table @code
21410 @item none
21411 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
21412 @item all
21413 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
21414 @item timestamps
21415 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
21416 @end table
21417
21418 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
21419 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
21420
21421 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
21422 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
21423 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
21424 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
21425 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
21426 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
21427
21428 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
21429 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
21430
21431 @item monitor exit
21432 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
21433 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
21434 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
21435 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
21436 of a multi-process mode debug session.
21437
21438 @end table
21439
21440 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
21441 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
21442
21443 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
21444 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
21445
21446 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
21447 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
21448 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
21449 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
21450 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
21451 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
21452 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
21453 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
21454 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
21455 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
21456 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
21457 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
21458
21459 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
21460
21461 @table @code
21462 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
21463
21464 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
21465 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
21466 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
21467
21468 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
21469
21470 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
21471 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
21472 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
21473 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
21474 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
21475 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
21476
21477 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
21478
21479 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
21480 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
21481 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
21482 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
21483 command for that. For example:
21484
21485 @smallexample
21486 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
21487 @end smallexample
21488
21489 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
21490 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
21491 @end table
21492
21493 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
21494 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
21495 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
21496 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
21497 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
21498 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
21499 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
21500 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
21501 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
21502 @code{gdbserver} like so:
21503
21504 @smallexample
21505 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
21506 @end smallexample
21507
21508 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
21509
21510 @smallexample
21511 $ gdb myprogram
21512 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
21513 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
21514 (@value{GDBP}) b main
21515 (@value{GDBP}) continue
21516 @end smallexample
21517
21518 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
21519 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
21520 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
21521 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
21522 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
21523 tracing.
21524
21525 @node Remote Configuration
21526 @section Remote Configuration
21527
21528 @kindex set remote
21529 @kindex show remote
21530 This section documents the configuration options available when
21531 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
21532 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
21533 system-call-allowed}.
21534
21535 @table @code
21536 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
21537 @cindex address size for remote targets
21538 @cindex bits in remote address
21539 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
21540 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
21541 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
21542 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
21543
21544 @item show remoteaddresssize
21545 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
21546
21547 @item set serial baud @var{n}
21548 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
21549 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
21550 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
21551 remote targets.
21552
21553 @item show serial baud
21554 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
21555
21556 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
21557 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
21558 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
21559
21560 @item show serial parity
21561 Show the current parity of the serial port.
21562
21563 @item set remotebreak
21564 @cindex interrupt remote programs
21565 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
21566 @anchor{set remotebreak}
21567 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
21568 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
21569 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
21570 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
21571 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
21572
21573 @item show remotebreak
21574 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
21575 interrupt the remote program.
21576
21577 @item set remoteflow on
21578 @itemx set remoteflow off
21579 @kindex set remoteflow
21580 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
21581 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
21582
21583 @item show remoteflow
21584 @kindex show remoteflow
21585 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
21586
21587 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
21588 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
21589 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
21590 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
21591 @code{ascii}.
21592
21593 @item show remotelogbase
21594 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
21595 protocol.
21596
21597 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
21598 @cindex record serial communications on file
21599 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
21600 default is not to record at all.
21601
21602 @item show remotelogfile.
21603 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
21604 serial communications.
21605
21606 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
21607 @cindex timeout for serial communications
21608 @cindex remote timeout
21609 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
21610 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
21611
21612 @item show remotetimeout
21613 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
21614 responses.
21615
21616 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
21617 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
21618 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
21619 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
21620 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
21621 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
21622 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware watchpoints
21623 or breakpoints. The @var{limit} can be set to 0 to disable hardware
21624 watchpoints or breakpoints, and @code{unlimited} for unlimited
21625 watchpoints or breakpoints.
21626
21627 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-limit
21628 @itemx show remote hardware-breakpoint-limit
21629 Show the current limit for the number of hardware watchpoints or
21630 breakpoints that @value{GDBN} can use.
21631
21632 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
21633 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
21634 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
21635 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
21636 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum
21637 length of a remote hardware watchpoint. A @var{limit} of 0 disables
21638 hardware watchpoints and @code{unlimited} allows watchpoints of any
21639 length.
21640
21641 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
21642 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
21643 a remote hardware watchpoint.
21644
21645 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
21646 @itemx show remote exec-file
21647 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
21648 @cindex executable file, for remote target
21649 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
21650 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
21651 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
21652 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
21653
21654 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
21655 @cindex interrupt remote programs
21656 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
21657 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
21658 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
21659 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
21660 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
21661 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
21662 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
21663 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
21664
21665 @item show interrupt-sequence
21666 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
21667 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
21668 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
21669 also known as Magic SysRq g.
21670
21671 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
21672 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
21673 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
21674 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
21675 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
21676 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
21677
21678 @item show interrupt-on-connect
21679 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
21680 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
21681
21682 @kindex set tcp
21683 @kindex show tcp
21684 @item set tcp auto-retry on
21685 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
21686 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
21687 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
21688 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
21689 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
21690 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
21691 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
21692 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
21693
21694 @item set tcp auto-retry off
21695 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
21696
21697 @item show tcp auto-retry
21698 Show the current auto-retry setting.
21699
21700 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
21701 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
21702 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
21703 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
21704 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
21705 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
21706 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
21707 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
21708 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
21709 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
21710 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
21711
21712 @item show tcp connect-timeout
21713 Show the current connection timeout setting.
21714 @end table
21715
21716 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
21717 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
21718 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
21719 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
21720 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
21721 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
21722 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
21723 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
21724 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
21725
21726 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
21727 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
21728 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
21729 @value{GDBN} developers.
21730
21731 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
21732 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
21733 are:
21734
21735 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
21736 @item Command Name
21737 @tab Remote Packet
21738 @tab Related Features
21739
21740 @item @code{fetch-register}
21741 @tab @code{p}
21742 @tab @code{info registers}
21743
21744 @item @code{set-register}
21745 @tab @code{P}
21746 @tab @code{set}
21747
21748 @item @code{binary-download}
21749 @tab @code{X}
21750 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
21751
21752 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
21753 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
21754 @tab @code{info auxv}
21755
21756 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
21757 @tab @code{qSymbol}
21758 @tab Detecting multiple threads
21759
21760 @item @code{attach}
21761 @tab @code{vAttach}
21762 @tab @code{attach}
21763
21764 @item @code{verbose-resume}
21765 @tab @code{vCont}
21766 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
21767
21768 @item @code{run}
21769 @tab @code{vRun}
21770 @tab @code{run}
21771
21772 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
21773 @tab @code{Z0}
21774 @tab @code{break}
21775
21776 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
21777 @tab @code{Z1}
21778 @tab @code{hbreak}
21779
21780 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
21781 @tab @code{Z2}
21782 @tab @code{watch}
21783
21784 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
21785 @tab @code{Z3}
21786 @tab @code{rwatch}
21787
21788 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
21789 @tab @code{Z4}
21790 @tab @code{awatch}
21791
21792 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
21793 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
21794 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
21795
21796 @item @code{target-features}
21797 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
21798 @tab @code{set architecture}
21799
21800 @item @code{library-info}
21801 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
21802 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
21803
21804 @item @code{memory-map}
21805 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
21806 @tab @code{info mem}
21807
21808 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
21809 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
21810 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
21811
21812 @item @code{read-spu-object}
21813 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
21814 @tab @code{info spu}
21815
21816 @item @code{write-spu-object}
21817 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
21818 @tab @code{info spu}
21819
21820 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
21821 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
21822 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
21823
21824 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
21825 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
21826 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
21827
21828 @item @code{threads}
21829 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
21830 @tab @code{info threads}
21831
21832 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
21833 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
21834 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
21835
21836 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
21837 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
21838 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
21839
21840 @item @code{search-memory}
21841 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
21842 @tab @code{find}
21843
21844 @item @code{supported-packets}
21845 @tab @code{qSupported}
21846 @tab Remote communications parameters
21847
21848 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
21849 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
21850 @tab @code{catch syscall}
21851
21852 @item @code{pass-signals}
21853 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
21854 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21855
21856 @item @code{program-signals}
21857 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
21858 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21859
21860 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
21861 @tab @code{vFile:close}
21862 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21863
21864 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
21865 @tab @code{vFile:open}
21866 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21867
21868 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
21869 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
21870 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21871
21872 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
21873 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
21874 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21875
21876 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
21877 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
21878 @tab @code{remote delete}
21879
21880 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
21881 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
21882 @tab Host I/O
21883
21884 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
21885 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
21886 @tab Host I/O
21887
21888 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
21889 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
21890 @tab Host I/O
21891
21892 @item @code{noack-packet}
21893 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
21894 @tab Packet acknowledgment
21895
21896 @item @code{osdata}
21897 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
21898 @tab @code{info os}
21899
21900 @item @code{query-attached}
21901 @tab @code{qAttached}
21902 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
21903
21904 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
21905 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
21906 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
21907
21908 @item @code{trace-status}
21909 @tab @code{qTStatus}
21910 @tab @code{tstatus}
21911
21912 @item @code{traceframe-info}
21913 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
21914 @tab Traceframe info
21915
21916 @item @code{install-in-trace}
21917 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
21918 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
21919
21920 @item @code{disable-randomization}
21921 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
21922 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
21923
21924 @item @code{startup-with-shell}
21925 @tab @code{QStartupWithShell}
21926 @tab @code{set startup-with-shell}
21927
21928 @item @code{environment-hex-encoded}
21929 @tab @code{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
21930 @tab @code{set environment}
21931
21932 @item @code{environment-unset}
21933 @tab @code{QEnvironmentUnset}
21934 @tab @code{unset environment}
21935
21936 @item @code{environment-reset}
21937 @tab @code{QEnvironmentReset}
21938 @tab @code{Reset the inferior environment (i.e., unset user-set variables)}
21939
21940 @item @code{set-working-dir}
21941 @tab @code{QSetWorkingDir}
21942 @tab @code{set cwd}
21943
21944 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
21945 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
21946 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
21947
21948 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
21949 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
21950 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
21951
21952 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
21953 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
21954 @tab @code{break}
21955
21956 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
21957 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
21958 @tab @code{hbreak}
21959
21960 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
21961 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
21962 @tab @code{fork}
21963
21964 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
21965 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
21966 @tab @code{vfork}
21967
21968 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
21969 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
21970 @tab @code{exec}
21971
21972 @item @code{thread-events}
21973 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
21974 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21975
21976 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
21977 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
21978 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21979
21980 @end multitable
21981
21982 @node Remote Stub
21983 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
21984
21985 @cindex debugging stub, example
21986 @cindex remote stub, example
21987 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
21988 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
21989 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
21990 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
21991 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
21992 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
21993 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
21994 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
21995
21996 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
21997 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
21998 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
21999 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
22000 program, you need:
22001
22002 @enumerate
22003 @item
22004 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
22005 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
22006 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
22007
22008 @item
22009 A C subroutine library to support your program's
22010 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
22011
22012 @item
22013 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
22014 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
22015 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
22016 documentation.
22017 @end enumerate
22018
22019 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
22020 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
22021 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
22022
22023 @table @emph
22024 @item On the host,
22025 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
22026 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
22027 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
22028
22029 @item On the target,
22030 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
22031 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
22032 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
22033
22034 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
22035 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
22036 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
22037 @end table
22038
22039 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
22040 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
22041 @sc{sparc} boards.
22042
22043 @cindex remote serial stub list
22044 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
22045
22046 @table @code
22047
22048 @item i386-stub.c
22049 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
22050 @cindex Intel
22051 @cindex i386
22052 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
22053
22054 @item m68k-stub.c
22055 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
22056 @cindex Motorola 680x0
22057 @cindex m680x0
22058 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
22059
22060 @item sh-stub.c
22061 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
22062 @cindex Renesas
22063 @cindex SH
22064 For Renesas SH architectures.
22065
22066 @item sparc-stub.c
22067 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
22068 @cindex Sparc
22069 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
22070
22071 @item sparcl-stub.c
22072 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
22073 @cindex Fujitsu
22074 @cindex SparcLite
22075 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
22076
22077 @end table
22078
22079 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
22080 recently added stubs.
22081
22082 @menu
22083 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
22084 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
22085 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
22086 @end menu
22087
22088 @node Stub Contents
22089 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
22090
22091 @cindex remote serial stub
22092 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
22093 subroutines:
22094
22095 @table @code
22096 @item set_debug_traps
22097 @findex set_debug_traps
22098 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
22099 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
22100 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
22101 program's startup code.
22102
22103 @item handle_exception
22104 @findex handle_exception
22105 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
22106 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
22107 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
22108 run when a trap is triggered.
22109
22110 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
22111 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
22112 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
22113 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
22114 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
22115 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
22116 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
22117 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
22118 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
22119 machine.
22120
22121 @item breakpoint
22122 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
22123 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
22124 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
22125 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
22126 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
22127 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
22128 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
22129 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
22130 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
22131 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
22132 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
22133
22134 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
22135 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
22136 start of your debugging session.
22137 @end table
22138
22139 @node Bootstrapping
22140 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
22141
22142 @cindex remote stub, support routines
22143 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
22144 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
22145 debugging target machine.
22146
22147 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
22148 serial port.
22149
22150 @table @code
22151 @item int getDebugChar()
22152 @findex getDebugChar
22153 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
22154 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
22155 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
22156
22157 @item void putDebugChar(int)
22158 @findex putDebugChar
22159 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
22160 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
22161 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
22162 @end table
22163
22164 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
22165 @cindex interrupting remote targets
22166 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
22167 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
22168 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
22169 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
22170 remote system to stop.
22171
22172 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
22173 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
22174 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
22175 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
22176
22177 Other routines you need to supply are:
22178
22179 @table @code
22180 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
22181 @findex exceptionHandler
22182 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
22183 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
22184 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
22185 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
22186 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
22187 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
22188 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
22189 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
22190 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
22191 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
22192 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
22193 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
22194 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
22195
22196 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
22197 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
22198 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
22199 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
22200 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
22201
22202 @item void flush_i_cache()
22203 @findex flush_i_cache
22204 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
22205 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
22206 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
22207
22208 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
22209 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
22210 @end table
22211
22212 @noindent
22213 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
22214
22215 @table @code
22216 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
22217 @findex memset
22218 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
22219 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
22220 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
22221 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
22222 @end table
22223
22224 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
22225 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
22226 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
22227 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
22228
22229
22230 @node Debug Session
22231 @subsection Putting it All Together
22232
22233 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
22234 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
22235 steps.
22236
22237 @enumerate
22238 @item
22239 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
22240 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
22241 @display
22242 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
22243 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
22244 @end display
22245
22246 @item
22247 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
22248 procedure is called:
22249
22250 @smallexample
22251 set_debug_traps();
22252 breakpoint();
22253 @end smallexample
22254
22255 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
22256 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
22257 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
22258 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
22259 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
22260 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
22261 progress.
22262
22263 @item
22264 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
22265 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
22266
22267 @smallexample
22268 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
22269 @end smallexample
22270
22271 @noindent
22272 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
22273 function in your program, that function is called when
22274 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
22275 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
22276 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
22277
22278 @item
22279 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
22280 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
22281
22282 @item
22283 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
22284 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
22285
22286 @item
22287 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
22288 @c document that. FIXME.
22289 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
22290 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
22291
22292 @item
22293 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
22294 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
22295
22296 @end enumerate
22297
22298 @node Configurations
22299 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
22300
22301 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
22302 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
22303 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
22304
22305 There are three major categories of configurations: native
22306 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
22307 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
22308 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
22309 are quite different from each other.
22310
22311 @menu
22312 * Native::
22313 * Embedded OS::
22314 * Embedded Processors::
22315 * Architectures::
22316 @end menu
22317
22318 @node Native
22319 @section Native
22320
22321 This section describes details specific to particular native
22322 configurations.
22323
22324 @menu
22325 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
22326 * Process Information:: Process information
22327 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
22328 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
22329 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
22330 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
22331 @end menu
22332
22333 @node BSD libkvm Interface
22334 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
22335
22336 @cindex libkvm
22337 @cindex kernel memory image
22338 @cindex kernel crash dump
22339
22340 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
22341 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
22342 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
22343 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
22344 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
22345 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
22346 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
22347 @code{kvm} target:
22348
22349 @smallexample
22350 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
22351 @end smallexample
22352
22353 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
22354 argument:
22355
22356 @smallexample
22357 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
22358 @end smallexample
22359
22360 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
22361 available:
22362
22363 @table @code
22364 @kindex kvm
22365 @item kvm pcb
22366 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
22367
22368 @item kvm proc
22369 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
22370 modern FreeBSD systems.
22371 @end table
22372
22373 @node Process Information
22374 @subsection Process Information
22375 @cindex /proc
22376 @cindex examine process image
22377 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
22378
22379 Some operating systems provide interfaces to fetch additional
22380 information about running processes beyond memory and per-thread
22381 register state. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system
22382 with a supported interface, the command @code{info proc} is available
22383 to report information about the process running your program, or about
22384 any process running on your system.
22385
22386 One supported interface is a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
22387 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
22388 subroutines. This facility is supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris
22389 systems.
22390
22391 On FreeBSD systems, system control nodes are used to query process
22392 information.
22393
22394 In addition, some systems may provide additional process information
22395 in core files. Note that a core file may include a subset of the
22396 information available from a live process. Process information is
22397 currently avaiable from cores created on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD
22398 systems.
22399
22400 @table @code
22401 @kindex info proc
22402 @cindex process ID
22403 @item info proc
22404 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
22405 Summarize available information about a process. If a
22406 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
22407 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
22408 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
22409 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
22410 executable file's absolute file name.
22411
22412 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
22413 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
22414 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
22415 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
22416 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
22417 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
22418
22419 @item info proc cmdline
22420 @cindex info proc cmdline
22421 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
22422 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22423
22424 @item info proc cwd
22425 @cindex info proc cwd
22426 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
22427 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22428
22429 @item info proc exe
22430 @cindex info proc exe
22431 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is supported
22432 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22433
22434 @item info proc files
22435 @cindex info proc files
22436 Show the file descriptors open by the process. For each open file
22437 descriptor, @value{GDBN} shows its number, type (file, directory,
22438 character device, socket), file pointer offset, and the name of the
22439 resource open on the descriptor. The resource name can be a file name
22440 (for files, directories, and devices) or a protocol followed by socket
22441 address (for network connections). This command is supported on
22442 FreeBSD.
22443
22444 This example shows the open file descriptors for a process using a
22445 tty for standard input and output as well as two network sockets:
22446
22447 @smallexample
22448 (gdb) info proc files 22136
22449 process 22136
22450 Open files:
22451
22452 FD Type Offset Flags Name
22453 text file - r-------- /usr/bin/ssh
22454 ctty chr - rw------- /dev/pts/20
22455 cwd dir - r-------- /usr/home/john
22456 root dir - r-------- /
22457 0 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
22458 1 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
22459 2 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
22460 3 socket 0x0 rw----n-- tcp4 10.0.1.2:53014 -> 10.0.1.10:22
22461 4 socket 0x0 rw------- unix stream:/tmp/ssh-FIt89oAzOn5f/agent.2456
22462 @end smallexample
22463
22464 @item info proc mappings
22465 @cindex memory address space mappings
22466 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in a process. On
22467 Solaris and FreeBSD systems, each memory range includes information on
22468 whether the process has read, write, or execute access rights to each
22469 range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD systems, each memory range
22470 includes the object file which is mapped to that range.
22471
22472 @item info proc stat
22473 @itemx info proc status
22474 @cindex process detailed status information
22475 Show additional process-related information, including the user ID and
22476 group ID; virtual memory usage; the signals that are pending, blocked,
22477 and ignored; its TTY; its consumption of system and user time; its
22478 stack size; its @samp{nice} value; etc. These commands are supported
22479 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22480
22481 For @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, see the @samp{proc} man page for more
22482 information (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
22483
22484 For FreeBSD systems, @code{info proc stat} is an alias for @code{info
22485 proc status}.
22486
22487 @item info proc all
22488 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
22489 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
22490
22491 @ignore
22492 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
22493 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
22494 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
22495 @kindex info proc times
22496 @item info proc times
22497 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
22498 its children.
22499
22500 @kindex info proc id
22501 @item info proc id
22502 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
22503 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
22504 @end ignore
22505
22506 @item set procfs-trace
22507 @kindex set procfs-trace
22508 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
22509 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
22510
22511 @item show procfs-trace
22512 @kindex show procfs-trace
22513 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
22514
22515 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
22516 @kindex set procfs-file
22517 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
22518 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
22519 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
22520 standard output.
22521
22522 @item show procfs-file
22523 @kindex show procfs-file
22524 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
22525
22526 @item proc-trace-entry
22527 @itemx proc-trace-exit
22528 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
22529 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
22530 @kindex proc-trace-entry
22531 @kindex proc-trace-exit
22532 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
22533 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
22534 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
22535 from the @code{syscall} interface.
22536
22537 @item info pidlist
22538 @kindex info pidlist
22539 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
22540 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
22541 processes and all the threads within each process.
22542
22543 @item info meminfo
22544 @kindex info meminfo
22545 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
22546 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
22547 @end table
22548
22549 @node DJGPP Native
22550 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
22551 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
22552 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
22553 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
22554
22555 @cindex DPMI
22556 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
22557 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
22558 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
22559 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
22560
22561 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
22562 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
22563 subsection describes those commands.
22564
22565 @table @code
22566 @kindex info dos
22567 @item info dos
22568 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
22569 information about the target system and important OS structures.
22570
22571 @kindex sysinfo
22572 @cindex MS-DOS system info
22573 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
22574 @item info dos sysinfo
22575 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
22576 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
22577 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
22578
22579 @cindex GDT
22580 @cindex LDT
22581 @cindex IDT
22582 @cindex segment descriptor tables
22583 @cindex descriptor tables display
22584 @item info dos gdt
22585 @itemx info dos ldt
22586 @itemx info dos idt
22587 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
22588 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
22589 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
22590 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
22591 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
22592 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
22593 rights.
22594
22595 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
22596 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
22597 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
22598 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
22599 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
22600
22601 @cindex garbled pointers
22602 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
22603 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
22604 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
22605 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
22606 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
22607 debugged program's data segment:
22608
22609 @smallexample
22610 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
22611 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
22612 @end smallexample
22613
22614 @noindent
22615 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
22616 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
22617
22618 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
22619 @item info dos pde
22620 @itemx info dos pte
22621 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
22622 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
22623 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
22624 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
22625 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
22626 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
22627 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
22628 that is currently in use.
22629
22630 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
22631 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
22632 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
22633 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
22634 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
22635 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
22636 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
22637
22638 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
22639 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
22640 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
22641 controller.
22642
22643 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
22644
22645 @cindex physical address from linear address
22646 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
22647 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
22648 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
22649 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
22650 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
22651 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
22652 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
22653
22654 @smallexample
22655 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
22656 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
22657 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
22658 @end smallexample
22659
22660 @noindent
22661 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
22662 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
22663 attributes of that page.
22664
22665 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
22666 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
22667 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
22668 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
22669 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
22670 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
22671
22672 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
22673 transfer buffer:
22674
22675 @smallexample
22676 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
22677 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
22678 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
22679 @end smallexample
22680
22681 @noindent
22682 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
22683 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
22684 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
22685 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
22686 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
22687
22688 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
22689 @end table
22690
22691 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
22692 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
22693 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
22694 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
22695
22696 @table @code
22697 @kindex set com1base
22698 @kindex set com1irq
22699 @kindex set com2base
22700 @kindex set com2irq
22701 @kindex set com3base
22702 @kindex set com3irq
22703 @kindex set com4base
22704 @kindex set com4irq
22705 @item set com1base @var{addr}
22706 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
22707 port.
22708
22709 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
22710 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
22711 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
22712
22713 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
22714 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
22715 other 3 COM ports.
22716
22717 @kindex show com1base
22718 @kindex show com1irq
22719 @kindex show com2base
22720 @kindex show com2irq
22721 @kindex show com3base
22722 @kindex show com3irq
22723 @kindex show com4base
22724 @kindex show com4irq
22725 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
22726 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
22727 lines used by the COM ports.
22728
22729 @item info serial
22730 @kindex info serial
22731 @cindex DOS serial port status
22732 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
22733 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
22734 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
22735 counts of various errors encountered so far.
22736 @end table
22737
22738
22739 @node Cygwin Native
22740 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
22741 @cindex MS Windows debugging
22742 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
22743 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
22744
22745 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
22746 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
22747
22748 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
22749 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
22750 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
22751 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
22752 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
22753 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
22754 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
22755 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
22756
22757 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
22758 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
22759 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
22760
22761 @table @code
22762 @kindex info w32
22763 @item info w32
22764 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
22765 information about the target system and important OS structures.
22766
22767 @item info w32 selector
22768 This command displays information returned by
22769 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
22770 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
22771 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
22772 Without argument, this command displays information
22773 about the six segment registers.
22774
22775 @item info w32 thread-information-block
22776 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
22777 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
22778 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
22779
22780 @kindex signal-event
22781 @item signal-event @var{id}
22782 This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
22783 crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
22784
22785 To use it, create or edit the following keys in
22786 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
22787 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
22788 (for x86_64 versions):
22789
22790 @itemize @minus
22791 @item
22792 @code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
22793 Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
22794 "attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
22795
22796 The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
22797 crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
22798 the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
22799 to attach.
22800
22801 @item
22802 @code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
22803 make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
22804 automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
22805 ``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
22806 terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
22807 @end itemize
22808
22809 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
22810 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
22811 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
22812 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
22813 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
22814 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
22815 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
22816 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
22817 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
22818 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
22819 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
22820
22821 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
22822 @item show cygwin-exceptions
22823 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
22824 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
22825
22826 @kindex set new-console
22827 @item set new-console @var{mode}
22828 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
22829 be started in a new console on next start.
22830 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
22831 be started in the same console as the debugger.
22832
22833 @kindex show new-console
22834 @item show new-console
22835 Displays whether a new console is used
22836 when the debuggee is started.
22837
22838 @kindex set new-group
22839 @item set new-group @var{mode}
22840 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
22841 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
22842 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
22843 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
22844
22845 @kindex show new-group
22846 @item show new-group
22847 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
22848
22849 @kindex set debugevents
22850 @item set debugevents
22851 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
22852 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
22853 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
22854 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
22855 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
22856
22857 @kindex set debugexec
22858 @item set debugexec
22859 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
22860 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
22861
22862 @kindex set debugexceptions
22863 @item set debugexceptions
22864 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
22865 debuggee seen by the debugger.
22866
22867 @kindex set debugmemory
22868 @item set debugmemory
22869 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
22870 and writes by the debugger.
22871
22872 @kindex set shell
22873 @item set shell
22874 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
22875 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
22876
22877 @kindex show shell
22878 @item show shell
22879 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
22880
22881 @end table
22882
22883 @menu
22884 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
22885 @end menu
22886
22887 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
22888 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
22889 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
22890 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
22891
22892 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
22893 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
22894 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
22895 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
22896 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
22897 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
22898 ``minimal symbols''.
22899
22900 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
22901 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
22902 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
22903 program run once to completion.
22904
22905 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
22906
22907 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
22908 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
22909 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
22910 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
22911 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
22912 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
22913 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
22914 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
22915 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
22916
22917 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
22918 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
22919 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
22920 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
22921 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
22922 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
22923
22924 @smallexample
22925 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
22926 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
22927
22928 Non-debugging symbols:
22929 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
22930 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
22931 @end smallexample
22932
22933 @smallexample
22934 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
22935 All functions matching regular expression "!":
22936
22937 Non-debugging symbols:
22938 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
22939 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
22940 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
22941 [etc...]
22942 @end smallexample
22943
22944 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
22945
22946 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
22947 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
22948 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
22949 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
22950 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
22951 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
22952 a function within a DLL without a running program.
22953
22954 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
22955 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
22956 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
22957 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
22958 problem:
22959
22960 @smallexample
22961 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
22962 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22963 @end smallexample
22964
22965 @smallexample
22966 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
22967 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22968 @end smallexample
22969
22970 And two possible solutions:
22971
22972 @smallexample
22973 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
22974 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22975 @end smallexample
22976
22977 @smallexample
22978 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
22979 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
22980 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
22981 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
22982 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
22983 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22984 @end smallexample
22985
22986 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
22987 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
22988 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
22989 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
22990 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
22991
22992 @smallexample
22993 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
22994 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
22995 @end smallexample
22996
22997 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
22998 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
22999 safe.
23000
23001 @node Hurd Native
23002 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
23003 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
23004
23005 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
23006 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
23007
23008 @table @code
23009 @item set signals
23010 @itemx set sigs
23011 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
23012 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
23013 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
23014 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
23015 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
23016 @code{signals}.
23017
23018 @item show signals
23019 @itemx show sigs
23020 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
23021 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
23022 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
23023
23024 @item set signal-thread
23025 @itemx set sigthread
23026 @kindex set signal-thread
23027 @kindex set sigthread
23028 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
23029 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
23030 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
23031 signal-thread}.
23032
23033 @item show signal-thread
23034 @itemx show sigthread
23035 @kindex show signal-thread
23036 @kindex show sigthread
23037 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
23038 delivered a signal.
23039
23040 @item set stopped
23041 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
23042 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
23043 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
23044 continued by delivering a signal to it.
23045
23046 @item show stopped
23047 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
23048 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
23049 stopped.
23050
23051 @item set exceptions
23052 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
23053 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
23054 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
23055 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
23056 trapping on.
23057
23058 @item show exceptions
23059 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
23060 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
23061
23062 @item set task pause
23063 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
23064 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23065 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23066 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
23067 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
23068 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
23069 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
23070 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
23071 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
23072
23073 @item show task pause
23074 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
23075 Show the current state of task suspension.
23076
23077 @item set task detach-suspend-count
23078 @cindex task suspend count
23079 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23080 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
23081 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
23082
23083 @item show task detach-suspend-count
23084 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
23085
23086 @item set task exception-port
23087 @itemx set task excp
23088 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23089 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
23090 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
23091 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
23092
23093 @item set noninvasive
23094 @cindex noninvasive task options
23095 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
23096 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
23097 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
23098 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
23099
23100 @item info send-rights
23101 @itemx info receive-rights
23102 @itemx info port-rights
23103 @itemx info port-sets
23104 @itemx info dead-names
23105 @itemx info ports
23106 @itemx info psets
23107 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23108 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23109 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23110 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23111 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23112 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
23113 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
23114 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
23115 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
23116
23117 @item set thread pause
23118 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
23119 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23120 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23121 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
23122 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
23123 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
23124 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
23125 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
23126 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
23127 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
23128 only the current thread.
23129
23130 @item show thread pause
23131 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
23132 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
23133
23134 @item set thread run
23135 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
23136
23137 @item show thread run
23138 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
23139
23140 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
23141 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23142 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23143 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
23144 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
23145 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
23146 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
23147
23148 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
23149 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
23150 detaching.
23151
23152 @item set thread exception-port
23153 @itemx set thread excp
23154 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
23155 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
23156 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
23157
23158 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
23159 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
23160 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
23161 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
23162
23163 @item set thread default
23164 @itemx show thread default
23165 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23166 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
23167 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
23168 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
23169 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
23170 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
23171 the non-default commands.
23172 @end table
23173
23174 @node Darwin
23175 @subsection Darwin
23176 @cindex Darwin
23177
23178 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
23179
23180 @table @code
23181 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
23182 @kindex set debug darwin
23183 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
23184 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
23185
23186 @item show debug darwin
23187 @kindex show debug darwin
23188 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
23189
23190 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
23191 @kindex set debug mach-o
23192 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
23193 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
23194 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
23195 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
23196 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
23197 usage.
23198
23199 @item show debug mach-o
23200 @kindex show debug mach-o
23201 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
23202
23203 @item set mach-exceptions on
23204 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
23205 @kindex set mach-exceptions
23206 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
23207 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
23208 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
23209 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
23210
23211 @item show mach-exceptions
23212 @kindex show mach-exceptions
23213 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
23214 @end table
23215
23216
23217 @node Embedded OS
23218 @section Embedded Operating Systems
23219
23220 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
23221 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
23222 architectures.
23223
23224 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
23225 various real-time operating systems.
23226
23227 @node Embedded Processors
23228 @section Embedded Processors
23229
23230 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
23231 configurations.
23232
23233 @cindex send command to simulator
23234 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
23235 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
23236
23237 @table @code
23238 @item sim @var{command}
23239 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
23240 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
23241 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
23242 acceptable commands.
23243 @end table
23244
23245
23246 @menu
23247 * ARC:: Synopsys ARC
23248 * ARM:: ARM
23249 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
23250 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
23251 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
23252 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRISC 1000 (or1k)
23253 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
23254 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
23255 * CRIS:: CRIS
23256 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
23257 @end menu
23258
23259 @node ARC
23260 @subsection Synopsys ARC
23261 @cindex Synopsys ARC
23262 @cindex ARC specific commands
23263 @cindex ARC600
23264 @cindex ARC700
23265 @cindex ARC EM
23266 @cindex ARC HS
23267
23268 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
23269
23270 @table @code
23271 @item set debug arc
23272 @kindex set debug arc
23273 Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the
23274 default), 1 for debug messages, and 2 for even more debug messages.
23275
23276 @item show debug arc
23277 @kindex show debug arc
23278 Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
23279
23280 @item maint print arc arc-instruction @var{address}
23281 @kindex maint print arc arc-instruction
23282 Print internal disassembler information about instruction at a given address.
23283
23284 @end table
23285
23286 @node ARM
23287 @subsection ARM
23288
23289 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
23290
23291 @table @code
23292 @item set arm disassembler
23293 @kindex set arm
23294 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
23295 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
23296
23297 @item show arm disassembler
23298 @kindex show arm
23299 Show the current disassembly style.
23300
23301 @item set arm apcs32
23302 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
23303 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
23304
23305 @item show arm apcs32
23306 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
23307
23308 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
23309 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
23310 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
23311
23312 @table @code
23313 @item auto
23314 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
23315 @item softfpa
23316 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
23317 processors.
23318 @item fpa
23319 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
23320 @item softvfp
23321 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
23322 @item vfp
23323 VFP co-processor.
23324 @end table
23325
23326 @item show arm fpu
23327 Show the current type of the FPU.
23328
23329 @item set arm abi
23330 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
23331
23332 @item show arm abi
23333 Show the currently used ABI.
23334
23335 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
23336 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
23337 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
23338 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
23339 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
23340 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
23341 register).
23342
23343 @item show arm fallback-mode
23344 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
23345
23346 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
23347 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
23348 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
23349 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
23350 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
23351
23352 @item show arm force-mode
23353 Show the current forced instruction mode.
23354
23355 @item set debug arm
23356 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
23357 target support subsystem.
23358
23359 @item show debug arm
23360 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
23361 @end table
23362
23363 @table @code
23364 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
23365 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
23366
23367 @table @code
23368 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
23369 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
23370 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
23371 The default value is @code{all}.
23372
23373 @table @code
23374 @item none
23375 @item demon
23376 @item angel
23377 @item redboot
23378 @item all
23379 @end table
23380 @end table
23381 @end table
23382
23383 @node M68K
23384 @subsection M68k
23385
23386 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
23387
23388 @node MicroBlaze
23389 @subsection MicroBlaze
23390 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
23391 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
23392
23393 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
23394 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
23395 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
23396 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
23397 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
23398 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
23399 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
23400 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
23401 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
23402 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
23403 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
23404
23405 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
23406
23407 @table @code
23408 @item target remote :1234
23409 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
23410 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
23411
23412 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
23413 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
23414 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
23415
23416 @item load
23417 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
23418
23419 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
23420 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
23421
23422 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
23423 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
23424 @end table
23425
23426 @node MIPS Embedded
23427 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
23428
23429 @noindent
23430 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
23431
23432 @table @code
23433 @item set mipsfpu double
23434 @itemx set mipsfpu single
23435 @itemx set mipsfpu none
23436 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
23437 @itemx show mipsfpu
23438 @kindex set mipsfpu
23439 @kindex show mipsfpu
23440 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
23441 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
23442 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
23443 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
23444 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
23445 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
23446 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
23447 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
23448 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
23449 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
23450 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
23451 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
23452 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
23453
23454 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
23455 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
23456 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
23457
23458 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
23459 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
23460 @end table
23461
23462 @node OpenRISC 1000
23463 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
23464 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
23465
23466 @noindent
23467 The OpenRISC 1000 provides a free RISC instruction set architecture. It is
23468 mainly provided as a soft-core which can run on Xilinx, Altera and other
23469 FPGA's.
23470
23471 @value{GDBN} for OpenRISC supports the below commands when connecting to
23472 a target:
23473
23474 @table @code
23475
23476 @kindex target sim
23477 @item target sim
23478
23479 Runs the builtin CPU simulator which can run very basic
23480 programs but does not support most hardware functions like MMU.
23481 For more complex use cases the user is advised to run an external
23482 target, and connect using @samp{target remote}.
23483
23484 Example: @code{target sim}
23485
23486 @item set debug or1k
23487 Toggle whether to display OpenRISC-specific debugging messages from the
23488 OpenRISC target support subsystem.
23489
23490 @item show debug or1k
23491 Show whether OpenRISC-specific debugging messages are enabled.
23492 @end table
23493
23494 @node PowerPC Embedded
23495 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
23496
23497 @cindex DVC register
23498 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
23499 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
23500
23501 @smallexample
23502 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
23503 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
23504 @end smallexample
23505
23506 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
23507 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
23508 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
23509 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
23510 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
23511 or newer.
23512
23513 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
23514 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
23515 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
23516 watching variables of scalar types.
23517
23518 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
23519 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
23520
23521 @smallexample
23522 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
23523 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
23524 @end smallexample
23525
23526 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
23527 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
23528
23529 @cindex ranged breakpoint
23530 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
23531 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
23532 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
23533 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
23534 use the @code{break-range} command.
23535
23536 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
23537
23538 @table @code
23539 @kindex break-range
23540 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
23541 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
23542 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
23543 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
23544 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
23545 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
23546 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
23547 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
23548 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
23549
23550 @kindex set powerpc
23551 @item set powerpc soft-float
23552 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
23553 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
23554 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
23555 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
23556
23557 @item set powerpc vector-abi
23558 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
23559 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
23560 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
23561 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
23562 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
23563 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
23564 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
23565
23566 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
23567 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
23568 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
23569 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
23570 address of its first byte.
23571
23572 @end table
23573
23574 @node AVR
23575 @subsection Atmel AVR
23576 @cindex AVR
23577
23578 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
23579 following AVR-specific commands:
23580
23581 @table @code
23582 @item info io_registers
23583 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
23584 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
23585 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
23586 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
23587 @end table
23588
23589 @node CRIS
23590 @subsection CRIS
23591 @cindex CRIS
23592
23593 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
23594 following CRIS-specific commands:
23595
23596 @table @code
23597 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
23598 @cindex CRIS version
23599 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
23600 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
23601 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
23602
23603 @item show cris-version
23604 Show the current CRIS version.
23605
23606 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
23607 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
23608 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
23609 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
23610 @code{R59}.
23611
23612 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
23613 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
23614
23615 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
23616 @cindex CRIS mode
23617 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
23618 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
23619 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
23620
23621 @item show cris-mode
23622 Show the current CRIS mode.
23623 @end table
23624
23625 @node Super-H
23626 @subsection Renesas Super-H
23627 @cindex Super-H
23628
23629 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
23630 commands:
23631
23632 @table @code
23633 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
23634 @kindex set sh calling-convention
23635 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
23636 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
23637 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
23638 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
23639 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
23640 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
23641 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
23642 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
23643 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
23644 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
23645
23646 @item show sh calling-convention
23647 @kindex show sh calling-convention
23648 Show the current calling convention setting.
23649
23650 @end table
23651
23652
23653 @node Architectures
23654 @section Architectures
23655
23656 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
23657 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
23658
23659 @menu
23660 * AArch64::
23661 * i386::
23662 * Alpha::
23663 * MIPS::
23664 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
23665 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
23666 * PowerPC::
23667 * Nios II::
23668 * Sparc64::
23669 * S12Z::
23670 @end menu
23671
23672 @node AArch64
23673 @subsection AArch64
23674 @cindex AArch64 support
23675
23676 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
23677 following special commands:
23678
23679 @table @code
23680 @item set debug aarch64
23681 @kindex set debug aarch64
23682 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
23683 messages are to be displayed.
23684
23685 @item show debug aarch64
23686 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
23687
23688 @end table
23689
23690 @subsubsection AArch64 SVE.
23691 @cindex AArch64 SVE.
23692
23693 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, if the Scalable Vector
23694 Extension (SVE) is present, then @value{GDBN} will provide the vector registers
23695 @code{$z0} through @code{$z31}, vector predicate registers @code{$p0} through
23696 @code{$p15}, and the @code{$ffr} register. In addition, the pseudo register
23697 @code{$vg} will be provided. This is the vector granule for the current thread
23698 and represents the number of 64-bit chunks in an SVE @code{z} register.
23699
23700 If the vector length changes, then the @code{$vg} register will be updated,
23701 but the lengths of the @code{z} and @code{p} registers will not change. This
23702 is a known limitation of @value{GDBN} and does not affect the execution of the
23703 target process.
23704
23705
23706 @node i386
23707 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
23708
23709 @table @code
23710 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
23711 @kindex set struct-convention
23712 @cindex struct return convention
23713 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
23714 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
23715 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
23716 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
23717 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
23718 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
23719 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
23720 be returned in a register.
23721
23722 @item show struct-convention
23723 @kindex show struct-convention
23724 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
23725 from functions.
23726 @end table
23727
23728
23729 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
23730 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
23731
23732 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
23733 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
23734 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
23735 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
23736 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
23737 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
23738 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
23739
23740 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
23741 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
23742 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
23743 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
23744 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
23745 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
23746
23747 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
23748 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
23749 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
23750
23751 @smallexample
23752 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
23753 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
23754 @end smallexample
23755
23756 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
23757 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
23758 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
23759 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
23760 the pointer.
23761
23762 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
23763 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
23764 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
23765 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
23766 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
23767
23768 @table @code
23769 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
23770 @kindex show mpx bound
23771 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
23772
23773 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
23774 @kindex set mpx bound
23775 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
23776 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
23777 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
23778 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
23779 @end table
23780
23781 When you call an inferior function on an Intel MPX enabled program,
23782 GDB sets the inferior's bound registers to the init (disabled) state
23783 before calling the function. As a consequence, bounds checks for the
23784 pointer arguments passed to the function will always pass.
23785
23786 This is necessary because when you call an inferior function, the
23787 program is usually in the middle of the execution of other function.
23788 Since at that point bound registers are in an arbitrary state, not
23789 clearing them would lead to random bound violations in the called
23790 function.
23791
23792 You can still examine the influence of the bound registers on the
23793 execution of the called function by stopping the execution of the
23794 called function at its prologue, setting bound registers, and
23795 continuing the execution. For example:
23796
23797 @smallexample
23798 $ break *upper
23799 Breakpoint 2 at 0x4009de: file i386-mpx-call.c, line 47.
23800 $ print upper (a, b, c, d, 1)
23801 Breakpoint 2, upper (a=0x0, b=0x6e0000005b, c=0x0, d=0x0, len=48)....
23802 $ print $bnd0
23803 @{lbound = 0x0, ubound = ffffffff@} : size -1
23804 @end smallexample
23805
23806 At this last step the value of bnd0 can be changed for investigation of bound
23807 violations caused along the execution of the call. In order to know how to
23808 set the bound registers or bound table for the call consult the ABI.
23809
23810 @node Alpha
23811 @subsection Alpha
23812
23813 See the following section.
23814
23815 @node MIPS
23816 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
23817
23818 @cindex stack on Alpha
23819 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
23820 @cindex Alpha stack
23821 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
23822 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
23823 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
23824 find the beginning of a function.
23825
23826 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
23827 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
23828 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
23829 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
23830 commands:
23831
23832 @table @code
23833 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
23834 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
23835 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
23836 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
23837 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
23838 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
23839 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
23840 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
23841
23842 @item show heuristic-fence-post
23843 Display the current limit.
23844 @end table
23845
23846 @noindent
23847 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
23848 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
23849
23850 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
23851 programs:
23852
23853 @table @code
23854 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
23855 @kindex set mips abi
23856 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
23857 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
23858 values of @var{arg} are:
23859
23860 @table @samp
23861 @item auto
23862 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
23863 default).
23864 @item o32
23865 @item o64
23866 @item n32
23867 @item n64
23868 @item eabi32
23869 @item eabi64
23870 @end table
23871
23872 @item show mips abi
23873 @kindex show mips abi
23874 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
23875
23876 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
23877 @kindex set mips compression
23878 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
23879 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
23880 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
23881 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
23882 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
23883 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
23884 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
23885 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
23886 provided by the executable.
23887
23888 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
23889 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
23890 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
23891 identified as such.
23892
23893 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
23894 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
23895 implicitly from an executable.
23896
23897 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
23898 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
23899 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
23900 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
23901 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
23902
23903 @item show mips compression
23904 @kindex show mips compression
23905 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
23906 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
23907
23908 @item set mipsfpu
23909 @itemx show mipsfpu
23910 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
23911
23912 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
23913 @kindex set mips mask-address
23914 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
23915 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
23916 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
23917 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
23918 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
23919
23920 @item show mips mask-address
23921 @kindex show mips mask-address
23922 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
23923 not.
23924
23925 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23926 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23927 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
23928 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
23929 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
23930 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
23931
23932 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23933 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23934 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
23935
23936 @item set debug mips
23937 @kindex set debug mips
23938 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
23939 target code in @value{GDBN}.
23940
23941 @item show debug mips
23942 @kindex show debug mips
23943 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
23944 @end table
23945
23946
23947 @node HPPA
23948 @subsection HPPA
23949 @cindex HPPA support
23950
23951 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
23952 following special commands:
23953
23954 @table @code
23955 @item set debug hppa
23956 @kindex set debug hppa
23957 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
23958 messages are to be displayed.
23959
23960 @item show debug hppa
23961 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
23962
23963 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
23964 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
23965 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
23966 given @var{address}.
23967
23968 @end table
23969
23970
23971 @node SPU
23972 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
23973 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
23974 @cindex SPU
23975
23976 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
23977 it provides the following special commands:
23978
23979 @table @code
23980 @item info spu event
23981 @kindex info spu
23982 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
23983 and pending event status.
23984
23985 @item info spu signal
23986 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
23987 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
23988 notification channels.
23989
23990 @item info spu mailbox
23991 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
23992 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
23993 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
23994
23995 @item info spu dma
23996 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
23997 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
23998 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
23999
24000 @item info spu proxydma
24001 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
24002 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
24003 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
24004
24005 @end table
24006
24007 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
24008 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
24009 special commands:
24010
24011 @table @code
24012 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
24013 @kindex set spu
24014 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
24015 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
24016 function. The default is @code{off}.
24017
24018 @item show spu stop-on-load
24019 @kindex show spu
24020 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
24021
24022 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
24023 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
24024 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
24025 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
24026 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
24027 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
24028
24029 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
24030 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
24031
24032 @end table
24033
24034 @node PowerPC
24035 @subsection PowerPC
24036 @cindex PowerPC architecture
24037
24038 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
24039 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
24040 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
24041 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
24042 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
24043
24044 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
24045 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
24046 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
24047
24048 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
24049 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
24050
24051 @node Nios II
24052 @subsection Nios II
24053 @cindex Nios II architecture
24054
24055 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
24056 it provides the following special commands:
24057
24058 @table @code
24059
24060 @item set debug nios2
24061 @kindex set debug nios2
24062 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
24063 target code in @value{GDBN}.
24064
24065 @item show debug nios2
24066 @kindex show debug nios2
24067 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
24068 @end table
24069
24070 @node Sparc64
24071 @subsection Sparc64
24072 @cindex Sparc64 support
24073 @cindex Application Data Integrity
24074 @subsubsection ADI Support
24075
24076 The M7 processor supports an Application Data Integrity (ADI) feature that
24077 detects invalid data accesses. When software allocates memory and enables
24078 ADI on the allocated memory, it chooses a 4-bit version number, sets the
24079 version in the upper 4 bits of the 64-bit pointer to that data, and stores
24080 the 4-bit version in every cacheline of that data. Hardware saves the latter
24081 in spare bits in the cache and memory hierarchy. On each load and store,
24082 the processor compares the upper 4 VA (virtual address) bits to the
24083 cacheline's version. If there is a mismatch, the processor generates a
24084 version mismatch trap which can be either precise or disrupting. The trap
24085 is an error condition which the kernel delivers to the process as a SIGSEGV
24086 signal.
24087
24088 Note that only 64-bit applications can use ADI and need to be built with
24089 ADI-enabled.
24090
24091 Values of the ADI version tags, which are in granularity of a
24092 cacheline (64 bytes), can be viewed or modified.
24093
24094
24095 @table @code
24096 @kindex adi examine
24097 @item adi (examine | x) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr}
24098
24099 The @code{adi examine} command displays the value of one ADI version tag per
24100 cacheline.
24101
24102 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes; the default
24103 is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the ratio of 1:ADI
24104 block size, to display.
24105
24106 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
24107 to begin displaying the ADI version tags.
24108
24109 Below is an example of displaying ADI versions of variable "shmaddr".
24110
24111 @smallexample
24112 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
24113 0xfff800010002c000: 0 0
24114 @end smallexample
24115
24116 @kindex adi assign
24117 @item adi (assign | a) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr} = @var{tag}
24118
24119 The @code{adi assign} command is used to assign new ADI version tag
24120 to an address.
24121
24122 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes;
24123 the default is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the
24124 ratio of 1:ADI block size, to modify.
24125
24126 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
24127 to begin modifying the ADI version tags.
24128
24129 @var{tag} is the new ADI version tag.
24130
24131 For example, do the following to modify then verify ADI versions of
24132 variable "shmaddr":
24133
24134 @smallexample
24135 (@value{GDBP}) adi a/100 shmaddr = 7
24136 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
24137 0xfff800010002c000: 7 7
24138 @end smallexample
24139
24140 @end table
24141
24142 @node S12Z
24143 @subsection S12Z
24144 @cindex S12Z support
24145
24146 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the S12Z architecture,
24147 it provides the following special command:
24148
24149 @table @code
24150 @item maint info bdccsr
24151 @kindex maint info bdccsr@r{, S12Z}
24152 This command displays the current value of the microprocessor's
24153 BDCCSR register.
24154 @end table
24155
24156
24157 @node Controlling GDB
24158 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
24159
24160 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
24161 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
24162 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
24163 described here.
24164
24165 @menu
24166 * Prompt:: Prompt
24167 * Editing:: Command editing
24168 * Command History:: Command history
24169 * Screen Size:: Screen size
24170 * Numbers:: Numbers
24171 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
24172 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
24173 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
24174 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
24175 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
24176 @end menu
24177
24178 @node Prompt
24179 @section Prompt
24180
24181 @cindex prompt
24182
24183 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
24184 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
24185 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
24186 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
24187 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
24188 which one you are talking to.
24189
24190 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
24191 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
24192 or a prompt that does not.
24193
24194 @table @code
24195 @kindex set prompt
24196 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
24197 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
24198
24199 @kindex show prompt
24200 @item show prompt
24201 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
24202 @end table
24203
24204 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
24205 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
24206 are:
24207
24208 @table @code
24209 @kindex set extended-prompt
24210 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
24211 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
24212 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
24213 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
24214 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
24215 is displayed.
24216
24217 For example:
24218
24219 @smallexample
24220 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
24221 @end smallexample
24222
24223 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
24224 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
24225
24226 @kindex show extended-prompt
24227 @item show extended-prompt
24228 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
24229 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
24230 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
24231 @end table
24232
24233 @node Editing
24234 @section Command Editing
24235 @cindex readline
24236 @cindex command line editing
24237
24238 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
24239 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
24240 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
24241 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
24242 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
24243 debugging sessions.
24244
24245 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
24246 command @code{set}.
24247
24248 @table @code
24249 @kindex set editing
24250 @cindex editing
24251 @item set editing
24252 @itemx set editing on
24253 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
24254
24255 @item set editing off
24256 Disable command line editing.
24257
24258 @kindex show editing
24259 @item show editing
24260 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
24261 @end table
24262
24263 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24264 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
24265 @end ifset
24266 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24267 @xref{Command Line Editing},
24268 @end ifclear
24269 for more details about the Readline
24270 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
24271 encouraged to read that chapter.
24272
24273 @node Command History
24274 @section Command History
24275 @cindex command history
24276
24277 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
24278 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
24279 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
24280 history facility.
24281
24282 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
24283 package, to provide the history facility.
24284 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24285 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
24286 @end ifset
24287 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24288 @xref{Using History Interactively},
24289 @end ifclear
24290 for the detailed description of the History library.
24291
24292 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
24293 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
24294 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
24295 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
24296 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
24297 pressed on a line by itself.
24298
24299 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
24300 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
24301 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
24302 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
24303
24304 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
24305 history.
24306
24307 @table @code
24308 @cindex history substitution
24309 @cindex history file
24310 @kindex set history filename
24311 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
24312 @item set history filename @var{fname}
24313 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
24314 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
24315 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
24316 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
24317 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
24318 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
24319 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
24320 is not set.
24321
24322 @cindex save command history
24323 @kindex set history save
24324 @item set history save
24325 @itemx set history save on
24326 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
24327 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
24328
24329 @item set history save off
24330 Stop recording command history in a file.
24331
24332 @cindex history size
24333 @kindex set history size
24334 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
24335 @item set history size @var{size}
24336 @itemx set history size unlimited
24337 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
24338 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
24339 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
24340 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
24341 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
24342 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
24343
24344 @cindex remove duplicate history
24345 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
24346 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
24347 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
24348 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
24349 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
24350 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
24351 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
24352 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
24353 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
24354
24355 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
24356 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
24357
24358 @end table
24359
24360 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
24361 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24362 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
24363 @end ifset
24364 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24365 @xref{Event Designators},
24366 @end ifclear
24367 for more details.
24368
24369 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
24370 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
24371 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
24372 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
24373 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
24374 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
24375 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
24376 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
24377
24378 The commands to control history expansion are:
24379
24380 @table @code
24381 @item set history expansion on
24382 @itemx set history expansion
24383 @kindex set history expansion
24384 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
24385
24386 @item set history expansion off
24387 Disable history expansion.
24388
24389 @c @group
24390 @kindex show history
24391 @item show history
24392 @itemx show history filename
24393 @itemx show history save
24394 @itemx show history size
24395 @itemx show history expansion
24396 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
24397 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
24398 @c @end group
24399 @end table
24400
24401 @table @code
24402 @kindex show commands
24403 @cindex show last commands
24404 @cindex display command history
24405 @item show commands
24406 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
24407
24408 @item show commands @var{n}
24409 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
24410
24411 @item show commands +
24412 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
24413 @end table
24414
24415 @node Screen Size
24416 @section Screen Size
24417 @cindex size of screen
24418 @cindex screen size
24419 @cindex pagination
24420 @cindex page size
24421 @cindex pauses in output
24422
24423 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
24424 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
24425 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
24426 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to see one more page of output,
24427 @kbd{q} to discard the remaining output, or @kbd{c} to continue
24428 without paging for the rest of the current command. Also, the screen
24429 width setting determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on
24430 what is being printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a
24431 readable place, rather than simply letting it overflow onto the
24432 following line.
24433
24434 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
24435 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
24436 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
24437 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
24438 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
24439 width} commands:
24440
24441 @table @code
24442 @kindex set height
24443 @kindex set width
24444 @kindex show width
24445 @kindex show height
24446 @item set height @var{lpp}
24447 @itemx set height unlimited
24448 @itemx show height
24449 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
24450 @itemx set width unlimited
24451 @itemx show width
24452 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
24453 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
24454 commands display the current settings.
24455
24456 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
24457 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
24458 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
24459 buffer.
24460
24461 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
24462 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
24463
24464 @item set pagination on
24465 @itemx set pagination off
24466 @kindex set pagination
24467 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
24468 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
24469 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
24470 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
24471
24472 @item show pagination
24473 @kindex show pagination
24474 Show the current pagination mode.
24475 @end table
24476
24477 @node Numbers
24478 @section Numbers
24479 @cindex number representation
24480 @cindex entering numbers
24481
24482 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
24483 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
24484 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
24485 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
24486 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
24487 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
24488 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
24489 both input and output with the commands described below.
24490
24491 @table @code
24492 @kindex set input-radix
24493 @item set input-radix @var{base}
24494 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
24495 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
24496 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
24497 example, any of
24498
24499 @smallexample
24500 set input-radix 012
24501 set input-radix 10.
24502 set input-radix 0xa
24503 @end smallexample
24504
24505 @noindent
24506 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
24507 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
24508 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
24509 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
24510 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
24511 change the radix.
24512
24513 @kindex set output-radix
24514 @item set output-radix @var{base}
24515 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
24516 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
24517 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
24518
24519 @kindex show input-radix
24520 @item show input-radix
24521 Display the current default base for numeric input.
24522
24523 @kindex show output-radix
24524 @item show output-radix
24525 Display the current default base for numeric display.
24526
24527 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
24528 @itemx show radix
24529 @kindex set radix
24530 @kindex show radix
24531 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
24532 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
24533 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
24534 default value of 10.
24535
24536 @end table
24537
24538 @node ABI
24539 @section Configuring the Current ABI
24540
24541 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
24542 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
24543 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
24544 current ABI.
24545
24546 @cindex OS ABI
24547 @kindex set osabi
24548 @kindex show osabi
24549 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
24550
24551 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
24552 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
24553 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
24554 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
24555 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
24556 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
24557 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
24558 platform provides.
24559
24560 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
24561 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
24562 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
24563 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
24564
24565 @table @code
24566 @item show osabi
24567 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
24568
24569 @item set osabi
24570 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
24571
24572 @item set osabi @var{abi}
24573 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
24574 @end table
24575
24576 @cindex float promotion
24577
24578 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
24579 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
24580 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
24581 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
24582 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
24583 @code{double} and then passed.
24584
24585 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
24586 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
24587 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
24588
24589 @table @code
24590 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
24591 @item set coerce-float-to-double
24592 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
24593 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
24594 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
24595
24596 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
24597 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
24598 functions.
24599
24600 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
24601 @item show coerce-float-to-double
24602 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
24603 @end table
24604
24605 @kindex set cp-abi
24606 @kindex show cp-abi
24607 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
24608 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
24609 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
24610 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
24611 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
24612 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
24613 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
24614 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
24615 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
24616 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
24617 ``auto''.
24618
24619 @table @code
24620 @item show cp-abi
24621 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
24622
24623 @item set cp-abi
24624 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
24625
24626 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
24627 @itemx set cp-abi auto
24628 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
24629 @end table
24630
24631 @node Auto-loading
24632 @section Automatically loading associated files
24633 @cindex auto-loading
24634
24635 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
24636 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
24637 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
24638 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
24639 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
24640 sources).
24641
24642 @menu
24643 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
24644 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
24645
24646 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
24647 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
24648 @end menu
24649
24650 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
24651 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
24652 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24653
24654 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
24655 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
24656 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24657
24658 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
24659 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
24660
24661 @table @code
24662 @anchor{set auto-load off}
24663 @kindex set auto-load off
24664 @item set auto-load off
24665 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
24666 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
24667 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
24668 @smallexample
24669 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
24670 @end smallexample
24671
24672 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
24673 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
24674 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
24675 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
24676 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
24677 @code{set auto-load no}.
24678
24679 @anchor{show auto-load}
24680 @kindex show auto-load
24681 @item show auto-load
24682 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
24683 or disabled.
24684
24685 @smallexample
24686 (gdb) show auto-load
24687 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
24688 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
24689 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
24690 is on.
24691 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
24692 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
24693 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
24694 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
24695 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
24696 @end smallexample
24697
24698 @anchor{info auto-load}
24699 @kindex info auto-load
24700 @item info auto-load
24701 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
24702 not.
24703
24704 @smallexample
24705 (gdb) info auto-load
24706 gdb-scripts:
24707 Loaded Script
24708 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
24709 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
24710 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
24711 loaded.
24712 python-scripts:
24713 Loaded Script
24714 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
24715 @end smallexample
24716 @end table
24717
24718 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
24719
24720 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
24721 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
24722 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
24723 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
24724 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
24725 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
24726 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
24727 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24728 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24729 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24730 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24731 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24732 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24733 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
24734 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24735 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
24736 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24737 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
24738 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24739 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
24740 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24741 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
24742 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24743 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
24744 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24745 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
24746 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24747 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
24748 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24749 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
24750 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
24751 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24752 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
24753 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24754 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
24755 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24756 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
24757 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
24758 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
24759 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
24760 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
24761 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
24762 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
24763 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
24764 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
24765 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
24766 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
24767 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
24768 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
24769 @end multitable
24770
24771 @node Init File in the Current Directory
24772 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
24773 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
24774
24775 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
24776 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
24777 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
24778
24779 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
24780 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24781
24782 @table @code
24783 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
24784 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
24785 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
24786 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
24787 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
24788
24789 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
24790 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
24791 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
24792 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
24793 current directory is enabled or disabled.
24794
24795 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
24796 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
24797 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
24798 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
24799 current directory have been auto-loaded.
24800 @end table
24801
24802 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
24803 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
24804 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
24805
24806 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
24807
24808 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
24809 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
24810
24811 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
24812 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
24813 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
24814 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
24815 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
24816 library.
24817
24818 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
24819 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24820
24821 @table @code
24822 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
24823 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
24824 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
24825 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
24826
24827 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
24828 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
24829 @item show auto-load libthread-db
24830 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
24831 enabled or disabled.
24832
24833 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
24834 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
24835 @item info auto-load libthread-db
24836 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
24837 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
24838 @end table
24839
24840 @node Auto-loading safe path
24841 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
24842 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
24843
24844 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
24845 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
24846 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
24847 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
24848 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
24849
24850 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
24851 get loaded:
24852
24853 @smallexample
24854 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
24855 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
24856 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
24857 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
24858 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
24859 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
24860 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
24861 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
24862 @end smallexample
24863
24864 @noindent
24865 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
24866 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
24867
24868 @smallexample
24869 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
24870 @end smallexample
24871
24872 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
24873
24874 @table @code
24875 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
24876 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
24877 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24878 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
24879 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
24880 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
24881 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
24882 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
24883 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
24884 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
24885
24886 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24887 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24888 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24889
24890 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
24891 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
24892 @item show auto-load safe-path
24893 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
24894 scripts.
24895
24896 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
24897 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
24898 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
24899 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
24900 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
24901 by the host platform path separator in use.
24902 @end table
24903
24904 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
24905 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
24906 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
24907 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
24908 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
24909
24910 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
24911 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
24912 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
24913 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
24914 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
24915 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
24916 init file in the current directory
24917 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
24918
24919 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
24920 example, you could use one of the following ways:
24921
24922 @table @asis
24923 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
24924 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
24925 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
24926 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
24927
24928 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
24929 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
24930 @value{GDBN} session.
24931
24932 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
24933 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
24934 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
24935 from trusted sources.
24936
24937 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
24938 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
24939 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
24940 trusted sources.
24941 @end table
24942
24943 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
24944 also suppresses any such warning messages:
24945
24946 @table @asis
24947 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
24948 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
24949
24950 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
24951 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
24952 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
24953 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
24954 @end table
24955
24956 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
24957 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
24958 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
24959 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
24960 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
24961 recommended to be entered.
24962
24963 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
24964 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
24965 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
24966
24967 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
24968 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
24969 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
24970 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
24971 be printed.
24972
24973 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
24974 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
24975 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
24976
24977 @smallexample
24978 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
24979 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
24980 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
24981 for objfile "/tmp/true".
24982 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
24983 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
24984 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
24985 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
24986 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
24987 @end smallexample
24988
24989 @table @code
24990 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
24991 @kindex set debug auto-load
24992 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
24993 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
24994
24995 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
24996 @kindex show debug auto-load
24997 @item show debug auto-load
24998 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
24999 on or off.
25000 @end table
25001
25002 @node Messages/Warnings
25003 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
25004
25005 @cindex verbose operation
25006 @cindex optional warnings
25007 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
25008 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
25009 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
25010 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
25011
25012 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
25013 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
25014 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25015
25016 @table @code
25017 @kindex set verbose
25018 @item set verbose on
25019 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
25020
25021 @item set verbose off
25022 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
25023
25024 @kindex show verbose
25025 @item show verbose
25026 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
25027 @end table
25028
25029 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
25030 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
25031 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
25032 Symbol Files}).
25033
25034 @table @code
25035
25036 @kindex set complaints
25037 @item set complaints @var{limit}
25038 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
25039 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
25040 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
25041 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
25042
25043 @kindex show complaints
25044 @item show complaints
25045 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
25046
25047 @end table
25048
25049 @anchor{confirmation requests}
25050 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
25051 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
25052 you try to run a program which is already running:
25053
25054 @smallexample
25055 (@value{GDBP}) run
25056 The program being debugged has been started already.
25057 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
25058 @end smallexample
25059
25060 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
25061 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
25062
25063 @table @code
25064
25065 @kindex set confirm
25066 @cindex flinching
25067 @cindex confirmation
25068 @cindex stupid questions
25069 @item set confirm off
25070 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
25071 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
25072 automatically disables confirmation requests.
25073
25074 @item set confirm on
25075 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
25076
25077 @kindex show confirm
25078 @item show confirm
25079 Displays state of confirmation requests.
25080
25081 @end table
25082
25083 @cindex command tracing
25084 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
25085 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
25086 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
25087 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
25088
25089 @table @code
25090 @kindex set trace-commands
25091 @cindex command scripts, debugging
25092 @item set trace-commands on
25093 Enable command tracing.
25094 @item set trace-commands off
25095 Disable command tracing.
25096 @item show trace-commands
25097 Display the current state of command tracing.
25098 @end table
25099
25100 @node Debugging Output
25101 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
25102 @cindex optional debugging messages
25103
25104 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
25105 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
25106 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
25107 section documents those commands.
25108
25109 @table @code
25110 @kindex set exec-done-display
25111 @item set exec-done-display
25112 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
25113 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
25114 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
25115 @kindex show exec-done-display
25116 @item show exec-done-display
25117 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
25118 notification.
25119 @kindex set debug
25120 @cindex ARM AArch64
25121 @item set debug aarch64
25122 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
25123 The default is off.
25124 @kindex show debug
25125 @item show debug aarch64
25126 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25127 ARM AArch64.
25128 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
25129 @cindex architecture debugging info
25130 @item set debug arch
25131 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
25132 @item show debug arch
25133 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
25134 @item set debug aix-solib
25135 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
25136 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
25137 support module. The default is off.
25138 @item show debug aix-thread
25139 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
25140 @item set debug aix-thread
25141 @cindex AIX threads
25142 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
25143 module.
25144 @item show debug aix-thread
25145 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
25146 @item set debug check-physname
25147 @cindex physname
25148 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
25149 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
25150 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
25151 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
25152 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
25153 both ways and display any discrepancies.
25154 @item show debug check-physname
25155 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
25156 @item set debug coff-pe-read
25157 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
25158 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
25159 exported symbols. The default is off.
25160 @item show debug coff-pe-read
25161 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25162 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
25163 @item set debug dwarf-die
25164 @cindex DWARF DIEs
25165 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
25166 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
25167 A value of zero turns off the display.
25168 @item show debug dwarf-die
25169 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
25170 @item set debug dwarf-line
25171 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
25172 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
25173 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
25174 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25175 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25176 @item show debug dwarf-line
25177 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
25178 @item set debug dwarf-read
25179 @cindex DWARF Reading
25180 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
25181 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
25182 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25183 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25184 @item show debug dwarf-read
25185 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
25186 @item set debug displaced
25187 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
25188 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
25189 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
25190 @item show debug displaced
25191 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
25192 related to displaced stepping.
25193 @item set debug event
25194 @cindex event debugging info
25195 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
25196 default is off.
25197 @item show debug event
25198 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
25199 info.
25200 @item set debug expression
25201 @cindex expression debugging info
25202 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
25203 expression parsing. The default is off.
25204 @item show debug expression
25205 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
25206 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
25207 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
25208 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
25209 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
25210 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
25211 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
25212 @item set debug fbsd-nat
25213 @cindex FreeBSD native target debug messages
25214 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD native target.
25215 @item show debug fbsd-nat
25216 Show the current state of FreeBSD native target debugging messages.
25217 @item set debug frame
25218 @cindex frame debugging info
25219 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
25220 default is off.
25221 @item show debug frame
25222 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
25223 info.
25224 @item set debug gnu-nat
25225 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
25226 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
25227 @item show debug gnu-nat
25228 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
25229 @item set debug infrun
25230 @cindex inferior debugging info
25231 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
25232 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
25233 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
25234 @item show debug infrun
25235 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
25236 @item set debug jit
25237 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
25238 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
25239 @item show debug jit
25240 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
25241 @item set debug lin-lwp
25242 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
25243 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
25244 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
25245 @item show debug lin-lwp
25246 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
25247 @item set debug linux-namespaces
25248 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
25249 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
25250 @item show debug linux-namespaces
25251 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
25252 @item set debug mach-o
25253 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
25254 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
25255 processing. The default is off.
25256 @item show debug mach-o
25257 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25258 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
25259 @item set debug notification
25260 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
25261 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
25262 The default is off.
25263 @item show debug notification
25264 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
25265 @item set debug observer
25266 @cindex observer debugging info
25267 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
25268 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
25269 @item show debug observer
25270 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
25271 @item set debug overload
25272 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
25273 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
25274 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
25275 is off.
25276 @item show debug overload
25277 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
25278 debugging info.
25279 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
25280 @cindex debug expression parser
25281 @item set debug parser
25282 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
25283 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
25284 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
25285 details. The default is off.
25286 @item show debug parser
25287 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
25288 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
25289 @cindex serial connections, debugging
25290 @cindex debug remote protocol
25291 @cindex remote protocol debugging
25292 @cindex display remote packets
25293 @item set debug remote
25294 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
25295 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
25296 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
25297 @item show debug remote
25298 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
25299
25300 @item set debug separate-debug-file
25301 Turns on or off display of debug output about separate debug file search.
25302 @item show debug separate-debug-file
25303 Displays the state of separate debug file search debug output.
25304
25305 @item set debug serial
25306 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
25307 default is off.
25308 @item show debug serial
25309 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
25310 info.
25311 @item set debug solib-frv
25312 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
25313 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
25314 @item show debug solib-frv
25315 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
25316 messages.
25317 @item set debug symbol-lookup
25318 @cindex symbol lookup
25319 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
25320 The default is 0 (off).
25321 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25322 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25323 @item show debug symbol-lookup
25324 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
25325 @item set debug symfile
25326 @cindex symbol file functions
25327 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
25328 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
25329 @item show debug symfile
25330 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
25331 @item set debug symtab-create
25332 @cindex symbol table creation
25333 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
25334 The default is 0 (off).
25335 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25336 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25337 @item show debug symtab-create
25338 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
25339 @item set debug target
25340 @cindex target debugging info
25341 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
25342 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
25343 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
25344 value of large memory transfers.
25345 @item show debug target
25346 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
25347 info.
25348 @item set debug timestamp
25349 @cindex timestampping debugging info
25350 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
25351 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
25352 message.
25353 @item show debug timestamp
25354 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
25355 debugging info.
25356 @item set debug varobj
25357 @cindex variable object debugging info
25358 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
25359 info. The default is off.
25360 @item show debug varobj
25361 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
25362 debugging info.
25363 @item set debug xml
25364 @cindex XML parser debugging
25365 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
25366 @item show debug xml
25367 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
25368 @end table
25369
25370 @node Other Misc Settings
25371 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
25372 @cindex miscellaneous settings
25373
25374 @table @code
25375 @kindex set interactive-mode
25376 @item set interactive-mode
25377 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
25378 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
25379 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
25380 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
25381 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
25382 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
25383 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
25384 is, non-interactively otherwise.
25385
25386 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
25387 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
25388 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
25389 inside a cygwin window.
25390
25391 @kindex show interactive-mode
25392 @item show interactive-mode
25393 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
25394 @end table
25395
25396 @node Extending GDB
25397 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
25398 @cindex extending GDB
25399
25400 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
25401 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
25402 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
25403 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
25404 being debugged.
25405
25406 @menu
25407 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
25408 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
25409 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
25410 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
25411 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
25412 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
25413 @end menu
25414
25415 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
25416 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
25417 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
25418 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
25419 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
25420 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
25421
25422 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
25423 setting:
25424
25425 @table @code
25426 @kindex set script-extension
25427 @kindex show script-extension
25428 @item set script-extension off
25429 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
25430
25431 @item set script-extension soft
25432 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
25433 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
25434 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
25435 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
25436
25437 @item set script-extension strict
25438 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
25439 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
25440 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
25441
25442 @item show script-extension
25443 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
25444
25445 @end table
25446
25447 @node Sequences
25448 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
25449
25450 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
25451 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
25452 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
25453 files.
25454
25455 @menu
25456 * Define:: How to define your own commands
25457 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
25458 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
25459 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
25460 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
25461 @end menu
25462
25463 @node Define
25464 @subsection User-defined Commands
25465
25466 @cindex user-defined command
25467 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
25468 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
25469 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
25470 @code{define} command. User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments
25471 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
25472 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}. A trivial example:
25473
25474 @smallexample
25475 define adder
25476 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
25477 end
25478 @end smallexample
25479
25480 @noindent
25481 To execute the command use:
25482
25483 @smallexample
25484 adder 1 2 3
25485 @end smallexample
25486
25487 @noindent
25488 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
25489 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
25490 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
25491 functions calls.
25492
25493 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
25494 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
25495 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
25496 been passed.
25497
25498 @smallexample
25499 define adder
25500 if $argc == 2
25501 print $arg0 + $arg1
25502 end
25503 if $argc == 3
25504 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
25505 end
25506 end
25507 @end smallexample
25508
25509 Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier
25510 to process a variable number of arguments:
25511
25512 @smallexample
25513 define adder
25514 set $i = 0
25515 set $sum = 0
25516 while $i < $argc
25517 eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
25518 set $i = $i + 1
25519 end
25520 print $sum
25521 end
25522 @end smallexample
25523
25524 @table @code
25525
25526 @kindex define
25527 @item define @var{commandname}
25528 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
25529 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
25530 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
25531 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
25532 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
25533 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
25534
25535 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
25536 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
25537 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
25538
25539 @kindex document
25540 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
25541 @item document @var{commandname}
25542 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
25543 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
25544 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
25545 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
25546 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
25547 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
25548
25549 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
25550 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
25551 does not change the documentation.
25552
25553 @kindex dont-repeat
25554 @cindex don't repeat command
25555 @item dont-repeat
25556 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
25557 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
25558 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
25559
25560 @kindex help user-defined
25561 @item help user-defined
25562 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
25563 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
25564 included (if any).
25565
25566 @kindex show user
25567 @item show user
25568 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
25569 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
25570 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
25571 definitions for all user-defined commands.
25572 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
25573
25574 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
25575 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
25576 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
25577 @item show max-user-call-depth
25578 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
25579 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
25580 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
25581 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
25582 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
25583 @end table
25584
25585 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
25586 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
25587
25588 When user-defined commands are executed, the
25589 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
25590 stops execution of the user-defined command.
25591
25592 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
25593 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
25594 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
25595 messages when used in a user-defined command.
25596
25597 @node Hooks
25598 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
25599 @cindex command hooks
25600 @cindex hooks, for commands
25601 @cindex hooks, pre-command
25602
25603 @kindex hook
25604 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
25605 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
25606 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
25607 before that command.
25608
25609 @cindex hooks, post-command
25610 @kindex hookpost
25611 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
25612 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
25613 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
25614 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
25615 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
25616
25617 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
25618 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
25619
25620 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
25621 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
25622
25623 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
25624 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
25625 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
25626 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
25627 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
25628
25629 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
25630 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
25631 you could define:
25632
25633 @smallexample
25634 define hook-stop
25635 handle SIGALRM nopass
25636 end
25637
25638 define hook-run
25639 handle SIGALRM pass
25640 end
25641
25642 define hook-continue
25643 handle SIGALRM pass
25644 end
25645 @end smallexample
25646
25647 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
25648 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
25649 you could define:
25650
25651 @smallexample
25652 define hook-echo
25653 echo <<<---
25654 end
25655
25656 define hookpost-echo
25657 echo --->>>\n
25658 end
25659
25660 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
25661 <<<---Hello World--->>>
25662 (@value{GDBP})
25663
25664 @end smallexample
25665
25666 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
25667 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
25668 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
25669 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
25670 @c or not?
25671 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
25672 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
25673 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
25674
25675 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
25676 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
25677 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
25678
25679 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
25680 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
25681
25682 @node Command Files
25683 @subsection Command Files
25684
25685 @cindex command files
25686 @cindex scripting commands
25687 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
25688 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
25689 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
25690 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
25691 terminal.
25692
25693 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
25694 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
25695 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
25696 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
25697 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
25698
25699 @table @code
25700 @kindex source
25701 @cindex execute commands from a file
25702 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
25703 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
25704 @end table
25705
25706 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
25707 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
25708 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
25709 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
25710 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
25711
25712 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
25713 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
25714 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
25715 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
25716 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
25717 is not relevant to scripts.
25718
25719 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
25720 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
25721 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
25722 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
25723 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
25724 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
25725 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
25726 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
25727 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
25728 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
25729 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
25730 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
25731 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
25732 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
25733
25734 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
25735 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
25736 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
25737
25738 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
25739 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
25740 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
25741 when called from command files.
25742
25743 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
25744 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
25745 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
25746 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
25747 the next command.
25748
25749 @smallexample
25750 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
25751 @end smallexample
25752
25753 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
25754 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
25755 would be directed to @file{log}.
25756
25757 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
25758 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
25759 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
25760 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
25761 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
25762 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
25763 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
25764 conditionally, etc.
25765
25766 @table @code
25767 @kindex if
25768 @kindex else
25769 @item if
25770 @itemx else
25771 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
25772 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
25773 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
25774 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
25775 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
25776 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
25777 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
25778
25779 @kindex while
25780 @item while
25781 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
25782 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
25783 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
25784 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
25785 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
25786 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
25787
25788 @kindex loop_break
25789 @item loop_break
25790 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
25791 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
25792 line.
25793
25794 @kindex loop_continue
25795 @item loop_continue
25796 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
25797 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
25798 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
25799 the controlling expression.
25800
25801 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
25802 @item end
25803 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
25804 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
25805 @end table
25806
25807
25808 @node Output
25809 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
25810
25811 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
25812 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
25813 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
25814 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
25815 want.
25816
25817 @table @code
25818 @kindex echo
25819 @item echo @var{text}
25820 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
25821 @c because it is not in ANSI.
25822 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
25823 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
25824 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
25825 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
25826 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
25827 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
25828 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
25829 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
25830 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
25831
25832 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
25833 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
25834
25835 @smallexample
25836 echo This is some text\n\
25837 which is continued\n\
25838 onto several lines.\n
25839 @end smallexample
25840
25841 produces the same output as
25842
25843 @smallexample
25844 echo This is some text\n
25845 echo which is continued\n
25846 echo onto several lines.\n
25847 @end smallexample
25848
25849 @kindex output
25850 @item output @var{expression}
25851 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
25852 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
25853 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
25854 on expressions.
25855
25856 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
25857 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
25858 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
25859 Formats}, for more information.
25860
25861 @kindex printf
25862 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
25863 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
25864 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
25865 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
25866 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
25867 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
25868 executing the code below:
25869
25870 @smallexample
25871 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
25872 @end smallexample
25873
25874 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
25875 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
25876 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
25877 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
25878 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
25879 printed.
25880
25881 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
25882
25883 @smallexample
25884 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
25885 @end smallexample
25886
25887 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
25888 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
25889 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
25890
25891 @itemize @bullet
25892 @item
25893 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
25894
25895 @item
25896 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
25897 width.
25898
25899 @item
25900 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
25901 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
25902
25903 @item
25904 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
25905 supported.
25906
25907 @item
25908 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
25909
25910 @item
25911 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
25912 @end itemize
25913
25914 @noindent
25915 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
25916 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
25917 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
25918 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
25919
25920 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
25921 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
25922 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
25923 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
25924 supported.
25925
25926 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
25927 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
25928 together with a floating point specifier.
25929 letters:
25930
25931 @itemize @bullet
25932 @item
25933 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
25934
25935 @item
25936 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
25937
25938 @item
25939 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
25940 @end itemize
25941
25942 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
25943 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
25944 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
25945
25946 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
25947 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
25948
25949 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
25950 @smallexample
25951 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
25952 @end smallexample
25953
25954 @anchor{eval}
25955 @kindex eval
25956 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
25957 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
25958 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
25959
25960 @end table
25961
25962 @node Auto-loading sequences
25963 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
25964 @cindex native script auto-loading
25965
25966 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
25967 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
25968 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
25969 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
25970
25971 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
25972 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
25973
25974 @table @code
25975 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
25976 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
25977 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
25978 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
25979
25980 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
25981 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
25982 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
25983 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
25984 disabled.
25985
25986 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
25987 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
25988 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
25989 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
25990 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
25991 auto-loaded.
25992 @end table
25993
25994 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
25995 matching names are printed.
25996
25997 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
25998 @include python.texi
25999
26000 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
26001 @include guile.texi
26002
26003 @node Auto-loading extensions
26004 @section Auto-loading extensions
26005 @cindex auto-loading extensions
26006
26007 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
26008 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
26009 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
26010 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
26011 section of modern file formats like ELF.
26012
26013 @menu
26014 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
26015 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
26016 * Which flavor to choose?::
26017 @end menu
26018
26019 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
26020 debugging commands and features.
26021
26022 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
26023 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
26024 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
26025 for more information.
26026 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
26027 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
26028
26029 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
26030 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26031
26032 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
26033 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
26034 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
26035 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
26036 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
26037
26038 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
26039 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
26040 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
26041 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
26042
26043 @table @code
26044 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
26045 GDB's own command language
26046 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
26047 Python
26048 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
26049 Guile
26050 @end table
26051
26052 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
26053 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
26054 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
26055 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
26056 script in the specified extension language.
26057
26058 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
26059 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
26060
26061 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
26062 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26063
26064 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
26065 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
26066 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
26067 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
26068 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
26069 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
26070
26071 @table @code
26072 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
26073 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
26074 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
26075 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
26076 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
26077 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
26078
26079 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
26080 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
26081
26082 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
26083 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
26084 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
26085 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
26086
26087 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
26088 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
26089 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
26090 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
26091 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
26092 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
26093 platform.
26094
26095 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
26096 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
26097 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
26098
26099 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
26100 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
26101 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
26102 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
26103
26104 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
26105 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
26106 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
26107 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
26108 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
26109 @end table
26110
26111 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
26112 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
26113 @var{objfile} is opened.
26114 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
26115 is evaluated more than once.
26116
26117 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
26118 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
26119 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
26120
26121 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
26122 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
26123 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
26124 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
26125 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
26126 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
26127 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
26128
26129 The following entries are supported:
26130
26131 @table @code
26132 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
26133 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
26134 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
26135 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
26136 @end table
26137
26138 @subsubsection Script File Entries
26139
26140 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
26141 in the current directory and then along the source search path
26142 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
26143 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
26144 directory is not relevant to scripts.
26145
26146 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
26147 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
26148
26149 @example
26150 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
26151 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
26152 asm("\
26153 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
26154 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
26155 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
26156 .popsection \n\
26157 ");
26158 @end example
26159
26160 @noindent
26161 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
26162 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
26163
26164 @example
26165 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
26166 @end example
26167
26168 The script name may include directories if desired.
26169
26170 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
26171 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26172
26173 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
26174 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
26175 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
26176 will remove duplicates.
26177
26178 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
26179
26180 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
26181 itself instead of loading it from a file.
26182 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
26183 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
26184 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
26185 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
26186 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
26187 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
26188 on its name.
26189
26190 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
26191 testsuite.
26192
26193 @example
26194 #include "symcat.h"
26195 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
26196 asm(
26197 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
26198 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
26199 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
26200 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
26201 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
26202 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
26203 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
26204 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
26205 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
26206 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
26207 ".byte 0\n"
26208 ".popsection\n"
26209 );
26210 @end example
26211
26212 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
26213 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26214 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
26215 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
26216
26217 @node Which flavor to choose?
26218 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
26219
26220 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
26221 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
26222
26223 @noindent
26224 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
26225
26226 @itemize @bullet
26227 @item
26228 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
26229
26230 @item
26231 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
26232
26233 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
26234 in the source search path.
26235 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
26236 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
26237
26238 @item
26239 Doesn't require source code additions.
26240 @end itemize
26241
26242 @noindent
26243 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
26244
26245 @itemize @bullet
26246 @item
26247 Works with static linking.
26248
26249 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
26250 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
26251 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
26252 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
26253 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
26254
26255 @item
26256 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
26257
26258 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
26259 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
26260
26261 @item
26262 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
26263
26264 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
26265 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
26266 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
26267 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
26268 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
26269 top of the source tree to the source search path.
26270 @end itemize
26271
26272 @node Multiple Extension Languages
26273 @section Multiple Extension Languages
26274
26275 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
26276 and generally do not interfere with each other.
26277 There are some things to be aware of, however.
26278
26279 @subsection Python comes first
26280
26281 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
26282 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
26283 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
26284 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
26285 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
26286 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
26287 pretty-printed form of a value).
26288 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
26289 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
26290 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
26291
26292 @node Aliases
26293 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
26294 @cindex aliases for commands
26295
26296 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
26297 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
26298 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
26299 that involves less typing.
26300
26301 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
26302 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
26303 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
26304
26305 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
26306 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
26307 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
26308
26309 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
26310
26311 @table @code
26312
26313 @kindex alias
26314 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
26315
26316 @end table
26317
26318 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
26319 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
26320 underscores.
26321
26322 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
26323 that is being aliased.
26324
26325 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
26326 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
26327 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
26328
26329 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
26330 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
26331
26332 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
26333 of a command so that there is less to type.
26334 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
26335 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
26336 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
26337 The following will accomplish this.
26338
26339 @smallexample
26340 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
26341 @end smallexample
26342
26343 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
26344 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
26345 for it with the @samp{document} command.
26346 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
26347
26348 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
26349 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
26350 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
26351 of a command.
26352
26353 @smallexample
26354 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
26355 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
26356 (gdb) set p elms 20
26357 (gdb) show p elms
26358 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
26359 @end smallexample
26360
26361 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
26362 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
26363 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
26364
26365 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
26366 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
26367
26368 @smallexample
26369 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
26370 @end smallexample
26371
26372 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
26373 alias for a more complex command.
26374 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
26375
26376 @smallexample
26377 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
26378 (gdb) spe 20
26379 @end smallexample
26380
26381 @node Interpreters
26382 @chapter Command Interpreters
26383 @cindex command interpreters
26384
26385 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
26386 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
26387 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
26388
26389 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
26390 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
26391 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
26392 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
26393
26394 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
26395 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
26396 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
26397 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
26398
26399 @table @code
26400 @item console
26401 @cindex console interpreter
26402 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
26403 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
26404 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
26405
26406 @item mi
26407 @cindex mi interpreter
26408 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
26409 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
26410 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
26411 Interface}.
26412
26413 @item mi2
26414 @cindex mi2 interpreter
26415 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
26416
26417 @item mi1
26418 @cindex mi1 interpreter
26419 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
26420
26421 @end table
26422
26423 @cindex invoke another interpreter
26424
26425 @kindex interpreter-exec
26426 You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
26427 interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
26428 console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
26429
26430 @smallexample
26431 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
26432 @end smallexample
26433
26434 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
26435 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
26436
26437 Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
26438 duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
26439 permanently.
26440
26441 @cindex start a new independent interpreter
26442
26443 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
26444 possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
26445 device (usually a tty).
26446
26447 For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
26448 @value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
26449 emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
26450 command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
26451 terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
26452 input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
26453 at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
26454 while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
26455 the separate MI interpreter.
26456
26457 To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
26458 @code{new-ui} command:
26459
26460 @kindex new-ui
26461 @cindex new user interface
26462 @smallexample
26463 new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
26464 @end smallexample
26465
26466 The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
26467 This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
26468 For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
26469 @var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
26470 interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
26471 pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
26472
26473 @smallexample
26474 (@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
26475 @end smallexample
26476
26477 @noindent
26478 runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
26479
26480 @node TUI
26481 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
26482 @cindex TUI
26483 @cindex Text User Interface
26484
26485 @menu
26486 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
26487 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
26488 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
26489 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
26490 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
26491 @end menu
26492
26493 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
26494 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
26495 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
26496 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
26497 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
26498 is available.
26499
26500 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
26501 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
26502 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
26503 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
26504 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
26505 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
26506
26507 @node TUI Overview
26508 @section TUI Overview
26509
26510 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
26511
26512 @table @emph
26513 @item command
26514 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
26515 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
26516 managed using readline.
26517
26518 @item source
26519 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
26520 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
26521
26522 @item assembly
26523 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
26524
26525 @item register
26526 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
26527 when their values change.
26528 @end table
26529
26530 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
26531 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
26532 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
26533 indicates the breakpoint type:
26534
26535 @table @code
26536 @item B
26537 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
26538
26539 @item b
26540 Breakpoint which was never hit.
26541
26542 @item H
26543 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
26544
26545 @item h
26546 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
26547 @end table
26548
26549 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
26550
26551 @table @code
26552 @item +
26553 Breakpoint is enabled.
26554
26555 @item -
26556 Breakpoint is disabled.
26557 @end table
26558
26559 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
26560 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
26561 changes.
26562
26563 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
26564 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
26565 layouts:
26566
26567 @itemize @bullet
26568 @item
26569 source only,
26570
26571 @item
26572 assembly only,
26573
26574 @item
26575 source and assembly,
26576
26577 @item
26578 source and registers, or
26579
26580 @item
26581 assembly and registers.
26582 @end itemize
26583
26584 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
26585
26586 @table @emph
26587 @item target
26588 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
26589 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
26590
26591 @item process
26592 Gives the current process or thread number.
26593 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
26594
26595 @item function
26596 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
26597 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
26598 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
26599 the string @code{??} is displayed.
26600
26601 @item line
26602 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
26603 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
26604
26605 @item pc
26606 Indicates the current program counter address.
26607 @end table
26608
26609 @node TUI Keys
26610 @section TUI Key Bindings
26611 @cindex TUI key bindings
26612
26613 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
26614 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
26615 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
26616 @end ifset
26617 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
26618 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
26619 @end ifclear
26620 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
26621 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
26622
26623 @table @kbd
26624 @kindex C-x C-a
26625 @item C-x C-a
26626 @kindex C-x a
26627 @itemx C-x a
26628 @kindex C-x A
26629 @itemx C-x A
26630 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
26631 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
26632 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
26633 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
26634 The screen is then refreshed.
26635
26636 @kindex C-x 1
26637 @item C-x 1
26638 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
26639 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
26640 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
26641
26642 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
26643
26644 @kindex C-x 2
26645 @item C-x 2
26646 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
26647 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
26648 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
26649 previous layout and the new one.
26650
26651 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
26652
26653 @kindex C-x o
26654 @item C-x o
26655 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
26656 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
26657 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
26658
26659 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
26660
26661 @kindex C-x s
26662 @item C-x s
26663 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
26664 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
26665 @end table
26666
26667 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
26668
26669 @table @asis
26670 @kindex PgUp
26671 @item @key{PgUp}
26672 Scroll the active window one page up.
26673
26674 @kindex PgDn
26675 @item @key{PgDn}
26676 Scroll the active window one page down.
26677
26678 @kindex Up
26679 @item @key{Up}
26680 Scroll the active window one line up.
26681
26682 @kindex Down
26683 @item @key{Down}
26684 Scroll the active window one line down.
26685
26686 @kindex Left
26687 @item @key{Left}
26688 Scroll the active window one column left.
26689
26690 @kindex Right
26691 @item @key{Right}
26692 Scroll the active window one column right.
26693
26694 @kindex C-L
26695 @item @kbd{C-L}
26696 Refresh the screen.
26697 @end table
26698
26699 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
26700 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
26701 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
26702 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
26703 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
26704
26705 @node TUI Single Key Mode
26706 @section TUI Single Key Mode
26707 @cindex TUI single key mode
26708
26709 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
26710 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
26711 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
26712
26713 @table @kbd
26714 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26715 @item c
26716 continue
26717
26718 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26719 @item d
26720 down
26721
26722 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26723 @item f
26724 finish
26725
26726 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26727 @item n
26728 next
26729
26730 @kindex o @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26731 @item o
26732 nexti. The shortcut letter @samp{o} stands for ``step Over''.
26733
26734 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26735 @item q
26736 exit the SingleKey mode.
26737
26738 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26739 @item r
26740 run
26741
26742 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26743 @item s
26744 step
26745
26746 @kindex i @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26747 @item i
26748 stepi. The shortcut letter @samp{i} stands for ``step Into''.
26749
26750 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26751 @item u
26752 up
26753
26754 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26755 @item v
26756 info locals
26757
26758 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26759 @item w
26760 where
26761 @end table
26762
26763 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
26764 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
26765 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
26766 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
26767 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
26768 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
26769
26770
26771 @node TUI Commands
26772 @section TUI-specific Commands
26773 @cindex TUI commands
26774
26775 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
26776 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
26777 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
26778 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
26779
26780 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
26781 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
26782 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
26783 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
26784 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
26785
26786 @table @code
26787 @item tui enable
26788 @kindex tui enable
26789 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
26790 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
26791 otherwise a default layout is used.
26792
26793 @item tui disable
26794 @kindex tui disable
26795 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
26796
26797 @item info win
26798 @kindex info win
26799 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
26800
26801 @item layout @var{name}
26802 @kindex layout
26803 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
26804 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
26805 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
26806
26807 @table @code
26808 @item next
26809 Display the next layout.
26810
26811 @item prev
26812 Display the previous layout.
26813
26814 @item src
26815 Display the source and command windows.
26816
26817 @item asm
26818 Display the assembly and command windows.
26819
26820 @item split
26821 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
26822
26823 @item regs
26824 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
26825 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
26826 register, assembler, and command windows.
26827 @end table
26828
26829 @item focus @var{name}
26830 @kindex focus
26831 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
26832 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
26833
26834 @table @code
26835 @item next
26836 Make the next window active for scrolling.
26837
26838 @item prev
26839 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
26840
26841 @item src
26842 Make the source window active for scrolling.
26843
26844 @item asm
26845 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
26846
26847 @item regs
26848 Make the register window active for scrolling.
26849
26850 @item cmd
26851 Make the command window active for scrolling.
26852 @end table
26853
26854 @item refresh
26855 @kindex refresh
26856 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
26857
26858 @item tui reg @var{group}
26859 @kindex tui reg
26860 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
26861 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
26862 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
26863 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
26864 following groups are available on most targets:
26865 @table @code
26866 @item next
26867 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
26868 through all of the available register groups.
26869
26870 @item prev
26871 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
26872 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
26873 @var{next}.
26874
26875 @item general
26876 Display the general registers.
26877 @item float
26878 Display the floating point registers.
26879 @item system
26880 Display the system registers.
26881 @item vector
26882 Display the vector registers.
26883 @item all
26884 Display all registers.
26885 @end table
26886
26887 @item update
26888 @kindex update
26889 Update the source window and the current execution point.
26890
26891 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
26892 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
26893 @kindex winheight
26894 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
26895 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
26896 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
26897 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
26898 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
26899 @end table
26900
26901 @node TUI Configuration
26902 @section TUI Configuration Variables
26903 @cindex TUI configuration variables
26904
26905 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
26906
26907 @table @code
26908 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
26909 @kindex set tui border-kind
26910 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
26911 The possible values are the following:
26912 @table @code
26913 @item space
26914 Use a space character to draw the border.
26915
26916 @item ascii
26917 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
26918
26919 @item acs
26920 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
26921 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
26922 @end table
26923
26924 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
26925 @kindex set tui border-mode
26926 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
26927 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
26928 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
26929 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
26930 @table @code
26931 @item normal
26932 Use normal attributes to display the border.
26933
26934 @item standout
26935 Use standout mode.
26936
26937 @item reverse
26938 Use reverse video mode.
26939
26940 @item half
26941 Use half bright mode.
26942
26943 @item half-standout
26944 Use half bright and standout mode.
26945
26946 @item bold
26947 Use extra bright or bold mode.
26948
26949 @item bold-standout
26950 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
26951 @end table
26952
26953 @item set tui tab-width @var{nchars}
26954 @kindex set tui tab-width
26955 @kindex tabset
26956 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
26957 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
26958 assembly windows.
26959 @end table
26960
26961 @node Emacs
26962 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
26963
26964 @cindex Emacs
26965 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
26966 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
26967 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
26968 @value{GDBN}.
26969
26970 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
26971 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
26972 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
26973 created Emacs buffer.
26974 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
26975
26976 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
26977 things:
26978
26979 @itemize @bullet
26980 @item
26981 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
26982 the GUD buffer.
26983
26984 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
26985 and output done by the program you are debugging.
26986
26987 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
26988 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
26989 in this way.
26990
26991 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
26992 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
26993 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
26994 stop.
26995
26996 @item
26997 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
26998
26999 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
27000 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
27001 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
27002 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
27003 and the source.
27004
27005 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
27006 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
27007 @end itemize
27008
27009 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
27010 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
27011 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
27012 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
27013
27014 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
27015 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
27016 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
27017 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
27018 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
27019 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
27020 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
27021 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
27022 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
27023
27024 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
27025 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
27026 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
27027 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
27028
27029 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
27030 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
27031 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
27032 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
27033 one you want.
27034
27035 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
27036 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
27037
27038 @table @kbd
27039 @item C-h m
27040 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
27041
27042 @item C-c C-s
27043 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
27044 update the display window to show the current file and location.
27045
27046 @item C-c C-n
27047 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
27048 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
27049 to show the current file and location.
27050
27051 @item C-c C-i
27052 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
27053 display window accordingly.
27054
27055 @item C-c C-f
27056 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
27057 @code{finish} command.
27058
27059 @item C-c C-r
27060 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
27061 command.
27062
27063 @item C-c <
27064 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
27065 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
27066 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
27067
27068 @item C-c >
27069 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
27070 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
27071 @end table
27072
27073 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
27074 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
27075
27076 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
27077 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
27078 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
27079 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
27080 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
27081 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
27082 speedbar displays watch expressions.
27083
27084 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
27085 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
27086 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
27087 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
27088 frame.
27089
27090 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
27091 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
27092 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
27093 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
27094 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
27095 to correspond properly with the code.
27096
27097 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
27098 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
27099 Emacs Manual}).
27100
27101 @node GDB/MI
27102 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
27103
27104 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
27105
27106 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
27107 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
27108 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
27109 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
27110 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
27111 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
27112
27113 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
27114 in the form of a reference manual.
27115
27116 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
27117 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
27118 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
27119
27120 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
27121
27122 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
27123 This chapter uses the following notation:
27124
27125 @itemize @bullet
27126 @item
27127 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
27128
27129 @item
27130 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
27131 it may or may not be given.
27132
27133 @item
27134 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
27135 may repeat zero or more times.
27136
27137 @item
27138 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
27139 may repeat one or more times.
27140
27141 @item
27142 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
27143 @end itemize
27144
27145 @ignore
27146 @heading Dependencies
27147 @end ignore
27148
27149 @menu
27150 * GDB/MI General Design::
27151 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
27152 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
27153 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
27154 * GDB/MI Output Records::
27155 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
27156 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
27157 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
27158 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27159 * GDB/MI Program Context::
27160 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
27161 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
27162 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
27163 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
27164 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
27165 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
27166 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
27167 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
27168 * GDB/MI File Commands::
27169 @ignore
27170 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
27171 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
27172 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
27173 @end ignore
27174 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
27175 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
27176 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
27177 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
27178 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
27179 @end menu
27180
27181 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27182 @node GDB/MI General Design
27183 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
27184 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
27185
27186 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
27187 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
27188 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
27189 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
27190 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
27191 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
27192 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
27193 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
27194 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
27195 a command and reported as part of that command response.
27196
27197 The important examples of notifications are:
27198 @itemize @bullet
27199
27200 @item
27201 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
27202 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
27203 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
27204 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
27205 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
27206 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
27207 command itself was successfully executed.
27208
27209 @item
27210 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
27211 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
27212 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
27213 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
27214 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
27215 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
27216
27217 @item
27218 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
27219 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
27220 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
27221 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
27222 orthogonal frontend design.
27223
27224 @end itemize
27225
27226 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
27227 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
27228 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
27229 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
27230 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
27231 the user interface.
27232
27233
27234 @menu
27235 * Context management::
27236 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
27237 * Thread groups::
27238 @end menu
27239
27240 @node Context management
27241 @subsection Context management
27242
27243 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
27244
27245 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
27246 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
27247 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
27248 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
27249 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
27250 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
27251 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
27252 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
27253 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
27254
27255 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
27256 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
27257 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
27258 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
27259 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
27260 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
27261 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
27262 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
27263 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
27264 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
27265 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
27266
27267 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
27268 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
27269 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
27270 current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a
27271 breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
27272 hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
27273 @samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
27274 frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN}
27275 communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
27276 @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
27277
27278 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
27279 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
27280 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
27281 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
27282 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
27283 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
27284 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
27285 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
27286 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
27287 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
27288 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
27289 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
27290 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
27291 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
27292 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
27293 @samp{--frame} options.
27294
27295 @subsubsection Language
27296
27297 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
27298 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
27299 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
27300 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
27301 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
27302 For instance:
27303
27304 @smallexample
27305 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
27306 ^done,value="4"
27307 (gdb)
27308 @end smallexample
27309
27310 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
27311 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
27312 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
27313
27314 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
27315 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
27316
27317 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
27318 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
27319 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
27320 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
27321 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
27322 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
27323 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
27324 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
27325 @code{-list-target-features} command.
27326
27327 @table @code
27328 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
27329 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
27330 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
27331
27332 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
27333 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
27334 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
27335
27336 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
27337 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
27338 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
27339 MI commands even while the target is running.
27340
27341 @item -gdb-show mi-async
27342 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
27343 @end table
27344
27345 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
27346 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
27347 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
27348 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
27349 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
27350 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
27351
27352 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
27353 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
27354 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
27355 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
27356 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
27357 are running.
27358
27359 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
27360 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
27361 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
27362 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
27363 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
27364 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
27365 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
27366 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
27367 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
27368 @samp{--thread} option).
27369
27370 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
27371 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
27372 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
27373 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
27374
27375 @node Thread groups
27376 @subsection Thread groups
27377 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
27378 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
27379 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
27380 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
27381 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
27382
27383 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
27384 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
27385 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
27386 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
27387 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
27388 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
27389 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
27390 into processes.
27391
27392 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
27393 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
27394 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
27395 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
27396 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
27397 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
27398 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
27399 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
27400 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
27401 the members of specific thread group.
27402
27403 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
27404 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
27405 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
27406 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
27407 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
27408 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
27409 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
27410 after attaching to that thread group.
27411
27412 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
27413 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
27414 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
27415 such thread groups.
27416
27417 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27418 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
27419 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
27420
27421 @menu
27422 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
27423 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
27424 @end menu
27425
27426 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
27427 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
27428
27429 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
27430 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
27431 @table @code
27432 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
27433 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
27434
27435 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
27436 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
27437 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
27438
27439 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
27440 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
27441 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
27442
27443 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
27444 "any sequence of digits"
27445
27446 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
27447 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
27448
27449 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
27450 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
27451
27452 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
27453 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
27454
27455 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
27456 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
27457 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
27458
27459 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
27460 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
27461
27462 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
27463 @code{CR | CR-LF}
27464 @end table
27465
27466 @noindent
27467 Notes:
27468
27469 @itemize @bullet
27470 @item
27471 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
27472 output is described below.
27473
27474 @item
27475 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
27476 finishes.
27477
27478 @item
27479 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
27480 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
27481 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
27482 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
27483 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
27484 @end itemize
27485
27486 Pragmatics:
27487
27488 @itemize @bullet
27489 @item
27490 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
27491
27492 @item
27493 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
27494 @end itemize
27495
27496 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
27497 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
27498
27499 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
27500 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
27501 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
27502 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
27503 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
27504 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
27505
27506 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
27507 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
27508 @var{token}.
27509
27510 @table @code
27511 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
27512 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
27513
27514 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
27515 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
27516
27517 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
27518 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
27519
27520 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
27521 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
27522
27523 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
27524 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
27525
27526 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
27527 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
27528
27529 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
27530 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
27531
27532 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
27533 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
27534
27535 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
27536 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
27537
27538 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
27539 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
27540 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
27541
27542 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
27543 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
27544
27545 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
27546 @code{ @var{string} }
27547
27548 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
27549 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
27550
27551 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
27552 @code{@var{c-string}}
27553
27554 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
27555 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
27556
27557 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
27558 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
27559 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
27560
27561 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
27562 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
27563
27564 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
27565 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
27566
27567 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
27568 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
27569
27570 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
27571 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
27572
27573 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
27574 @code{CR | CR-LF}
27575
27576 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
27577 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
27578 @end table
27579
27580 @noindent
27581 Notes:
27582
27583 @itemize @bullet
27584 @item
27585 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
27586
27587 @item
27588 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
27589 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
27590 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
27591 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
27592 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
27593 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
27594 prior command.
27595
27596 @item
27597 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27598 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
27599 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
27600 prefixed by @samp{+}.
27601
27602 @item
27603 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27604 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
27605 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
27606 @samp{*}.
27607
27608 @item
27609 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27610 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
27611 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
27612 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
27613
27614 @item
27615 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27616 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
27617 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
27618 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
27619
27620 @item
27621 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27622 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
27623 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
27624
27625 @item
27626 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27627 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
27628 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
27629 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
27630
27631 @item
27632 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27633 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
27634 @var{values}.
27635
27636
27637 @end itemize
27638
27639 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
27640 details about the various output records.
27641
27642 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27643 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
27644 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
27645
27646 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
27647 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
27648
27649 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
27650 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
27651 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
27652 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
27653 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
27654 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
27655
27656 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
27657 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
27658 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
27659
27660 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27661 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
27662 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
27663 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
27664
27665 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
27666 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
27667
27668 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
27669 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
27670 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
27671 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
27672 might change.
27673
27674 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
27675 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
27676 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
27677 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
27678
27679 @itemize @bullet
27680 @item
27681 New MI commands may be added.
27682
27683 @item
27684 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
27685
27686 @item
27687 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
27688 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
27689
27690 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
27691 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
27692
27693 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
27694 @c resolve inconsistencies.
27695 @end itemize
27696
27697 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
27698 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
27699 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
27700 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
27701 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
27702
27703 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
27704 @c version?
27705
27706 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
27707 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
27708 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
27709 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
27710 @cindex mailing lists
27711
27712 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27713 @node GDB/MI Output Records
27714 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
27715
27716 @menu
27717 * GDB/MI Result Records::
27718 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
27719 * GDB/MI Async Records::
27720 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
27721 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
27722 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
27723 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
27724 @end menu
27725
27726 @node GDB/MI Result Records
27727 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
27728
27729 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27730 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
27731 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
27732 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
27733
27734 @table @code
27735 @findex ^done
27736 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
27737 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
27738 values.
27739
27740 @item "^running"
27741 @findex ^running
27742 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
27743 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
27744 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
27745 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
27746 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
27747 which threads are resumed.
27748
27749 @item "^connected"
27750 @findex ^connected
27751 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
27752
27753 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
27754 @findex ^error
27755 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
27756 the corresponding error message.
27757
27758 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
27759 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
27760 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
27761
27762 @table @samp
27763 @item "undefined-command"
27764 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
27765 @end table
27766
27767 @item "^exit"
27768 @findex ^exit
27769 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
27770
27771 @end table
27772
27773 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
27774 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
27775
27776 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
27777 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27778 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
27779 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
27780 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
27781
27782 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
27783 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
27784 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
27785 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
27786 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
27787
27788 @table @code
27789 @item "~" @var{string-output}
27790 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
27791 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
27792
27793 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
27794 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
27795 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
27796 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
27797
27798 @item "&" @var{string-output}
27799 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
27800 internals.
27801 @end table
27802
27803 @node GDB/MI Async Records
27804 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
27805
27806 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27807 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
27808 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
27809 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
27810 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
27811 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
27812
27813 The following is the list of possible async records:
27814
27815 @table @code
27816
27817 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
27818 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
27819 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
27820 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
27821 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
27822 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
27823 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
27824 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
27825 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
27826 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
27827 it run freely.
27828
27829 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
27830 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
27831 following values:
27832
27833 @table @code
27834 @item breakpoint-hit
27835 A breakpoint was reached.
27836 @item watchpoint-trigger
27837 A watchpoint was triggered.
27838 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
27839 A read watchpoint was triggered.
27840 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
27841 An access watchpoint was triggered.
27842 @item function-finished
27843 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
27844 @item location-reached
27845 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
27846 @item watchpoint-scope
27847 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
27848 @item end-stepping-range
27849 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
27850 similar CLI command was accomplished.
27851 @item exited-signalled
27852 The inferior exited because of a signal.
27853 @item exited
27854 The inferior exited.
27855 @item exited-normally
27856 The inferior exited normally.
27857 @item signal-received
27858 A signal was received by the inferior.
27859 @item solib-event
27860 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
27861 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
27862 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
27863 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
27864 @item fork
27865 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
27866 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27867 @item vfork
27868 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
27869 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27870 @item syscall-entry
27871 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
27872 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27873 @item syscall-return
27874 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
27875 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27876 @item exec
27877 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
27878 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27879 @end table
27880
27881 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
27882 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
27883 Depending on whether all-stop
27884 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
27885 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
27886 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
27887 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
27888 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
27889 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
27890 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
27891 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
27892 if such information is not available.
27893
27894 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
27895 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
27896 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
27897 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
27898 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
27899 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
27900 cannot be used in any way.
27901
27902 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
27903 A thread group became associated with a running program,
27904 either because the program was just started or the thread group
27905 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
27906 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
27907 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
27908
27909 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
27910 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
27911 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
27912 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
27913 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
27914 only when the inferior exited with some code.
27915
27916 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
27917 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
27918 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
27919 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
27920 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
27921
27922 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
27923 Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification
27924 is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
27925 @code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
27926 that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
27927 changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
27928 (via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
27929 will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another
27930 user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
27931
27932 The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
27933 stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
27934
27935 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
27936 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
27937 that thread.
27938
27939 @item =library-loaded,...
27940 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
27941 notification has 5 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
27942 @var{host-name}, @var{symbols-loaded} and @var{ranges}. The @var{id} field is an
27943 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
27944 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
27945 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
27946 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
27947 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
27948 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
27949 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
27950 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
27951 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
27952 thread groups. The @var{ranges} field specifies the ranges of addresses belonging
27953 to this library.
27954
27955 @item =library-unloaded,...
27956 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
27957 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
27958 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
27959 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
27960 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
27961 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
27962 thread groups.
27963
27964 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
27965 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
27966 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
27967 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
27968 frame is @var{tpnum}.
27969
27970 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
27971 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
27972 initial value @var{initial}.
27973
27974 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
27975 @itemx =tsv-deleted
27976 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
27977 trace state variables are deleted.
27978
27979 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
27980 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
27981 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
27982 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
27983 value of trace state variable is known.
27984
27985 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
27986 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
27987 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
27988 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
27989 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
27990 user.
27991
27992 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
27993 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
27994 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
27995
27996 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
27997 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
27998
27999 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
28000 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
28001 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
28002 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
28003 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
28004
28005 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
28006 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
28007 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay},
28008 for existing method and format values.
28009
28010 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
28011 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
28012 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
28013 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
28014 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
28015 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
28016
28017 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
28018 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
28019 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
28020 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
28021 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
28022 executable code.
28023 @end table
28024
28025 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
28026 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
28027
28028 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
28029 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
28030 following fields:
28031
28032 @table @code
28033 @item number
28034 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
28035 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
28036 @samp{1.2}.
28037
28038 @item type
28039 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
28040 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
28041
28042 @item catch-type
28043 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
28044 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
28045
28046 @item disp
28047 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
28048 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
28049 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
28050
28051 @item enabled
28052 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
28053 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
28054 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
28055
28056 @item addr
28057 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
28058 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
28059 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
28060 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
28061 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
28062
28063 @item func
28064 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
28065 If not known, this field is not present.
28066
28067 @item filename
28068 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
28069 If not known, this field is not present.
28070
28071 @item fullname
28072 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
28073 known. If not known, this field is not present.
28074
28075 @item line
28076 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
28077 If not known, this field is not present.
28078
28079 @item at
28080 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
28081 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
28082 by a symbol name.
28083
28084 @item pending
28085 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
28086 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
28087
28088 @item evaluated-by
28089 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
28090 @samp{target}.
28091
28092 @item thread
28093 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
28094 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
28095
28096 @item task
28097 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
28098 field will hold the task identifier.
28099
28100 @item cond
28101 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
28102
28103 @item ignore
28104 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
28105
28106 @item enable
28107 The enable count of the breakpoint.
28108
28109 @item traceframe-usage
28110 FIXME.
28111
28112 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
28113 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
28114
28115 @item mask
28116 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
28117
28118 @item pass
28119 A tracepoint's pass count.
28120
28121 @item original-location
28122 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
28123 This field is optional.
28124
28125 @item times
28126 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
28127
28128 @item installed
28129 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
28130 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
28131 is not.
28132
28133 @item what
28134 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
28135
28136 @end table
28137
28138 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
28139 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
28140
28141 @smallexample
28142 -> -break-insert main
28143 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28144 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
28145 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
28146 times="0"@}
28147 <- (gdb)
28148 @end smallexample
28149
28150 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
28151 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
28152
28153 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
28154 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
28155 fields:
28156
28157 @table @code
28158 @item level
28159 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
28160 zero. This field is always present.
28161
28162 @item func
28163 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
28164 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
28165
28166 @item addr
28167 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
28168
28169 @item file
28170 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
28171 address. This field may be absent.
28172
28173 @item line
28174 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
28175 may be absent.
28176
28177 @item from
28178 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
28179 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
28180
28181 @end table
28182
28183 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
28184 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
28185
28186 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
28187 uses a tuple with the following fields. The fields are always present unless
28188 stated otherwise.
28189
28190 @table @code
28191 @item id
28192 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}.
28193
28194 @item target-id
28195 The target-specific string identifying the thread.
28196
28197 @item details
28198 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
28199 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
28200 frontend. This field is optional.
28201
28202 @item name
28203 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
28204 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
28205 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
28206 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
28207 field is omitted.
28208
28209 @item state
28210 The execution state of the thread, either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running},
28211 depending on whether the thread is presently running.
28212
28213 @item frame
28214 The stack frame currently executing in the thread. This field is only present
28215 if the thread is stopped. Its format is documented in
28216 @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information}.
28217
28218 @item core
28219 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
28220 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
28221 @end table
28222
28223 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
28224 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
28225
28226 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
28227 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
28228 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
28229 the @code{exception-name} field. Also, for exceptions that were raised
28230 with an exception message, @value{GDBN} provides that message via
28231 the @code{exception-message} field.
28232
28233 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28234 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
28235 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
28236 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
28237
28238 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
28239 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
28240 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
28241 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
28242
28243 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
28244 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
28245
28246 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
28247
28248 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
28249 information of the breakpoint.
28250
28251 @smallexample
28252 -> -break-insert main
28253 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28254 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
28255 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
28256 times="0"@}
28257 <- (gdb)
28258 @end smallexample
28259
28260 @subheading Program Execution
28261
28262 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
28263 reason that execution stopped.
28264
28265 @smallexample
28266 -> -exec-run
28267 <- ^running
28268 <- (gdb)
28269 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
28270 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
28271 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
28272 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",
28273 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28274 <- (gdb)
28275 -> -exec-continue
28276 <- ^running
28277 <- (gdb)
28278 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28279 <- (gdb)
28280 @end smallexample
28281
28282 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
28283
28284 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
28285
28286 @smallexample
28287 -> (gdb)
28288 <- -gdb-exit
28289 <- ^exit
28290 @end smallexample
28291
28292 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
28293 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
28294 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
28295 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
28296 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
28297 fails to exit in reasonable time.
28298
28299 @subheading A Bad Command
28300
28301 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
28302
28303 @smallexample
28304 -> -rubbish
28305 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
28306 <- (gdb)
28307 @end smallexample
28308
28309
28310 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28311 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
28312 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
28313
28314 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
28315 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
28316
28317 @subheading Motivation
28318
28319 The motivation for this collection of commands.
28320
28321 @subheading Introduction
28322
28323 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
28324
28325 @subheading Commands
28326
28327 For each command in the block, the following is described:
28328
28329 @subsubheading Synopsis
28330
28331 @smallexample
28332 -command @var{args}@dots{}
28333 @end smallexample
28334
28335 @subsubheading Result
28336
28337 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28338
28339 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
28340
28341 @subsubheading Example
28342
28343 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
28344 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
28345
28346
28347 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28348 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
28349 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
28350
28351 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
28352 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
28353 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
28354 breakpoints.
28355
28356 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
28357 @findex -break-after
28358
28359 @subsubheading Synopsis
28360
28361 @smallexample
28362 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
28363 @end smallexample
28364
28365 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
28366 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
28367 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
28368 @samp{-break-list} command below.
28369
28370 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28371
28372 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
28373
28374 @subsubheading Example
28375
28376 @smallexample
28377 (gdb)
28378 -break-insert main
28379 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28380 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
28381 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28382 times="0"@}
28383 (gdb)
28384 -break-after 1 3
28385 ~
28386 ^done
28387 (gdb)
28388 -break-list
28389 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28390 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28391 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28392 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28393 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28394 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28395 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28396 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28397 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28398 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
28399 (gdb)
28400 @end smallexample
28401
28402 @ignore
28403 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
28404 @findex -break-catch
28405 @end ignore
28406
28407 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
28408 @findex -break-commands
28409
28410 @subsubheading Synopsis
28411
28412 @smallexample
28413 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
28414 @end smallexample
28415
28416 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
28417 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
28418 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
28419 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
28420 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
28421 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
28422
28423 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28424
28425 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
28426
28427 @subsubheading Example
28428
28429 @smallexample
28430 (gdb)
28431 -break-insert main
28432 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28433 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
28434 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28435 times="0"@}
28436 (gdb)
28437 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
28438 ^done
28439 (gdb)
28440 @end smallexample
28441
28442 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
28443 @findex -break-condition
28444
28445 @subsubheading Synopsis
28446
28447 @smallexample
28448 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
28449 @end smallexample
28450
28451 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
28452 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
28453 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
28454 command below).
28455
28456 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28457
28458 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
28459
28460 @subsubheading Example
28461
28462 @smallexample
28463 (gdb)
28464 -break-condition 1 1
28465 ^done
28466 (gdb)
28467 -break-list
28468 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28469 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28470 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28471 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28472 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28473 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28474 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28475 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28476 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28477 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
28478 (gdb)
28479 @end smallexample
28480
28481 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
28482 @findex -break-delete
28483
28484 @subsubheading Synopsis
28485
28486 @smallexample
28487 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28488 @end smallexample
28489
28490 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
28491 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
28492
28493 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28494
28495 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
28496
28497 @subsubheading Example
28498
28499 @smallexample
28500 (gdb)
28501 -break-delete 1
28502 ^done
28503 (gdb)
28504 -break-list
28505 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
28506 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28507 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28508 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28509 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28510 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28511 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28512 body=[]@}
28513 (gdb)
28514 @end smallexample
28515
28516 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
28517 @findex -break-disable
28518
28519 @subsubheading Synopsis
28520
28521 @smallexample
28522 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28523 @end smallexample
28524
28525 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
28526 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
28527
28528 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28529
28530 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
28531
28532 @subsubheading Example
28533
28534 @smallexample
28535 (gdb)
28536 -break-disable 2
28537 ^done
28538 (gdb)
28539 -break-list
28540 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28541 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28542 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28543 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28544 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28545 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28546 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28547 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
28548 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28549 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28550 (gdb)
28551 @end smallexample
28552
28553 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
28554 @findex -break-enable
28555
28556 @subsubheading Synopsis
28557
28558 @smallexample
28559 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28560 @end smallexample
28561
28562 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
28563
28564 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28565
28566 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
28567
28568 @subsubheading Example
28569
28570 @smallexample
28571 (gdb)
28572 -break-enable 2
28573 ^done
28574 (gdb)
28575 -break-list
28576 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28577 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28578 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28579 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28580 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28581 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28582 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28583 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28584 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28585 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28586 (gdb)
28587 @end smallexample
28588
28589 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
28590 @findex -break-info
28591
28592 @subsubheading Synopsis
28593
28594 @smallexample
28595 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
28596 @end smallexample
28597
28598 @c REDUNDANT???
28599 Get information about a single breakpoint.
28600
28601 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
28602 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
28603 table.
28604
28605 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28606
28607 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
28608
28609 @subsubheading Example
28610 N.A.
28611
28612 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
28613 @findex -break-insert
28614 @anchor{-break-insert}
28615
28616 @subsubheading Synopsis
28617
28618 @smallexample
28619 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
28620 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
28621 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
28622 @end smallexample
28623
28624 @noindent
28625 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
28626
28627 @table @var
28628 @item linespec location
28629 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
28630
28631 @item explicit location
28632 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
28633 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
28634 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
28635
28636 @table @samp
28637 @item --source @var{filename}
28638 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
28639 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
28640
28641 @item --function @var{function}
28642 The name of a function or method.
28643
28644 @item --label @var{label}
28645 The name of a label.
28646
28647 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
28648 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
28649 @end table
28650
28651 @item address location
28652 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
28653 @end table
28654
28655 @noindent
28656 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
28657
28658 @table @samp
28659 @item -t
28660 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
28661 @item -h
28662 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
28663 @item -f
28664 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
28665 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
28666 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
28667 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
28668 cannot be parsed.
28669 @item -d
28670 Create a disabled breakpoint.
28671 @item -a
28672 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
28673 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
28674 @item -c @var{condition}
28675 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28676 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
28677 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
28678 @item -p @var{thread-id}
28679 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
28680 @var{thread-id}.
28681 @end table
28682
28683 @subsubheading Result
28684
28685 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
28686 resulting breakpoint.
28687
28688 Note: this format is open to change.
28689 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
28690
28691 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28692
28693 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
28694 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
28695
28696 @subsubheading Example
28697
28698 @smallexample
28699 (gdb)
28700 -break-insert main
28701 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
28702 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
28703 times="0"@}
28704 (gdb)
28705 -break-insert -t foo
28706 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
28707 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28708 times="0"@}
28709 (gdb)
28710 -break-list
28711 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28712 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28713 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28714 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28715 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28716 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28717 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28718 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28719 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
28720 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
28721 times="0"@},
28722 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
28723 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
28724 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28725 times="0"@}]@}
28726 (gdb)
28727 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
28728 @c ~int foo(int, int);
28729 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
28730 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28731 @c times="0"@}
28732 @c (gdb)
28733 @end smallexample
28734
28735 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
28736 @findex -dprintf-insert
28737
28738 @subsubheading Synopsis
28739
28740 @smallexample
28741 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
28742 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
28743 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
28744 [ @var{argument} ]
28745 @end smallexample
28746
28747 @noindent
28748 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
28749 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
28750
28751 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
28752
28753 @table @samp
28754 @item -t
28755 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
28756 @item -f
28757 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
28758 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
28759 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
28760 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
28761 cannot be parsed.
28762 @item -d
28763 Create a disabled breakpoint.
28764 @item -c @var{condition}
28765 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28766 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
28767 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
28768 to @var{ignore-count}.
28769 @item -p @var{thread-id}
28770 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
28771 @var{thread-id}.
28772 @end table
28773
28774 @subsubheading Result
28775
28776 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
28777 resulting breakpoint.
28778
28779 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
28780
28781 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28782
28783 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
28784
28785 @subsubheading Example
28786
28787 @smallexample
28788 (gdb)
28789 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
28790 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28791 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
28792 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
28793 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
28794 original-location="foo"@}
28795 (gdb)
28796 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
28797 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28798 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
28799 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
28800 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
28801 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
28802 (gdb)
28803 @end smallexample
28804
28805 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
28806 @findex -break-list
28807
28808 @subsubheading Synopsis
28809
28810 @smallexample
28811 -break-list
28812 @end smallexample
28813
28814 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
28815
28816 @table @samp
28817 @item Number
28818 number of the breakpoint
28819 @item Type
28820 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
28821 @item Disposition
28822 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
28823 or @samp{nokeep}
28824 @item Enabled
28825 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
28826 @item Address
28827 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
28828 @item What
28829 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
28830 name, line number
28831 @item Thread-groups
28832 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
28833 @item Times
28834 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
28835 @end table
28836
28837 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
28838 @code{body} field is an empty list.
28839
28840 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28841
28842 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
28843
28844 @subsubheading Example
28845
28846 @smallexample
28847 (gdb)
28848 -break-list
28849 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28850 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28851 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28852 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28853 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28854 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28855 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28856 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28857 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28858 times="0"@},
28859 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28860 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28861 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28862 (gdb)
28863 @end smallexample
28864
28865 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
28866
28867 @smallexample
28868 (gdb)
28869 -break-list
28870 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
28871 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28872 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28873 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28874 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28875 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28876 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28877 body=[]@}
28878 (gdb)
28879 @end smallexample
28880
28881 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
28882 @findex -break-passcount
28883
28884 @subsubheading Synopsis
28885
28886 @smallexample
28887 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
28888 @end smallexample
28889
28890 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
28891 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
28892 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
28893 command @samp{passcount}.
28894
28895 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
28896 @findex -break-watch
28897
28898 @subsubheading Synopsis
28899
28900 @smallexample
28901 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
28902 @end smallexample
28903
28904 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
28905 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
28906 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
28907 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
28908 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
28909 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
28910 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
28911 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
28912
28913 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
28914 breakpoints inserted.
28915
28916 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28917
28918 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
28919 @samp{rwatch}.
28920
28921 @subsubheading Example
28922
28923 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
28924
28925 @smallexample
28926 (gdb)
28927 -break-watch x
28928 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
28929 (gdb)
28930 -exec-continue
28931 ^running
28932 (gdb)
28933 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
28934 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
28935 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28936 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28937 (gdb)
28938 @end smallexample
28939
28940 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
28941 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
28942 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
28943
28944 @smallexample
28945 (gdb)
28946 -break-watch C
28947 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
28948 (gdb)
28949 -exec-continue
28950 ^running
28951 (gdb)
28952 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
28953 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
28954 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28955 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28956 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
28957 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28958 (gdb)
28959 -exec-continue
28960 ^running
28961 (gdb)
28962 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
28963 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
28964 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28965 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28966 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
28967 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28968 (gdb)
28969 @end smallexample
28970
28971 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
28972 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
28973 deleted.
28974
28975 @smallexample
28976 (gdb)
28977 -break-watch C
28978 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
28979 (gdb)
28980 -break-list
28981 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28982 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28983 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28984 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28985 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28986 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28987 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28988 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28989 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28990 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28991 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
28992 times="1"@},
28993 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
28994 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28995 (gdb)
28996 -exec-continue
28997 ^running
28998 (gdb)
28999 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
29000 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
29001 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
29002 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29003 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
29004 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29005 (gdb)
29006 -break-list
29007 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
29008 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29009 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29010 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29011 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29012 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29013 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29014 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29015 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29016 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29017 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
29018 times="1"@},
29019 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
29020 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
29021 (gdb)
29022 -exec-continue
29023 ^running
29024 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
29025 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
29026 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
29027 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29028 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
29029 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29030 (gdb)
29031 -break-list
29032 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
29033 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29034 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29035 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29036 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29037 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29038 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29039 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29040 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29041 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29042 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
29043 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
29044 (gdb)
29045 @end smallexample
29046
29047
29048 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29049 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
29050 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
29051
29052 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
29053 catchpoints.
29054
29055 @menu
29056 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
29057 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
29058 @end menu
29059
29060 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
29061 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
29062
29063 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
29064 @findex -catch-load
29065
29066 @subsubheading Synopsis
29067
29068 @smallexample
29069 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
29070 @end smallexample
29071
29072 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
29073 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
29074 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
29075 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
29076 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
29077
29078
29079 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29080
29081 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
29082
29083 @subsubheading Example
29084
29085 @smallexample
29086 -catch-load -t foo.so
29087 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
29088 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
29089 (gdb)
29090 @end smallexample
29091
29092
29093 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
29094 @findex -catch-unload
29095
29096 @subsubheading Synopsis
29097
29098 @smallexample
29099 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
29100 @end smallexample
29101
29102 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
29103 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
29104 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
29105 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
29106 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
29107
29108 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29109
29110 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
29111
29112 @subsubheading Example
29113
29114 @smallexample
29115 -catch-unload -d bar.so
29116 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
29117 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
29118 (gdb)
29119 @end smallexample
29120
29121 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
29122 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
29123
29124 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
29125 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
29126
29127 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
29128 @findex -catch-assert
29129
29130 @subsubheading Synopsis
29131
29132 @smallexample
29133 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
29134 @end smallexample
29135
29136 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
29137
29138 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
29139
29140 @table @samp
29141 @item -c @var{condition}
29142 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29143 @item -d
29144 Create a disabled catchpoint.
29145 @item -t
29146 Create a temporary catchpoint.
29147 @end table
29148
29149 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29150
29151 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
29152
29153 @subsubheading Example
29154
29155 @smallexample
29156 -catch-assert
29157 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29158 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
29159 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
29160 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
29161 (gdb)
29162 @end smallexample
29163
29164 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
29165 @findex -catch-exception
29166
29167 @subsubheading Synopsis
29168
29169 @smallexample
29170 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
29171 [ -t ] [ -u ]
29172 @end smallexample
29173
29174 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
29175 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
29176 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
29177 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
29178 catchpoints.
29179
29180 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
29181
29182 @table @samp
29183 @item -c @var{condition}
29184 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29185 @item -d
29186 Create a disabled catchpoint.
29187 @item -e @var{exception-name}
29188 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
29189 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
29190 @item -t
29191 Create a temporary catchpoint.
29192 @item -u
29193 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
29194 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
29195 @end table
29196
29197 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29198
29199 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
29200 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
29201
29202 @subsubheading Example
29203
29204 @smallexample
29205 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
29206 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29207 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
29208 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
29209 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
29210 (gdb)
29211 @end smallexample
29212
29213 @subheading The @code{-catch-handlers} Command
29214 @findex -catch-handlers
29215
29216 @subsubheading Synopsis
29217
29218 @smallexample
29219 -catch-handlers [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
29220 [ -t ]
29221 @end smallexample
29222
29223 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are handled.
29224 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
29225 gets handled. But it is also possible, by using some of the
29226 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
29227 catchpoints.
29228
29229 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
29230
29231 @table @samp
29232 @item -c @var{condition}
29233 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29234 @item -d
29235 Create a disabled catchpoint.
29236 @item -e @var{exception-name}
29237 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is handled.
29238 @item -t
29239 Create a temporary catchpoint.
29240 @end table
29241
29242 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29243
29244 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch handlers}.
29245
29246 @subsubheading Example
29247
29248 @smallexample
29249 -catch-handlers -e Constraint_Error
29250 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29251 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000402f68",
29252 what="`Constraint_Error' Ada exception handlers",thread-groups=["i1"],
29253 times="0",original-location="__gnat_begin_handler"@}
29254 (gdb)
29255 @end smallexample
29256
29257 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29258 @node GDB/MI Program Context
29259 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
29260
29261 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
29262 @findex -exec-arguments
29263
29264
29265 @subsubheading Synopsis
29266
29267 @smallexample
29268 -exec-arguments @var{args}
29269 @end smallexample
29270
29271 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
29272 @samp{-exec-run}.
29273
29274 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29275
29276 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
29277
29278 @subsubheading Example
29279
29280 @smallexample
29281 (gdb)
29282 -exec-arguments -v word
29283 ^done
29284 (gdb)
29285 @end smallexample
29286
29287
29288 @ignore
29289 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
29290 @findex -exec-show-arguments
29291
29292 @subsubheading Synopsis
29293
29294 @smallexample
29295 -exec-show-arguments
29296 @end smallexample
29297
29298 Print the arguments of the program.
29299
29300 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29301
29302 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
29303
29304 @subsubheading Example
29305 N.A.
29306 @end ignore
29307
29308
29309 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
29310 @findex -environment-cd
29311
29312 @subsubheading Synopsis
29313
29314 @smallexample
29315 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
29316 @end smallexample
29317
29318 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
29319
29320 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29321
29322 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
29323
29324 @subsubheading Example
29325
29326 @smallexample
29327 (gdb)
29328 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
29329 ^done
29330 (gdb)
29331 @end smallexample
29332
29333
29334 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
29335 @findex -environment-directory
29336
29337 @subsubheading Synopsis
29338
29339 @smallexample
29340 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
29341 @end smallexample
29342
29343 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
29344 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
29345 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
29346 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
29347 occurs as normal.
29348 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
29349 multiple directories in a single command
29350 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
29351 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
29352 If blanks are needed as
29353 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
29354 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
29355 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
29356 character must not be used
29357 in any directory name.
29358 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
29359
29360 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29361
29362 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
29363
29364 @subsubheading Example
29365
29366 @smallexample
29367 (gdb)
29368 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
29369 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
29370 (gdb)
29371 -environment-directory ""
29372 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
29373 (gdb)
29374 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
29375 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
29376 (gdb)
29377 -environment-directory -r
29378 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
29379 (gdb)
29380 @end smallexample
29381
29382
29383 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
29384 @findex -environment-path
29385
29386 @subsubheading Synopsis
29387
29388 @smallexample
29389 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
29390 @end smallexample
29391
29392 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
29393 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
29394 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
29395 supplied in addition to the
29396 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
29397 occurs as normal.
29398 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
29399 multiple directories in a single command
29400 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
29401 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
29402 If blanks are needed as
29403 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
29404 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
29405 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
29406 character must not be used
29407 in any directory name.
29408 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
29409
29410
29411 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29412
29413 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
29414
29415 @subsubheading Example
29416
29417 @smallexample
29418 (gdb)
29419 -environment-path
29420 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
29421 (gdb)
29422 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
29423 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
29424 (gdb)
29425 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
29426 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
29427 (gdb)
29428 @end smallexample
29429
29430
29431 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
29432 @findex -environment-pwd
29433
29434 @subsubheading Synopsis
29435
29436 @smallexample
29437 -environment-pwd
29438 @end smallexample
29439
29440 Show the current working directory.
29441
29442 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29443
29444 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
29445
29446 @subsubheading Example
29447
29448 @smallexample
29449 (gdb)
29450 -environment-pwd
29451 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
29452 (gdb)
29453 @end smallexample
29454
29455 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29456 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
29457 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
29458
29459
29460 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
29461 @findex -thread-info
29462
29463 @subsubheading Synopsis
29464
29465 @smallexample
29466 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
29467 @end smallexample
29468
29469 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
29470 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
29471 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
29472 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
29473 current thread.
29474
29475 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29476
29477 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
29478 about all threads.
29479
29480 @subsubheading Result
29481
29482 The result contains the following attributes:
29483
29484 @table @samp
29485 @item threads
29486 A list of threads. The format of the elements of the list is described in
29487 @ref{GDB/MI Thread Information}.
29488
29489 @item current-thread-id
29490 The global id of the currently selected thread. This field is omitted if there
29491 is no selected thread (for example, when the selected inferior is not running,
29492 and therefore has no threads) or if a @var{thread-id} argument was passed to
29493 the command.
29494
29495 @end table
29496
29497 @subsubheading Example
29498
29499 @smallexample
29500 -thread-info
29501 ^done,threads=[
29502 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
29503 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
29504 args=[]@},state="running"@},
29505 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
29506 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
29507 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
29508 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},
29509 state="running"@}],
29510 current-thread-id="1"
29511 (gdb)
29512 @end smallexample
29513
29514 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
29515 @findex -thread-list-ids
29516
29517 @subsubheading Synopsis
29518
29519 @smallexample
29520 -thread-list-ids
29521 @end smallexample
29522
29523 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
29524 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
29525 threads.
29526
29527 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
29528 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
29529
29530 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29531
29532 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
29533
29534 @subsubheading Example
29535
29536 @smallexample
29537 (gdb)
29538 -thread-list-ids
29539 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
29540 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
29541 (gdb)
29542 @end smallexample
29543
29544
29545 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
29546 @findex -thread-select
29547
29548 @subsubheading Synopsis
29549
29550 @smallexample
29551 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
29552 @end smallexample
29553
29554 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
29555 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
29556 topmost frame for that thread.
29557
29558 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
29559 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
29560
29561 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29562
29563 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
29564
29565 @subsubheading Example
29566
29567 @smallexample
29568 (gdb)
29569 -exec-next
29570 ^running
29571 (gdb)
29572 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
29573 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
29574 (gdb)
29575 -thread-list-ids
29576 ^done,
29577 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
29578 number-of-threads="3"
29579 (gdb)
29580 -thread-select 3
29581 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
29582 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
29583 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
29584 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29585 (gdb)
29586 @end smallexample
29587
29588 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29589 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
29590 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
29591
29592 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
29593 @findex -ada-task-info
29594
29595 @subsubheading Synopsis
29596
29597 @smallexample
29598 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
29599 @end smallexample
29600
29601 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
29602 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
29603
29604 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29605
29606 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
29607 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
29608
29609 @subsubheading Result
29610
29611 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
29612 defined for each Ada task:
29613
29614 @table @samp
29615 @item current
29616 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
29617
29618 @item id
29619 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
29620
29621 @item task-id
29622 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
29623
29624 @item thread-id
29625 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
29626 task.
29627
29628 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
29629 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
29630 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
29631
29632 @item parent-id
29633 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
29634 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
29635
29636 @item priority
29637 The base priority of the task.
29638
29639 @item state
29640 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
29641 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
29642
29643 @item name
29644 The name of the task.
29645
29646 @end table
29647
29648 @subsubheading Example
29649
29650 @smallexample
29651 -ada-task-info
29652 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
29653 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
29654 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
29655 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
29656 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
29657 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
29658 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
29659 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
29660 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
29661 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
29662 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
29663 (gdb)
29664 @end smallexample
29665
29666 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29667 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
29668 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
29669
29670 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
29671 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
29672 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
29673 other cases.
29674
29675 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
29676 @findex -exec-continue
29677
29678 @subsubheading Synopsis
29679
29680 @smallexample
29681 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
29682 @end smallexample
29683
29684 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
29685 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
29686 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
29687 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
29688 @itemize @bullet
29689 @item
29690 breakpoints or watchpoints
29691 @item
29692 signals or exceptions
29693 @item
29694 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
29695 @item
29696 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
29697 @end itemize
29698 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
29699 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
29700 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
29701 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
29702 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
29703 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
29704
29705 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29706
29707 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
29708
29709 @subsubheading Example
29710
29711 @smallexample
29712 -exec-continue
29713 ^running
29714 (gdb)
29715 @@Hello world
29716 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
29717 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
29718 line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29719 (gdb)
29720 @end smallexample
29721
29722
29723 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
29724 @findex -exec-finish
29725
29726 @subsubheading Synopsis
29727
29728 @smallexample
29729 -exec-finish [--reverse]
29730 @end smallexample
29731
29732 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
29733 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
29734 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
29735 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
29736 function was called.
29737
29738 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29739
29740 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
29741
29742 @subsubheading Example
29743
29744 Function returning @code{void}.
29745
29746 @smallexample
29747 -exec-finish
29748 ^running
29749 (gdb)
29750 @@hello from foo
29751 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
29752 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29753 (gdb)
29754 @end smallexample
29755
29756 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
29757 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
29758 value itself.
29759
29760 @smallexample
29761 -exec-finish
29762 ^running
29763 (gdb)
29764 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
29765 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
29766 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
29767 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
29768 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
29769 (gdb)
29770 @end smallexample
29771
29772
29773 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
29774 @findex -exec-interrupt
29775
29776 @subsubheading Synopsis
29777
29778 @smallexample
29779 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
29780 @end smallexample
29781
29782 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
29783 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
29784 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
29785 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
29786 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
29787
29788 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
29789 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
29790 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
29791 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
29792
29793 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
29794 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
29795 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
29796 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
29797
29798 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29799
29800 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
29801
29802 @subsubheading Example
29803
29804 @smallexample
29805 (gdb)
29806 111-exec-continue
29807 111^running
29808
29809 (gdb)
29810 222-exec-interrupt
29811 222^done
29812 (gdb)
29813 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
29814 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29815 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29816 (gdb)
29817
29818 (gdb)
29819 -exec-interrupt
29820 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
29821 (gdb)
29822 @end smallexample
29823
29824 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
29825 @findex -exec-jump
29826
29827 @subsubheading Synopsis
29828
29829 @smallexample
29830 -exec-jump @var{location}
29831 @end smallexample
29832
29833 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
29834 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
29835 different forms of @var{location}.
29836
29837 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29838
29839 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
29840
29841 @subsubheading Example
29842
29843 @smallexample
29844 -exec-jump foo.c:10
29845 *running,thread-id="all"
29846 ^running
29847 @end smallexample
29848
29849
29850 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
29851 @findex -exec-next
29852
29853 @subsubheading Synopsis
29854
29855 @smallexample
29856 -exec-next [--reverse]
29857 @end smallexample
29858
29859 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
29860 of the next source line is reached.
29861
29862 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
29863 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
29864 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
29865 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
29866 source line where the function was called.
29867
29868
29869 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29870
29871 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
29872
29873 @subsubheading Example
29874
29875 @smallexample
29876 -exec-next
29877 ^running
29878 (gdb)
29879 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
29880 (gdb)
29881 @end smallexample
29882
29883
29884 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
29885 @findex -exec-next-instruction
29886
29887 @subsubheading Synopsis
29888
29889 @smallexample
29890 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
29891 @end smallexample
29892
29893 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
29894 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
29895 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
29896 printed as well.
29897
29898 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
29899 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
29900 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
29901 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
29902 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
29903
29904 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29905
29906 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
29907
29908 @subsubheading Example
29909
29910 @smallexample
29911 (gdb)
29912 -exec-next-instruction
29913 ^running
29914
29915 (gdb)
29916 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29917 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
29918 (gdb)
29919 @end smallexample
29920
29921
29922 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
29923 @findex -exec-return
29924
29925 @subsubheading Synopsis
29926
29927 @smallexample
29928 -exec-return
29929 @end smallexample
29930
29931 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
29932 Displays the new current frame.
29933
29934 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29935
29936 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
29937
29938 @subsubheading Example
29939
29940 @smallexample
29941 (gdb)
29942 200-break-insert callee4
29943 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
29944 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
29945 (gdb)
29946 000-exec-run
29947 000^running
29948 (gdb)
29949 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
29950 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
29951 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29952 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
29953 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29954 (gdb)
29955 205-break-delete
29956 205^done
29957 (gdb)
29958 111-exec-return
29959 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
29960 args=[@{name="strarg",
29961 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
29962 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29963 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
29964 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29965 (gdb)
29966 @end smallexample
29967
29968
29969 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
29970 @findex -exec-run
29971
29972 @subsubheading Synopsis
29973
29974 @smallexample
29975 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
29976 @end smallexample
29977
29978 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
29979 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
29980 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
29981 the program has exited exceptionally.
29982
29983 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
29984 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
29985 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
29986 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
29987 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
29988
29989 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
29990 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
29991 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
29992 (@pxref{Starting}).
29993
29994 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29995
29996 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
29997
29998 @subsubheading Examples
29999
30000 @smallexample
30001 (gdb)
30002 -break-insert main
30003 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
30004 (gdb)
30005 -exec-run
30006 ^running
30007 (gdb)
30008 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
30009 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
30010 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30011 (gdb)
30012 @end smallexample
30013
30014 @noindent
30015 Program exited normally:
30016
30017 @smallexample
30018 (gdb)
30019 -exec-run
30020 ^running
30021 (gdb)
30022 x = 55
30023 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
30024 (gdb)
30025 @end smallexample
30026
30027 @noindent
30028 Program exited exceptionally:
30029
30030 @smallexample
30031 (gdb)
30032 -exec-run
30033 ^running
30034 (gdb)
30035 x = 55
30036 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
30037 (gdb)
30038 @end smallexample
30039
30040 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
30041 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
30042
30043 @smallexample
30044 (gdb)
30045 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
30046 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
30047 @end smallexample
30048
30049
30050 @c @subheading -exec-signal
30051
30052
30053 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
30054 @findex -exec-step
30055
30056 @subsubheading Synopsis
30057
30058 @smallexample
30059 -exec-step [--reverse]
30060 @end smallexample
30061
30062 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
30063 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
30064 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
30065 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
30066 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
30067 previously executed source line.
30068
30069 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30070
30071 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
30072
30073 @subsubheading Example
30074
30075 Stepping into a function:
30076
30077 @smallexample
30078 -exec-step
30079 ^running
30080 (gdb)
30081 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
30082 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
30083 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
30084 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30085 (gdb)
30086 @end smallexample
30087
30088 Regular stepping:
30089
30090 @smallexample
30091 -exec-step
30092 ^running
30093 (gdb)
30094 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
30095 (gdb)
30096 @end smallexample
30097
30098
30099 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
30100 @findex -exec-step-instruction
30101
30102 @subsubheading Synopsis
30103
30104 @smallexample
30105 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
30106 @end smallexample
30107
30108 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
30109 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
30110 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
30111 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
30112 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
30113 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
30114 as well.
30115
30116 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30117
30118 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
30119
30120 @subsubheading Example
30121
30122 @smallexample
30123 (gdb)
30124 -exec-step-instruction
30125 ^running
30126
30127 (gdb)
30128 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
30129 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
30130 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30131 (gdb)
30132 -exec-step-instruction
30133 ^running
30134
30135 (gdb)
30136 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
30137 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
30138 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30139 (gdb)
30140 @end smallexample
30141
30142
30143 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
30144 @findex -exec-until
30145
30146 @subsubheading Synopsis
30147
30148 @smallexample
30149 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
30150 @end smallexample
30151
30152 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
30153 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
30154 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
30155 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
30156
30157 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30158
30159 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
30160
30161 @subsubheading Example
30162
30163 @smallexample
30164 (gdb)
30165 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
30166 ^running
30167 (gdb)
30168 x = 55
30169 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
30170 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6",
30171 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30172 (gdb)
30173 @end smallexample
30174
30175 @ignore
30176 @subheading -file-clear
30177 Is this going away????
30178 @end ignore
30179
30180 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30181 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
30182 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
30183
30184 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
30185 @findex -enable-frame-filters
30186
30187 @smallexample
30188 -enable-frame-filters
30189 @end smallexample
30190
30191 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
30192 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
30193 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
30194 request that this functionality be enabled.
30195
30196 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
30197
30198 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
30199 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
30200
30201 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
30202 @findex -stack-info-frame
30203
30204 @subsubheading Synopsis
30205
30206 @smallexample
30207 -stack-info-frame
30208 @end smallexample
30209
30210 Get info on the selected frame.
30211
30212 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30213
30214 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
30215 (without arguments).
30216
30217 @subsubheading Example
30218
30219 @smallexample
30220 (gdb)
30221 -stack-info-frame
30222 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
30223 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30224 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
30225 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30226 (gdb)
30227 @end smallexample
30228
30229 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
30230 @findex -stack-info-depth
30231
30232 @subsubheading Synopsis
30233
30234 @smallexample
30235 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
30236 @end smallexample
30237
30238 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
30239 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
30240
30241 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30242
30243 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
30244
30245 @subsubheading Example
30246
30247 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
30248
30249 @smallexample
30250 (gdb)
30251 -stack-info-depth
30252 ^done,depth="12"
30253 (gdb)
30254 -stack-info-depth 4
30255 ^done,depth="4"
30256 (gdb)
30257 -stack-info-depth 12
30258 ^done,depth="12"
30259 (gdb)
30260 -stack-info-depth 11
30261 ^done,depth="11"
30262 (gdb)
30263 -stack-info-depth 13
30264 ^done,depth="12"
30265 (gdb)
30266 @end smallexample
30267
30268 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
30269 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
30270 @findex -stack-list-arguments
30271
30272 @subsubheading Synopsis
30273
30274 @smallexample
30275 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30276 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
30277 @end smallexample
30278
30279 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
30280 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
30281 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
30282 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
30283 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
30284 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
30285 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
30286 which case only existing frames will be returned.
30287
30288 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30289 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30290 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30291 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30292 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
30293 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
30294
30295 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
30296 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
30297 are still displayed, however.
30298
30299 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
30300 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
30301
30302 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30303
30304 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
30305 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
30306 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
30307
30308 @subsubheading Example
30309
30310 @smallexample
30311 (gdb)
30312 -stack-list-frames
30313 ^done,
30314 stack=[
30315 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
30316 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30317 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
30318 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30319 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
30320 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30321 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
30322 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30323 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
30324 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30325 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22",
30326 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30327 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
30328 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30329 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27",
30330 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30331 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
30332 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30333 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32",
30334 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30335 (gdb)
30336 -stack-list-arguments 0
30337 ^done,
30338 stack-args=[
30339 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
30340 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
30341 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
30342 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
30343 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
30344 (gdb)
30345 -stack-list-arguments 1
30346 ^done,
30347 stack-args=[
30348 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
30349 frame=@{level="1",
30350 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
30351 frame=@{level="2",args=[
30352 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30353 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
30354 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
30355 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30356 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
30357 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
30358 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
30359 (gdb)
30360 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
30361 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
30362 (gdb)
30363 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
30364 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
30365 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30366 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
30367 (gdb)
30368 @end smallexample
30369
30370 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
30371
30372
30373 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
30374 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
30375 @findex -stack-list-frames
30376
30377 @subsubheading Synopsis
30378
30379 @smallexample
30380 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
30381 @end smallexample
30382
30383 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
30384 following info:
30385
30386 @table @samp
30387 @item @var{level}
30388 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
30389 @item @var{addr}
30390 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
30391 @item @var{func}
30392 Function name.
30393 @item @var{file}
30394 File name of the source file where the function lives.
30395 @item @var{fullname}
30396 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
30397 @item @var{line}
30398 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
30399 @item @var{from}
30400 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
30401 if the frame's function is not known.
30402 @item @var{arch}
30403 Frame's architecture.
30404 @end table
30405
30406 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
30407 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
30408 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
30409 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
30410 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
30411 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
30412 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
30413 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
30414 Python frame filters will not be executed.
30415
30416 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30417
30418 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
30419
30420 @subsubheading Example
30421
30422 Full stack backtrace:
30423
30424 @smallexample
30425 (gdb)
30426 -stack-list-frames
30427 ^done,stack=
30428 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
30429 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",
30430 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30431 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30432 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30433 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30434 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30435 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30436 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30437 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30438 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30439 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30440 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30441 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30442 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30443 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30444 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30445 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30446 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30447 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30448 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30449 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30450 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30451 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30452 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30453 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30454 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30455 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30456 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30457 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30458 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30459 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30460 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30461 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
30462 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",
30463 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30464 (gdb)
30465 @end smallexample
30466
30467 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
30468
30469 @smallexample
30470 (gdb)
30471 -stack-list-frames 3 5
30472 ^done,stack=
30473 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30474 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30475 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30476 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30477 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30478 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30479 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30480 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30481 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30482 (gdb)
30483 @end smallexample
30484
30485 Show a single frame:
30486
30487 @smallexample
30488 (gdb)
30489 -stack-list-frames 3 3
30490 ^done,stack=
30491 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30492 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30493 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30494 (gdb)
30495 @end smallexample
30496
30497
30498 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
30499 @findex -stack-list-locals
30500 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
30501
30502 @subsubheading Synopsis
30503
30504 @smallexample
30505 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30506 @end smallexample
30507
30508 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
30509 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30510 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30511 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30512 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30513 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
30514 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
30515 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
30516 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
30517 Python frame filters will not be executed.
30518
30519 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
30520 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
30521 variables are still displayed, however.
30522
30523 This command is deprecated in favor of the
30524 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
30525
30526 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30527
30528 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
30529
30530 @subsubheading Example
30531
30532 @smallexample
30533 (gdb)
30534 -stack-list-locals 0
30535 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
30536 (gdb)
30537 -stack-list-locals --all-values
30538 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
30539 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
30540 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
30541 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
30542 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
30543 (gdb)
30544 @end smallexample
30545
30546 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
30547 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
30548 @findex -stack-list-variables
30549
30550 @subsubheading Synopsis
30551
30552 @smallexample
30553 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30554 @end smallexample
30555
30556 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
30557 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30558 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30559 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30560 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30561 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
30562 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
30563
30564 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
30565 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
30566 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
30567
30568 @subsubheading Example
30569
30570 @smallexample
30571 (gdb)
30572 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
30573 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
30574 (gdb)
30575 @end smallexample
30576
30577
30578 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
30579 @findex -stack-select-frame
30580
30581 @subsubheading Synopsis
30582
30583 @smallexample
30584 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
30585 @end smallexample
30586
30587 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
30588 the stack.
30589
30590 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
30591 option to every command.
30592
30593 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30594
30595 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
30596 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
30597
30598 @subsubheading Example
30599
30600 @smallexample
30601 (gdb)
30602 -stack-select-frame 2
30603 ^done
30604 (gdb)
30605 @end smallexample
30606
30607 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30608 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
30609 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
30610
30611 @ignore
30612
30613 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
30614
30615 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
30616 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
30617 used by @code{Insight}.
30618
30619 The two main reasons for that are:
30620
30621 @enumerate 1
30622 @item
30623 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
30624
30625 @item
30626 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
30627 now).
30628 @end enumerate
30629
30630 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
30631 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
30632 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
30633 hints about their use.
30634
30635 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
30636 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
30637 least, the following operations:
30638
30639 @itemize @bullet
30640 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
30641 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
30642 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
30643 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
30644 @end itemize
30645
30646 @end ignore
30647
30648 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
30649
30650 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
30651
30652 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
30653 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
30654 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
30655 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
30656 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
30657 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
30658 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
30659 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
30660 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
30661 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
30662 object, or to change display format.
30663
30664 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
30665 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
30666 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
30667 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
30668 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
30669 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
30670 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
30671 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
30672 child will be created.
30673
30674 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
30675 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
30676 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
30677 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
30678 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
30679
30680 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
30681 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
30682 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
30683 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
30684 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
30685 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
30686 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
30687 variables that frontend has created.
30688
30689 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
30690 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
30691 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
30692 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
30693 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
30694 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
30695 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
30696 implicitly updated.
30697
30698 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
30699 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
30700 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
30701 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
30702 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
30703 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
30704 frame. Consider this example:
30705
30706 @smallexample
30707 void do_work(...)
30708 @{
30709 struct work_state state;
30710
30711 if (...)
30712 do_work(...);
30713 @}
30714 @end smallexample
30715
30716 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
30717 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
30718 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
30719 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
30720 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
30721
30722 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
30723 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
30724 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
30725 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
30726 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
30727 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
30728
30729 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
30730 access this functionality:
30731
30732 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
30733 @item @strong{Operation}
30734 @tab @strong{Description}
30735
30736 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
30737 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
30738 @item @code{-var-create}
30739 @tab create a variable object
30740 @item @code{-var-delete}
30741 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
30742 @item @code{-var-set-format}
30743 @tab set the display format of this variable
30744 @item @code{-var-show-format}
30745 @tab show the display format of this variable
30746 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
30747 @tab tells how many children this object has
30748 @item @code{-var-list-children}
30749 @tab return a list of the object's children
30750 @item @code{-var-info-type}
30751 @tab show the type of this variable object
30752 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
30753 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
30754 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
30755 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
30756 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
30757 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
30758 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
30759 @tab get the value of this variable
30760 @item @code{-var-assign}
30761 @tab set the value of this variable
30762 @item @code{-var-update}
30763 @tab update the variable and its children
30764 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
30765 @tab set frozeness attribute
30766 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
30767 @tab set range of children to display on update
30768 @end multitable
30769
30770 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
30771 how it can be used.
30772
30773 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
30774
30775 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
30776 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
30777
30778 @smallexample
30779 -enable-pretty-printing
30780 @end smallexample
30781
30782 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
30783 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
30784 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
30785 request that this functionality be enabled.
30786
30787 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
30788
30789 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
30790 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
30791
30792 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
30793 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
30794
30795 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
30796 @findex -var-create
30797
30798 @subsubheading Synopsis
30799
30800 @smallexample
30801 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
30802 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
30803 @end smallexample
30804
30805 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
30806 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
30807 register.
30808
30809 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
30810 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
30811 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
30812 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
30813 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
30814
30815 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
30816 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
30817 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
30818 object must be created.
30819
30820 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
30821 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
30822
30823 @itemize @bullet
30824 @item
30825 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
30826
30827 @item
30828 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
30829
30830 @item
30831 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
30832 @end itemize
30833
30834 @cindex dynamic varobj
30835 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
30836 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
30837 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
30838 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
30839 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
30840 compatibility for existing clients.
30841
30842 @subsubheading Result
30843
30844 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
30845 are:
30846
30847 @table @samp
30848 @item name
30849 The name of the varobj.
30850
30851 @item numchild
30852 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
30853 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
30854 @samp{has_more} attribute.
30855
30856 @item value
30857 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
30858 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
30859 will not be interesting.
30860
30861 @item type
30862 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
30863 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
30864 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
30865 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
30866 @emph{declared} one.
30867
30868 @item thread-id
30869 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
30870 thread's global identifier.
30871
30872 @item has_more
30873 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
30874 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
30875
30876 @item dynamic
30877 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30878 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30879 then this attribute will not be present.
30880
30881 @item displayhint
30882 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
30883 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
30884 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
30885 @end table
30886
30887 Typical output will look like this:
30888
30889 @smallexample
30890 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
30891 has_more="@var{has_more}"
30892 @end smallexample
30893
30894
30895 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
30896 @findex -var-delete
30897
30898 @subsubheading Synopsis
30899
30900 @smallexample
30901 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
30902 @end smallexample
30903
30904 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
30905 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
30906
30907 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
30908
30909
30910 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
30911 @findex -var-set-format
30912
30913 @subsubheading Synopsis
30914
30915 @smallexample
30916 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
30917 @end smallexample
30918
30919 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
30920 @var{format-spec}.
30921
30922 @anchor{-var-set-format}
30923 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
30924
30925 @smallexample
30926 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
30927 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
30928 @end smallexample
30929
30930 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
30931 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
30932 for pointers, etc.).
30933
30934 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
30935 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
30936 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
30937 zero-hexadecimal format.
30938
30939 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
30940 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
30941
30942 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
30943 @findex -var-show-format
30944
30945 @subsubheading Synopsis
30946
30947 @smallexample
30948 -var-show-format @var{name}
30949 @end smallexample
30950
30951 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
30952
30953 @smallexample
30954 @var{format} @expansion{}
30955 @var{format-spec}
30956 @end smallexample
30957
30958
30959 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
30960 @findex -var-info-num-children
30961
30962 @subsubheading Synopsis
30963
30964 @smallexample
30965 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
30966 @end smallexample
30967
30968 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
30969
30970 @smallexample
30971 numchild=@var{n}
30972 @end smallexample
30973
30974 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
30975 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
30976 be available.
30977
30978
30979 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
30980 @findex -var-list-children
30981
30982 @subsubheading Synopsis
30983
30984 @smallexample
30985 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
30986 @end smallexample
30987 @anchor{-var-list-children}
30988
30989 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
30990 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
30991 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
30992 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
30993 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
30994 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
30995 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
30996 and unions.
30997
30998 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
30999 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
31000 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
31001 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
31002 reported.
31003
31004 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
31005 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
31006 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
31007 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
31008 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
31009 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
31010 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
31011 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
31012 the visible items.
31013
31014 For each child the following results are returned:
31015
31016 @table @var
31017
31018 @item name
31019 Name of the variable object created for this child.
31020
31021 @item exp
31022 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
31023 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
31024
31025 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
31026 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
31027
31028 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
31029 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
31030 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
31031 type and value are not present.
31032
31033 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
31034 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
31035 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
31036
31037 @item numchild
31038 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
31039 0.
31040
31041 @item type
31042 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
31043 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
31044 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
31045 @emph{declared} one.
31046
31047 @item value
31048 If values were requested, this is the value.
31049
31050 @item thread-id
31051 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
31052 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
31053
31054 @item frozen
31055 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
31056
31057 @item displayhint
31058 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
31059 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
31060 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
31061
31062 @item dynamic
31063 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
31064 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
31065 then this attribute will not be present.
31066
31067 @end table
31068
31069 The result may have its own attributes:
31070
31071 @table @samp
31072 @item displayhint
31073 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
31074 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
31075 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
31076
31077 @item has_more
31078 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
31079 remaining after the end of the selected range.
31080 @end table
31081
31082 @subsubheading Example
31083
31084 @smallexample
31085 (gdb)
31086 -var-list-children n
31087 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
31088 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
31089 (gdb)
31090 -var-list-children --all-values n
31091 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
31092 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
31093 @end smallexample
31094
31095
31096 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
31097 @findex -var-info-type
31098
31099 @subsubheading Synopsis
31100
31101 @smallexample
31102 -var-info-type @var{name}
31103 @end smallexample
31104
31105 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
31106 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
31107 @value{GDBN} CLI:
31108
31109 @smallexample
31110 type=@var{typename}
31111 @end smallexample
31112
31113
31114 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
31115 @findex -var-info-expression
31116
31117 @subsubheading Synopsis
31118
31119 @smallexample
31120 -var-info-expression @var{name}
31121 @end smallexample
31122
31123 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
31124 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
31125 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
31126
31127 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
31128 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
31129
31130 @smallexample
31131 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
31132 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
31133 @end smallexample
31134
31135 @noindent
31136 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
31137 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
31138
31139 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
31140 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
31141 is of limited use.
31142
31143 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
31144 @findex -var-info-path-expression
31145
31146 @subsubheading Synopsis
31147
31148 @smallexample
31149 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
31150 @end smallexample
31151
31152 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
31153 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
31154 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
31155 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
31156 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
31157 watchpoint from a variable object.
31158
31159 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
31160 and will give an error when invoked on one.
31161
31162 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
31163 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
31164 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
31165 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
31166 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
31167 @smallexample
31168 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
31169 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
31170 @end smallexample
31171
31172 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
31173 @findex -var-show-attributes
31174
31175 @subsubheading Synopsis
31176
31177 @smallexample
31178 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
31179 @end smallexample
31180
31181 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
31182
31183 @smallexample
31184 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
31185 @end smallexample
31186
31187 @noindent
31188 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
31189
31190 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
31191 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
31192
31193 @subsubheading Synopsis
31194
31195 @smallexample
31196 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
31197 @end smallexample
31198
31199 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
31200 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
31201 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
31202 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
31203 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
31204 the current display format will be used. The current display format
31205 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
31206
31207 @smallexample
31208 value=@var{value}
31209 @end smallexample
31210
31211 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
31212 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
31213
31214 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
31215 @findex -var-assign
31216
31217 @subsubheading Synopsis
31218
31219 @smallexample
31220 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
31221 @end smallexample
31222
31223 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
31224 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
31225 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
31226 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
31227
31228 @subsubheading Example
31229
31230 @smallexample
31231 (gdb)
31232 -var-assign var1 3
31233 ^done,value="3"
31234 (gdb)
31235 -var-update *
31236 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
31237 (gdb)
31238 @end smallexample
31239
31240 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
31241 @findex -var-update
31242
31243 @subsubheading Synopsis
31244
31245 @smallexample
31246 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
31247 @end smallexample
31248
31249 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
31250 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
31251 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
31252 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
31253 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
31254 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
31255 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
31256 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
31257 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
31258 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
31259 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
31260 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
31261 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
31262
31263 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
31264 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
31265 diagnostic.
31266
31267 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
31268 only the selected range of children will be reported.
31269
31270 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
31271 @samp{changelist}.
31272
31273 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
31274
31275 @table @samp
31276 @item name
31277 The name of the varobj.
31278
31279 @item value
31280 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
31281 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
31282
31283 @item in_scope
31284 @anchor{-var-update}
31285 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
31286
31287 @table @code
31288 @item "true"
31289 The variable object's current value is valid.
31290
31291 @item "false"
31292 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
31293 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
31294 scope.
31295
31296 @item "invalid"
31297 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
31298 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
31299 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
31300 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
31301 objects.
31302 @end table
31303
31304 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
31305 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
31306
31307 @item type_changed
31308 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
31309 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
31310 be @samp{false}.
31311
31312 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
31313 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
31314 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
31315 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
31316 unset.
31317
31318 @item new_type
31319 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
31320 hold the new type.
31321
31322 @item new_num_children
31323 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
31324 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
31325
31326 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
31327 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
31328 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
31329 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
31330 children which may be available.
31331
31332 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
31333 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
31334 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
31335 only happen at the end of the update range).
31336
31337 @item displayhint
31338 The display hint, if any.
31339
31340 @item has_more
31341 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
31342 available outside the varobj's update range.
31343
31344 @item dynamic
31345 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
31346 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
31347 then this attribute will not be present.
31348
31349 @item new_children
31350 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
31351 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
31352 be listed in this attribute.
31353 @end table
31354
31355 @subsubheading Example
31356
31357 @smallexample
31358 (gdb)
31359 -var-assign var1 3
31360 ^done,value="3"
31361 (gdb)
31362 -var-update --all-values var1
31363 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
31364 type_changed="false"@}]
31365 (gdb)
31366 @end smallexample
31367
31368 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
31369 @findex -var-set-frozen
31370 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
31371
31372 @subsubheading Synopsis
31373
31374 @smallexample
31375 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
31376 @end smallexample
31377
31378 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
31379 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
31380 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
31381 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
31382 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
31383 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
31384 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
31385 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
31386 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
31387 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
31388 @code{-var-update} does.
31389
31390 @subsubheading Example
31391
31392 @smallexample
31393 (gdb)
31394 -var-set-frozen V 1
31395 ^done
31396 (gdb)
31397 @end smallexample
31398
31399 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
31400 @findex -var-set-update-range
31401 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
31402
31403 @subsubheading Synopsis
31404
31405 @smallexample
31406 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
31407 @end smallexample
31408
31409 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
31410 @code{-var-update}.
31411
31412 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
31413 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
31414 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
31415 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
31416
31417 @subsubheading Example
31418
31419 @smallexample
31420 (gdb)
31421 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
31422 ^done
31423 @end smallexample
31424
31425 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
31426 @findex -var-set-visualizer
31427 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
31428
31429 @subsubheading Synopsis
31430
31431 @smallexample
31432 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
31433 @end smallexample
31434
31435 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
31436
31437 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
31438 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
31439
31440 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
31441 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
31442 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
31443 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
31444 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
31445 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
31446 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
31447
31448 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
31449 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
31450 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
31451 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
31452
31453 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
31454 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
31455 can be used to check this.
31456
31457 @subsubheading Example
31458
31459 Resetting the visualizer:
31460
31461 @smallexample
31462 (gdb)
31463 -var-set-visualizer V None
31464 ^done
31465 @end smallexample
31466
31467 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
31468
31469 @smallexample
31470 (gdb)
31471 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
31472 ^done
31473 @end smallexample
31474
31475 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
31476 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
31477
31478 @smallexample
31479 (gdb)
31480 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
31481 ^done
31482 @end smallexample
31483
31484 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31485 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
31486 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
31487
31488 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
31489 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
31490 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
31491 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
31492
31493 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
31494 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
31495
31496 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
31497 @c @subheading -data-assign
31498 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
31499 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
31500 @c set variable
31501 @c @subsubheading Example
31502 @c N.A.
31503
31504 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
31505 @findex -data-disassemble
31506
31507 @subsubheading Synopsis
31508
31509 @smallexample
31510 -data-disassemble
31511 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
31512 | [ -a @var{addr} ]
31513 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
31514 -- @var{mode}
31515 @end smallexample
31516
31517 @noindent
31518 Where:
31519
31520 @table @samp
31521 @item @var{start-addr}
31522 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
31523 @item @var{end-addr}
31524 is the end address
31525 @item @var{addr}
31526 is an address anywhere within (or the name of) the function to
31527 disassemble. If an address is specified, the whole function
31528 surrounding that address will be disassembled. If a name is
31529 specified, the whole function with that name will be disassembled.
31530 @item @var{filename}
31531 is the name of the file to disassemble
31532 @item @var{linenum}
31533 is the line number to disassemble around
31534 @item @var{lines}
31535 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
31536 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
31537 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
31538 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
31539 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
31540 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
31541 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
31542 are displayed.
31543 @item @var{mode}
31544 is one of:
31545 @itemize @bullet
31546 @item 0 disassembly only
31547 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
31548 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
31549 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
31550 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
31551 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
31552 @end itemize
31553
31554 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
31555 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
31556 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
31557 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
31558 @end table
31559
31560 @subsubheading Result
31561
31562 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
31563 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
31564 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
31565
31566 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
31567 following fields:
31568
31569 @table @code
31570 @item address
31571 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
31572
31573 @item func-name
31574 The name of the function this instruction is within.
31575
31576 @item offset
31577 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
31578
31579 @item inst
31580 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
31581
31582 @item opcodes
31583 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
31584 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
31585
31586 @end table
31587
31588 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
31589 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
31590
31591 @table @code
31592 @item line
31593 The line number within @samp{file}.
31594
31595 @item file
31596 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
31597 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
31598 used.
31599
31600 @item fullname
31601 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
31602 using the source file search path
31603 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
31604 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
31605
31606 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
31607 present in the debug information.
31608
31609 @item line_asm_insn
31610 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
31611 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
31612 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
31613 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
31614 @samp{opcodes}.
31615
31616 @end table
31617
31618 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
31619 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
31620 adjust its format.
31621
31622 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31623
31624 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
31625
31626 @subsubheading Example
31627
31628 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
31629
31630 @smallexample
31631 (gdb)
31632 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
31633 ^done,
31634 asm_insns=[
31635 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31636 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31637 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31638 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31639 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
31640 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
31641 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
31642 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31643 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
31644 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
31645 (gdb)
31646 @end smallexample
31647
31648 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
31649 @code{main}.
31650
31651 @smallexample
31652 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
31653 ^done,asm_insns=[
31654 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
31655 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
31656 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31657 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31658 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31659 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31660 [@dots{}]
31661 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
31662 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
31663 (gdb)
31664 @end smallexample
31665
31666 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
31667
31668 @smallexample
31669 (gdb)
31670 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
31671 ^done,asm_insns=[
31672 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
31673 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
31674 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31675 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31676 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31677 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
31678 (gdb)
31679 @end smallexample
31680
31681 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
31682
31683 @smallexample
31684 (gdb)
31685 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
31686 ^done,asm_insns=[
31687 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
31688 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31689 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31690 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
31691 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
31692 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
31693 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31694 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31695 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
31696 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31697 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31698 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
31699 (gdb)
31700 @end smallexample
31701
31702
31703 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
31704 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
31705
31706 @subsubheading Synopsis
31707
31708 @smallexample
31709 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
31710 @end smallexample
31711
31712 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
31713 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
31714 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
31715
31716 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31717
31718 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
31719 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
31720 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
31721
31722 @subsubheading Example
31723
31724 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
31725 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
31726 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
31727 output.
31728
31729 @smallexample
31730 211-data-evaluate-expression A
31731 211^done,value="1"
31732 (gdb)
31733 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
31734 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
31735 (gdb)
31736 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
31737 411^done,value="4"
31738 (gdb)
31739 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
31740 511^done,value="4"
31741 (gdb)
31742 @end smallexample
31743
31744
31745 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
31746 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
31747
31748 @subsubheading Synopsis
31749
31750 @smallexample
31751 -data-list-changed-registers
31752 @end smallexample
31753
31754 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
31755
31756 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31757
31758 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
31759 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
31760
31761 @subsubheading Example
31762
31763 On a PPC MBX board:
31764
31765 @smallexample
31766 (gdb)
31767 -exec-continue
31768 ^running
31769
31770 (gdb)
31771 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
31772 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
31773 line="5",arch="powerpc"@}
31774 (gdb)
31775 -data-list-changed-registers
31776 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
31777 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
31778 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
31779 (gdb)
31780 @end smallexample
31781
31782
31783 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
31784 @findex -data-list-register-names
31785
31786 @subsubheading Synopsis
31787
31788 @smallexample
31789 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
31790 @end smallexample
31791
31792 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
31793 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
31794 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
31795 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
31796 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
31797 include empty register names.
31798
31799 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31800
31801 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
31802 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
31803 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
31804
31805 @subsubheading Example
31806
31807 For the PPC MBX board:
31808 @smallexample
31809 (gdb)
31810 -data-list-register-names
31811 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
31812 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
31813 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
31814 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
31815 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
31816 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
31817 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
31818 (gdb)
31819 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
31820 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
31821 (gdb)
31822 @end smallexample
31823
31824 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
31825 @findex -data-list-register-values
31826
31827 @subsubheading Synopsis
31828
31829 @smallexample
31830 -data-list-register-values
31831 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
31832 @end smallexample
31833
31834 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
31835 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
31836 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
31837 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
31838 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
31839 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
31840
31841 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
31842
31843 @table @code
31844 @item x
31845 Hexadecimal
31846 @item o
31847 Octal
31848 @item t
31849 Binary
31850 @item d
31851 Decimal
31852 @item r
31853 Raw
31854 @item N
31855 Natural
31856 @end table
31857
31858 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31859
31860 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
31861 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
31862
31863 @subsubheading Example
31864
31865 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
31866 don't appear in the actual output):
31867
31868 @smallexample
31869 (gdb)
31870 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
31871 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
31872 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
31873 (gdb)
31874 -data-list-register-values x
31875 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
31876 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
31877 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
31878 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
31879 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
31880 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
31881 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
31882 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
31883 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
31884 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
31885 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
31886 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
31887 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
31888 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
31889 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
31890 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
31891 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
31892 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
31893 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
31894 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
31895 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
31896 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
31897 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
31898 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
31899 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
31900 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
31901 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
31902 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
31903 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
31904 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
31905 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
31906 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
31907 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
31908 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
31909 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
31910 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
31911 (gdb)
31912 @end smallexample
31913
31914
31915 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
31916 @findex -data-read-memory
31917
31918 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
31919
31920 @subsubheading Synopsis
31921
31922 @smallexample
31923 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
31924 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
31925 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
31926 @end smallexample
31927
31928 @noindent
31929 where:
31930
31931 @table @samp
31932 @item @var{address}
31933 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
31934 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
31935 quoted using the C convention.
31936
31937 @item @var{word-format}
31938 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
31939 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
31940 ,Output Formats}).
31941
31942 @item @var{word-size}
31943 The size of each memory word in bytes.
31944
31945 @item @var{nr-rows}
31946 The number of rows in the output table.
31947
31948 @item @var{nr-cols}
31949 The number of columns in the output table.
31950
31951 @item @var{aschar}
31952 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
31953 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
31954 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
31955 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
31956
31957 @item @var{byte-offset}
31958 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
31959 @end table
31960
31961 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
31962 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
31963 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
31964 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
31965 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
31966 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
31967 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
31968 @samp{addr}.
31969
31970 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
31971 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
31972 @samp{prev-page}.
31973
31974 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31975
31976 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
31977 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
31978
31979 @subsubheading Example
31980
31981 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
31982 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
31983 word. Display each word in hex.
31984
31985 @smallexample
31986 (gdb)
31987 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
31988 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
31989 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
31990 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
31991 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
31992 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
31993 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
31994 (gdb)
31995 @end smallexample
31996
31997 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
31998 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
31999
32000 @smallexample
32001 (gdb)
32002 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
32003 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
32004 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
32005 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
32006 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
32007 (gdb)
32008 @end smallexample
32009
32010 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
32011 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
32012 used as the non-printable character.
32013
32014 @smallexample
32015 (gdb)
32016 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
32017 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
32018 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
32019 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
32020 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
32021 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
32022 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
32023 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
32024 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
32025 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
32026 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
32027 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
32028 (gdb)
32029 @end smallexample
32030
32031 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
32032 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
32033
32034 @subsubheading Synopsis
32035
32036 @smallexample
32037 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
32038 @var{address} @var{count}
32039 @end smallexample
32040
32041 @noindent
32042 where:
32043
32044 @table @samp
32045 @item @var{address}
32046 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
32047 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
32048 quoted using the C convention.
32049
32050 @item @var{count}
32051 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
32052 literal.
32053
32054 @item @var{offset}
32055 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
32056 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
32057 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
32058 arithmetics itself.
32059
32060 @end table
32061
32062 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
32063 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
32064 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
32065 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
32066 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
32067 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
32068
32069 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
32070 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
32071 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
32072 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
32073 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
32074 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
32075 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
32076 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
32077
32078 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
32079 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
32080 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
32081 and has the following fields:
32082
32083 @table @code
32084 @item begin
32085 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
32086
32087 @item end
32088 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
32089
32090 @item offset
32091 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
32092 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
32093
32094 @item contents
32095 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
32096
32097 @end table
32098
32099
32100
32101 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32102
32103 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
32104
32105 @subsubheading Example
32106
32107 @smallexample
32108 (gdb)
32109 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
32110 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
32111 end="0xbffff15e",
32112 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
32113 (gdb)
32114 @end smallexample
32115
32116
32117 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
32118 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
32119
32120 @subsubheading Synopsis
32121
32122 @smallexample
32123 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
32124 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
32125 @end smallexample
32126
32127 @noindent
32128 where:
32129
32130 @table @samp
32131 @item @var{address}
32132 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
32133 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
32134 be quoted using the C convention.
32135
32136 @item @var{contents}
32137 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
32138 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
32139
32140 @item @var{count}
32141 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
32142 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
32143 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
32144 @var{count} memory units.
32145
32146 @end table
32147
32148 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32149
32150 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32151
32152 @subsubheading Example
32153
32154 @smallexample
32155 (gdb)
32156 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
32157 ^done
32158 (gdb)
32159 @end smallexample
32160
32161 @smallexample
32162 (gdb)
32163 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
32164 ^done
32165 (gdb)
32166 @end smallexample
32167
32168 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32169 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
32170 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
32171
32172 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
32173 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
32174
32175 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
32176 @findex -trace-find
32177
32178 @subsubheading Synopsis
32179
32180 @smallexample
32181 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
32182 @end smallexample
32183
32184 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
32185 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
32186 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
32187
32188 @table @samp
32189
32190 @item none
32191 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
32192
32193 @item frame-number
32194 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
32195 that index.
32196
32197 @item tracepoint-number
32198 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
32199 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
32200
32201 @item pc
32202 An address is required as parameter. Finds
32203 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
32204 address.
32205
32206 @item pc-inside-range
32207 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
32208 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
32209 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
32210
32211 @item pc-outside-range
32212 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
32213 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
32214 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
32215
32216 @item line
32217 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
32218 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
32219 the specified location.
32220
32221 @end table
32222
32223 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
32224 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
32225
32226 @table @samp
32227 @item found
32228 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
32229 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
32230
32231 @item traceframe
32232 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
32233 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
32234
32235 @item tracepoint
32236 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
32237 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
32238
32239 @item frame
32240 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
32241 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
32242 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
32243
32244 @end table
32245
32246 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32247
32248 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
32249
32250 @subheading -trace-define-variable
32251 @findex -trace-define-variable
32252
32253 @subsubheading Synopsis
32254
32255 @smallexample
32256 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
32257 @end smallexample
32258
32259 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
32260 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
32261 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
32262 with the @samp{$} character.
32263
32264 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32265
32266 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
32267
32268 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
32269 @findex -trace-frame-collected
32270
32271 @subsubheading Synopsis
32272
32273 @smallexample
32274 -trace-frame-collected
32275 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
32276 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
32277 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
32278 [--memory-contents]
32279 @end smallexample
32280
32281 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
32282 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
32283 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
32284 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
32285 See the output description table below for more details.
32286
32287 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
32288 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
32289 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
32290 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
32291 memory range and which is a computed expression.
32292
32293 For instance, if the actions were
32294 @smallexample
32295 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
32296 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
32297 @end smallexample
32298
32299 @noindent
32300 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
32301 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
32302 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
32303 objects would be computed expressions.
32304
32305 An example output would be:
32306
32307 @smallexample
32308 (gdb)
32309 -trace-frame-collected
32310 ^done,
32311 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
32312 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
32313 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
32314 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
32315 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
32316 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
32317 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
32318 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
32319 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
32320 ...
32321 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
32322 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
32323 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
32324 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
32325 (gdb)
32326 @end smallexample
32327
32328 Where:
32329
32330 @table @code
32331 @item explicit-variables
32332 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
32333 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
32334 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
32335 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
32336 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
32337 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
32338 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
32339 arrays, structures and unions.
32340
32341 @item computed-expressions
32342 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
32343 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
32344 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
32345 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
32346
32347 @item registers
32348 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
32349 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
32350 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
32351 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
32352 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
32353
32354 @item tvars
32355 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
32356 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
32357 current value are returned.
32358
32359 @item memory
32360 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
32361 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
32362 collected memory range and has the following fields:
32363
32364 @table @code
32365 @item address
32366 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
32367
32368 @item length
32369 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
32370
32371 @item contents
32372 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
32373 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
32374
32375 @end table
32376
32377 @end table
32378
32379 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32380
32381 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32382
32383 @subsubheading Example
32384
32385 @subheading -trace-list-variables
32386 @findex -trace-list-variables
32387
32388 @subsubheading Synopsis
32389
32390 @smallexample
32391 -trace-list-variables
32392 @end smallexample
32393
32394 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
32395 table has the following fields:
32396
32397 @table @samp
32398 @item name
32399 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
32400
32401 @item initial
32402 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
32403 field is always present.
32404
32405 @item current
32406 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
32407 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
32408 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
32409 presently running.
32410
32411 @end table
32412
32413 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32414
32415 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
32416
32417 @subsubheading Example
32418
32419 @smallexample
32420 (gdb)
32421 -trace-list-variables
32422 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
32423 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
32424 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
32425 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
32426 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
32427 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
32428 (gdb)
32429 @end smallexample
32430
32431 @subheading -trace-save
32432 @findex -trace-save
32433
32434 @subsubheading Synopsis
32435
32436 @smallexample
32437 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
32438 @end smallexample
32439
32440 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
32441 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
32442 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
32443 to perform the save.
32444
32445 By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can
32446 supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
32447 @ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
32448
32449 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32450
32451 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
32452
32453
32454 @subheading -trace-start
32455 @findex -trace-start
32456
32457 @subsubheading Synopsis
32458
32459 @smallexample
32460 -trace-start
32461 @end smallexample
32462
32463 Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not
32464 have any fields.
32465
32466 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32467
32468 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
32469
32470 @subheading -trace-status
32471 @findex -trace-status
32472
32473 @subsubheading Synopsis
32474
32475 @smallexample
32476 -trace-status
32477 @end smallexample
32478
32479 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
32480 the following fields:
32481
32482 @table @samp
32483
32484 @item supported
32485 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
32486 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
32487 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
32488 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
32489 started. This field is always present.
32490
32491 @item running
32492 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
32493 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
32494 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
32495
32496 @item stop-reason
32497 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
32498 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
32499 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
32500 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
32501 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
32502 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
32503 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
32504 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
32505 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
32506
32507 @item stopping-tracepoint
32508 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
32509 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
32510 @samp{passcount}.
32511
32512 @item frames
32513 @itemx frames-created
32514 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
32515 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
32516 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
32517 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
32518
32519 @item buffer-size
32520 @itemx buffer-free
32521 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
32522 remaining space. These fields are optional.
32523
32524 @item circular
32525 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
32526 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
32527 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
32528 and may fill up.
32529
32530 @item disconnected
32531 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
32532 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
32533 that the trace run will stop.
32534
32535 @item trace-file
32536 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
32537 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
32538
32539 @end table
32540
32541 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32542
32543 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
32544
32545 @subheading -trace-stop
32546 @findex -trace-stop
32547
32548 @subsubheading Synopsis
32549
32550 @smallexample
32551 -trace-stop
32552 @end smallexample
32553
32554 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
32555 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
32556 @samp{running} fields are not output.
32557
32558 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32559
32560 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
32561
32562
32563 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32564 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
32565 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
32566
32567
32568 @ignore
32569 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
32570 @findex -symbol-info-address
32571
32572 @subsubheading Synopsis
32573
32574 @smallexample
32575 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
32576 @end smallexample
32577
32578 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
32579
32580 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32581
32582 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
32583
32584 @subsubheading Example
32585 N.A.
32586
32587
32588 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
32589 @findex -symbol-info-file
32590
32591 @subsubheading Synopsis
32592
32593 @smallexample
32594 -symbol-info-file
32595 @end smallexample
32596
32597 Show the file for the symbol.
32598
32599 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32600
32601 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
32602 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
32603
32604 @subsubheading Example
32605 N.A.
32606
32607
32608 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
32609 @findex -symbol-info-function
32610
32611 @subsubheading Synopsis
32612
32613 @smallexample
32614 -symbol-info-function
32615 @end smallexample
32616
32617 Show which function the symbol lives in.
32618
32619 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32620
32621 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
32622
32623 @subsubheading Example
32624 N.A.
32625
32626
32627 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
32628 @findex -symbol-info-line
32629
32630 @subsubheading Synopsis
32631
32632 @smallexample
32633 -symbol-info-line
32634 @end smallexample
32635
32636 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
32637
32638 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32639
32640 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
32641 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
32642
32643 @subsubheading Example
32644 N.A.
32645
32646
32647 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
32648 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
32649
32650 @subsubheading Synopsis
32651
32652 @smallexample
32653 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
32654 @end smallexample
32655
32656 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
32657
32658 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32659
32660 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
32661
32662 @subsubheading Example
32663 N.A.
32664
32665
32666 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
32667 @findex -symbol-list-functions
32668
32669 @subsubheading Synopsis
32670
32671 @smallexample
32672 -symbol-list-functions
32673 @end smallexample
32674
32675 List the functions in the executable.
32676
32677 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32678
32679 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
32680 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32681
32682 @subsubheading Example
32683 N.A.
32684 @end ignore
32685
32686
32687 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
32688 @findex -symbol-list-lines
32689
32690 @subsubheading Synopsis
32691
32692 @smallexample
32693 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
32694 @end smallexample
32695
32696 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
32697 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
32698 ascending PC order.
32699
32700 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32701
32702 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32703
32704 @subsubheading Example
32705 @smallexample
32706 (gdb)
32707 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
32708 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
32709 (gdb)
32710 @end smallexample
32711
32712
32713 @ignore
32714 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
32715 @findex -symbol-list-types
32716
32717 @subsubheading Synopsis
32718
32719 @smallexample
32720 -symbol-list-types
32721 @end smallexample
32722
32723 List all the type names.
32724
32725 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32726
32727 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
32728 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32729
32730 @subsubheading Example
32731 N.A.
32732
32733
32734 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
32735 @findex -symbol-list-variables
32736
32737 @subsubheading Synopsis
32738
32739 @smallexample
32740 -symbol-list-variables
32741 @end smallexample
32742
32743 List all the global and static variable names.
32744
32745 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32746
32747 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32748
32749 @subsubheading Example
32750 N.A.
32751
32752
32753 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
32754 @findex -symbol-locate
32755
32756 @subsubheading Synopsis
32757
32758 @smallexample
32759 -symbol-locate
32760 @end smallexample
32761
32762 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32763
32764 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
32765
32766 @subsubheading Example
32767 N.A.
32768
32769
32770 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
32771 @findex -symbol-type
32772
32773 @subsubheading Synopsis
32774
32775 @smallexample
32776 -symbol-type @var{variable}
32777 @end smallexample
32778
32779 Show type of @var{variable}.
32780
32781 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32782
32783 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
32784 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
32785
32786 @subsubheading Example
32787 N.A.
32788 @end ignore
32789
32790
32791 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32792 @node GDB/MI File Commands
32793 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
32794
32795 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
32796 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
32797
32798 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
32799 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
32800
32801 @subsubheading Synopsis
32802
32803 @smallexample
32804 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
32805 @end smallexample
32806
32807 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
32808 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
32809 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
32810 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
32811 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
32812 notification.
32813
32814 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32815
32816 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
32817
32818 @subsubheading Example
32819
32820 @smallexample
32821 (gdb)
32822 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32823 ^done
32824 (gdb)
32825 @end smallexample
32826
32827
32828 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
32829 @findex -file-exec-file
32830
32831 @subsubheading Synopsis
32832
32833 @smallexample
32834 -file-exec-file @var{file}
32835 @end smallexample
32836
32837 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
32838 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
32839 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
32840 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
32841 notification.
32842
32843 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32844
32845 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
32846
32847 @subsubheading Example
32848
32849 @smallexample
32850 (gdb)
32851 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32852 ^done
32853 (gdb)
32854 @end smallexample
32855
32856
32857 @ignore
32858 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
32859 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
32860
32861 @subsubheading Synopsis
32862
32863 @smallexample
32864 -file-list-exec-sections
32865 @end smallexample
32866
32867 List the sections of the current executable file.
32868
32869 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32870
32871 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
32872 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
32873 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
32874
32875 @subsubheading Example
32876 N.A.
32877 @end ignore
32878
32879
32880 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
32881 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
32882
32883 @subsubheading Synopsis
32884
32885 @smallexample
32886 -file-list-exec-source-file
32887 @end smallexample
32888
32889 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
32890 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
32891 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
32892 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
32893
32894 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32895
32896 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
32897
32898 @subsubheading Example
32899
32900 @smallexample
32901 (gdb)
32902 123-file-list-exec-source-file
32903 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
32904 (gdb)
32905 @end smallexample
32906
32907
32908 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
32909 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
32910
32911 @subsubheading Synopsis
32912
32913 @smallexample
32914 -file-list-exec-source-files
32915 @end smallexample
32916
32917 List the source files for the current executable.
32918
32919 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
32920 name) of a source file.
32921
32922 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32923
32924 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
32925 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
32926
32927 @subsubheading Example
32928 @smallexample
32929 (gdb)
32930 -file-list-exec-source-files
32931 ^done,files=[
32932 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
32933 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
32934 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
32935 (gdb)
32936 @end smallexample
32937
32938 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
32939 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
32940
32941 @subsubheading Synopsis
32942
32943 @smallexample
32944 -file-list-shared-libraries [ @var{regexp} ]
32945 @end smallexample
32946
32947 List the shared libraries in the program.
32948 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those libraries whose
32949 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
32950
32951 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32952
32953 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}. The fields
32954 have a similar meaning to the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
32955 The @code{ranges} field specifies the multiple segments belonging to this
32956 library. Each range has the following fields:
32957
32958 @table @samp
32959 @item from
32960 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the segment.
32961 @item to
32962 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the segment.
32963 @end table
32964
32965 @subsubheading Example
32966 @smallexample
32967 (gdb)
32968 -file-list-exec-source-files
32969 ^done,shared-libraries=[
32970 @{id="/lib/libfoo.so",target-name="/lib/libfoo.so",host-name="/lib/libfoo.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x72815989",to="0x728162c0"@}]@},
32971 @{id="/lib/libbar.so",target-name="/lib/libbar.so",host-name="/lib/libbar.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x76ee48c0",to="0x76ee9160"@}]@}]
32972 (gdb)
32973 @end smallexample
32974
32975
32976 @ignore
32977 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
32978 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
32979
32980 @subsubheading Synopsis
32981
32982 @smallexample
32983 -file-list-symbol-files
32984 @end smallexample
32985
32986 List symbol files.
32987
32988 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32989
32990 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
32991
32992 @subsubheading Example
32993 N.A.
32994 @end ignore
32995
32996
32997 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
32998 @findex -file-symbol-file
32999
33000 @subsubheading Synopsis
33001
33002 @smallexample
33003 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
33004 @end smallexample
33005
33006 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
33007 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
33008 produced, except for a completion notification.
33009
33010 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33011
33012 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
33013
33014 @subsubheading Example
33015
33016 @smallexample
33017 (gdb)
33018 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
33019 ^done
33020 (gdb)
33021 @end smallexample
33022
33023 @ignore
33024 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33025 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
33026 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
33027
33028 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
33029
33030 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
33031
33032 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
33033
33034 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
33035
33036 @c @subheading -overlay-map
33037
33038 @c @subheading -overlay-off
33039
33040 @c @subheading -overlay-on
33041
33042 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
33043
33044 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33045 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
33046 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
33047
33048 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
33049
33050 @c @subheading -signal-handle
33051
33052 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
33053
33054 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
33055 @end ignore
33056
33057
33058 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33059 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
33060 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
33061
33062
33063 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
33064 @findex -target-attach
33065
33066 @subsubheading Synopsis
33067
33068 @smallexample
33069 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
33070 @end smallexample
33071
33072 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
33073 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
33074 group, the id previously returned by
33075 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
33076
33077 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33078
33079 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
33080
33081 @subsubheading Example
33082 @smallexample
33083 (gdb)
33084 -target-attach 34
33085 =thread-created,id="1"
33086 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
33087 ^done
33088 (gdb)
33089 @end smallexample
33090
33091 @ignore
33092 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
33093 @findex -target-compare-sections
33094
33095 @subsubheading Synopsis
33096
33097 @smallexample
33098 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
33099 @end smallexample
33100
33101 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
33102 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
33103
33104 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33105
33106 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
33107
33108 @subsubheading Example
33109 N.A.
33110 @end ignore
33111
33112
33113 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
33114 @findex -target-detach
33115
33116 @subsubheading Synopsis
33117
33118 @smallexample
33119 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
33120 @end smallexample
33121
33122 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
33123 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
33124 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
33125
33126 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33127
33128 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
33129
33130 @subsubheading Example
33131
33132 @smallexample
33133 (gdb)
33134 -target-detach
33135 ^done
33136 (gdb)
33137 @end smallexample
33138
33139
33140 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
33141 @findex -target-disconnect
33142
33143 @subsubheading Synopsis
33144
33145 @smallexample
33146 -target-disconnect
33147 @end smallexample
33148
33149 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
33150 generally not resumed.
33151
33152 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33153
33154 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
33155
33156 @subsubheading Example
33157
33158 @smallexample
33159 (gdb)
33160 -target-disconnect
33161 ^done
33162 (gdb)
33163 @end smallexample
33164
33165
33166 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
33167 @findex -target-download
33168
33169 @subsubheading Synopsis
33170
33171 @smallexample
33172 -target-download
33173 @end smallexample
33174
33175 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
33176 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
33177
33178 @table @samp
33179 @item section
33180 The name of the section.
33181 @item section-sent
33182 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
33183 @item section-size
33184 The size of the section.
33185 @item total-sent
33186 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
33187 @item total-size
33188 The size of the overall executable to download.
33189 @end table
33190
33191 @noindent
33192 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
33193 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
33194
33195 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
33196 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
33197
33198 @table @samp
33199 @item section
33200 The name of the section.
33201 @item section-size
33202 The size of the section.
33203 @item total-size
33204 The size of the overall executable to download.
33205 @end table
33206
33207 @noindent
33208 At the end, a summary is printed.
33209
33210 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33211
33212 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
33213
33214 @subsubheading Example
33215
33216 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
33217 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
33218
33219 @smallexample
33220 (gdb)
33221 -target-download
33222 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
33223 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
33224 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
33225 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
33226 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
33227 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
33228 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
33229 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
33230 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
33231 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
33232 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
33233 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
33234 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
33235 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
33236 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
33237 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
33238 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
33239 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
33240 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
33241 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
33242 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
33243 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
33244 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
33245 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
33246 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
33247 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
33248 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
33249 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
33250 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
33251 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
33252 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
33253 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
33254 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
33255 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
33256 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
33257 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
33258 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
33259 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
33260 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
33261 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
33262 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
33263 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
33264 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
33265 write-rate="429"
33266 (gdb)
33267 @end smallexample
33268
33269
33270 @ignore
33271 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
33272 @findex -target-exec-status
33273
33274 @subsubheading Synopsis
33275
33276 @smallexample
33277 -target-exec-status
33278 @end smallexample
33279
33280 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
33281 not, for instance).
33282
33283 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33284
33285 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
33286
33287 @subsubheading Example
33288 N.A.
33289
33290
33291 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
33292 @findex -target-list-available-targets
33293
33294 @subsubheading Synopsis
33295
33296 @smallexample
33297 -target-list-available-targets
33298 @end smallexample
33299
33300 List the possible targets to connect to.
33301
33302 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33303
33304 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
33305
33306 @subsubheading Example
33307 N.A.
33308
33309
33310 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
33311 @findex -target-list-current-targets
33312
33313 @subsubheading Synopsis
33314
33315 @smallexample
33316 -target-list-current-targets
33317 @end smallexample
33318
33319 Describe the current target.
33320
33321 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33322
33323 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
33324 other things).
33325
33326 @subsubheading Example
33327 N.A.
33328
33329
33330 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
33331 @findex -target-list-parameters
33332
33333 @subsubheading Synopsis
33334
33335 @smallexample
33336 -target-list-parameters
33337 @end smallexample
33338
33339 @c ????
33340 @end ignore
33341
33342 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33343
33344 No equivalent.
33345
33346 @subsubheading Example
33347 N.A.
33348
33349 @subheading The @code{-target-flash-erase} Command
33350 @findex -target-flash-erase
33351
33352 @subsubheading Synopsis
33353
33354 @smallexample
33355 -target-flash-erase
33356 @end smallexample
33357
33358 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
33359
33360 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{flash-erase}.
33361
33362 The output is a list of flash regions that have been erased, with starting
33363 addresses and memory region sizes.
33364
33365 @smallexample
33366 (gdb)
33367 -target-flash-erase
33368 ^done,erased-regions=@{address="0x0",size="0x40000"@}
33369 (gdb)
33370 @end smallexample
33371
33372 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
33373 @findex -target-select
33374
33375 @subsubheading Synopsis
33376
33377 @smallexample
33378 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
33379 @end smallexample
33380
33381 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
33382
33383 @table @samp
33384 @item @var{type}
33385 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
33386 @item @var{parameters}
33387 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
33388 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
33389 @end table
33390
33391 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
33392 which the target program is, in the following form:
33393
33394 @smallexample
33395 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
33396 args=[@var{arg list}]
33397 @end smallexample
33398
33399 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33400
33401 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
33402
33403 @subsubheading Example
33404
33405 @smallexample
33406 (gdb)
33407 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
33408 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
33409 (gdb)
33410 @end smallexample
33411
33412 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33413 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
33414 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
33415
33416
33417 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
33418 @findex -target-file-put
33419
33420 @subsubheading Synopsis
33421
33422 @smallexample
33423 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
33424 @end smallexample
33425
33426 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
33427 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
33428
33429 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33430
33431 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
33432
33433 @subsubheading Example
33434
33435 @smallexample
33436 (gdb)
33437 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
33438 ^done
33439 (gdb)
33440 @end smallexample
33441
33442
33443 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
33444 @findex -target-file-get
33445
33446 @subsubheading Synopsis
33447
33448 @smallexample
33449 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
33450 @end smallexample
33451
33452 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
33453 on the host system.
33454
33455 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33456
33457 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
33458
33459 @subsubheading Example
33460
33461 @smallexample
33462 (gdb)
33463 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
33464 ^done
33465 (gdb)
33466 @end smallexample
33467
33468
33469 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
33470 @findex -target-file-delete
33471
33472 @subsubheading Synopsis
33473
33474 @smallexample
33475 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
33476 @end smallexample
33477
33478 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
33479
33480 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33481
33482 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
33483
33484 @subsubheading Example
33485
33486 @smallexample
33487 (gdb)
33488 -target-file-delete remotefile
33489 ^done
33490 (gdb)
33491 @end smallexample
33492
33493
33494 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33495 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
33496 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
33497
33498 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
33499 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
33500
33501 @subsubheading Synopsis
33502
33503 @smallexample
33504 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
33505 @end smallexample
33506
33507 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
33508 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
33509 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
33510
33511 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33512
33513 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
33514
33515 @subsubheading Result
33516
33517 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
33518 defined for each exception:
33519
33520 @table @samp
33521 @item name
33522 The name of the exception.
33523
33524 @item address
33525 The address of the exception.
33526
33527 @end table
33528
33529 @subsubheading Example
33530
33531 @smallexample
33532 -info-ada-exceptions aint
33533 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
33534 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
33535 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
33536 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
33537 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
33538 @end smallexample
33539
33540 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
33541
33542 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
33543 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
33544 Catchpoint Commands}.
33545
33546
33547 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33548 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
33549 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
33550
33551 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
33552 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
33553 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
33554 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
33555
33556 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
33557 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
33558 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
33559
33560 @subsubheading Synopsis
33561
33562 @smallexample
33563 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
33564 @end smallexample
33565
33566 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
33567
33568 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
33569 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
33570 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
33571 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
33572 dash.
33573
33574 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33575
33576 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
33577
33578 @subsubheading Result
33579
33580 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
33581
33582 @table @samp
33583 @item exists
33584 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
33585 @code{"false"} otherwise.
33586
33587 @end table
33588
33589 @subsubheading Example
33590
33591 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
33592
33593 @smallexample
33594 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
33595 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
33596 @end smallexample
33597
33598 @noindent
33599 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
33600 to the debugger:
33601
33602 @smallexample
33603 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
33604 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
33605 @end smallexample
33606
33607 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
33608 @findex -list-features
33609 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
33610
33611 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
33612 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
33613 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
33614 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
33615 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
33616 startup.
33617
33618 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
33619 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
33620 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
33621 is given below.
33622
33623 Example output:
33624
33625 @smallexample
33626 (gdb) -list-features
33627 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
33628 @end smallexample
33629
33630 The current list of features is:
33631
33632 @ftable @samp
33633 @item frozen-varobjs
33634 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
33635 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
33636 of @code{-varobj-create}.
33637 @item pending-breakpoints
33638 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
33639 command.
33640 @item python
33641 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
33642 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
33643 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
33644 @item thread-info
33645 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
33646 @item data-read-memory-bytes
33647 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
33648 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
33649 @item breakpoint-notifications
33650 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
33651 CLI will be announced via async records.
33652 @item ada-task-info
33653 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
33654 @item language-option
33655 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
33656 option (@pxref{Context management}).
33657 @item info-gdb-mi-command
33658 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
33659 @item undefined-command-error-code
33660 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
33661 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
33662 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
33663 @item exec-run-start-option
33664 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
33665 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
33666 @item data-disassemble-a-option
33667 Indicates that the @code{-data-disassemble} command supports the @option{-a}
33668 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Data Manipulation}).
33669 @end ftable
33670
33671 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
33672 @findex -list-target-features
33673
33674 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
33675 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
33676 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
33677 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
33678 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
33679 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
33680 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
33681 Example output:
33682
33683 @smallexample
33684 (gdb) -list-target-features
33685 ^done,result=["async"]
33686 @end smallexample
33687
33688 The current list of features is:
33689
33690 @table @samp
33691 @item async
33692 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
33693 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
33694 while the target is running.
33695
33696 @item reverse
33697 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
33698 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
33699
33700 @end table
33701
33702 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33703 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
33704 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
33705
33706 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
33707
33708 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
33709 @findex -gdb-exit
33710
33711 @subsubheading Synopsis
33712
33713 @smallexample
33714 -gdb-exit
33715 @end smallexample
33716
33717 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
33718
33719 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33720
33721 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
33722
33723 @subsubheading Example
33724
33725 @smallexample
33726 (gdb)
33727 -gdb-exit
33728 ^exit
33729 @end smallexample
33730
33731
33732 @ignore
33733 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
33734 @findex -exec-abort
33735
33736 @subsubheading Synopsis
33737
33738 @smallexample
33739 -exec-abort
33740 @end smallexample
33741
33742 Kill the inferior running program.
33743
33744 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33745
33746 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
33747
33748 @subsubheading Example
33749 N.A.
33750 @end ignore
33751
33752
33753 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
33754 @findex -gdb-set
33755
33756 @subsubheading Synopsis
33757
33758 @smallexample
33759 -gdb-set
33760 @end smallexample
33761
33762 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
33763 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
33764
33765 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33766
33767 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
33768
33769 @subsubheading Example
33770
33771 @smallexample
33772 (gdb)
33773 -gdb-set $foo=3
33774 ^done
33775 (gdb)
33776 @end smallexample
33777
33778
33779 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
33780 @findex -gdb-show
33781
33782 @subsubheading Synopsis
33783
33784 @smallexample
33785 -gdb-show
33786 @end smallexample
33787
33788 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
33789
33790 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33791
33792 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
33793
33794 @subsubheading Example
33795
33796 @smallexample
33797 (gdb)
33798 -gdb-show annotate
33799 ^done,value="0"
33800 (gdb)
33801 @end smallexample
33802
33803 @c @subheading -gdb-source
33804
33805
33806 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
33807 @findex -gdb-version
33808
33809 @subsubheading Synopsis
33810
33811 @smallexample
33812 -gdb-version
33813 @end smallexample
33814
33815 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
33816
33817 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33818
33819 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
33820 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
33821
33822 @subsubheading Example
33823
33824 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
33825 @c box in TeX.
33826 @smallexample
33827 (gdb)
33828 -gdb-version
33829 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
33830 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
33831 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
33832 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
33833 ~ certain conditions.
33834 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
33835 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
33836 ~ details.
33837 ~This GDB was configured as
33838 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
33839 ^done
33840 (gdb)
33841 @end smallexample
33842
33843 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
33844 @findex -list-thread-groups
33845
33846 @subheading Synopsis
33847
33848 @smallexample
33849 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
33850 @end smallexample
33851
33852 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
33853 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
33854 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
33855 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
33856 top-level thread groups.
33857
33858 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
33859 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
33860 available on the target.
33861
33862 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
33863 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
33864 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
33865 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
33866 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
33867 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
33868 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
33869 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
33870
33871 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
33872 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
33873 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
33874 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
33875 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
33876 @samp{threads} field.
33877
33878 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
33879 the following caveats:
33880
33881 @itemize @bullet
33882 @item
33883 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
33884 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
33885 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
33886
33887 @item
33888 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
33889 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
33890 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
33891 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
33892 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
33893 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
33894
33895 @end itemize
33896
33897 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
33898 have the following fields:
33899
33900 @table @code
33901 @item id
33902 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
33903 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
33904 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
33905
33906 @item type
33907 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
33908 valid type.
33909
33910 @item pid
33911 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
33912 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
33913
33914 @item exit-code
33915 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
33916 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
33917 only if the process is not running.
33918
33919 @item num_children
33920 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
33921 absent for an available thread group.
33922
33923 @item threads
33924 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
33925 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
33926 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
33927
33928 @item cores
33929 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
33930 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
33931 such information is not available.
33932
33933 @item executable
33934 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
33935 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
33936 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
33937
33938 @end table
33939
33940 @subheading Example
33941
33942 @smallexample
33943 @value{GDBP}
33944 -list-thread-groups
33945 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
33946 -list-thread-groups 17
33947 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
33948 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
33949 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
33950 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
33951 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},state="running"@}]]
33952 -list-thread-groups --available
33953 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
33954 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
33955 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
33956 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
33957 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
33958 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
33959 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
33960 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
33961 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
33962 @end smallexample
33963
33964 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
33965 @findex -info-os
33966
33967 @subsubheading Synopsis
33968
33969 @smallexample
33970 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
33971 @end smallexample
33972
33973 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
33974 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
33975 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
33976 of data of that type.
33977
33978 The types of information available depend on the target operating
33979 system.
33980
33981 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33982
33983 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
33984
33985 @subsubheading Example
33986
33987 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
33988 like this:
33989
33990 @smallexample
33991 @value{GDBP}
33992 -info-os
33993 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
33994 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
33995 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
33996 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
33997 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
33998 col2="CPUs"@},
33999 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
34000 col2="File descriptors"@},
34001 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
34002 col2="Kernel modules"@},
34003 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
34004 col2="Message queues"@},
34005 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
34006 col2="Processes"@},
34007 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
34008 col2="Process groups"@},
34009 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
34010 col2="Semaphores"@},
34011 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
34012 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
34013 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
34014 col2="Sockets"@},
34015 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
34016 col2="Threads"@}]
34017 @value{GDBP}
34018 -info-os processes
34019 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
34020 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
34021 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
34022 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
34023 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
34024 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
34025 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
34026 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
34027 ...
34028 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
34029 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
34030 (gdb)
34031 @end smallexample
34032
34033 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
34034 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
34035 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
34036 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
34037 @code{info os} omits it.)
34038
34039 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
34040 @findex -add-inferior
34041
34042 @subheading Synopsis
34043
34044 @smallexample
34045 -add-inferior
34046 @end smallexample
34047
34048 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
34049 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
34050 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
34051 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
34052 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
34053 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
34054
34055 @subheading Example
34056
34057 @smallexample
34058 @value{GDBP}
34059 -add-inferior
34060 ^done,inferior="i3"
34061 @end smallexample
34062
34063 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
34064 @findex -interpreter-exec
34065
34066 @subheading Synopsis
34067
34068 @smallexample
34069 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
34070 @end smallexample
34071 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
34072
34073 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
34074
34075 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34076
34077 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
34078
34079 @subheading Example
34080
34081 @smallexample
34082 (gdb)
34083 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
34084 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
34085 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
34086 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
34087 ^done
34088 (gdb)
34089 @end smallexample
34090
34091 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
34092 @findex -inferior-tty-set
34093
34094 @subheading Synopsis
34095
34096 @smallexample
34097 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
34098 @end smallexample
34099
34100 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
34101
34102 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34103
34104 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
34105
34106 @subheading Example
34107
34108 @smallexample
34109 (gdb)
34110 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
34111 ^done
34112 (gdb)
34113 @end smallexample
34114
34115 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
34116 @findex -inferior-tty-show
34117
34118 @subheading Synopsis
34119
34120 @smallexample
34121 -inferior-tty-show
34122 @end smallexample
34123
34124 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
34125
34126 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34127
34128 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
34129
34130 @subheading Example
34131
34132 @smallexample
34133 (gdb)
34134 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
34135 ^done
34136 (gdb)
34137 -inferior-tty-show
34138 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
34139 (gdb)
34140 @end smallexample
34141
34142 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
34143 @findex -enable-timings
34144
34145 @subheading Synopsis
34146
34147 @smallexample
34148 -enable-timings [yes | no]
34149 @end smallexample
34150
34151 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
34152 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
34153 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
34154 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
34155
34156 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34157
34158 No equivalent.
34159
34160 @subheading Example
34161
34162 @smallexample
34163 (gdb)
34164 -enable-timings
34165 ^done
34166 (gdb)
34167 -break-insert main
34168 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
34169 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
34170 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
34171 times="0"@},
34172 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
34173 (gdb)
34174 -enable-timings no
34175 ^done
34176 (gdb)
34177 -exec-run
34178 ^running
34179 (gdb)
34180 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
34181 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
34182 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
34183 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
34184 (gdb)
34185 @end smallexample
34186
34187 @node Annotations
34188 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
34189
34190 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
34191 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
34192 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
34193 relatively high level.
34194
34195 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
34196 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
34197
34198 @ignore
34199 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
34200 @end ignore
34201
34202 @menu
34203 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
34204 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
34205 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
34206 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
34207 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
34208 * Annotations for Running::
34209 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
34210 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
34211 @end menu
34212
34213 @node Annotations Overview
34214 @section What is an Annotation?
34215 @cindex annotations
34216
34217 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
34218 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
34219 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
34220 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
34221 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
34222 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
34223 cannot contain newline characters.
34224
34225 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
34226 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
34227 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
34228 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
34229 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
34230 means those three characters as output.
34231
34232 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
34233 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
34234 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
34235 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
34236 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
34237 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
34238 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
34239 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
34240 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
34241
34242 @table @code
34243 @kindex set annotate
34244 @item set annotate @var{level}
34245 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
34246 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
34247
34248 @item show annotate
34249 @kindex show annotate
34250 Show the current annotation level.
34251 @end table
34252
34253 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
34254
34255 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
34256
34257 @smallexample
34258 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
34259 GNU gdb 6.0
34260 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
34261 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
34262 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
34263 under certain conditions.
34264 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
34265 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
34266 for details.
34267 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
34268
34269 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
34270 (@value{GDBP})
34271 ^Z^Zprompt
34272 @kbd{quit}
34273
34274 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
34275 $
34276 @end smallexample
34277
34278 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
34279 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
34280 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
34281 output from @value{GDBN}.
34282
34283 @node Server Prefix
34284 @section The Server Prefix
34285 @cindex server prefix
34286
34287 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
34288 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
34289 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
34290 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
34291 a transparent manner.
34292
34293 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
34294 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
34295 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
34296 @code{print} command.
34297
34298 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
34299 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
34300
34301 @node Prompting
34302 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
34303
34304 @cindex annotations for prompts
34305 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
34306 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
34307 over, etc.
34308
34309 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
34310 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
34311 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
34312 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
34313 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
34314 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
34315 features the following annotations:
34316
34317 @smallexample
34318 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
34319 ^Z^Zprompt
34320 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
34321 @end smallexample
34322
34323 The input types are
34324
34325 @table @code
34326 @findex pre-prompt annotation
34327 @findex prompt annotation
34328 @findex post-prompt annotation
34329 @item prompt
34330 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
34331
34332 @findex pre-commands annotation
34333 @findex commands annotation
34334 @findex post-commands annotation
34335 @item commands
34336 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
34337 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
34338
34339 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
34340 @findex overload-choice annotation
34341 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
34342 @item overload-choice
34343 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
34344
34345 @findex pre-query annotation
34346 @findex query annotation
34347 @findex post-query annotation
34348 @item query
34349 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
34350
34351 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
34352 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
34353 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
34354 @item prompt-for-continue
34355 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
34356 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
34357 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
34358 presence of annotations.
34359 @end table
34360
34361 @node Errors
34362 @section Errors
34363 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
34364
34365 @findex quit annotation
34366 @smallexample
34367 ^Z^Zquit
34368 @end smallexample
34369
34370 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
34371
34372 @findex error annotation
34373 @smallexample
34374 ^Z^Zerror
34375 @end smallexample
34376
34377 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
34378
34379 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
34380 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
34381 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
34382 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
34383 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
34384 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
34385 to the top level.
34386
34387 @findex error-begin annotation
34388 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
34389
34390 @smallexample
34391 ^Z^Zerror-begin
34392 @end smallexample
34393
34394 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
34395 message.
34396
34397 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
34398 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
34399 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
34400
34401 @node Invalidation
34402 @section Invalidation Notices
34403
34404 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
34405 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
34406 changed.
34407
34408 @table @code
34409 @findex frames-invalid annotation
34410 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
34411
34412 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
34413 have changed.
34414
34415 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
34416 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
34417
34418 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
34419 deleted a breakpoint.
34420 @end table
34421
34422 @node Annotations for Running
34423 @section Running the Program
34424 @cindex annotations for running programs
34425
34426 @findex starting annotation
34427 @findex stopping annotation
34428 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
34429 @code{step} or @code{continue},
34430
34431 @smallexample
34432 ^Z^Zstarting
34433 @end smallexample
34434
34435 is output. When the program stops,
34436
34437 @smallexample
34438 ^Z^Zstopped
34439 @end smallexample
34440
34441 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
34442 annotations describe how the program stopped.
34443
34444 @table @code
34445 @findex exited annotation
34446 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
34447 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
34448 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
34449
34450 @findex signalled annotation
34451 @findex signal-name annotation
34452 @findex signal-name-end annotation
34453 @findex signal-string annotation
34454 @findex signal-string-end annotation
34455 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
34456 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
34457 annotation continues:
34458
34459 @smallexample
34460 @var{intro-text}
34461 ^Z^Zsignal-name
34462 @var{name}
34463 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
34464 @var{middle-text}
34465 ^Z^Zsignal-string
34466 @var{string}
34467 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
34468 @var{end-text}
34469 @end smallexample
34470
34471 @noindent
34472 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
34473 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
34474 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
34475 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
34476 user's benefit and have no particular format.
34477
34478 @findex signal annotation
34479 @item ^Z^Zsignal
34480 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
34481 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
34482 terminated with it.
34483
34484 @findex breakpoint annotation
34485 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
34486 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
34487
34488 @findex watchpoint annotation
34489 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
34490 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
34491 @end table
34492
34493 @node Source Annotations
34494 @section Displaying Source
34495 @cindex annotations for source display
34496
34497 @findex source annotation
34498 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
34499
34500 @smallexample
34501 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
34502 @end smallexample
34503
34504 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
34505 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
34506 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
34507 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
34508 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
34509 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
34510 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
34511 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
34512 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
34513 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
34514 depend on the language).
34515
34516 @node JIT Interface
34517 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
34518 @cindex just-in-time compilation
34519 @cindex JIT compilation interface
34520
34521 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
34522 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
34523 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
34524 performance while maintaining platform independence.
34525
34526 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
34527 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
34528 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
34529 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
34530 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
34531 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
34532
34533 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
34534 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
34535 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
34536 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
34537 LLVM JIT.
34538
34539 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
34540 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
34541 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
34542 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
34543 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
34544 out about additional code.
34545
34546 @menu
34547 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
34548 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
34549 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
34550 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
34551 @end menu
34552
34553 @node Declarations
34554 @section JIT Declarations
34555
34556 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
34557 implement the interface:
34558
34559 @smallexample
34560 typedef enum
34561 @{
34562 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
34563 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
34564 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
34565 @} jit_actions_t;
34566
34567 struct jit_code_entry
34568 @{
34569 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
34570 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
34571 const char *symfile_addr;
34572 uint64_t symfile_size;
34573 @};
34574
34575 struct jit_descriptor
34576 @{
34577 uint32_t version;
34578 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
34579 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
34580 uint32_t action_flag;
34581 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
34582 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
34583 @};
34584
34585 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
34586 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
34587
34588 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
34589 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
34590 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
34591 @end smallexample
34592
34593 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
34594 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
34595 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
34596
34597 @node Registering Code
34598 @section Registering Code
34599
34600 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
34601
34602 @itemize @bullet
34603 @item
34604 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
34605 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
34606
34607 @item
34608 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
34609 file.
34610
34611 @item
34612 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
34613
34614 @item
34615 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
34616
34617 @item
34618 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
34619 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
34620 @end itemize
34621
34622 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
34623 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
34624 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
34625 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
34626
34627 @node Unregistering Code
34628 @section Unregistering Code
34629
34630 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
34631
34632 @itemize @bullet
34633 @item
34634 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
34635
34636 @item
34637 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
34638
34639 @item
34640 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
34641 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
34642 @end itemize
34643
34644 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
34645 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
34646
34647 @node Custom Debug Info
34648 @section Custom Debug Info
34649 @cindex custom JIT debug info
34650 @cindex JIT debug info reader
34651
34652 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
34653 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
34654 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
34655 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
34656 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
34657 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
34658 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
34659 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
34660 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
34661
34662 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
34663 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
34664 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
34665 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
34666 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
34667 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
34668 compiler.
34669
34670 @menu
34671 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
34672 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
34673 @end menu
34674
34675 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
34676 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
34677 @kindex jit-reader-load
34678 @kindex jit-reader-unload
34679
34680 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
34681 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
34682
34683 @table @code
34684 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
34685 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
34686 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
34687 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
34688 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
34689 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
34690 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
34691
34692 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
34693 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
34694 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
34695 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
34696 @code{jit-reader-load}.
34697
34698 @item jit-reader-unload
34699 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
34700
34701 @end table
34702
34703 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
34704 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
34705 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
34706
34707 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
34708 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
34709
34710 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
34711 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
34712 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
34713 the system include directory.
34714
34715 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
34716 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
34717 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
34718
34719 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
34720 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
34721
34722 @findex gdb_init_reader
34723 @smallexample
34724 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
34725 @end smallexample
34726
34727 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
34728
34729 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
34730 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
34731 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
34732 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
34733 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
34734 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
34735
34736 @smallexample
34737 struct gdb_reader_funcs
34738 @{
34739 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
34740 int reader_version;
34741
34742 /* For use by the reader. */
34743 void *priv_data;
34744
34745 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
34746 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
34747 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
34748 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
34749 @};
34750 @end smallexample
34751
34752 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
34753 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
34754
34755 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
34756 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
34757 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
34758 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
34759 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
34760 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
34761 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
34762 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
34763 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
34764 target's address space.
34765
34766 @node In-Process Agent
34767 @chapter In-Process Agent
34768 @cindex debugging agent
34769 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
34770 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
34771 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
34772 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
34773 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
34774 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
34775 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
34776 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
34777 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
34778 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
34779 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
34780 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
34781 behavior without interrupting it.
34782
34783 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
34784 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
34785 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
34786 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
34787 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
34788 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
34789 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
34790 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
34791 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
34792
34793 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
34794 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
34795 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
34796 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
34797
34798 @anchor{Control Agent}
34799 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
34800 debugging with the following commands:
34801
34802 @table @code
34803 @kindex set agent on
34804 @item set agent on
34805 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
34806 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
34807 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
34808 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
34809 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
34810 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
34811
34812 @kindex set agent off
34813 @item set agent off
34814 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
34815 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
34816
34817 @kindex show agent
34818 @item show agent
34819 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
34820 the in-process agent.
34821 @end table
34822
34823 @menu
34824 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
34825 @end menu
34826
34827 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
34828 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
34829 @cindex in-process agent protocol
34830
34831 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
34832 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
34833 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
34834 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
34835 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
34836 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
34837 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
34838 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
34839 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
34840
34841 @menu
34842 * IPA Protocol Objects::
34843 * IPA Protocol Commands::
34844 @end menu
34845
34846 @node IPA Protocol Objects
34847 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
34848 @cindex ipa protocol objects
34849
34850 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
34851 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
34852
34853 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
34854 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
34855 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
34856 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
34857
34858 @enumerate
34859 @item
34860 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
34861 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
34862 @item
34863 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
34864 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
34865 the other one.
34866 @end enumerate
34867
34868 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
34869
34870 @enumerate
34871 @item
34872 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
34873 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
34874 @anchor{agent expression object}
34875 @item
34876 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
34877 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
34878 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
34879 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
34880 @item
34881 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
34882 @anchor{tracepoint object}
34883
34884 @end enumerate
34885
34886 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
34887 object:
34888
34889 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
34890 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
34891 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
34892 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
34893 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
34894 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
34895 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34896 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
34897 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
34898 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
34899 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
34900 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
34901 memory address for collecting.
34902 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
34903 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34904 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
34905 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34906 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
34907 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34908 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
34909 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
34910 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
34911 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
34912 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
34913 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
34914 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
34915 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
34916 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
34917 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
34918 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
34919 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
34920 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
34921 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
34922 @ref{agent expression object}
34923 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
34924 @ref{agent expression object}
34925 @item actions @tab variable
34926 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
34927 @end multitable
34928
34929 @node IPA Protocol Commands
34930 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
34931 @cindex ipa protocol commands
34932
34933 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
34934 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
34935
34936 @table @samp
34937
34938 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
34939 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
34940 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
34941 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
34942 in IPA finally.
34943
34944 Replies:
34945 @table @samp
34946 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
34947 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
34948 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
34949 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
34950 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
34951 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
34952 @item E @var{NN}
34953 for an error
34954
34955 @end table
34956
34957 @item close
34958 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
34959 is about to kill inferiors.
34960
34961 @item qTfSTM
34962 @xref{qTfSTM}.
34963 @item qTsSTM
34964 @xref{qTsSTM}.
34965 @item qTSTMat
34966 @xref{qTSTMat}.
34967 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
34968 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
34969
34970 Replies:
34971 @table @samp
34972 @item E @var{NN}
34973 for an error
34974 @end table
34975 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
34976 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
34977 @end table
34978
34979 @node GDB Bugs
34980 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
34981 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
34982 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
34983
34984 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
34985
34986 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
34987 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
34988 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
34989 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
34990
34991 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
34992 information that enables us to fix the bug.
34993
34994 @menu
34995 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
34996 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
34997 @end menu
34998
34999 @node Bug Criteria
35000 @section Have You Found a Bug?
35001 @cindex bug criteria
35002
35003 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
35004
35005 @itemize @bullet
35006 @cindex fatal signal
35007 @cindex debugger crash
35008 @cindex crash of debugger
35009 @item
35010 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
35011 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
35012
35013 @cindex error on valid input
35014 @item
35015 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
35016 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
35017 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
35018
35019 @cindex invalid input
35020 @item
35021 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
35022 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
35023 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
35024 for traditional practice''.
35025
35026 @item
35027 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
35028 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
35029 @end itemize
35030
35031 @node Bug Reporting
35032 @section How to Report Bugs
35033 @cindex bug reports
35034 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
35035
35036 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
35037 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
35038 contact that organization first.
35039
35040 You can find contact information for many support companies and
35041 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
35042 distribution.
35043 @c should add a web page ref...
35044
35045 @ifset BUGURL
35046 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
35047 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
35048 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
35049 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
35050 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
35051 be used.
35052
35053 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
35054 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
35055 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
35056 @samp{bug-gdb}.
35057
35058 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
35059 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
35060 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
35061 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
35062 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
35063 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
35064 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
35065 bug reports to the mailing list.
35066 @end ifset
35067 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
35068 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
35069 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
35070 @end ifclear
35071 @end ifset
35072
35073 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
35074 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
35075 fact or leave it out, state it!
35076
35077 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
35078 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
35079 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
35080 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
35081 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
35082 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
35083 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
35084 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
35085 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
35086
35087 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
35088 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
35089 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
35090 self-contained.
35091
35092 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
35093 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
35094 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
35095 bugs properly.
35096
35097 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
35098
35099 @itemize @bullet
35100 @item
35101 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
35102 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
35103 version}.
35104
35105 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
35106 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
35107
35108 @item
35109 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
35110 version number.
35111
35112 @item
35113 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
35114 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
35115 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
35116 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
35117
35118 @item
35119 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
35120 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
35121
35122 @item
35123 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
35124 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
35125 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
35126 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
35127 those compilers.
35128
35129 @item
35130 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
35131 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
35132 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
35133 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
35134
35135 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
35136 and then we might not encounter the bug.
35137
35138 @item
35139 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
35140 reproduce the bug.
35141
35142 @item
35143 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
35144 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
35145
35146 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
35147 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
35148 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
35149 a chance to make a mistake.
35150
35151 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
35152 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
35153 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
35154 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
35155 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
35156 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
35157 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
35158 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
35159
35160 @pindex script
35161 @cindex recording a session script
35162 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
35163 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
35164 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
35165 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
35166
35167 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
35168 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
35169
35170 @item
35171 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
35172 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
35173 it by context, not by line number.
35174
35175 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
35176 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
35177
35178 @end itemize
35179
35180 Here are some things that are not necessary:
35181
35182 @itemize @bullet
35183 @item
35184 A description of the envelope of the bug.
35185
35186 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
35187 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
35188 changes will not affect it.
35189
35190 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
35191 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
35192 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
35193 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
35194
35195 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
35196 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
35197 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
35198 less time, and so on.
35199
35200 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
35201 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
35202
35203 @item
35204 A patch for the bug.
35205
35206 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
35207 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
35208 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
35209 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
35210
35211 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
35212 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
35213 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
35214 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
35215
35216 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
35217 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
35218 help us to understand.
35219
35220 @item
35221 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
35222
35223 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
35224 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
35225 @end itemize
35226
35227 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
35228 @c and consists of the two following files:
35229 @c rluser.texi
35230 @c hsuser.texi
35231 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
35232 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
35233 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
35234 @include rluser.texi
35235 @include hsuser.texi
35236 @end ifclear
35237
35238 @node In Memoriam
35239 @appendix In Memoriam
35240
35241 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
35242 contributors:
35243
35244 @table @code
35245 @item Fred Fish
35246 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
35247 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
35248 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
35249
35250 @item Michael Snyder
35251 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
35252 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
35253 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
35254 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
35255 @end table
35256
35257 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
35258 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
35259
35260 @node Formatting Documentation
35261 @appendix Formatting Documentation
35262
35263 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
35264 @cindex reference card
35265 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
35266 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
35267 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
35268 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
35269 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
35270 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
35271
35272 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
35273 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
35274
35275 @smallexample
35276 make refcard.dvi
35277 @end smallexample
35278
35279 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
35280 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
35281 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
35282 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
35283 your @sc{dvi} output program.
35284
35285 @cindex documentation
35286
35287 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
35288 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
35289 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
35290 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
35291 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
35292 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
35293
35294 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
35295 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
35296 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
35297 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
35298 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
35299 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
35300 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
35301 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
35302
35303 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
35304 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
35305 @code{makeinfo}.
35306
35307 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
35308 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
35309 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
35310
35311 @smallexample
35312 cd gdb
35313 make gdb.info
35314 @end smallexample
35315
35316 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
35317 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
35318 Texinfo definitions file.
35319
35320 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
35321 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
35322 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
35323 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
35324 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
35325 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
35326 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
35327
35328 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
35329 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
35330 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
35331 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
35332 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
35333 directory.
35334
35335 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
35336 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
35337 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
35338 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
35339
35340 @smallexample
35341 make gdb.dvi
35342 @end smallexample
35343
35344 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
35345
35346 @node Installing GDB
35347 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
35348 @cindex installation
35349
35350 @menu
35351 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
35352 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
35353 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
35354 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
35355 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
35356 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
35357 @end menu
35358
35359 @node Requirements
35360 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
35361 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
35362
35363 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
35364 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
35365
35366 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
35367 @table @asis
35368 @item C@t{++}11 compiler
35369 @value{GDBN} is written in C@t{++}11. It should be buildable with any
35370 recent C@t{++}11 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
35371
35372 @item GNU make
35373 @value{GDBN}'s build system relies on features only found in the GNU
35374 make program. Other variants of @code{make} will not work.
35375 @end table
35376
35377 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
35378 @table @asis
35379 @item Expat
35380 @anchor{Expat}
35381 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
35382 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
35383 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
35384 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
35385 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
35386 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
35387
35388 Expat is used for:
35389
35390 @itemize @bullet
35391 @item
35392 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
35393 @item
35394 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
35395 @item
35396 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
35397 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
35398 @item
35399 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
35400 @item
35401 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
35402 @item
35403 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
35404 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
35405 @end itemize
35406
35407 @item Guile
35408 @value{GDBN} can be scripted using GNU Guile. @xref{Guile}. By
35409 default, @value{GDBN} will be compiled if the Guile libraries are
35410 installed and are found by @file{configure}. You can use the
35411 @code{--with-guile} option to request Guile, and pass either the Guile
35412 version number or the file name of the relevant @code{pkg-config}
35413 program to choose a particular version of Guile.
35414
35415 @item iconv
35416 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
35417 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
35418 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
35419 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
35420
35421 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
35422 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to
35423 find it. This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies
35424 the directory that contains the @code{iconv} program. This program is
35425 run in order to make a list of the available character sets.
35426
35427 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If
35428 Libiconv is installed in a standard place, @value{GDBN} will
35429 automatically use it if it is needed. If you have previously
35430 installed Libiconv in a non-standard place, you can use the
35431 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to @file{configure}.
35432
35433 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
35434 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
35435 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
35436 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
35437 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
35438 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
35439 Libiconv, unpack it inside the top-level directory of the @value{GDBN}
35440 source tree, and then rename the directory holding the Libiconv source
35441 code to @samp{libiconv}.
35442
35443 @item lzma
35444 @value{GDBN} can support debugging sections that are compressed with
35445 the LZMA library. @xref{MiniDebugInfo}. If this library is not
35446 included with your operating system, you can find it in the xz package
35447 at @url{http://tukaani.org/xz/}. If the LZMA library is available in
35448 the usual place, then the @file{configure} script will use it
35449 automatically. If it is installed in an unusual path, you can use the
35450 @option{--with-lzma-prefix} option to specify its location.
35451
35452 @item MPFR
35453 @anchor{MPFR}
35454 @value{GDBN} can use the GNU MPFR multiple-precision floating-point
35455 library. This library may be included with your operating system
35456 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
35457 @url{http://www.mpfr.org}. The @file{configure} script will search
35458 for this library in several standard locations; if it is installed
35459 in an unusual path, you can use the @option{--with-libmpfr-prefix}
35460 option to specify its location.
35461
35462 GNU MPFR is used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during
35463 expression evaluation when the target uses different floating-point
35464 formats than the host. If GNU MPFR it is not available, @value{GDBN}
35465 will fall back to using host floating-point arithmetic.
35466
35467 @item Python
35468 @value{GDBN} can be scripted using Python language. @xref{Python}.
35469 By default, @value{GDBN} will be compiled if the Python libraries are
35470 installed and are found by @file{configure}. You can use the
35471 @code{--with-python} option to request Python, and pass either the
35472 file name of the relevant @code{python} executable, or the name of the
35473 directory in which Python is installed, to choose a particular
35474 installation of Python.
35475
35476 @item zlib
35477 @cindex compressed debug sections
35478 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
35479 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
35480 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
35481 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
35482 information in such binaries.
35483
35484 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
35485 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
35486 @url{http://zlib.net}.
35487 @end table
35488
35489 @node Running Configure
35490 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
35491 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
35492 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
35493 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
35494 build the @code{gdb} program.
35495 @iftex
35496 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
35497 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
35498 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
35499 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
35500 @end iftex
35501
35502 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
35503 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
35504 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
35505
35506 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
35507 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
35508
35509 @table @code
35510 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
35511 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
35512
35513 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
35514 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
35515
35516 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
35517 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
35518
35519 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
35520 @sc{gnu} include files
35521
35522 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
35523 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
35524
35525 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
35526 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
35527
35528 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
35529 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
35530 @end table
35531
35532 There may be other subdirectories as well.
35533
35534 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
35535 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
35536 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
35537
35538 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
35539 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
35540 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
35541 argument.
35542
35543 For example:
35544
35545 @smallexample
35546 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
35547 ./configure
35548 make
35549 @end smallexample
35550
35551 Running @samp{configure} and then running @code{make} builds the
35552 included supporting libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured
35553 source files, and the binaries, are left in the corresponding source
35554 directories.
35555
35556 @need 750
35557 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
35558 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
35559 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
35560
35561 @smallexample
35562 sh configure
35563 @end smallexample
35564
35565 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
35566 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
35567 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
35568 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
35569 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
35570 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
35571 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
35572 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
35573 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
35574
35575 You can install @code{@value{GDBN}} anywhere. The best way to do this
35576 is to pass the @code{--prefix} option to @code{configure}, and then
35577 install it with @code{make install}.
35578
35579 @node Separate Objdir
35580 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
35581
35582 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
35583 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
35584 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
35585 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
35586 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
35587 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
35588 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
35589 program specified there.
35590
35591 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
35592 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
35593 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
35594 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
35595 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
35596 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
35597
35598 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
35599 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
35600
35601 @smallexample
35602 @group
35603 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
35604 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
35605 cd ../gdb-sun4
35606 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure
35607 make
35608 @end group
35609 @end smallexample
35610
35611 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
35612 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
35613 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
35614 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
35615 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
35616 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
35617
35618 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
35619 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
35620 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
35621 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
35622 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
35623
35624 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
35625 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
35626 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
35627 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
35628 You specify a cross-debugging target by
35629 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
35630
35631 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
35632 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
35633 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
35634
35635 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
35636 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
35637 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
35638 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
35639 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
35640
35641 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
35642 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
35643 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
35644 with each other.
35645
35646 @node Config Names
35647 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
35648
35649 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
35650 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
35651 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
35652 of information in the following pattern:
35653
35654 @smallexample
35655 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
35656 @end smallexample
35657
35658 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
35659 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
35660 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
35661
35662 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
35663 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
35664 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
35665 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
35666 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
35667 abbreviations---for example:
35668
35669 @smallexample
35670 % sh config.sub i386-linux
35671 i386-pc-linux-gnu
35672 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
35673 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
35674 % sh config.sub hp9k700
35675 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
35676 % sh config.sub sun4
35677 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
35678 % sh config.sub sun3
35679 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
35680 % sh config.sub i986v
35681 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
35682 @end smallexample
35683
35684 @noindent
35685 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
35686 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
35687
35688 @node Configure Options
35689 @section @file{configure} Options
35690
35691 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
35692 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure}
35693 also has several other options not listed here. @inforef{Running
35694 configure scripts,,autoconf.info}, for a full
35695 explanation of @file{configure}.
35696
35697 @smallexample
35698 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
35699 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
35700 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
35701 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
35702 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
35703 @end smallexample
35704
35705 @noindent
35706 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
35707 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
35708 @samp{--}.
35709
35710 @table @code
35711 @item --help
35712 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
35713
35714 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
35715 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
35716 @file{@var{dir}}.
35717
35718 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
35719 Configure the source to install programs under directory
35720 @file{@var{dir}}.
35721
35722 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
35723 @need 2000
35724 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
35725 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
35726 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
35727 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
35728 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
35729 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
35730 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
35731 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
35732 @var{dirname}.
35733
35734 @item --target=@var{target}
35735 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
35736 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
35737 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
35738
35739 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available
35740 targets. Also see the @code{--enable-targets} option, below.
35741 @end table
35742
35743 There are many other options that are specific to @value{GDBN}. This
35744 lists just the most common ones; there are some very specialized
35745 options not described here.
35746
35747 @table @code
35748 @item --enable-targets=@r{[}@var{target}@r{]}@dots{}
35749 @itemx --enable-targets=all
35750 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the
35751 specified list of targets. The special value @samp{all} configures
35752 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs running on any target it supports.
35753
35754 @item --with-gdb-datadir=@var{path}
35755 Set the @value{GDBN}-specific data directory. @value{GDBN} will look
35756 here for certain supporting files or scripts. This defaults to the
35757 @file{gdb} subdirectory of @samp{datadi} (which can be set using
35758 @code{--datadir}).
35759
35760 @item --with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}
35761 Sets up the default source path substitution rule so that directory
35762 names recorded in debug information will be automatically adjusted for
35763 any directory under @var{dir}. @var{dir} should be a subdirectory of
35764 @value{GDBN}'s configured prefix, the one mentioned in the
35765 @code{--prefix} or @code{--exec-prefix} options to configure. This
35766 option is useful if GDB is supposed to be moved to a different place
35767 after it is built.
35768
35769 @item --enable-64-bit-bfd
35770 Enable 64-bit support in BFD on 32-bit hosts.
35771
35772 @item --disable-gdbmi
35773 Build @value{GDBN} without the GDB/MI machine interface
35774 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
35775
35776 @item --enable-tui
35777 Build @value{GDBN} with the text-mode full-screen user interface
35778 (TUI). Requires a curses library (ncurses and cursesX are also
35779 supported).
35780
35781 @item --with-curses
35782 Use the curses library instead of the termcap library, for text-mode
35783 terminal operations.
35784
35785 @item --with-libunwind-ia64
35786 Use the libunwind library for unwinding function call stack on ia64
35787 target platforms. See http://www.nongnu.org/libunwind/index.html for
35788 details.
35789
35790 @item --with-system-readline
35791 Use the readline library installed on the host, rather than the
35792 library supplied as part of @value{GDBN}.
35793
35794 @item --with-system-zlib
35795 Use the zlib library installed on the host, rather than the library
35796 supplied as part of @value{GDBN}.
35797
35798 @item --with-expat
35799 Build @value{GDBN} with Expat, a library for XML parsing. (Done by
35800 default if libexpat is installed and found at configure time.) This
35801 library is used to read XML files supplied with @value{GDBN}. If it
35802 is unavailable, some features, such as remote protocol memory maps,
35803 target descriptions, and shared library lists, that are based on XML
35804 files, will not be available in @value{GDBN}. If your host does not
35805 have libexpat installed, you can get the latest version from
35806 `http://expat.sourceforge.net'.
35807
35808 @item --with-libiconv-prefix@r{[}=@var{dir}@r{]}
35809
35810 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU libiconv, a character set encoding
35811 conversion library. This is not done by default, as on GNU systems
35812 the @code{iconv} that is built in to the C library is sufficient. If
35813 your host does not have a working @code{iconv}, you can get the latest
35814 version of GNU iconv from `https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/'.
35815
35816 @value{GDBN}'s build system also supports building GNU libiconv as
35817 part of the overall build. @xref{Requirements}.
35818
35819 @item --with-lzma
35820 Build @value{GDBN} with LZMA, a compression library. (Done by default
35821 if liblzma is installed and found at configure time.) LZMA is used by
35822 @value{GDBN}'s "mini debuginfo" feature, which is only useful on
35823 platforms using the ELF object file format. If your host does not
35824 have liblzma installed, you can get the latest version from
35825 `https://tukaani.org/xz/'.
35826
35827 @item --with-mpfr
35828 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU MPFR, a library for multiple-precision
35829 floating-point computation with correct rounding. (Done by default if
35830 GNU MPFR is installed and found at configure time.) This library is
35831 used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during expression
35832 evaluation when the target uses different floating-point formats than
35833 the host. If GNU MPFR is not available, @value{GDBN} will fall back
35834 to using host floating-point arithmetic. If your host does not have
35835 GNU MPFR installed, you can get the latest version from
35836 `http://www.mpfr.org'.
35837
35838 @item --with-python@r{[}=@var{python}@r{]}
35839 Build @value{GDBN} with Python scripting support. (Done by default if
35840 libpython is present and found at configure time.) Python makes
35841 @value{GDBN} scripting much more powerful than the restricted CLI
35842 scripting language. If your host does not have Python installed, you
35843 can find it on `http://www.python.org/download/'. The oldest version
35844 of Python supported by GDB is 2.4. The optional argument @var{python}
35845 is used to find the Python headers and libraries. It can be either
35846 the name of a Python executable, or the name of the directory in which
35847 Python is installed.
35848
35849 @item --with-guile[=GUILE]'
35850 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU Guile scripting support. (Done by default
35851 if libguile is present and found at configure time.) If your host
35852 does not have Guile installed, you can find it at
35853 `https://www.gnu.org/software/guile/'. The optional argument GUILE
35854 can be a version number, which will cause @code{configure} to try to
35855 use that version of Guile; or the file name of a @code{pkg-config}
35856 executable, which will be queried to find the information needed to
35857 compile and link against Guile.
35858
35859 @item --without-included-regex
35860 Don't use the regex library included with @value{GDBN} (as part of the
35861 libiberty library). This is the default on hosts with version 2 of
35862 the GNU C library.
35863
35864 @item --with-sysroot=@var{dir}
35865 Use @var{dir} as the default system root directory for libraries whose
35866 file names begin with @file{/lib}' or @file{/usr/lib'}. (The value of
35867 @var{dir} can be modified at run time by using the @command{set
35868 sysroot} command.) If @var{dir} is under the @value{GDBN} configured
35869 prefix (set with @code{--prefix} or @code{--exec-prefix options}, the
35870 default system root will be automatically adjusted if and when
35871 @value{GDBN} is moved to a different location.
35872
35873 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
35874 Configure @value{GDBN} to automatically load a system-wide init file.
35875 @var{file} should be an absolute file name. If @var{file} is in a
35876 directory under the configured prefix, and @value{GDBN} is moved to
35877 another location after being built, the location of the system-wide
35878 init file will be adjusted accordingly.
35879
35880 @item --enable-build-warnings
35881 When building the @value{GDBN} sources, ask the compiler to warn about
35882 any code which looks even vaguely suspicious. It passes many
35883 different warning flags, depending on the exact version of the
35884 compiler you are using.
35885
35886 @item --enable-werror
35887 Treat compiler warnings as werrors. It adds the @code{-Werror} flag
35888 to the compiler, which will fail the compilation if the compiler
35889 outputs any warning messages.
35890
35891 @item --enable-ubsan
35892 Enable the GCC undefined behavior sanitizer. This is disabled by
35893 default, but passing @code{--enable-ubsan=yes} or
35894 @code{--enable-ubsan=auto} to @code{configure} will enable it. The
35895 undefined behavior sanitizer checks for C@t{++} undefined behavior.
35896 It has a performance cost, so if you are looking at @value{GDBN}'s
35897 performance, you should disable it. The undefined behavior sanitizer
35898 was first introduced in GCC 4.9.
35899 @end table
35900
35901 @node System-wide configuration
35902 @section System-wide configuration and settings
35903 @cindex system-wide init file
35904
35905 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
35906 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
35907 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
35908
35909 Here is the corresponding configure option:
35910
35911 @table @code
35912 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
35913 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
35914 @var{file}.
35915 @end table
35916
35917 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
35918 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
35919
35920 @itemize @bullet
35921 @item
35922 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
35923 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
35924 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
35925 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
35926 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
35927 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
35928
35929 @item
35930 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
35931 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
35932 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
35933 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
35934 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
35935 @end itemize
35936
35937 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
35938 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
35939 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
35940 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
35941 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
35942 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
35943 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
35944 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
35945 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
35946 reread.
35947
35948 @menu
35949 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
35950 @end menu
35951
35952 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
35953 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
35954 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
35955
35956 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
35957 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
35958 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
35959 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
35960 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
35961 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
35962
35963 The following scripts are currently available:
35964 @itemize @bullet
35965
35966 @item @file{elinos.py}
35967 @pindex elinos.py
35968 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
35969 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
35970 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
35971 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
35972 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
35973 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
35974
35975 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
35976 @pindex wrs-linux.py
35977 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
35978 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
35979 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
35980 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
35981
35982 @end itemize
35983
35984 @node Maintenance Commands
35985 @appendix Maintenance Commands
35986 @cindex maintenance commands
35987 @cindex internal commands
35988
35989 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
35990 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
35991 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
35992 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
35993 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
35994
35995 @table @code
35996 @kindex maint agent
35997 @kindex maint agent-eval
35998 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
35999 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
36000 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
36001 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
36002 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
36003 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
36004 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
36005 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
36006 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
36007 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
36008 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
36009 addition and return the sum.
36010 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
36011 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
36012
36013 @kindex maint agent-printf
36014 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
36015 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
36016 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
36017 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
36018 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
36019
36020 @kindex maint info breakpoints
36021 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
36022 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
36023 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
36024 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
36025 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
36026 is shown:
36027
36028 @table @code
36029 @item breakpoint
36030 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
36031
36032 @item watchpoint
36033 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
36034
36035 @item longjmp
36036 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
36037 @code{longjmp} calls.
36038
36039 @item longjmp resume
36040 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
36041
36042 @item until
36043 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
36044
36045 @item finish
36046 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
36047
36048 @item shlib events
36049 Shared library events.
36050
36051 @end table
36052
36053 @kindex maint info btrace
36054 @item maint info btrace
36055 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
36056
36057 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
36058 @item maint btrace packet-history
36059 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
36060 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
36061 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
36062 recording format.
36063
36064 @table @code
36065 @item bts
36066 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
36067 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
36068
36069 @table @asis
36070 @item Block number
36071 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
36072 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
36073 @item Highest @samp{PC}
36074 @end table
36075
36076 @item pt
36077 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
36078 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
36079 information is printed:
36080
36081 @table @asis
36082 @item Packet number
36083 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
36084 @item Trace offset
36085 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
36086 @item Packet opcode and payload
36087 @end table
36088 @end table
36089
36090 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
36091 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
36092 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
36093 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
36094 needed.
36095
36096 @kindex maint btrace clear
36097 @item maint btrace clear
36098 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
36099 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
36100
36101 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
36102 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
36103 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
36104 buffer.
36105
36106 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
36107 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
36108 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
36109 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
36110 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
36111 packet history.
36112
36113 @kindex set displaced-stepping
36114 @kindex show displaced-stepping
36115 @cindex displaced stepping support
36116 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
36117 @item set displaced-stepping
36118 @itemx show displaced-stepping
36119 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
36120 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
36121 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
36122 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
36123 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
36124
36125 @table @code
36126 @item set displaced-stepping on
36127 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
36128 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
36129
36130 @item set displaced-stepping off
36131 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
36132 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
36133
36134 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
36135 @item set displaced-stepping auto
36136 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
36137 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
36138 architecture supports displaced stepping.
36139 @end table
36140
36141 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
36142 @item maint check-psymtabs
36143 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
36144 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
36145
36146 @kindex maint check-symtabs
36147 @item maint check-symtabs
36148 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
36149
36150 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
36151 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
36152 Expand symbol tables.
36153 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
36154 names matching @var{regexp}.
36155
36156 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
36157 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
36158 @cindex demangler crashes
36159 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
36160 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
36161 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
36162 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
36163 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
36164 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
36165 option to terminate the current session.
36166
36167 @kindex maint cplus first_component
36168 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
36169 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
36170
36171 @kindex maint cplus namespace
36172 @item maint cplus namespace
36173 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
36174
36175 @kindex maint deprecate
36176 @kindex maint undeprecate
36177 @cindex deprecated commands
36178 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
36179 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
36180 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
36181 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
36182 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
36183 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
36184 the replacement as part of the warning.
36185
36186 @kindex maint dump-me
36187 @item maint dump-me
36188 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
36189 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
36190 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
36191 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
36192
36193 @kindex maint internal-error
36194 @kindex maint internal-warning
36195 @kindex maint demangler-warning
36196 @cindex demangler crashes
36197 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
36198 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
36199 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
36200
36201 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
36202 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
36203 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
36204 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
36205 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
36206 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
36207 @value{GDBN} session.
36208
36209 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
36210 used as the text of the error or warning message.
36211
36212 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
36213
36214 @smallexample
36215 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
36216 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
36217 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
36218 debugging may prove unreliable.
36219 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
36220 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
36221 (@value{GDBP})
36222 @end smallexample
36223
36224 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
36225 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
36226 @cindex demangler crashes
36227
36228 @kindex maint set internal-error
36229 @kindex maint show internal-error
36230 @kindex maint set internal-warning
36231 @kindex maint show internal-warning
36232 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
36233 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
36234 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
36235 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
36236 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
36237 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
36238 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
36239 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
36240 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
36241 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
36242 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
36243 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
36244 described in the table below.
36245
36246 @table @samp
36247 @item quit
36248 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
36249 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
36250
36251 @item corefile
36252 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
36253 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
36254 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
36255 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
36256 disabled.
36257 @end table
36258
36259 @kindex maint packet
36260 @item maint packet @var{text}
36261 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
36262 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
36263 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
36264 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
36265 checksum.
36266
36267 @kindex maint print architecture
36268 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36269 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
36270 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
36271
36272 @kindex maint print c-tdesc @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36273 @item maint print c-tdesc
36274 Print the target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
36275 a C source file. By default, the target description is for the current
36276 target, but if the optional argument @var{file} is provided, that file
36277 is used to produce the description. The @var{file} should be an XML
36278 document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description Format}.
36279 The created source file is built into @value{GDBN} when @value{GDBN} is
36280 built again. This command is used by developers after they add or
36281 modify XML target descriptions.
36282
36283 @kindex maint check xml-descriptions
36284 @item maint check xml-descriptions @var{dir}
36285 Check that the target descriptions dynamically created by @value{GDBN}
36286 equal the descriptions created from XML files found in @var{dir}.
36287
36288 @anchor{maint check libthread-db}
36289 @kindex maint check libthread-db
36290 @item maint check libthread-db
36291 Run integrity checks on the current inferior's thread debugging
36292 library. This exercises all @code{libthread_db} functionality used by
36293 @value{GDBN} on GNU/Linux systems, and by extension also exercises the
36294 @code{proc_service} functions provided by @value{GDBN} that
36295 @code{libthread_db} uses. Note that parts of the test may be skipped
36296 on some platforms when debugging core files.
36297
36298 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
36299 @item maint print dummy-frames
36300 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
36301
36302 @smallexample
36303 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
36304 @dots{}
36305 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
36306 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
36307 58 return (a + b);
36308 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
36309 @dots{}
36310 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
36311 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
36312 (@value{GDBP})
36313 @end smallexample
36314
36315 Takes an optional file parameter.
36316
36317 @kindex maint print registers
36318 @kindex maint print raw-registers
36319 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
36320 @kindex maint print register-groups
36321 @kindex maint print remote-registers
36322 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36323 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36324 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36325 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36326 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36327 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
36328
36329 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
36330 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
36331 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
36332 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
36333 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
36334 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
36335 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
36336 and offsets in the `G' packets.
36337
36338 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
36339 write the information.
36340
36341 @kindex maint print reggroups
36342 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36343 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
36344 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
36345 information.
36346
36347 The register groups info looks like this:
36348
36349 @smallexample
36350 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
36351 Group Type
36352 general user
36353 float user
36354 all user
36355 vector user
36356 system user
36357 save internal
36358 restore internal
36359 @end smallexample
36360
36361 @kindex flushregs
36362 @item flushregs
36363 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
36364
36365 @kindex maint print objfiles
36366 @cindex info for known object files
36367 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
36368 Print a dump of all known object files.
36369 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
36370 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
36371 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
36372
36373 @kindex maint print user-registers
36374 @cindex user registers
36375 @item maint print user-registers
36376 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
36377 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
36378 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
36379 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
36380 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
36381 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
36382 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
36383
36384 @kindex maint print section-scripts
36385 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
36386 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
36387 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
36388 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
36389 matching @var{regexp}.
36390 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
36391 and the full path if known.
36392 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
36393
36394 @kindex maint print statistics
36395 @cindex bcache statistics
36396 @item maint print statistics
36397 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
36398 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
36399 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
36400 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
36401 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
36402 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
36403 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
36404 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
36405 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
36406 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
36407 lengths.
36408
36409 @kindex maint print target-stack
36410 @cindex target stack description
36411 @item maint print target-stack
36412 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
36413 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
36414 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
36415 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
36416 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
36417 address.
36418
36419 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
36420 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
36421
36422 @kindex maint print type
36423 @cindex type chain of a data type
36424 @item maint print type @var{expr}
36425 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
36426 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
36427 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
36428 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
36429 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
36430
36431 @kindex maint selftest
36432 @cindex self tests
36433 @item maint selftest @r{[}@var{filter}@r{]}
36434 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
36435 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
36436 If a @var{filter} is passed, only the tests with @var{filter} in their
36437 name will by ran.
36438
36439 @kindex "maint info selftests"
36440 @cindex self tests
36441 @item maint info selftests
36442 List the selftests compiled in to @value{GDBN}.
36443
36444 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
36445 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
36446 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
36447 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
36448 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
36449 information.
36450
36451 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
36452 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
36453 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
36454 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
36455 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
36456 always see the disassembly form.
36457
36458 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
36459
36460 @smallexample
36461 (gdb) info addr argc
36462 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
36463 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
36464 @end smallexample
36465
36466 For more information on these expressions, see
36467 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
36468
36469 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
36470 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
36471 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
36472 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
36473 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
36474
36475 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
36476 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
36477 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
36478 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
36479 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
36480 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
36481 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
36482 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
36483 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
36484
36485 @kindex maint set dwarf unwinders
36486 @kindex maint show dwarf unwinders
36487 @item maint set dwarf unwinders
36488 @itemx maint show dwarf unwinders
36489 Control use of the DWARF frame unwinders.
36490
36491 @cindex DWARF frame unwinders
36492 Many targets that support DWARF debugging use @value{GDBN}'s DWARF
36493 frame unwinders to build the backtrace. Many of these targets will
36494 also have a second mechanism for building the backtrace for use in
36495 cases where DWARF information is not available, this second mechanism
36496 is often an analysis of a function's prologue.
36497
36498 In order to extend testing coverage of the second level stack
36499 unwinding mechanisms it is helpful to be able to disable the DWARF
36500 stack unwinders, this can be done with this switch.
36501
36502 In normal use of @value{GDBN} disabling the DWARF unwinders is not
36503 advisable, there are cases that are better handled through DWARF than
36504 prologue analysis, and the debug experience is likely to be better
36505 with the DWARF frame unwinders enabled.
36506
36507 If DWARF frame unwinders are not supported for a particular target
36508 architecture, then enabling this flag does not cause them to be used.
36509 @kindex maint set profile
36510 @kindex maint show profile
36511 @cindex profiling GDB
36512 @item maint set profile
36513 @itemx maint show profile
36514 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
36515
36516 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
36517 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
36518 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
36519 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
36520 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
36521 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
36522 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
36523
36524 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
36525 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
36526
36527 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
36528 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
36529 @cindex hardware debug registers
36530 @item maint set show-debug-regs
36531 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
36532 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
36533 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
36534 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
36535 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
36536 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
36537
36538 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
36539 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
36540 @item maint set show-all-tib
36541 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
36542 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
36543 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
36544 command.
36545
36546 @kindex maint set target-async
36547 @kindex maint show target-async
36548 @item maint set target-async
36549 @itemx maint show target-async
36550 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
36551 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
36552 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
36553 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
36554
36555 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
36556 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
36557 @item maint set target-non-stop
36558 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
36559
36560 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
36561 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
36562 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
36563 if supported by the target.
36564
36565 @table @code
36566 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
36567 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
36568 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
36569
36570 @item maint set target-non-stop on
36571 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
36572 does not indicate support.
36573
36574 @item maint set target-non-stop off
36575 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
36576 target supports it.
36577 @end table
36578
36579 @kindex maint set per-command
36580 @kindex maint show per-command
36581 @item maint set per-command
36582 @itemx maint show per-command
36583 @cindex resources used by commands
36584
36585 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
36586 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
36587
36588 @table @code
36589 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
36590 @itemx maint show per-command space
36591 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
36592 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
36593 took, following the command's own output.
36594 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
36595 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
36596
36597 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
36598 @itemx maint show per-command time
36599 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
36600 for each command.
36601 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
36602 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
36603 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
36604 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
36605 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
36606 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
36607 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
36608 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
36609 spent by the program been debugged.
36610 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
36611 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
36612
36613 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
36614 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
36615 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
36616 for each command.
36617 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
36618
36619 @enumerate a
36620 @item
36621 number of symbol tables
36622 @item
36623 number of primary symbol tables
36624 @item
36625 number of blocks in the blockvector
36626 @end enumerate
36627 @end table
36628
36629 @kindex maint set check-libthread-db
36630 @kindex maint show check-libthread-db
36631 @item maint set check-libthread-db [on|off]
36632 @itemx maint show check-libthread-db
36633 Control whether @value{GDBN} should run integrity checks on inferior
36634 specific thread debugging libraries as they are loaded. The default
36635 is not to perform such checks. If any check fails @value{GDBN} will
36636 unload the library and continue searching for a suitable candidate as
36637 described in @ref{set libthread-db-search-path}. For more information
36638 about the tests, see @ref{maint check libthread-db}.
36639
36640 @kindex maint space
36641 @cindex memory used by commands
36642 @item maint space @var{value}
36643 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
36644 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
36645
36646 @kindex maint time
36647 @cindex time of command execution
36648 @item maint time @var{value}
36649 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
36650 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
36651
36652 @kindex maint translate-address
36653 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
36654 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
36655 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
36656 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
36657 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
36658 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
36659 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
36660
36661 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
36662 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
36663 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
36664
36665 @end table
36666
36667 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
36668 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
36669
36670 @table @code
36671 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
36672 @kindex set watchdog
36673 @cindex watchdog timer
36674 @cindex timeout for commands
36675 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
36676 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
36677 reports and error and the command is aborted.
36678
36679 @item show watchdog
36680 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
36681 @end table
36682
36683 @node Remote Protocol
36684 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
36685
36686 @menu
36687 * Overview::
36688 * Packets::
36689 * Stop Reply Packets::
36690 * General Query Packets::
36691 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
36692 * Tracepoint Packets::
36693 * Host I/O Packets::
36694 * Interrupts::
36695 * Notification Packets::
36696 * Remote Non-Stop::
36697 * Packet Acknowledgment::
36698 * Examples::
36699 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
36700 * Library List Format::
36701 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
36702 * Memory Map Format::
36703 * Thread List Format::
36704 * Traceframe Info Format::
36705 * Branch Trace Format::
36706 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
36707 @end menu
36708
36709 @node Overview
36710 @section Overview
36711
36712 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
36713 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
36714 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
36715 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
36716
36717 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
36718 transmitted and received data, respectively.
36719
36720 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
36721 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
36722 @cindex remote serial protocol
36723 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
36724 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
36725 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
36726 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
36727 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
36728
36729 @smallexample
36730 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36731 @end smallexample
36732 @noindent
36733
36734 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
36735 @noindent
36736 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
36737 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
36738 eight bit unsigned checksum).
36739
36740 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
36741 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
36742
36743 @smallexample
36744 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36745 @end smallexample
36746
36747 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
36748 @noindent
36749 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
36750 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
36751 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
36752
36753 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
36754 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
36755 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
36756 retransmission):
36757
36758 @smallexample
36759 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36760 <- @code{+}
36761 @end smallexample
36762 @noindent
36763
36764 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
36765 once a connection is established.
36766 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
36767
36768 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
36769 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
36770 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
36771 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
36772 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
36773 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
36774 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
36775
36776 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
36777 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
36778 exceptions).
36779
36780 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
36781 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
36782 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
36783 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
36784
36785 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
36786 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
36787 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
36788
36789 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
36790 @anchor{Binary Data}
36791 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
36792 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
36793 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
36794 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
36795 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
36796 binary data.
36797
36798 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
36799 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
36800 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
36801 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
36802 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
36803 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
36804 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
36805 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
36806 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
36807 (described next).
36808
36809 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
36810 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
36811 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
36812 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
36813 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
36814 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
36815 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
36816 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
36817 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
36818 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
36819 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
36820 3}} more times.
36821
36822 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
36823 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
36824 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
36825 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
36826 @samp{0*"00}.
36827
36828 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
36829 error number. That number is not well defined.
36830
36831 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
36832 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
36833 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
36834 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
36835 on that response.
36836
36837 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
36838 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
36839 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
36840 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
36841 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
36842 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
36843
36844 @node Packets
36845 @section Packets
36846
36847 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
36848 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
36849 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
36850 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
36851
36852 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
36853 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
36854 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
36855 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
36856 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
36857 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
36858 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
36859 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
36860 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
36861 @var{baz}.
36862
36863 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
36864 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
36865 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
36866 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
36867 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
36868 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
36869 pick any thread.
36870
36871 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
36872 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
36873 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
36874 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
36875 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
36876 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
36877 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
36878 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
36879 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
36880 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
36881 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
36882 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
36883 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
36884
36885 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
36886 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
36887 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
36888 more information.
36889
36890 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
36891 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
36892
36893 Here are the packet descriptions.
36894
36895 @table @samp
36896
36897 @item !
36898 @cindex @samp{!} packet
36899 @anchor{extended mode}
36900 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
36901 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
36902 debugged.
36903
36904 Reply:
36905 @table @samp
36906 @item OK
36907 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
36908 @end table
36909
36910 @item ?
36911 @cindex @samp{?} packet
36912 @anchor{? packet}
36913 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
36914 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
36915 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
36916
36917 Reply:
36918 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36919
36920 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
36921 @cindex @samp{A} packet
36922 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
36923 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
36924 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
36925
36926 Reply:
36927 @table @samp
36928 @item OK
36929 The arguments were set.
36930 @item E @var{NN}
36931 An error occurred.
36932 @end table
36933
36934 @item b @var{baud}
36935 @cindex @samp{b} packet
36936 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
36937 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
36938
36939 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
36940 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
36941 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
36942
36943 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
36944 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
36945 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
36946 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
36947 of view, nothing actually happened.}
36948
36949 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
36950 @cindex @samp{B} packet
36951 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
36952 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
36953
36954 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
36955 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
36956
36957 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
36958 @anchor{bc}
36959 @item bc
36960 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
36961 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
36962
36963 Reply:
36964 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36965
36966 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
36967 @anchor{bs}
36968 @item bs
36969 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
36970 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
36971
36972 Reply:
36973 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36974
36975 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
36976 @cindex @samp{c} packet
36977 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
36978 is omitted, resume at current address.
36979
36980 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36981 packet}.
36982
36983 Reply:
36984 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36985
36986 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
36987 @cindex @samp{C} packet
36988 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
36989 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
36990
36991 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36992 packet}.
36993
36994 Reply:
36995 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36996
36997 @item d
36998 @cindex @samp{d} packet
36999 Toggle debug flag.
37000
37001 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
37002 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
37003
37004 @item D
37005 @itemx D;@var{pid}
37006 @cindex @samp{D} packet
37007 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
37008 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
37009 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
37010
37011 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
37012 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
37013 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
37014 big-endian hex string.
37015
37016 Reply:
37017 @table @samp
37018 @item OK
37019 for success
37020 @item E @var{NN}
37021 for an error
37022 @end table
37023
37024 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
37025 @cindex @samp{F} packet
37026 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
37027 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
37028 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
37029
37030 @item g
37031 @anchor{read registers packet}
37032 @cindex @samp{g} packet
37033 Read general registers.
37034
37035 Reply:
37036 @table @samp
37037 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
37038 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
37039 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
37040 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
37041 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
37042 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
37043
37044 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
37045 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
37046 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
37047 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
37048 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
37049 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
37050 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
37051 have been collected, and both have zero value:
37052
37053 @smallexample
37054 -> @code{g}
37055 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
37056 @end smallexample
37057
37058 @item E @var{NN}
37059 for an error.
37060 @end table
37061
37062 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
37063 @cindex @samp{G} packet
37064 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
37065 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
37066
37067 Reply:
37068 @table @samp
37069 @item OK
37070 for success
37071 @item E @var{NN}
37072 for an error
37073 @end table
37074
37075 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
37076 @cindex @samp{H} packet
37077 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
37078 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
37079 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
37080 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
37081 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
37082 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
37083 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
37084
37085 Reply:
37086 @table @samp
37087 @item OK
37088 for success
37089 @item E @var{NN}
37090 for an error
37091 @end table
37092
37093 @c FIXME: JTC:
37094 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
37095 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
37096 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
37097 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
37098 @c described. For example:
37099 @c
37100 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
37101 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
37102 @c otherwise returns current registers.
37103 @c
37104 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
37105 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
37106 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
37107
37108 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
37109 @anchor{cycle step packet}
37110 @cindex @samp{i} packet
37111 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
37112 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
37113 step starting at that address.
37114
37115 @item I
37116 @cindex @samp{I} packet
37117 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
37118 step packet}.
37119
37120 @item k
37121 @cindex @samp{k} packet
37122 Kill request.
37123
37124 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
37125
37126 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
37127 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
37128
37129 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
37130
37131 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
37132 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
37133 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
37134
37135 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
37136 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
37137 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
37138
37139 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
37140 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
37141 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
37142 (@pxref{? packet}).
37143
37144 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
37145 @cindex @samp{m} packet
37146 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
37147 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
37148 any particular boundary.
37149
37150 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
37151 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
37152 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
37153 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
37154 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
37155 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
37156 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
37157 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
37158
37159 Reply:
37160 @table @samp
37161 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
37162 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
37163 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
37164 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
37165 @item E @var{NN}
37166 @var{NN} is errno
37167 @end table
37168
37169 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37170 @cindex @samp{M} packet
37171 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
37172 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
37173 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
37174
37175 Reply:
37176 @table @samp
37177 @item OK
37178 for success
37179 @item E @var{NN}
37180 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
37181 written).
37182 @end table
37183
37184 @item p @var{n}
37185 @cindex @samp{p} packet
37186 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
37187 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
37188 register value is encoded.
37189
37190 Reply:
37191 @table @samp
37192 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
37193 the register's value
37194 @item E @var{NN}
37195 for an error
37196 @item @w{}
37197 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
37198 @end table
37199
37200 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
37201 @anchor{write register packet}
37202 @cindex @samp{P} packet
37203 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
37204 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
37205 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
37206
37207 Reply:
37208 @table @samp
37209 @item OK
37210 for success
37211 @item E @var{NN}
37212 for an error
37213 @end table
37214
37215 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
37216 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
37217 @cindex @samp{q} packet
37218 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
37219 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
37220 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
37221
37222 @item r
37223 @cindex @samp{r} packet
37224 Reset the entire system.
37225
37226 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
37227
37228 @item R @var{XX}
37229 @cindex @samp{R} packet
37230 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
37231 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37232
37233 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
37234
37235 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
37236 @cindex @samp{s} packet
37237 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
37238 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
37239
37240 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37241 packet}.
37242
37243 Reply:
37244 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37245
37246 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
37247 @anchor{step with signal packet}
37248 @cindex @samp{S} packet
37249 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
37250 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
37251
37252 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37253 packet}.
37254
37255 Reply:
37256 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37257
37258 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
37259 @cindex @samp{t} packet
37260 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
37261 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
37262 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
37263
37264 @item T @var{thread-id}
37265 @cindex @samp{T} packet
37266 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
37267
37268 Reply:
37269 @table @samp
37270 @item OK
37271 thread is still alive
37272 @item E @var{NN}
37273 thread is dead
37274 @end table
37275
37276 @item v
37277 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
37278 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
37279
37280 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
37281 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
37282 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
37283 The process ID is a
37284 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
37285 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
37286 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
37287
37288 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
37289 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
37290 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
37291 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
37292 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
37293 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
37294 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
37295 @c stopping or restarting threads.
37296
37297 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37298
37299 Reply:
37300 @table @samp
37301 @item E @var{nn}
37302 for an error
37303 @item @r{Any stop packet}
37304 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
37305 @item OK
37306 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
37307 @end table
37308
37309 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
37310 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
37311 @anchor{vCont packet}
37312 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
37313
37314 For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
37315 @var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action
37316 remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the
37317 syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess
37318 extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
37319 can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
37320 @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no
37321 @var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an
37322 error.
37323
37324 Currently supported actions are:
37325
37326 @table @samp
37327 @item c
37328 Continue.
37329 @item C @var{sig}
37330 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
37331 @item s
37332 Step.
37333 @item S @var{sig}
37334 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
37335 @item t
37336 Stop.
37337 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
37338 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
37339 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
37340 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
37341 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
37342 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
37343
37344 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
37345 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
37346 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
37347 jumps to @var{start}).
37348
37349 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
37350 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
37351 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
37352
37353 @end table
37354
37355 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
37356 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
37357 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
37358
37359 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
37360 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
37361 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
37362 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
37363 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
37364 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
37365 as an implementation detail.
37366
37367 The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
37368 @samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely,
37369 the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
37370 stopped.
37371
37372 @emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
37373 @value{GDBN} acknowleges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
37374 the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
37375
37376 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
37377 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
37378
37379 Reply:
37380 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37381
37382 @item vCont?
37383 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
37384 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
37385
37386 Reply:
37387 @table @samp
37388 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
37389 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
37390 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
37391 @item @w{}
37392 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
37393 @end table
37394
37395 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
37396 @item vCtrlC
37397 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
37398 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
37399 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
37400 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
37401 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
37402 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
37403 variant.
37404
37405 Reply:
37406 @table @samp
37407 @item E @var{nn}
37408 for an error
37409 @item OK
37410 for success
37411 @end table
37412
37413 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
37414 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
37415 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
37416 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
37417
37418 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
37419 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
37420 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
37421 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
37422 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
37423 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
37424 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
37425 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
37426 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
37427 packet is received.
37428
37429 Reply:
37430 @table @samp
37431 @item OK
37432 for success
37433 @item E @var{NN}
37434 for an error
37435 @end table
37436
37437 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37438 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
37439 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
37440 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
37441 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
37442 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
37443 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
37444 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
37445 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
37446 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
37447 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
37448 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
37449
37450
37451 Reply:
37452 @table @samp
37453 @item OK
37454 for success
37455 @item E.memtype
37456 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
37457 @item E @var{NN}
37458 for an error
37459 @end table
37460
37461 @item vFlashDone
37462 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
37463 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
37464 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
37465 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
37466 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
37467 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
37468 request is completed.
37469
37470 @item vKill;@var{pid}
37471 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
37472 @anchor{vKill packet}
37473 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
37474 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
37475 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
37476 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
37477
37478 Reply:
37479 @table @samp
37480 @item E @var{nn}
37481 for an error
37482 @item OK
37483 for success
37484 @end table
37485
37486 @item vMustReplyEmpty
37487 @cindex @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} packet
37488 The correct reply to an unknown @samp{v} packet is to return the empty
37489 string, however, some older versions of @command{gdbserver} would
37490 incorrectly return @samp{OK} for unknown @samp{v} packets.
37491
37492 The @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} is used as a feature test to check how
37493 @command{gdbserver} handles unknown packets, it is important that this
37494 packet be handled in the same way as other unknown @samp{v} packets.
37495 If this packet is handled differently to other unknown @samp{v}
37496 packets then it is possile that @value{GDBN} may run into problems in
37497 other areas, specifically around use of @samp{vFile:setfs:}.
37498
37499 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
37500 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
37501 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
37502 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
37503 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
37504 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
37505 state.
37506
37507 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
37508
37509 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37510
37511 Reply:
37512 @table @samp
37513 @item E @var{nn}
37514 for an error
37515 @item @r{Any stop packet}
37516 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
37517 @end table
37518
37519 @item vStopped
37520 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
37521 @xref{Notification Packets}.
37522
37523 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37524 @anchor{X packet}
37525 @cindex @samp{X} packet
37526 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
37527 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
37528 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
37529 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
37530
37531 Reply:
37532 @table @samp
37533 @item OK
37534 for success
37535 @item E @var{NN}
37536 for an error
37537 @end table
37538
37539 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
37540 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
37541 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
37542 @cindex @samp{z} packet
37543 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
37544 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
37545 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
37546
37547 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
37548 separately.
37549
37550 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
37551 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
37552 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
37553 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
37554 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
37555 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
37556
37557 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37558 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
37559 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
37560 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
37561 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
37562 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
37563
37564 A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
37565 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
37566 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
37567 breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and
37568 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
37569 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
37570 (@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
37571 architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
37572 @var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
37573 conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
37574 the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into
37575 consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
37576 reported back to @value{GDBN}.
37577
37578 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
37579 for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
37580
37581 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
37582 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
37583
37584 @table @samp
37585
37586 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37587 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
37588 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
37589
37590 @end table
37591
37592 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
37593 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
37594 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
37595 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
37596 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
37597 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
37598 separators. Each expression has the following form:
37599
37600 @table @samp
37601
37602 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37603 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
37604 actual commands expression in bytecode form.
37605
37606 @end table
37607
37608 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
37609 code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
37610 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
37611 target, is not defined.}
37612
37613 Reply:
37614 @table @samp
37615 @item OK
37616 success
37617 @item @w{}
37618 not supported
37619 @item E @var{NN}
37620 for an error
37621 @end table
37622
37623 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37624 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
37625 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
37626 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
37627 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
37628 address @var{addr}.
37629
37630 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
37631 dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The
37632 @var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
37633 same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
37634
37635 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
37636 movement.}
37637
37638 Reply:
37639 @table @samp
37640 @item OK
37641 success
37642 @item @w{}
37643 not supported
37644 @item E @var{NN}
37645 for an error
37646 @end table
37647
37648 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37649 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37650 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
37651 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
37652 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37653 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37654
37655 Reply:
37656 @table @samp
37657 @item OK
37658 success
37659 @item @w{}
37660 not supported
37661 @item E @var{NN}
37662 for an error
37663 @end table
37664
37665 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37666 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37667 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
37668 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
37669 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37670 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37671
37672 Reply:
37673 @table @samp
37674 @item OK
37675 success
37676 @item @w{}
37677 not supported
37678 @item E @var{NN}
37679 for an error
37680 @end table
37681
37682 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37683 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37684 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
37685 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
37686 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37687 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37688
37689 Reply:
37690 @table @samp
37691 @item OK
37692 success
37693 @item @w{}
37694 not supported
37695 @item E @var{NN}
37696 for an error
37697 @end table
37698
37699 @end table
37700
37701 @node Stop Reply Packets
37702 @section Stop Reply Packets
37703 @cindex stop reply packets
37704
37705 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
37706 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
37707 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
37708 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
37709 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
37710 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
37711 @value{GDBN} source code.
37712
37713 In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
37714 such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
37715 notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
37716
37717 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
37718 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
37719 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
37720 components.
37721
37722 @table @samp
37723
37724 @item S @var{AA}
37725 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
37726 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
37727 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
37728
37729 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
37730 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
37731 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
37732 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
37733 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
37734 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
37735 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
37736 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
37737
37738 @itemize @bullet
37739 @item
37740 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
37741 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
37742 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
37743 two-digit hex number.
37744
37745 @item
37746 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
37747 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
37748
37749 @item
37750 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
37751 the core on which the stop event was detected.
37752
37753 @item
37754 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
37755 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
37756 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
37757 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
37758
37759 @item
37760 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
37761 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
37762 future.
37763 @end itemize
37764
37765 The currently defined stop reasons are:
37766
37767 @table @samp
37768 @item watch
37769 @itemx rwatch
37770 @itemx awatch
37771 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
37772 hex.
37773
37774 @item syscall_entry
37775 @itemx syscall_return
37776 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
37777 syscall number, in hex.
37778
37779 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
37780 @item library
37781 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
37782 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
37783 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
37784
37785 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
37786 @item replaylog
37787 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
37788 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
37789 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
37790 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
37791 for more information.
37792
37793 @item swbreak
37794 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
37795 The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
37796 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
37797 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
37798 part must be left empty.
37799
37800 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
37801 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
37802 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
37803 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
37804 address.
37805
37806 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37807 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37808 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37809 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37810 indicating support.
37811
37812 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
37813
37814 @item hwbreak
37815 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
37816 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
37817
37818 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
37819 apply.
37820
37821 @cindex fork events, remote reply
37822 @item fork
37823 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
37824 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
37825 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
37826 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
37827 fork events.
37828
37829 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37830 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37831 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37832 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37833 indicating support.
37834
37835 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
37836 @item vfork
37837 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
37838 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
37839 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
37840 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
37841 vfork events.
37842
37843 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37844 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37845 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37846 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37847 indicating support.
37848
37849 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
37850 @item vforkdone
37851 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
37852 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
37853 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
37854 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
37855 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
37856
37857 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37858 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37859 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37860 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37861 indicating support.
37862
37863 @cindex exec events, remote reply
37864 @item exec
37865 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
37866 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
37867 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
37868
37869 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37870 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37871 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37872 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37873 indicating support.
37874
37875 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
37876 @anchor{thread create event}
37877 @item create
37878 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
37879 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
37880 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
37881 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
37882 also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The
37883 @var{r} part is ignored.
37884
37885 @end table
37886
37887 @item W @var{AA}
37888 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
37889 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
37890 applicable to certain targets.
37891
37892 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
37893 exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
37894 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
37895 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
37896 hex strings.
37897
37898 @item X @var{AA}
37899 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
37900 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
37901
37902 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
37903 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
37904 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
37905 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
37906 hex strings.
37907
37908 @anchor{thread exit event}
37909 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
37910 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
37911
37912 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
37913 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
37914 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
37915 @var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
37916
37917 @item N
37918 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
37919 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
37920 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
37921 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
37922 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
37923 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
37924 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
37925 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
37926 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
37927 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
37928 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
37929 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
37930 support.
37931
37932 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
37933 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
37934 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
37935 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
37936 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
37937
37938 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
37939 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
37940 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
37941 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
37942 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
37943 system calls.
37944
37945 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
37946 this very system call.
37947
37948 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
37949 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
37950 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
37951 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
37952 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
37953 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
37954
37955 @end table
37956
37957 @node General Query Packets
37958 @section General Query Packets
37959 @cindex remote query requests
37960
37961 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
37962 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
37963 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
37964 sending information to and from the stub.
37965
37966 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
37967 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
37968 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
37969 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
37970 conventions:
37971
37972 @itemize @bullet
37973 @item
37974 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
37975 @item
37976 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
37977 letter.
37978 @item
37979 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
37980 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
37981 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
37982 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
37983 @end itemize
37984
37985 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
37986 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
37987 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
37988 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
37989 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
37990 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
37991 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
37992 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
37993 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
37994 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
37995 packet.}.
37996
37997 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
37998 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
37999 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
38000 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
38001 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
38002
38003 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
38004
38005 @table @samp
38006
38007 @item QAgent:1
38008 @itemx QAgent:0
38009 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
38010 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
38011
38012 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
38013 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
38014 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
38015 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
38016 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
38017 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
38018 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
38019 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
38020 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
38021 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
38022 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
38023
38024 @item qC
38025 @cindex current thread, remote request
38026 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
38027 Return the current thread ID.
38028
38029 Reply:
38030 @table @samp
38031 @item QC @var{thread-id}
38032 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
38033 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
38034 @item @r{(anything else)}
38035 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
38036 @end table
38037
38038 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
38039 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
38040 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
38041 @anchor{qCRC packet}
38042 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
38043 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
38044 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
38045 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
38046
38047 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
38048 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
38049 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
38050 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
38051 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
38052 detect trailing zeros.
38053
38054 Reply:
38055 @table @samp
38056 @item E @var{NN}
38057 An error (such as memory fault)
38058 @item C @var{crc32}
38059 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
38060 @end table
38061
38062 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
38063 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
38064 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
38065 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
38066 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
38067 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
38068 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
38069 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
38070 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
38071 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
38072 randomization.
38073
38074 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
38075
38076 Reply:
38077 @table @samp
38078 @item OK
38079 The request succeeded.
38080
38081 @item E @var{nn}
38082 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38083
38084 @item @w{}
38085 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
38086 by the stub.
38087 @end table
38088
38089 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38090 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38091 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
38092 address space randomization.
38093
38094 @item QStartupWithShell:@var{value}
38095 @cindex startup with shell, remote request
38096 @cindex @samp{QStartupWithShell} packet
38097 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to start the inferior using a
38098 shell program. This is the default behavior on both @value{GDBN} and
38099 @command{gdbserver} (@pxref{set startup-with-shell}). This packet is
38100 used to inform @command{gdbserver} whether it should start the
38101 inferior using a shell or not.
38102
38103 If @var{value} is @samp{0}, @command{gdbserver} will not use a shell
38104 to start the inferior. If @var{value} is @samp{1},
38105 @command{gdbserver} will use a shell to start the inferior. All other
38106 values are considered an error.
38107
38108 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38109 mode}).
38110
38111 Reply:
38112 @table @samp
38113 @item OK
38114 The request succeeded.
38115
38116 @item E @var{nn}
38117 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38118 @end table
38119
38120 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38121 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38122 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38123 actually support starting the inferior using a shell.
38124
38125 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set startup-with-shell}
38126 command; @pxref{set startup-with-shell}.
38127
38128 @item QEnvironmentHexEncoded:@var{hex-value}
38129 @anchor{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
38130 @cindex set environment variable, remote request
38131 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded} packet
38132 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to set environment variables that
38133 will be passed to the inferior during the startup process. This
38134 packet is used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment
38135 variable that has been defined by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{set
38136 environment}).
38137
38138 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
38139 representation of the @var{name=value} format representing an
38140 environment variable. The name of the environment variable is
38141 represented by @var{name}, and the value to be assigned to the
38142 environment variable is represented by @var{value}. If the variable
38143 has no value (i.e., the value is @code{null}), then @var{value} will
38144 not be present.
38145
38146 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38147 mode}).
38148
38149 Reply:
38150 @table @samp
38151 @item OK
38152 The request succeeded.
38153 @end table
38154
38155 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38156 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38157 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38158 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
38159 inferior.
38160
38161 This packet is related to the @code{set environment} command;
38162 @pxref{set environment}.
38163
38164 @item QEnvironmentUnset:@var{hex-value}
38165 @anchor{QEnvironmentUnset}
38166 @cindex unset environment variable, remote request
38167 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentUnset} packet
38168 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to unset environment variables
38169 before starting the inferior in the remote target. This packet is
38170 used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment variable that has
38171 been unset by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{unset environment}).
38172
38173 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
38174 representation of the name of the environment variable to be unset.
38175
38176 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38177 mode}).
38178
38179 Reply:
38180 @table @samp
38181 @item OK
38182 The request succeeded.
38183 @end table
38184
38185 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38186 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38187 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38188 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
38189 inferior.
38190
38191 This packet is related to the @code{unset environment} command;
38192 @pxref{unset environment}.
38193
38194 @item QEnvironmentReset
38195 @anchor{QEnvironmentReset}
38196 @cindex reset environment, remote request
38197 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentReset} packet
38198 On UNIX-like targets, this packet is used to reset the state of
38199 environment variables in the remote target before starting the
38200 inferior. In this context, reset means unsetting all environment
38201 variables that were previously set by the user (i.e., were not
38202 initially present in the environment). It is sent to
38203 @command{gdbserver} before the @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
38204 (@pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}) and the @samp{QEnvironmentUnset}
38205 (@pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}) packets.
38206
38207 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38208 mode}).
38209
38210 Reply:
38211 @table @samp
38212 @item OK
38213 The request succeeded.
38214 @end table
38215
38216 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38217 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38218 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38219 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
38220 inferior.
38221
38222 @item QSetWorkingDir:@r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
38223 @anchor{QSetWorkingDir packet}
38224 @cindex set working directory, remote request
38225 @cindex @samp{QSetWorkingDir} packet
38226 This packet is used to inform the remote server of the intended
38227 current working directory for programs that are going to be executed.
38228
38229 The packet is composed by @var{directory}, an hex encoded
38230 representation of the directory that the remote inferior will use as
38231 its current working directory. If @var{directory} is an empty string,
38232 the remote server should reset the inferior's current working
38233 directory to its original, empty value.
38234
38235 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38236 mode}).
38237
38238 Reply:
38239 @table @samp
38240 @item OK
38241 The request succeeded.
38242 @end table
38243
38244 @item qfThreadInfo
38245 @itemx qsThreadInfo
38246 @cindex list active threads, remote request
38247 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
38248 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
38249 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
38250 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
38251 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
38252 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
38253 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
38254 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
38255
38256 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
38257
38258 Reply:
38259 @table @samp
38260 @item m @var{thread-id}
38261 A single thread ID
38262 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
38263 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
38264 @item l
38265 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
38266 @end table
38267
38268 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
38269 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
38270 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
38271 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
38272 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
38273 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
38274 fields.
38275
38276 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
38277 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
38278 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
38279 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
38280 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
38281
38282 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
38283 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
38284 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
38285 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
38286 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
38287
38288 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
38289 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
38290
38291 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
38292 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
38293 information associated with the variable.)
38294
38295 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
38296 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
38297 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
38298 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
38299 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
38300 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
38301
38302 Reply:
38303 @table @samp
38304 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
38305 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
38306 local storage requested.
38307
38308 @item E @var{nn}
38309 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38310
38311 @item @w{}
38312 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
38313 @end table
38314
38315 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
38316 @cindex get thread information block address
38317 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
38318 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
38319
38320 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
38321
38322 Reply:
38323 @table @samp
38324 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
38325 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
38326 thread information block.
38327
38328 @item E @var{nn}
38329 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
38330 address could not be retrieved.
38331
38332 @item @w{}
38333 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
38334 @end table
38335
38336 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
38337 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
38338 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
38339 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
38340 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
38341 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
38342 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
38343
38344 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
38345
38346 Reply:
38347 @table @samp
38348 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
38349 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
38350 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
38351 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
38352 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
38353 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
38354 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
38355 @end table
38356
38357 @item qOffsets
38358 @cindex section offsets, remote request
38359 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
38360 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
38361 image.
38362
38363 Reply:
38364 @table @samp
38365 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
38366 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
38367 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
38368 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
38369 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
38370 segments by the supplied offsets.
38371
38372 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
38373 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
38374 to the @code{Bss} section.}
38375
38376 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
38377 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
38378 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
38379 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
38380 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
38381 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
38382 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
38383 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
38384 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
38385 @end table
38386
38387 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
38388 @cindex thread information, remote request
38389 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
38390 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
38391 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
38392 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
38393
38394 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
38395 (see below).
38396
38397 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
38398
38399 @item QNonStop:1
38400 @itemx QNonStop:0
38401 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
38402 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
38403 @anchor{QNonStop}
38404 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
38405 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
38406
38407 Reply:
38408 @table @samp
38409 @item OK
38410 The request succeeded.
38411
38412 @item E @var{nn}
38413 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38414
38415 @item @w{}
38416 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
38417 the stub.
38418 @end table
38419
38420 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38421 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38422 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
38423 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
38424
38425 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
38426 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
38427 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
38428 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
38429 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
38430 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
38431 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
38432
38433 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
38434 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
38435 is listed, every system call should be reported.
38436
38437 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
38438 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
38439 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
38440 report the requested syscalls.
38441
38442 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
38443 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
38444
38445 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
38446 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
38447 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
38448 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
38449
38450 Reply:
38451 @table @samp
38452 @item OK
38453 The request succeeded.
38454
38455 @item E @var{nn}
38456 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
38457
38458 @item @w{}
38459 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
38460 the stub.
38461 @end table
38462
38463 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
38464 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
38465 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38466 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38467
38468 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
38469 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
38470 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
38471 @anchor{QPassSignals}
38472 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
38473 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
38474 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
38475 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
38476 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
38477 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
38478 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
38479 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
38480 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
38481
38482 Reply:
38483 @table @samp
38484 @item OK
38485 The request succeeded.
38486
38487 @item E @var{nn}
38488 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38489
38490 @item @w{}
38491 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
38492 the stub.
38493 @end table
38494
38495 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
38496 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
38497 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38498 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38499
38500 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
38501 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
38502 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
38503 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
38504 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
38505 Others should be silently discarded.
38506
38507 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
38508 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
38509 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
38510 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
38511 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
38512 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
38513 signals.
38514
38515 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
38516 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
38517
38518 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
38519 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
38520 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
38521 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
38522 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
38523
38524 Reply:
38525 @table @samp
38526 @item OK
38527 The request succeeded.
38528
38529 @item E @var{nn}
38530 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38531
38532 @item @w{}
38533 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
38534 by the stub.
38535 @end table
38536
38537 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
38538 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
38539 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38540 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38541
38542 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
38543 @item QThreadEvents:1
38544 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
38545 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
38546 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
38547
38548 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
38549 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
38550 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
38551 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
38552 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
38553 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
38554 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
38555 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
38556 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
38557 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38558
38559 Reply:
38560 @table @samp
38561 @item OK
38562 The request succeeded.
38563
38564 @item E @var{nn}
38565 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38566
38567 @item @w{}
38568 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
38569 the stub.
38570 @end table
38571
38572 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
38573 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
38574
38575 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
38576 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
38577 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
38578 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
38579 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
38580 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
38581 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
38582 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
38583 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
38584
38585 Reply:
38586 @table @samp
38587 @item OK
38588 A command response with no output.
38589 @item @var{OUTPUT}
38590 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
38591 @item E @var{NN}
38592 Indicate a badly formed request.
38593 @item @w{}
38594 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
38595 @end table
38596
38597 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
38598 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
38599 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
38600 packets.)
38601
38602 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
38603 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
38604 @ifnotinfo
38605 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
38606 @end ifnotinfo
38607 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
38608 @anchor{qSearch memory}
38609 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
38610 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
38611 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
38612
38613 Reply:
38614 @table @samp
38615 @item 0
38616 The pattern was not found.
38617 @item 1,address
38618 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
38619 @item E @var{NN}
38620 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
38621 @item @w{}
38622 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
38623 @end table
38624
38625 @item QStartNoAckMode
38626 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
38627 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
38628 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
38629 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
38630
38631 Reply:
38632 @table @samp
38633 @item OK
38634 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
38635 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
38636 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
38637 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
38638 @item @w{}
38639 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
38640 @end table
38641
38642 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
38643 @cindex supported packets, remote query
38644 @cindex features of the remote protocol
38645 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
38646 @anchor{qSupported}
38647 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
38648 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
38649 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
38650 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
38651 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
38652 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
38653 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
38654 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
38655 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
38656 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
38657 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
38658 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
38659 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
38660 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
38661
38662 Reply:
38663 @table @samp
38664 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
38665 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
38666 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
38667 possible forms).
38668 @item @w{}
38669 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
38670 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
38671 @end table
38672
38673 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
38674 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
38675 are:
38676
38677 @table @samp
38678 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
38679 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
38680 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
38681 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
38682 @item @var{name}+
38683 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
38684 need an associated value.
38685 @item @var{name}-
38686 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
38687 @item @var{name}?
38688 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
38689 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
38690 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
38691 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
38692 @end table
38693
38694 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
38695 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
38696 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
38697 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
38698 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
38699
38700 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
38701 are defined:
38702
38703 @table @samp
38704 @item multiprocess
38705 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
38706 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38707 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38708 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38709 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
38710
38711 @item xmlRegisters
38712 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
38713 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
38714 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
38715 description.
38716
38717 @item qRelocInsn
38718 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
38719 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
38720 instruction reply packet}).
38721
38722 @item swbreak
38723 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
38724 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
38725
38726 @item hwbreak
38727 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
38728 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
38729
38730 @item fork-events
38731 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
38732 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38733 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38734 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38735
38736 @item vfork-events
38737 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
38738 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38739 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38740 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38741
38742 @item exec-events
38743 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
38744 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38745 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38746 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38747
38748 @item vContSupported
38749 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
38750 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
38751 @end table
38752
38753 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
38754 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
38755 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
38756 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
38757 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
38758 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
38759 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
38760 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
38761 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
38762 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
38763 all the features it supports.
38764
38765 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
38766 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
38767
38768 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
38769 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
38770 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
38771 form response.
38772
38773 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
38774 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
38775 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
38776 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
38777
38778 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
38779 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
38780 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
38781 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
38782 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
38783
38784 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
38785
38786 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
38787 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
38788 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
38789 @item Feature Name
38790 @tab Value Required
38791 @tab Default
38792 @tab Probe Allowed
38793
38794 @item @samp{PacketSize}
38795 @tab Yes
38796 @tab @samp{-}
38797 @tab No
38798
38799 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
38800 @tab No
38801 @tab @samp{-}
38802 @tab Yes
38803
38804 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
38805 @tab No
38806 @tab @samp{-}
38807 @tab Yes
38808
38809 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
38810 @tab No
38811 @tab @samp{-}
38812 @tab Yes
38813
38814 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
38815 @tab No
38816 @tab @samp{-}
38817 @tab Yes
38818
38819 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
38820 @tab No
38821 @tab @samp{-}
38822 @tab Yes
38823
38824 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
38825 @tab No
38826 @tab @samp{-}
38827 @tab Yes
38828
38829 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
38830 @tab No
38831 @tab @samp{-}
38832 @tab Yes
38833
38834 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
38835 @tab No
38836 @tab @samp{-}
38837 @tab No
38838
38839 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
38840 @tab No
38841 @tab @samp{-}
38842 @tab Yes
38843
38844 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
38845 @tab No
38846 @tab @samp{-}
38847 @tab Yes
38848
38849 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
38850 @tab No
38851 @tab @samp{-}
38852 @tab Yes
38853
38854 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
38855 @tab No
38856 @tab @samp{-}
38857 @tab Yes
38858
38859 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
38860 @tab No
38861 @tab @samp{-}
38862 @tab Yes
38863
38864 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
38865 @tab No
38866 @tab @samp{-}
38867 @tab Yes
38868
38869 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
38870 @tab No
38871 @tab @samp{-}
38872 @tab Yes
38873
38874 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
38875 @tab No
38876 @tab @samp{-}
38877 @tab Yes
38878
38879 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
38880 @tab No
38881 @tab @samp{-}
38882 @tab Yes
38883
38884 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
38885 @tab No
38886 @tab @samp{-}
38887 @tab Yes
38888
38889 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
38890 @tab Yes
38891 @tab @samp{-}
38892 @tab Yes
38893
38894 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
38895 @tab Yes
38896 @tab @samp{-}
38897 @tab Yes
38898
38899 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
38900 @tab Yes
38901 @tab @samp{-}
38902 @tab Yes
38903
38904 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
38905 @tab Yes
38906 @tab @samp{-}
38907 @tab Yes
38908
38909 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
38910 @tab Yes
38911 @tab @samp{-}
38912 @tab Yes
38913
38914 @item @samp{QNonStop}
38915 @tab No
38916 @tab @samp{-}
38917 @tab Yes
38918
38919 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
38920 @tab No
38921 @tab @samp{-}
38922 @tab Yes
38923
38924 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
38925 @tab No
38926 @tab @samp{-}
38927 @tab Yes
38928
38929 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
38930 @tab No
38931 @tab @samp{-}
38932 @tab Yes
38933
38934 @item @samp{multiprocess}
38935 @tab No
38936 @tab @samp{-}
38937 @tab No
38938
38939 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
38940 @tab No
38941 @tab @samp{-}
38942 @tab No
38943
38944 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
38945 @tab No
38946 @tab @samp{-}
38947 @tab No
38948
38949 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
38950 @tab No
38951 @tab @samp{-}
38952 @tab No
38953
38954 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
38955 @tab No
38956 @tab @samp{-}
38957 @tab No
38958
38959 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
38960 @tab No
38961 @tab @samp{-}
38962 @tab No
38963
38964 @item @samp{QAgent}
38965 @tab No
38966 @tab @samp{-}
38967 @tab No
38968
38969 @item @samp{QAllow}
38970 @tab No
38971 @tab @samp{-}
38972 @tab No
38973
38974 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
38975 @tab No
38976 @tab @samp{-}
38977 @tab No
38978
38979 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
38980 @tab No
38981 @tab @samp{-}
38982 @tab No
38983
38984 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
38985 @tab No
38986 @tab @samp{-}
38987 @tab No
38988
38989 @item @samp{tracenz}
38990 @tab No
38991 @tab @samp{-}
38992 @tab No
38993
38994 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
38995 @tab No
38996 @tab @samp{-}
38997 @tab No
38998
38999 @item @samp{swbreak}
39000 @tab No
39001 @tab @samp{-}
39002 @tab No
39003
39004 @item @samp{hwbreak}
39005 @tab No
39006 @tab @samp{-}
39007 @tab No
39008
39009 @item @samp{fork-events}
39010 @tab No
39011 @tab @samp{-}
39012 @tab No
39013
39014 @item @samp{vfork-events}
39015 @tab No
39016 @tab @samp{-}
39017 @tab No
39018
39019 @item @samp{exec-events}
39020 @tab No
39021 @tab @samp{-}
39022 @tab No
39023
39024 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
39025 @tab No
39026 @tab @samp{-}
39027 @tab No
39028
39029 @item @samp{no-resumed}
39030 @tab No
39031 @tab @samp{-}
39032 @tab No
39033
39034 @end multitable
39035
39036 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
39037
39038 @table @samp
39039 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
39040 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
39041 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
39042 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
39043 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
39044 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
39045 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
39046 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
39047 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
39048 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
39049
39050 @item qXfer:auxv:read
39051 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
39052 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
39053
39054 @item qXfer:btrace:read
39055 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
39056 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
39057
39058 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
39059 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
39060 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
39061
39062 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
39063 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
39064 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
39065
39066 @item qXfer:features:read
39067 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
39068 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
39069
39070 @item qXfer:libraries:read
39071 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
39072 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
39073
39074 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
39075 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
39076 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
39077
39078 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
39079 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
39080 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
39081 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
39082
39083 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
39084 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
39085 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
39086
39087 @item qXfer:sdata:read
39088 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
39089 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
39090
39091 @item qXfer:spu:read
39092 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
39093 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
39094
39095 @item qXfer:spu:write
39096 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
39097 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
39098
39099 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
39100 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
39101 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
39102
39103 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
39104 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
39105 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
39106
39107 @item qXfer:threads:read
39108 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
39109 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
39110
39111 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
39112 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
39113 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
39114
39115 @item qXfer:uib:read
39116 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
39117 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
39118
39119 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
39120 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
39121 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
39122
39123 @item QNonStop
39124 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
39125 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
39126
39127 @item QCatchSyscalls
39128 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
39129 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
39130
39131 @item QPassSignals
39132 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
39133 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
39134
39135 @item QStartNoAckMode
39136 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
39137 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
39138
39139 @item multiprocess
39140 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
39141 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
39142 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
39143 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
39144 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
39145 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
39146 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
39147 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
39148 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
39149 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
39150 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
39151
39152 @item qXfer:osdata:read
39153 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
39154 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
39155
39156 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
39157 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
39158 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
39159 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
39160
39161 @item ConditionalTracepoints
39162 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
39163 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
39164
39165 @item ReverseContinue
39166 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
39167 (@pxref{bc}).
39168
39169 @item ReverseStep
39170 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
39171 (@pxref{bs}).
39172
39173 @item TracepointSource
39174 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
39175 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
39176
39177 @item QAgent
39178 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
39179
39180 @item QAllow
39181 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
39182
39183 @item QDisableRandomization
39184 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
39185
39186 @item StaticTracepoint
39187 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
39188 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
39189
39190 @item InstallInTrace
39191 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
39192 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
39193
39194 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
39195 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
39196 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
39197 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
39198
39199 @item QTBuffer:size
39200 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
39201 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
39202
39203 @item tracenz
39204 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
39205 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
39206 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
39207
39208 @item BreakpointCommands
39209 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
39210 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
39211 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
39212
39213 @item Qbtrace:off
39214 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
39215
39216 @item Qbtrace:bts
39217 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
39218
39219 @item Qbtrace:pt
39220 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
39221
39222 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
39223 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
39224
39225 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
39226 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
39227
39228 @item swbreak
39229 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
39230 breakpoints.
39231
39232 @item hwbreak
39233 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
39234 breakpoints.
39235
39236 @item fork-events
39237 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
39238
39239 @item vfork-events
39240 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
39241 and vforkdone events.
39242
39243 @item exec-events
39244 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
39245
39246 @item vContSupported
39247 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
39248 @samp{vCont?} packet.
39249
39250 @item QThreadEvents
39251 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
39252
39253 @item no-resumed
39254 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
39255
39256 @end table
39257
39258 @item qSymbol::
39259 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
39260 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
39261 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
39262 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
39263
39264 Reply:
39265 @table @samp
39266 @item OK
39267 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
39268 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
39269 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
39270 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
39271 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
39272 below.
39273 @end table
39274
39275 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
39276 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
39277
39278 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
39279 target has previously requested.
39280
39281 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
39282 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
39283 will be empty.
39284
39285 Reply:
39286 @table @samp
39287 @item OK
39288 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
39289 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
39290 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
39291 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
39292 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
39293 @end table
39294
39295 @item qTBuffer
39296 @itemx QTBuffer
39297 @itemx QTDisconnected
39298 @itemx QTDP
39299 @itemx QTDPsrc
39300 @itemx QTDV
39301 @itemx qTfP
39302 @itemx qTfV
39303 @itemx QTFrame
39304 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
39305
39306 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
39307
39308 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
39309 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
39310 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
39311 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
39312 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
39313 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
39314 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
39315 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
39316 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
39317 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
39318 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
39319
39320 Reply:
39321 @table @samp
39322 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
39323 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
39324 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
39325 the thread's attributes.
39326 @end table
39327
39328 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
39329 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
39330 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
39331 packets.)
39332
39333 @item QTNotes
39334 @itemx qTP
39335 @itemx QTSave
39336 @itemx qTsP
39337 @itemx qTsV
39338 @itemx QTStart
39339 @itemx QTStop
39340 @itemx QTEnable
39341 @itemx QTDisable
39342 @itemx QTinit
39343 @itemx QTro
39344 @itemx qTStatus
39345 @itemx qTV
39346 @itemx qTfSTM
39347 @itemx qTsSTM
39348 @itemx qTSTMat
39349 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
39350
39351 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39352 @cindex read special object, remote request
39353 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
39354 @anchor{qXfer read}
39355 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
39356 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
39357 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
39358 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
39359 additional details about what data to access.
39360
39361 Reply:
39362 @table @samp
39363 @item m @var{data}
39364 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
39365 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
39366 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
39367 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
39368 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
39369 request.
39370
39371 @item l @var{data}
39372 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
39373 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
39374 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
39375
39376 @item l
39377 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
39378 There is no more data to be read.
39379
39380 @item E00
39381 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
39382
39383 @item E @var{nn}
39384 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
39385 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
39386
39387 @item @w{}
39388 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
39389 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
39390 @end table
39391
39392 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
39393 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
39394 formats, listed above.
39395
39396 @table @samp
39397 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39398 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
39399 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
39400 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
39401
39402 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39403 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39404
39405 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39406 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
39407
39408 Return a description of the current branch trace.
39409 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
39410 packet may have one of the following values:
39411
39412 @table @code
39413 @item all
39414 Returns all available branch trace.
39415
39416 @item new
39417 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
39418 the last read request.
39419
39420 @item delta
39421 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
39422 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
39423 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
39424 used to stitch traces together.
39425
39426 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
39427 @end table
39428
39429 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
39430 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39431
39432 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39433 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
39434
39435 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
39436 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
39437
39438 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
39439 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39440
39441 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39442 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
39443 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
39444 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
39445 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
39446 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
39447 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
39448
39449 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39450 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39451
39452 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39453 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
39454 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
39455 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
39456 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
39457
39458 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39459 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39460
39461 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39462 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
39463 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
39464 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39465 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39466
39467 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
39468 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
39469 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
39470
39471 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39472 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39473
39474 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39475 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
39476 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
39477 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
39478 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
39479 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
39480 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39481 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
39482
39483 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
39484 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
39485
39486 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39487 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39488
39489 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
39490 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
39491 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
39492 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
39493
39494 @table @code
39495 @item start=@var{address}
39496 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
39497 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
39498 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
39499 chosen as the starting point.
39500
39501 @item prev=@var{address}
39502 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
39503 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
39504 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
39505 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
39506 exists prior to the starting point.
39507
39508 @end table
39509
39510 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
39511 ignored.
39512
39513 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39514 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
39515 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
39516 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39517 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39518
39519 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39520 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39521
39522 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39523 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
39524
39525 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
39526 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
39527 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
39528 Action Lists}.
39529
39530 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39531 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39532 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39533
39534 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39535 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
39536 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
39537 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
39538 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39539
39540 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39541 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39542 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39543
39544 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39545 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
39546 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
39547 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
39548 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
39549 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
39550 in that context to be accessed.
39551
39552 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39553 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39554 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39555
39556 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39557 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
39558 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
39559 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39560 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39561
39562 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39563 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39564
39565 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39566 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
39567
39568 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
39569 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
39570 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39571
39572 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39573 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39574
39575 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39576 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
39577
39578 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
39579 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
39580
39581 This packet is not probed by default.
39582
39583 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39584 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
39585 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
39586 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
39587 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
39588
39589 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39590 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39591
39592 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39593 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
39594 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
39595 @xref{Operating System Information}.
39596
39597 @end table
39598
39599 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39600 @cindex write data into object, remote request
39601 @anchor{qXfer write}
39602 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
39603 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
39604 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
39605 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
39606 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
39607 to access.
39608
39609 Reply:
39610 @table @samp
39611 @item @var{nn}
39612 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
39613 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
39614
39615 @item E00
39616 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
39617
39618 @item E @var{nn}
39619 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
39620 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
39621
39622 @item @w{}
39623 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
39624 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
39625 @end table
39626
39627 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
39628 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
39629 formats, listed above.
39630
39631 @table @samp
39632 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39633 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
39634 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
39635 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
39636 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
39637
39638 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39639 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39640 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39641
39642 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39643 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
39644 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
39645 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
39646 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
39647 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
39648 in that context to be accessed.
39649
39650 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39651 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39652 @end table
39653
39654 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
39655 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
39656 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
39657 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
39658 must respond with an empty packet.
39659
39660 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
39661 @cindex query attached, remote request
39662 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
39663 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
39664 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
39665 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
39666 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
39667 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
39668 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
39669
39670 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
39671 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
39672 the @code{quit} command.
39673
39674 Reply:
39675 @table @samp
39676 @item 1
39677 The remote server attached to an existing process.
39678 @item 0
39679 The remote server created a new process.
39680 @item E @var{NN}
39681 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39682 @end table
39683
39684 @item Qbtrace:bts
39685 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
39686
39687 Reply:
39688 @table @samp
39689 @item OK
39690 Branch tracing has been enabled.
39691 @item E.errtext
39692 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39693 @end table
39694
39695 @item Qbtrace:pt
39696 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
39697
39698 Reply:
39699 @table @samp
39700 @item OK
39701 Branch tracing has been enabled.
39702 @item E.errtext
39703 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39704 @end table
39705
39706 @item Qbtrace:off
39707 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
39708
39709 Reply:
39710 @table @samp
39711 @item OK
39712 Branch tracing has been disabled.
39713 @item E.errtext
39714 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39715 @end table
39716
39717 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
39718 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
39719 btrace recording method in bts format.
39720
39721 Reply:
39722 @table @samp
39723 @item OK
39724 The ring buffer size has been set.
39725 @item E.errtext
39726 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39727 @end table
39728
39729 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
39730 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
39731 btrace recording method in pt format.
39732
39733 Reply:
39734 @table @samp
39735 @item OK
39736 The ring buffer size has been set.
39737 @item E.errtext
39738 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39739 @end table
39740
39741 @end table
39742
39743 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
39744 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
39745
39746 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
39747 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
39748 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
39749
39750 @menu
39751 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
39752 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
39753 @end menu
39754
39755 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
39756 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
39757
39758 @menu
39759 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
39760 @end menu
39761
39762 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
39763 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
39764 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
39765
39766 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
39767
39768 @table @r
39769
39770 @item 2
39771 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
39772
39773 @item 3
39774 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
39775
39776 @item 4
39777 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
39778
39779 @end table
39780
39781 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
39782 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
39783
39784 @menu
39785 * MIPS Register packet Format::
39786 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
39787 @end menu
39788
39789 @node MIPS Register packet Format
39790 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
39791 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
39792
39793 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
39794 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
39795 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
39796 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
39797 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
39798 most-significant -- least-significant.
39799
39800 @table @r
39801
39802 @item MIPS32
39803 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
39804 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
39805 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
39806
39807 @item MIPS64
39808 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
39809 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
39810 as @code{MIPS32}.
39811
39812 @end table
39813
39814 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
39815 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
39816 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
39817
39818 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
39819
39820 @table @r
39821
39822 @item 2
39823 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
39824
39825 @item 3
39826 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
39827
39828 @item 4
39829 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
39830
39831 @item 5
39832 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
39833
39834 @end table
39835
39836 @node Tracepoint Packets
39837 @section Tracepoint Packets
39838 @cindex tracepoint packets
39839 @cindex packets, tracepoint
39840
39841 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
39842 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
39843
39844 @table @samp
39845
39846 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
39847 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
39848 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
39849 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
39850 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
39851 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
39852 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
39853 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
39854 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
39855 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
39856 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
39857 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
39858 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
39859 actions.
39860
39861 Replies:
39862 @table @samp
39863 @item OK
39864 The packet was understood and carried out.
39865 @item qRelocInsn
39866 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
39867 @item @w{}
39868 The packet was not recognized.
39869 @end table
39870
39871 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
39872 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
39873 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
39874 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
39875 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
39876 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
39877 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
39878
39879 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
39880 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
39881 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
39882 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
39883 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
39884 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
39885 tracepoint actions.
39886
39887 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
39888 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
39889 following forms:
39890
39891 @table @samp
39892
39893 @item R @var{mask}
39894 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
39895 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
39896 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
39897 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
39898 not fit in a 32-bit word.
39899
39900 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
39901 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
39902 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
39903 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
39904 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
39905 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
39906 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
39907
39908 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
39909 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
39910 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
39911 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
39912 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
39913 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
39914 packet).
39915
39916 @end table
39917
39918 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
39919 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
39920 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
39921 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
39922 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
39923 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
39924 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
39925 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
39926
39927 Replies:
39928 @table @samp
39929 @item OK
39930 The packet was understood and carried out.
39931 @item qRelocInsn
39932 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
39933 @item @w{}
39934 The packet was not recognized.
39935 @end table
39936
39937 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
39938 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
39939 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
39940 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
39941 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
39942 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
39943 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
39944 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
39945
39946 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
39947 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
39948 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
39949 fit in a single packet.
39950 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
39951 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
39952
39953 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
39954 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
39955 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
39956 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
39957
39958 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
39959 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
39960 query packets.
39961
39962 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
39963 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
39964 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
39965 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
39966 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
39967 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
39968 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
39969 be found.
39970
39971 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
39972 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
39973 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
39974 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
39975 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
39976 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
39977 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
39978 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
39979 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
39980 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
39981 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
39982 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
39983 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
39984 variable.
39985
39986 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
39987 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
39988 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
39989 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
39990 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
39991
39992 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
39993 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
39994 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
39995 one of the following forms:
39996
39997 @table @samp
39998 @item F @var{f}
39999 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
40000 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
40001 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
40002
40003 @item T @var{t}
40004 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
40005 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
40006
40007 @end table
40008
40009 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
40010 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
40011 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
40012 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
40013
40014 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
40015 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
40016 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
40017 is a hexadecimal number.
40018
40019 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
40020 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
40021 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
40022 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
40023 numbers.
40024
40025 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
40026 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
40027 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
40028
40029 @item qTMinFTPILen
40030 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
40031 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
40032 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
40033 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
40034 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
40035 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
40036 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
40037 arrange for that.
40038
40039 Replies:
40040
40041 @table @samp
40042 @item 0
40043 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
40044 @item @var{length}
40045 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
40046 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
40047 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
40048 regardless of size.
40049 @item E
40050 An error has occurred.
40051 @item @w{}
40052 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
40053 @end table
40054
40055 @item QTStart
40056 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
40057 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
40058 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
40059 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
40060 instruction reply packet}).
40061
40062 @item QTStop
40063 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
40064 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
40065
40066 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
40067 @anchor{QTEnable}
40068 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
40069 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
40070 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
40071 of data from it will resume.
40072
40073 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
40074 @anchor{QTDisable}
40075 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
40076 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
40077 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
40078 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
40079
40080 @item QTinit
40081 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
40082 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
40083
40084 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
40085 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
40086 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
40087 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
40088 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
40089
40090 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
40091 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
40092 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
40093 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
40094
40095 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
40096 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
40097 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
40098 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
40099 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
40100 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
40101
40102 @item qTStatus
40103 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
40104 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
40105
40106 The reply has the form:
40107
40108 @table @samp
40109
40110 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
40111 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
40112 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
40113 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
40114
40115 @end table
40116
40117 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
40118 explanations as one of the optional fields:
40119
40120 @table @samp
40121
40122 @item tnotrun:0
40123 No trace has been run yet.
40124
40125 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
40126 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
40127 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
40128 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
40129 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
40130
40131 @item tfull:0
40132 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
40133
40134 @item tdisconnected:0
40135 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
40136
40137 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
40138 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
40139
40140 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
40141 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
40142 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
40143 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
40144 is hex encoded.
40145
40146 @item tunknown:0
40147 The trace stopped for some other reason.
40148
40149 @end table
40150
40151 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
40152 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
40153 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
40154 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
40155 trace.
40156
40157 @table @samp
40158
40159 @item tframes:@var{n}
40160 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
40161
40162 @item tcreated:@var{n}
40163 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
40164 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
40165
40166 @item tsize:@var{n}
40167 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
40168
40169 @item tfree:@var{n}
40170 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
40171
40172 @item circular:@var{n}
40173 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
40174 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
40175 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
40176 and may fill up.
40177
40178 @item disconn:@var{n}
40179 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
40180 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
40181 that the trace run will stop.
40182
40183 @end table
40184
40185 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
40186 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
40187 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
40188 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
40189 address @var{addr}.
40190
40191 Replies:
40192 @table @samp
40193 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
40194 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
40195 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
40196 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
40197 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
40198
40199 @end table
40200
40201 @item qTV:@var{var}
40202 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
40203 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
40204 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
40205
40206 Replies:
40207 @table @samp
40208 @item V@var{value}
40209 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
40210 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
40211 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
40212 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
40213 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
40214 program is running.
40215
40216 @item U
40217 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
40218 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
40219 was not collected.
40220 @end table
40221
40222 @item qTfP
40223 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
40224 @itemx qTsP
40225 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
40226 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
40227 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
40228 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
40229 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
40230 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
40231
40232 @item qTfV
40233 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
40234 @itemx qTsV
40235 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
40236 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
40237 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
40238 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
40239 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
40240 trace state variables.
40241
40242 @item qTfSTM
40243 @itemx qTsSTM
40244 @anchor{qTfSTM}
40245 @anchor{qTsSTM}
40246 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
40247 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
40248 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
40249 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
40250 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
40251 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
40252
40253 Reply:
40254 @table @samp
40255 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
40256 A single marker
40257 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
40258 a comma-separated list of markers
40259 @item l
40260 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
40261 @item E @var{nn}
40262 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
40263 @item @w{}
40264 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
40265 stub.
40266 @end table
40267
40268 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
40269 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
40270
40271 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
40272 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
40273 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
40274 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
40275 @dfn{last}).
40276
40277 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
40278 @anchor{qTSTMat}
40279 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
40280 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
40281 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
40282 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
40283 tracepoint markers.
40284
40285 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
40286 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
40287 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
40288 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
40289 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
40290 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
40291
40292 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
40293 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
40294 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
40295 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
40296 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
40297 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
40298 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
40299 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
40300 available.
40301
40302 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
40303 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
40304 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
40305
40306 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
40307 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
40308 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
40309 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
40310 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
40311 use whatever size it prefers.
40312
40313 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
40314 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
40315 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
40316 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
40317 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
40318
40319 @end table
40320
40321 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
40322 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
40323 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
40324 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
40325 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
40326 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
40327 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
40328 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
40329 it had executed in the original location.
40330
40331 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
40332 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
40333 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
40334 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
40335 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
40336 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
40337 format of the request is:
40338
40339 @table @samp
40340 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
40341
40342 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
40343 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
40344 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
40345 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
40346 memory starting at @var{to}.
40347 @end table
40348
40349 Replies:
40350 @table @samp
40351 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
40352 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
40353 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
40354 @item E @var{NN}
40355 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
40356 relocating the instruction.
40357 @end table
40358
40359 @node Host I/O Packets
40360 @section Host I/O Packets
40361 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
40362 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
40363
40364 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
40365 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
40366 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
40367 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
40368 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
40369 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
40370 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
40371 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
40372 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
40373 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
40374
40375 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
40376 its arguments. They have this format:
40377
40378 @table @samp
40379
40380 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
40381 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
40382 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
40383 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
40384 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
40385 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
40386 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
40387 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
40388 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
40389
40390 @end table
40391
40392 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
40393
40394 @table @samp
40395
40396 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
40397 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
40398 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
40399 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
40400 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
40401 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
40402 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
40403 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
40404 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
40405 @var{attachment}.
40406
40407 @item @w{}
40408 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
40409
40410 @end table
40411
40412 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
40413
40414 @table @samp
40415 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
40416 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
40417 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
40418 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
40419 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
40420 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
40421 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
40422
40423 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
40424 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
40425 -1 if an error occurs.
40426
40427 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
40428 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
40429 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
40430 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
40431 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
40432 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
40433 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
40434 @var{count} was zero.
40435
40436 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
40437 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
40438 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
40439 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
40440 some characters were escaped.
40441
40442 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
40443 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
40444 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
40445 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
40446 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
40447 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
40448 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
40449 error occurred.
40450
40451 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
40452 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
40453 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
40454 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
40455 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
40456 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
40457
40458 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
40459 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
40460 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
40461
40462 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
40463 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
40464 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
40465
40466 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
40467 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
40468 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
40469 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
40470 some characters were escaped.
40471
40472 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
40473 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
40474 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
40475 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
40476 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
40477 inferior(s).
40478
40479 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
40480 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
40481 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
40482 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
40483 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
40484 operation.
40485
40486 @end table
40487
40488 @node Interrupts
40489 @section Interrupts
40490 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
40491 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
40492
40493 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
40494 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
40495 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
40496 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
40497
40498 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
40499 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
40500 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
40501 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
40502 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
40503
40504 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
40505 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
40506 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
40507 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
40508 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
40509 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
40510 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
40511 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
40512
40513 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
40514 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
40515 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
40516
40517 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
40518 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
40519 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
40520 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
40521 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
40522 @code{0x03}.
40523
40524 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
40525 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
40526 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
40527 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
40528 currently-executing threads and processes.
40529 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
40530 running program, it should send one of the stop
40531 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
40532 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
40533 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
40534 Interrupts received while the
40535 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
40536 it is resumed next time.
40537
40538 @node Notification Packets
40539 @section Notification Packets
40540 @cindex notification packets
40541 @cindex packets, notification
40542
40543 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
40544 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
40545 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
40546 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
40547 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
40548 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
40549 is not a problem.
40550
40551 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
40552 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
40553 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
40554 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
40555 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
40556 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
40557 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
40558
40559 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
40560 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
40561
40562 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
40563 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
40564 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
40565 not they understand it.
40566
40567 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
40568 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
40569 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
40570 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
40571 recipients.
40572
40573 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
40574 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
40575 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
40576 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
40577 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
40578
40579 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
40580 @table @samp
40581 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
40582 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
40583 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
40584 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
40585 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
40586 @item @var{ack}
40587 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
40588 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
40589 @end table
40590
40591 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
40592 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
40593
40594 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
40595 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
40596 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
40597 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
40598 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
40599 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
40600 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
40601 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
40602 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
40603 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
40604
40605 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
40606 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
40607 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
40608 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
40609 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
40610 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
40611
40612 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
40613 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
40614 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
40615 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
40616 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
40617
40618 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
40619 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
40620 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
40621 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
40622 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
40623 normally.
40624
40625 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
40626 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
40627 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
40628 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
40629 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
40630 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
40631 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
40632 the process shall be repeated.
40633
40634 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
40635 following example:
40636 @smallexample
40637 <- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
40638 @code{...}
40639 -> @code{vStopped}
40640 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
40641 -> @code{vStopped}
40642 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
40643 -> @code{vStopped}
40644 <- @code{OK}
40645 @end smallexample
40646
40647 The following notifications are defined:
40648 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
40649
40650 @item Notification
40651 @tab Ack
40652 @tab Event
40653 @tab Description
40654
40655 @item Stop
40656 @tab vStopped
40657 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
40658 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
40659 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
40660 @value{GDBN}.
40661 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
40662
40663 @end multitable
40664
40665 @node Remote Non-Stop
40666 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
40667
40668 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
40669 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
40670 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
40671 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40672
40673 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
40674 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
40675 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
40676 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
40677 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
40678 probe the target state after a mode change.
40679
40680 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
40681 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
40682 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
40683 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
40684 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
40685 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
40686 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
40687 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
40688 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
40689 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
40690 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
40691
40692 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
40693 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
40694 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
40695 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
40696 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
40697 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
40698 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
40699 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
40700 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
40701 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
40702 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
40703 @samp{OK}.
40704
40705 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
40706 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
40707 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
40708 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
40709 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
40710 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
40711 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
40712 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
40713 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
40714 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
40715 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
40716 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
40717 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
40718
40719 @node Packet Acknowledgment
40720 @section Packet Acknowledgment
40721
40722 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
40723 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
40724 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
40725 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
40726 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
40727 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
40728 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
40729
40730 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
40731 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
40732 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
40733 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
40734 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
40735
40736 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
40737 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
40738 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
40739 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
40740
40741 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
40742 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
40743 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
40744 @pxref{qSupported}.
40745 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
40746 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
40747 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
40748 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
40749 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
40750 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
40751 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
40752
40753 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
40754 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
40755 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
40756 connection.
40757 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
40758 new connection is established,
40759 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
40760 for the current connection, once disabled.
40761
40762 @node Examples
40763 @section Examples
40764
40765 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
40766 does not get any direct output:
40767
40768 @smallexample
40769 -> @code{R00}
40770 <- @code{+}
40771 @emph{target restarts}
40772 -> @code{?}
40773 <- @code{+}
40774 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
40775 -> @code{+}
40776 @end smallexample
40777
40778 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
40779
40780 @smallexample
40781 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
40782 <- @code{+}
40783 -> @code{s}
40784 <- @code{+}
40785 @emph{time passes}
40786 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
40787 -> @code{+}
40788 -> @code{g}
40789 <- @code{+}
40790 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
40791 -> @code{+}
40792 @end smallexample
40793
40794 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
40795 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
40796 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
40797
40798 @menu
40799 * File-I/O Overview::
40800 * Protocol Basics::
40801 * The F Request Packet::
40802 * The F Reply Packet::
40803 * The Ctrl-C Message::
40804 * Console I/O::
40805 * List of Supported Calls::
40806 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
40807 * Constants::
40808 * File-I/O Examples::
40809 @end menu
40810
40811 @node File-I/O Overview
40812 @subsection File-I/O Overview
40813 @cindex file-i/o overview
40814
40815 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
40816 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
40817 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
40818 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
40819 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
40820 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
40821
40822 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
40823 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
40824 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
40825 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
40826 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
40827
40828 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
40829 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
40830 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
40831 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
40832 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
40833 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
40834 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
40835
40836 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
40837 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
40838 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
40839 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
40840 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
40841
40842 @smallexample
40843 (@value{GDBP}) continue
40844 <- target requests 'system call X'
40845 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
40846 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
40847 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
40848 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
40849 @end smallexample
40850
40851 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
40852 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
40853 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
40854 system are not supported by this protocol.
40855
40856 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
40857
40858 @node Protocol Basics
40859 @subsection Protocol Basics
40860 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
40861
40862 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
40863 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
40864 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
40865 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
40866 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
40867 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
40868 to call the appropriate host system call:
40869
40870 @itemize @bullet
40871 @item
40872 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
40873
40874 @item
40875 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
40876 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
40877 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
40878 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
40879
40880 @end itemize
40881
40882 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
40883
40884 @itemize @bullet
40885 @item
40886 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
40887 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
40888 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
40889 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
40890 packet.
40891
40892 @item
40893 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
40894 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
40895
40896 @item
40897 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
40898
40899 @item
40900 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
40901
40902 @item
40903 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
40904 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
40905 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
40906 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
40907 packet.
40908
40909 @end itemize
40910
40911 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
40912 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
40913
40914 @itemize @bullet
40915 @item
40916 Return value.
40917
40918 @item
40919 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
40920
40921 @item
40922 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
40923
40924 @end itemize
40925
40926 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
40927 the latest continue or step action.
40928
40929 @node The F Request Packet
40930 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
40931 @cindex file-i/o request packet
40932 @cindex @code{F} request packet
40933
40934 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
40935
40936 @table @samp
40937 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
40938
40939 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
40940 This is just the name of the function.
40941
40942 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
40943 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
40944 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
40945 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
40946 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
40947 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
40948 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
40949
40950 @end table
40951
40952
40953
40954 @node The F Reply Packet
40955 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
40956 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
40957 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
40958
40959 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
40960
40961 @table @samp
40962
40963 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
40964
40965 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
40966
40967 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
40968 representation.
40969 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
40970
40971 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
40972 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
40973 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
40974
40975 @smallexample
40976 F0,0,C
40977 @end smallexample
40978
40979 @noindent
40980 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
40981
40982 @smallexample
40983 F-1,4,C
40984 @end smallexample
40985
40986 @noindent
40987 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
40988
40989 @end table
40990
40991
40992 @node The Ctrl-C Message
40993 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
40994 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
40995
40996 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
40997 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
40998 the target should behave as if it had
40999 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
41000 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
41001 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
41002 packet.
41003
41004 It's important for the target to know in which
41005 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
41006
41007 @itemize @bullet
41008 @item
41009 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
41010
41011 @item
41012 The system call on the host has been finished.
41013
41014 @end itemize
41015
41016 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
41017 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
41018 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
41019 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
41020 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
41021 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
41022
41023 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
41024 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
41025 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
41026 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
41027 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
41028 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
41029 or the full action has been completed.
41030
41031 @node Console I/O
41032 @subsection Console I/O
41033 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
41034
41035 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
41036 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
41037 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
41038 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
41039 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
41040 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
41041 conditions is met:
41042
41043 @itemize @bullet
41044 @item
41045 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
41046 @code{read}
41047 system call is treated as finished.
41048
41049 @item
41050 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
41051 newline.
41052
41053 @item
41054 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
41055 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
41056
41057 @end itemize
41058
41059 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
41060 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
41061 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
41062 is stopped at the user's request.
41063
41064
41065 @node List of Supported Calls
41066 @subsection List of Supported Calls
41067 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
41068
41069 @menu
41070 * open::
41071 * close::
41072 * read::
41073 * write::
41074 * lseek::
41075 * rename::
41076 * unlink::
41077 * stat/fstat::
41078 * gettimeofday::
41079 * isatty::
41080 * system::
41081 @end menu
41082
41083 @node open
41084 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
41085 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
41086
41087 @table @asis
41088 @item Synopsis:
41089 @smallexample
41090 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
41091 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
41092 @end smallexample
41093
41094 @item Request:
41095 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
41096
41097 @noindent
41098 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
41099
41100 @table @code
41101 @item O_CREAT
41102 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
41103 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
41104 are concerned.
41105
41106 @item O_EXCL
41107 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
41108 an error and open() fails.
41109
41110 @item O_TRUNC
41111 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
41112 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
41113 truncated to zero length.
41114
41115 @item O_APPEND
41116 The file is opened in append mode.
41117
41118 @item O_RDONLY
41119 The file is opened for reading only.
41120
41121 @item O_WRONLY
41122 The file is opened for writing only.
41123
41124 @item O_RDWR
41125 The file is opened for reading and writing.
41126 @end table
41127
41128 @noindent
41129 Other bits are silently ignored.
41130
41131
41132 @noindent
41133 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
41134
41135 @table @code
41136 @item S_IRUSR
41137 User has read permission.
41138
41139 @item S_IWUSR
41140 User has write permission.
41141
41142 @item S_IRGRP
41143 Group has read permission.
41144
41145 @item S_IWGRP
41146 Group has write permission.
41147
41148 @item S_IROTH
41149 Others have read permission.
41150
41151 @item S_IWOTH
41152 Others have write permission.
41153 @end table
41154
41155 @noindent
41156 Other bits are silently ignored.
41157
41158
41159 @item Return value:
41160 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
41161 occurred.
41162
41163 @item Errors:
41164
41165 @table @code
41166 @item EEXIST
41167 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
41168
41169 @item EISDIR
41170 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
41171
41172 @item EACCES
41173 The requested access is not allowed.
41174
41175 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41176 @var{pathname} was too long.
41177
41178 @item ENOENT
41179 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
41180
41181 @item ENODEV
41182 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
41183
41184 @item EROFS
41185 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
41186 write access was requested.
41187
41188 @item EFAULT
41189 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
41190
41191 @item ENOSPC
41192 No space on device to create the file.
41193
41194 @item EMFILE
41195 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
41196
41197 @item ENFILE
41198 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
41199 has been reached.
41200
41201 @item EINTR
41202 The call was interrupted by the user.
41203 @end table
41204
41205 @end table
41206
41207 @node close
41208 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
41209 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
41210
41211 @table @asis
41212 @item Synopsis:
41213 @smallexample
41214 int close(int fd);
41215 @end smallexample
41216
41217 @item Request:
41218 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
41219
41220 @item Return value:
41221 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
41222
41223 @item Errors:
41224
41225 @table @code
41226 @item EBADF
41227 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
41228
41229 @item EINTR
41230 The call was interrupted by the user.
41231 @end table
41232
41233 @end table
41234
41235 @node read
41236 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
41237 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
41238
41239 @table @asis
41240 @item Synopsis:
41241 @smallexample
41242 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
41243 @end smallexample
41244
41245 @item Request:
41246 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
41247
41248 @item Return value:
41249 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
41250 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
41251 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
41252
41253 @item Errors:
41254
41255 @table @code
41256 @item EBADF
41257 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
41258 reading.
41259
41260 @item EFAULT
41261 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41262
41263 @item EINTR
41264 The call was interrupted by the user.
41265 @end table
41266
41267 @end table
41268
41269 @node write
41270 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
41271 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
41272
41273 @table @asis
41274 @item Synopsis:
41275 @smallexample
41276 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
41277 @end smallexample
41278
41279 @item Request:
41280 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
41281
41282 @item Return value:
41283 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
41284 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
41285 is returned.
41286
41287 @item Errors:
41288
41289 @table @code
41290 @item EBADF
41291 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
41292 writing.
41293
41294 @item EFAULT
41295 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41296
41297 @item EFBIG
41298 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
41299 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
41300
41301 @item ENOSPC
41302 No space on device to write the data.
41303
41304 @item EINTR
41305 The call was interrupted by the user.
41306 @end table
41307
41308 @end table
41309
41310 @node lseek
41311 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
41312 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
41313
41314 @table @asis
41315 @item Synopsis:
41316 @smallexample
41317 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
41318 @end smallexample
41319
41320 @item Request:
41321 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
41322
41323 @var{flag} is one of:
41324
41325 @table @code
41326 @item SEEK_SET
41327 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
41328
41329 @item SEEK_CUR
41330 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
41331 bytes.
41332
41333 @item SEEK_END
41334 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
41335 bytes.
41336 @end table
41337
41338 @item Return value:
41339 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
41340 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
41341 value of -1 is returned.
41342
41343 @item Errors:
41344
41345 @table @code
41346 @item EBADF
41347 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
41348
41349 @item ESPIPE
41350 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
41351
41352 @item EINVAL
41353 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
41354
41355 @item EINTR
41356 The call was interrupted by the user.
41357 @end table
41358
41359 @end table
41360
41361 @node rename
41362 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
41363 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
41364
41365 @table @asis
41366 @item Synopsis:
41367 @smallexample
41368 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
41369 @end smallexample
41370
41371 @item Request:
41372 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
41373
41374 @item Return value:
41375 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41376
41377 @item Errors:
41378
41379 @table @code
41380 @item EISDIR
41381 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
41382 directory.
41383
41384 @item EEXIST
41385 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
41386
41387 @item EBUSY
41388 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
41389 process.
41390
41391 @item EINVAL
41392 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
41393 of itself.
41394
41395 @item ENOTDIR
41396 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
41397 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
41398 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
41399
41400 @item EFAULT
41401 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
41402
41403 @item EACCES
41404 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41405
41406 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41407
41408 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
41409
41410 @item ENOENT
41411 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
41412
41413 @item EROFS
41414 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
41415
41416 @item ENOSPC
41417 The device containing the file has no room for the new
41418 directory entry.
41419
41420 @item EINTR
41421 The call was interrupted by the user.
41422 @end table
41423
41424 @end table
41425
41426 @node unlink
41427 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
41428 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
41429
41430 @table @asis
41431 @item Synopsis:
41432 @smallexample
41433 int unlink(const char *pathname);
41434 @end smallexample
41435
41436 @item Request:
41437 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
41438
41439 @item Return value:
41440 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41441
41442 @item Errors:
41443
41444 @table @code
41445 @item EACCES
41446 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41447
41448 @item EPERM
41449 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
41450
41451 @item EBUSY
41452 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
41453 being used by another process.
41454
41455 @item EFAULT
41456 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41457
41458 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41459 @var{pathname} was too long.
41460
41461 @item ENOENT
41462 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
41463
41464 @item ENOTDIR
41465 A component of the path is not a directory.
41466
41467 @item EROFS
41468 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
41469
41470 @item EINTR
41471 The call was interrupted by the user.
41472 @end table
41473
41474 @end table
41475
41476 @node stat/fstat
41477 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
41478 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
41479 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
41480
41481 @table @asis
41482 @item Synopsis:
41483 @smallexample
41484 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
41485 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
41486 @end smallexample
41487
41488 @item Request:
41489 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
41490 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
41491
41492 @item Return value:
41493 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41494
41495 @item Errors:
41496
41497 @table @code
41498 @item EBADF
41499 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
41500
41501 @item ENOENT
41502 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
41503 path is an empty string.
41504
41505 @item ENOTDIR
41506 A component of the path is not a directory.
41507
41508 @item EFAULT
41509 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41510
41511 @item EACCES
41512 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41513
41514 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41515 @var{pathname} was too long.
41516
41517 @item EINTR
41518 The call was interrupted by the user.
41519 @end table
41520
41521 @end table
41522
41523 @node gettimeofday
41524 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
41525 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
41526
41527 @table @asis
41528 @item Synopsis:
41529 @smallexample
41530 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
41531 @end smallexample
41532
41533 @item Request:
41534 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
41535
41536 @item Return value:
41537 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
41538
41539 @item Errors:
41540
41541 @table @code
41542 @item EINVAL
41543 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
41544
41545 @item EFAULT
41546 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41547 @end table
41548
41549 @end table
41550
41551 @node isatty
41552 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
41553 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
41554
41555 @table @asis
41556 @item Synopsis:
41557 @smallexample
41558 int isatty(int fd);
41559 @end smallexample
41560
41561 @item Request:
41562 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
41563
41564 @item Return value:
41565 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
41566
41567 @item Errors:
41568
41569 @table @code
41570 @item EINTR
41571 The call was interrupted by the user.
41572 @end table
41573
41574 @end table
41575
41576 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
41577 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
41578 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
41579 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
41580 needed.
41581
41582
41583 @node system
41584 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
41585 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
41586
41587 @table @asis
41588 @item Synopsis:
41589 @smallexample
41590 int system(const char *command);
41591 @end smallexample
41592
41593 @item Request:
41594 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
41595
41596 @item Return value:
41597 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
41598 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
41599 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
41600 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
41601 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
41602 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
41603 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
41604
41605 @item Errors:
41606
41607 @table @code
41608 @item EINTR
41609 The call was interrupted by the user.
41610 @end table
41611
41612 @end table
41613
41614 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
41615 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
41616 the host is simplified before it's returned
41617 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
41618 is discarded, and the return value consists
41619 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
41620
41621 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
41622 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
41623 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
41624
41625 @table @code
41626 @item set remote system-call-allowed
41627 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
41628 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
41629 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
41630
41631 @item show remote system-call-allowed
41632 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
41633 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
41634 protocol.
41635 @end table
41636
41637 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
41638 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
41639 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
41640
41641 @menu
41642 * Integral Datatypes::
41643 * Pointer Values::
41644 * Memory Transfer::
41645 * struct stat::
41646 * struct timeval::
41647 @end menu
41648
41649 @node Integral Datatypes
41650 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
41651 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
41652
41653 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
41654 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
41655 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
41656
41657 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
41658 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
41659
41660 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
41661
41662 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
41663 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
41664
41665 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
41666
41667 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
41668 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
41669 byte order.
41670
41671 @node Pointer Values
41672 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
41673 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
41674
41675 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
41676 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
41677 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
41678 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
41679
41680 @smallexample
41681 @code{1aaf/12}
41682 @end smallexample
41683
41684 @noindent
41685 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
41686 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
41687 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
41688 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
41689
41690 @smallexample
41691 @code{123456/d}
41692 @end smallexample
41693
41694 @node Memory Transfer
41695 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
41696 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
41697
41698 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
41699 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
41700 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
41701 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
41702 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
41703 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
41704 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
41705
41706
41707 @node struct stat
41708 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
41709 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
41710
41711 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
41712 is defined as follows:
41713
41714 @smallexample
41715 struct stat @{
41716 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
41717 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
41718 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
41719 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
41720 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
41721 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
41722 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
41723 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
41724 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
41725 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
41726 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
41727 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
41728 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
41729 @};
41730 @end smallexample
41731
41732 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
41733 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
41734 structure is of size 64 bytes.
41735
41736 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
41737 range of values.
41738
41739 @table @code
41740
41741 @item st_dev
41742 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
41743
41744 @item st_ino
41745 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
41746
41747 @item st_mode
41748 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
41749 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
41750
41751 @item st_uid
41752 @itemx st_gid
41753 @itemx st_rdev
41754 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
41755
41756 @item st_atime
41757 @itemx st_mtime
41758 @itemx st_ctime
41759 These values have a host and file system dependent
41760 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
41761 support exact timing values.
41762 @end table
41763
41764 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
41765 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
41766 continuing.
41767
41768 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
41769 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
41770 get truncated on the target.
41771
41772 @node struct timeval
41773 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
41774 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
41775
41776 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
41777 is defined as follows:
41778
41779 @smallexample
41780 struct timeval @{
41781 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
41782 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
41783 @};
41784 @end smallexample
41785
41786 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
41787 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
41788 structure is of size 8 bytes.
41789
41790 @node Constants
41791 @subsection Constants
41792 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
41793
41794 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
41795 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
41796 values before and after the call as needed.
41797
41798 @menu
41799 * Open Flags::
41800 * mode_t Values::
41801 * Errno Values::
41802 * Lseek Flags::
41803 * Limits::
41804 @end menu
41805
41806 @node Open Flags
41807 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
41808 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
41809
41810 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
41811
41812 @smallexample
41813 O_RDONLY 0x0
41814 O_WRONLY 0x1
41815 O_RDWR 0x2
41816 O_APPEND 0x8
41817 O_CREAT 0x200
41818 O_TRUNC 0x400
41819 O_EXCL 0x800
41820 @end smallexample
41821
41822 @node mode_t Values
41823 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
41824 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
41825
41826 All values are given in octal representation.
41827
41828 @smallexample
41829 S_IFREG 0100000
41830 S_IFDIR 040000
41831 S_IRUSR 0400
41832 S_IWUSR 0200
41833 S_IXUSR 0100
41834 S_IRGRP 040
41835 S_IWGRP 020
41836 S_IXGRP 010
41837 S_IROTH 04
41838 S_IWOTH 02
41839 S_IXOTH 01
41840 @end smallexample
41841
41842 @node Errno Values
41843 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
41844 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
41845
41846 All values are given in decimal representation.
41847
41848 @smallexample
41849 EPERM 1
41850 ENOENT 2
41851 EINTR 4
41852 EBADF 9
41853 EACCES 13
41854 EFAULT 14
41855 EBUSY 16
41856 EEXIST 17
41857 ENODEV 19
41858 ENOTDIR 20
41859 EISDIR 21
41860 EINVAL 22
41861 ENFILE 23
41862 EMFILE 24
41863 EFBIG 27
41864 ENOSPC 28
41865 ESPIPE 29
41866 EROFS 30
41867 ENAMETOOLONG 91
41868 EUNKNOWN 9999
41869 @end smallexample
41870
41871 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
41872 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
41873
41874 @node Lseek Flags
41875 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
41876 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
41877
41878 @smallexample
41879 SEEK_SET 0
41880 SEEK_CUR 1
41881 SEEK_END 2
41882 @end smallexample
41883
41884 @node Limits
41885 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
41886 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
41887
41888 All values are given in decimal representation.
41889
41890 @smallexample
41891 INT_MIN -2147483648
41892 INT_MAX 2147483647
41893 UINT_MAX 4294967295
41894 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
41895 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
41896 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
41897 @end smallexample
41898
41899 @node File-I/O Examples
41900 @subsection File-I/O Examples
41901 @cindex file-i/o examples
41902
41903 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
41904 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
41905
41906 @smallexample
41907 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
41908 @emph{request memory read from target}
41909 -> @code{m1234,6}
41910 <- XXXXXX
41911 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
41912 -> @code{F6}
41913 @end smallexample
41914
41915 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
41916 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
41917
41918 @smallexample
41919 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41920 @emph{request memory write to target}
41921 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
41922 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
41923 -> @code{F6}
41924 @end smallexample
41925
41926 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
41927 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
41928
41929 @smallexample
41930 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41931 -> @code{F-1,9}
41932 @end smallexample
41933
41934 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
41935 host is called:
41936
41937 @smallexample
41938 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41939 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
41940 <- @code{T02}
41941 @end smallexample
41942
41943 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
41944 host is called:
41945
41946 @smallexample
41947 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41948 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
41949 <- @code{T02}
41950 @end smallexample
41951
41952 @node Library List Format
41953 @section Library List Format
41954 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
41955
41956 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
41957 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
41958 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
41959 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
41960 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
41961 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
41962 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
41963 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
41964 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
41965 are loaded.
41966
41967 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
41968 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
41969 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
41970 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
41971
41972 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
41973 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
41974 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
41975 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
41976 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
41977 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
41978
41979 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41980 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
41981
41982 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
41983 offset, looks like this:
41984
41985 @smallexample
41986 <library-list>
41987 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
41988 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
41989 </library>
41990 </library-list>
41991 @end smallexample
41992
41993 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
41994 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
41995
41996 @smallexample
41997 <library-list>
41998 <library name="sharedlib.o">
41999 <section address="0x10000000"/>
42000 <section address="0x20000000"/>
42001 <section address="0x30000000"/>
42002 </library>
42003 </library-list>
42004 @end smallexample
42005
42006 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
42007
42008 @smallexample
42009 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
42010 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
42011 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42012 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
42013 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
42014 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
42015 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
42016 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
42017 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
42018 @end smallexample
42019
42020 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
42021 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
42022 section for each library.
42023
42024 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
42025 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
42026 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
42027
42028 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
42029 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
42030 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
42031 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
42032
42033 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
42034 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
42035 target, the following parameters are reported:
42036
42037 @itemize @minus
42038 @item
42039 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
42040 @code{struct link_map}.
42041 @item
42042 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
42043 (Thread Local Storage) access.
42044 @item
42045 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
42046 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
42047 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
42048 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
42049 @item
42050 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
42051 @end itemize
42052
42053 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
42054 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
42055 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
42056
42057 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42058 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
42059
42060 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
42061 looks like this:
42062
42063 @smallexample
42064 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
42065 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
42066 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
42067 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
42068 l_ld="0x152350"/>
42069 </library-list-svr>
42070 @end smallexample
42071
42072 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
42073
42074 @smallexample
42075 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
42076 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
42077 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42078 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
42079 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
42080 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
42081 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
42082 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
42083 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
42084 @end smallexample
42085
42086 @node Memory Map Format
42087 @section Memory Map Format
42088 @cindex memory map format
42089
42090 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
42091 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
42092 memory map.
42093
42094 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
42095 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
42096 lists memory regions.
42097
42098 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42099 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
42100
42101 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
42102
42103 @smallexample
42104 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42105 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
42106 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
42107 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
42108 <memory-map>
42109 region...
42110 </memory-map>
42111 @end smallexample
42112
42113 Each region can be either:
42114
42115 @itemize
42116
42117 @item
42118 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
42119 bytes from there:
42120
42121 @smallexample
42122 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
42123 @end smallexample
42124
42125
42126 @item
42127 A region of read-only memory:
42128
42129 @smallexample
42130 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
42131 @end smallexample
42132
42133
42134 @item
42135 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
42136 bytes in length:
42137
42138 @smallexample
42139 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
42140 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
42141 </memory>
42142 @end smallexample
42143
42144 @end itemize
42145
42146 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
42147 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
42148 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
42149
42150 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
42151
42152 @smallexample
42153 <!-- ................................................... -->
42154 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
42155 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
42156 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
42157 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
42158 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
42159 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory)*>
42160 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
42161 <!ELEMENT memory (property)*>
42162 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
42163 and its type, or device. -->
42164 <!ATTLIST memory type (ram|rom|flash) #REQUIRED
42165 start CDATA #REQUIRED
42166 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
42167 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
42168 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
42169 <!ATTLIST property name (blocksize) #REQUIRED>
42170 @end smallexample
42171
42172 @node Thread List Format
42173 @section Thread List Format
42174 @cindex thread list format
42175
42176 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
42177 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
42178 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
42179 the following structure:
42180
42181 @smallexample
42182 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42183 <threads>
42184 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
42185 ... description ...
42186 </thread>
42187 </threads>
42188 @end smallexample
42189
42190 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
42191 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
42192 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
42193 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
42194 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
42195 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
42196 auxiliary information. The @samp{handle} attribute, if present,
42197 is a hex encoded representation of the thread handle.
42198
42199
42200 @node Traceframe Info Format
42201 @section Traceframe Info Format
42202 @cindex traceframe info format
42203
42204 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
42205 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
42206 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
42207 collected in a traceframe.
42208
42209 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
42210 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
42211
42212 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42213 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
42214
42215 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
42216
42217 @smallexample
42218 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42219 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
42220 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
42221 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
42222 <traceframe-info>
42223 block...
42224 </traceframe-info>
42225 @end smallexample
42226
42227 Each traceframe block can be either:
42228
42229 @itemize
42230
42231 @item
42232 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
42233 @var{length} bytes from there:
42234
42235 @smallexample
42236 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
42237 @end smallexample
42238
42239 @item
42240 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
42241 collected:
42242
42243 @smallexample
42244 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
42245 @end smallexample
42246
42247 @end itemize
42248
42249 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
42250
42251 @smallexample
42252 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
42253 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42254
42255 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
42256 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
42257 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
42258 <!ELEMENT tvar>
42259 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
42260 @end smallexample
42261
42262 @node Branch Trace Format
42263 @section Branch Trace Format
42264 @cindex branch trace format
42265
42266 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
42267 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
42268 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
42269 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
42270
42271 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
42272 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
42273
42274 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42275 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
42276
42277 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
42278
42279 @smallexample
42280 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42281 <!DOCTYPE btrace
42282 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
42283 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
42284 <btrace>
42285 block...
42286 </btrace>
42287 @end smallexample
42288
42289 @itemize
42290
42291 @item
42292 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
42293 and ending at @var{end}:
42294
42295 @smallexample
42296 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
42297 @end smallexample
42298
42299 @end itemize
42300
42301 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
42302
42303 @smallexample
42304 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
42305 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42306
42307 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
42308 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
42309 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
42310
42311 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
42312
42313 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
42314
42315 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
42316 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
42317 family CDATA #REQUIRED
42318 model CDATA #REQUIRED
42319 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
42320
42321 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
42322 @end smallexample
42323
42324 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
42325 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
42326 @cindex branch trace configuration format
42327
42328 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
42329 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
42330 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
42331
42332 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
42333 settings for that format. The following information is described:
42334
42335 @table @code
42336 @item bts
42337 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
42338 @table @code
42339 @item size
42340 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
42341 @end table
42342 @item pt
42343 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
42344 PT}) format.
42345 @table @code
42346 @item size
42347 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
42348 @end table
42349 @end table
42350
42351 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42352 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
42353
42354 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
42355
42356 @smallexample
42357 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
42358 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42359
42360 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
42361 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
42362
42363 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
42364 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
42365 @end smallexample
42366
42367 @include agentexpr.texi
42368
42369 @node Target Descriptions
42370 @appendix Target Descriptions
42371 @cindex target descriptions
42372
42373 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
42374 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
42375 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
42376 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
42377 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
42378 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
42379 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
42380
42381 @itemize @bullet
42382 @item
42383 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
42384 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
42385 @item
42386 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
42387 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
42388 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
42389 @item
42390 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
42391 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
42392 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
42393 @end itemize
42394
42395 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
42396 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
42397 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
42398 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
42399 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
42400
42401 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42402 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
42403
42404 @menu
42405 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
42406 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
42407 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
42408 descriptions.
42409 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
42410 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
42411 @end menu
42412
42413 @node Retrieving Descriptions
42414 @section Retrieving Descriptions
42415
42416 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
42417 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
42418 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
42419 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
42420 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
42421 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
42422 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
42423 Format}.
42424
42425 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
42426 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
42427 specify a file are:
42428
42429 @table @code
42430 @cindex set tdesc filename
42431 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
42432 Read the target description from @var{path}.
42433
42434 @cindex unset tdesc filename
42435 @item unset tdesc filename
42436 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
42437 will use the description supplied by the current target.
42438
42439 @cindex show tdesc filename
42440 @item show tdesc filename
42441 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
42442 @end table
42443
42444
42445 @node Target Description Format
42446 @section Target Description Format
42447 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
42448
42449 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
42450 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
42451 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
42452 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
42453 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
42454 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
42455 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
42456
42457 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
42458 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
42459 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
42460 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
42461 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
42462
42463 Here is a simple target description:
42464
42465 @smallexample
42466 <target version="1.0">
42467 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
42468 </target>
42469 @end smallexample
42470
42471 @noindent
42472 This minimal description only says that the target uses
42473 the x86-64 architecture.
42474
42475 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
42476 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
42477 are explained further below.
42478
42479 @smallexample
42480 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42481 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
42482 <target version="1.0">
42483 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
42484 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
42485 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
42486 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
42487 </target>
42488 @end smallexample
42489
42490 @noindent
42491 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
42492 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
42493 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
42494 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
42495 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
42496 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
42497 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
42498 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
42499 the version mismatch.
42500
42501 @subsection Inclusion
42502 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
42503 @cindex XInclude
42504 @ifnotinfo
42505 @cindex <xi:include>
42506 @end ifnotinfo
42507
42508 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
42509 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
42510 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
42511 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
42512 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
42513
42514 @smallexample
42515 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
42516 @end smallexample
42517
42518 @noindent
42519 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
42520 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
42521 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
42522 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
42523 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
42524 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
42525 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
42526 original description.
42527
42528 @subsection Architecture
42529 @cindex <architecture>
42530
42531 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
42532
42533 @smallexample
42534 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
42535 @end smallexample
42536
42537 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
42538 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
42539
42540 @subsection OS ABI
42541 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
42542
42543 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
42544 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
42545
42546 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
42547
42548 @smallexample
42549 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
42550 @end smallexample
42551
42552 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
42553 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
42554
42555 @subsection Compatible Architecture
42556 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
42557
42558 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
42559 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
42560
42561 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
42562
42563 @smallexample
42564 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
42565 @end smallexample
42566
42567 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
42568 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
42569
42570 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
42571 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
42572 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
42573 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
42574 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
42575 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
42576 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
42577
42578 @smallexample
42579 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
42580 <compatible>spu</compatible>
42581 @end smallexample
42582
42583 @subsection Features
42584 @cindex <feature>
42585
42586 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
42587 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
42588 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
42589 has this form:
42590
42591 @smallexample
42592 <feature name="@var{name}">
42593 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
42594 @var{reg}@dots{}
42595 </feature>
42596 @end smallexample
42597
42598 @noindent
42599 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
42600 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
42601 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
42602 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
42603
42604 @subsection Types
42605
42606 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
42607 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
42608 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
42609 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
42610 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
42611 and enum types.
42612
42613 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
42614 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
42615 Types must be defined before they are used.
42616
42617 @cindex <vector>
42618 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
42619 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
42620 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
42621 @var{count}:
42622
42623 @smallexample
42624 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
42625 @end smallexample
42626
42627 @cindex <union>
42628 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
42629 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
42630 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
42631 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
42632
42633 @smallexample
42634 <union id="@var{id}">
42635 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
42636 @dots{}
42637 </union>
42638 @end smallexample
42639
42640 @cindex <struct>
42641 @cindex <flags>
42642 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
42643 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
42644 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
42645 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
42646 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
42647 specified.
42648
42649 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
42650
42651 @smallexample
42652 <struct id="@var{id}">
42653 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
42654 @dots{}
42655 </struct>
42656 @end smallexample
42657
42658 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
42659 No implicit padding is added.
42660
42661 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
42662
42663 @smallexample
42664 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42665 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
42666 @dots{}
42667 </struct>
42668 @end smallexample
42669
42670 @smallexample
42671 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42672 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
42673 @dots{}
42674 </flags>
42675 @end smallexample
42676
42677 The @var{name} value is required.
42678 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
42679 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
42680 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
42681
42682 The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
42683 is optional.
42684 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
42685 and zero represents the least significant bit.
42686
42687 The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
42688 and an unsigned integer otherwise.
42689
42690 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
42691
42692 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
42693 defining them with @samp{struct}:
42694
42695 @itemize @bullet
42696 @item
42697 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
42698 @item
42699 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
42700 @end itemize
42701
42702 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
42703 defining them with @samp{flags}:
42704
42705 @itemize @bullet
42706 @item
42707 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
42708
42709 @smallexample
42710 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
42711 $1 = 42
42712 @end smallexample
42713
42714 @end itemize
42715
42716 @subsection Registers
42717 @cindex <reg>
42718
42719 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
42720
42721 @smallexample
42722 <reg name="@var{name}"
42723 bitsize="@var{size}"
42724 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
42725 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
42726 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
42727 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
42728 @end smallexample
42729
42730 @noindent
42731 The components are as follows:
42732
42733 @table @var
42734
42735 @item name
42736 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
42737
42738 @item bitsize
42739 The register's size, in bits.
42740
42741 @item regnum
42742 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
42743 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
42744 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
42745 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
42746 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
42747 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
42748 in order of increasing register number.
42749
42750 @item save-restore
42751 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
42752 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
42753 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
42754 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
42755 ABI.
42756
42757 @item type
42758 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
42759 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
42760 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
42761 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
42762 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
42763 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
42764
42765 @item group
42766 The register group to which this register belongs. It can be one of the
42767 standard register groups @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{vector} or an
42768 arbitrary string. Group names should be limited to alphanumeric characters.
42769 If a group name is made up of multiple words the words may be separated by
42770 hyphens; e.g.@: @code{special-group} or @code{ultra-special-group}. If no
42771 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register in
42772 @code{info registers}.
42773
42774 @end table
42775
42776 @node Predefined Target Types
42777 @section Predefined Target Types
42778 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
42779
42780 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
42781 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
42782 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
42783 types. The currently supported types are:
42784
42785 @table @code
42786
42787 @item bool
42788 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
42789
42790 @item int8
42791 @itemx int16
42792 @itemx int24
42793 @itemx int32
42794 @itemx int64
42795 @itemx int128
42796 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
42797
42798 @item uint8
42799 @itemx uint16
42800 @itemx uint24
42801 @itemx uint32
42802 @itemx uint64
42803 @itemx uint128
42804 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
42805
42806 @item code_ptr
42807 @itemx data_ptr
42808 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
42809 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
42810 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
42811 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
42812 may be marked as data pointers.
42813
42814 @item ieee_single
42815 Single precision IEEE floating point.
42816
42817 @item ieee_double
42818 Double precision IEEE floating point.
42819
42820 @item arm_fpa_ext
42821 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
42822
42823 @item i387_ext
42824 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
42825
42826 @item i386_eflags
42827 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
42828
42829 @item i386_mxcsr
42830 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
42831
42832 @end table
42833
42834 @node Enum Target Types
42835 @section Enum Target Types
42836 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
42837
42838 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
42839 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
42840
42841 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
42842
42843 @smallexample
42844 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42845 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
42846 @dots{}
42847 </enum>
42848 @end smallexample
42849
42850 Enums must be defined before they are used.
42851
42852 @smallexample
42853 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
42854 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
42855 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
42856 </enum>
42857 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
42858 <field name="X" start="0"/>
42859 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
42860 </flags>
42861 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
42862 @end smallexample
42863
42864 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
42865 would be printed as:
42866
42867 @smallexample
42868 (gdb) info register flags
42869 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
42870 @end smallexample
42871
42872 @node Standard Target Features
42873 @section Standard Target Features
42874 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
42875
42876 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
42877 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
42878 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
42879 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
42880 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
42881 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
42882 can recognize them.
42883
42884 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
42885 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
42886 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
42887 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
42888 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
42889 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
42890 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
42891 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
42892
42893 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
42894 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
42895 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
42896
42897 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
42898 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
42899 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
42900 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
42901
42902 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
42903 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
42904 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
42905
42906 @menu
42907 * AArch64 Features::
42908 * ARC Features::
42909 * ARM Features::
42910 * i386 Features::
42911 * MicroBlaze Features::
42912 * MIPS Features::
42913 * M68K Features::
42914 * NDS32 Features::
42915 * Nios II Features::
42916 * OpenRISC 1000 Features::
42917 * PowerPC Features::
42918 * S/390 and System z Features::
42919 * Sparc Features::
42920 * TIC6x Features::
42921 @end menu
42922
42923
42924 @node AArch64 Features
42925 @subsection AArch64 Features
42926 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
42927
42928 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
42929 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
42930 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
42931
42932 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
42933 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
42934 and @samp{fpcr}.
42935
42936 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.sve} feature is optional. If present,
42937 it should contain registers @samp{z0} through @samp{z31}, @samp{p0}
42938 through @samp{p15}, @samp{ffr} and @samp{vg}.
42939
42940 @node ARC Features
42941 @subsection ARC Features
42942 @cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
42943
42944 ARC processors are highly configurable, so even core registers and their number
42945 are not completely predetermined. In addition flags and PC registers which are
42946 important to @value{GDBN} are not ``core'' registers in ARC. It is required
42947 that one of the core registers features is present.
42948 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is mandatory.
42949
42950 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and ARC HS
42951 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
42952 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
42953 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain register @samp{ilink}
42954 and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
42955 @samp{ilink} and extension core registers are not available to read/write, when
42956 debugging GNU/Linux applications, thus @samp{ilink} is made optional.
42957
42958 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core-reduced.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and
42959 ARC HS targets with a reduced register file. It should contain registers
42960 @samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, @samp{r10} through @samp{r15}, @samp{gp},
42961 @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.
42962 This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} and any of extension core
42963 registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
42964
42965 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.arcompact} feature is required for ARCompact
42966 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
42967 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
42968 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain registers
42969 @samp{ilink1}, @samp{ilink2} and any of extension core registers @samp{r32}
42970 through @samp{r59/acch}. @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} and extension core
42971 registers are not available when debugging GNU/Linux applications. The only
42972 difference with @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is in the names of
42973 @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} registers and that @samp{r30} is mandatory in
42974 ARC v2, but @samp{ilink2} is optional on ARCompact.
42975
42976 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is required for all ARC
42977 targets. It should contain registers @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
42978
42979 @node ARM Features
42980 @subsection ARM Features
42981 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
42982
42983 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
42984 ARM targets.
42985 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
42986 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
42987
42988 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
42989 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
42990 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
42991 and @samp{xpsr}.
42992
42993 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
42994 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
42995
42996 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
42997 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
42998 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
42999 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
43000
43001 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
43002 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
43003 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
43004 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
43005 halves of the double-precision registers.
43006
43007 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
43008 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
43009 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
43010 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
43011 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
43012 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
43013
43014 @node i386 Features
43015 @subsection i386 Features
43016 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
43017
43018 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
43019 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43020
43021 @itemize @minus
43022 @item
43023 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
43024 @item
43025 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
43026 @item
43027 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
43028 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
43029 @item
43030 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
43031 @item
43032 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
43033 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
43034 @end itemize
43035
43036 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
43037
43038 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
43039 describe registers:
43040
43041 @itemize @minus
43042 @item
43043 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
43044 @item
43045 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
43046 @item
43047 @samp{mxcsr}
43048 @end itemize
43049
43050 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
43051 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
43052 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
43053
43054 @itemize @minus
43055 @item
43056 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
43057 @item
43058 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
43059 @end itemize
43060
43061 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
43062 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
43063
43064 @itemize @minus
43065 @item
43066 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
43067 @item
43068 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
43069 @end itemize
43070
43071 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
43072 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
43073
43074 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.segments} feature is optional. It should
43075 describe two system registers: @samp{fs_base} and @samp{gs_base}.
43076
43077 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
43078 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
43079 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
43080
43081 @itemize @minus
43082 @item
43083 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
43084 @end itemize
43085
43086 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
43087
43088 @itemize @minus
43089 @item
43090 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
43091 @end itemize
43092
43093 It should
43094 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
43095
43096 @itemize @minus
43097 @item
43098 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
43099 @item
43100 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
43101 @end itemize
43102
43103 It should
43104 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
43105
43106 @itemize @minus
43107 @item
43108 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
43109 @end itemize
43110
43111 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.pkeys} feature is optional. It should
43112 describe a single register, @samp{pkru}. It is a 32-bit register
43113 valid for i386 and amd64.
43114
43115 @node MicroBlaze Features
43116 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
43117 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
43118
43119 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
43120 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
43121 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
43122 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
43123 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
43124
43125 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
43126 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
43127
43128 @node MIPS Features
43129 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
43130 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
43131
43132 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
43133 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
43134 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
43135 on the target.
43136
43137 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
43138 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
43139 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43140
43141 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
43142 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
43143 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
43144 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43145
43146 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
43147 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
43148 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
43149 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43150
43151 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
43152 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
43153 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
43154
43155 @node M68K Features
43156 @subsection M68K Features
43157 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
43158
43159 @table @code
43160 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
43161 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
43162 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
43163 One of those features must be always present.
43164 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
43165 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
43166 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
43167 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
43168
43169 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
43170 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
43171 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
43172 @samp{fpiaddr}.
43173 @end table
43174
43175 @node NDS32 Features
43176 @subsection NDS32 Features
43177 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
43178
43179 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
43180 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
43181 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
43182 and @samp{pc}.
43183
43184 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
43185 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
43186 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
43187 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
43188
43189 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
43190 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
43191 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
43192 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
43193 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
43194 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
43195 support to it could be totally removed some day.
43196
43197 @node Nios II Features
43198 @subsection Nios II Features
43199 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
43200
43201 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
43202 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
43203 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
43204 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
43205 @samp{mpuacc}).
43206
43207 @node OpenRISC 1000 Features
43208 @subsection Openrisc 1000 Features
43209 @cindex target descriptions, OpenRISC 1000 features
43210
43211 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0} feature is required for OpenRISC 1000
43212 targets. It should contain the 32 general purpose registers (@samp{r0}
43213 through @samp{r31}), @samp{ppc}, @samp{npc} and @samp{sr}.
43214
43215 @node PowerPC Features
43216 @subsection PowerPC Features
43217 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
43218
43219 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
43220 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
43221 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
43222 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43223
43224 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
43225 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
43226
43227 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
43228 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
43229 and @samp{vrsave}.
43230
43231 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
43232 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
43233 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
43234 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
43235 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
43236 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
43237
43238 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
43239 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
43240 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
43241 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
43242 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
43243 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
43244 user.
43245
43246 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.ppr} feature is optional. It should
43247 contain the 64-bit register @samp{ppr}.
43248
43249 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.dscr} feature is optional. It should
43250 contain the 64-bit register @samp{dscr}.
43251
43252 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.tar} feature is optional. It should
43253 contain the 64-bit register @samp{tar}.
43254
43255 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.ebb} feature is optional. It should
43256 contain registers @samp{bescr}, @samp{ebbhr} and @samp{ebbrr}, all
43257 64-bit wide.
43258
43259 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.linux.pmu} feature is optional. It should
43260 contain registers @samp{mmcr0}, @samp{mmcr2}, @samp{siar}, @samp{sdar}
43261 and @samp{sier}, all 64-bit wide. This is the subset of the isa 2.07
43262 server PMU registers provided by @sc{gnu}/Linux.
43263
43264 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.spr} feature is optional. It should
43265 contain registers @samp{tfhar}, @samp{texasr} and @samp{tfiar}, all
43266 64-bit wide.
43267
43268 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.core} feature is optional. It should
43269 contain the checkpointed general-purpose registers @samp{cr0} through
43270 @samp{cr31}, as well as the checkpointed registers @samp{clr} and
43271 @samp{cctr}. These registers may all be either 32-bit or 64-bit
43272 depending on the target. It should also contain the checkpointed
43273 registers @samp{ccr} and @samp{cxer}, which should both be 32-bit
43274 wide.
43275
43276 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.fpu} feature is optional. It should
43277 contain the checkpointed 64-bit floating-point registers @samp{cf0}
43278 through @samp{cf31}, as well as the checkpointed 64-bit register
43279 @samp{cfpscr}.
43280
43281 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.altivec} feature is optional. It
43282 should contain the checkpointed altivec registers @samp{cvr0} through
43283 @samp{cvr31}, all 128-bit wide. It should also contain the
43284 checkpointed registers @samp{cvscr} and @samp{cvrsave}, both 32-bit
43285 wide.
43286
43287 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.vsx} feature is optional. It should
43288 contain registers @samp{cvs0h} through @samp{cvs31h}. @value{GDBN}
43289 will combine these registers with the checkpointed floating point
43290 registers (@samp{cf0} through @samp{cf31}) and the checkpointed
43291 altivec registers (@samp{cvr0} through @samp{cvr31}) to present the
43292 128-bit wide checkpointed vector-scalar registers @samp{cvs0} through
43293 @samp{cvs63}. Therefore, this feature requires both
43294 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.altivec} and
43295 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.fpu}.
43296
43297 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.ppr} feature is optional. It should
43298 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{cppr}.
43299
43300 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.dscr} feature is optional. It should
43301 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{cdscr}.
43302
43303 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.tar} feature is optional. It should
43304 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{ctar}.
43305
43306 @node S/390 and System z Features
43307 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
43308 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
43309 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
43310
43311 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
43312 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
43313 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
43314 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
43315 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
43316 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
43317 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
43318 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
43319 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
43320
43321 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
43322 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
43323 @samp{fpc}.
43324
43325 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
43326 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
43327
43328 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
43329 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
43330 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
43331 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
43332 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
43333 32-bit wide.
43334
43335 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
43336 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
43337 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
43338
43339 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
43340 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
43341 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
43342 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
43343 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
43344 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
43345 @samp{v31}.
43346
43347 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gs} feature is optional. It should contain
43348 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage-control registers @samp{gsd},
43349 @samp{gssm}, and @samp{gsepla}.
43350
43351 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gsbc} feature is optional. It should contain
43352 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage broadcast control registers
43353 @samp{bc_gsd}, @samp{bc_gssm}, and @samp{bc_gsepla}.
43354
43355 @node Sparc Features
43356 @subsection Sparc Features
43357 @cindex target descriptions, sparc32 features
43358 @cindex target descriptions, sparc64 features
43359 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
43360 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43361
43362 @itemize @minus
43363 @item
43364 @samp{g0} through @samp{g7}
43365 @item
43366 @samp{o0} through @samp{o7}
43367 @item
43368 @samp{l0} through @samp{l7}
43369 @item
43370 @samp{i0} through @samp{i7}
43371 @end itemize
43372
43373 They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43374
43375 Also the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.fpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
43376 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43377
43378 @itemize @minus
43379 @item
43380 @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}
43381 @item
43382 @samp{f32} through @samp{f62} for sparc64
43383 @end itemize
43384
43385 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cp0} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
43386 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43387
43388 @itemize @minus
43389 @item
43390 @samp{y}, @samp{psr}, @samp{wim}, @samp{tbr}, @samp{pc}, @samp{npc},
43391 @samp{fsr}, and @samp{csr} for sparc32
43392 @item
43393 @samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, @samp{state}, @samp{fsr}, @samp{fprs}, and @samp{y}
43394 for sparc64
43395 @end itemize
43396
43397 @node TIC6x Features
43398 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
43399 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
43400 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
43401 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
43402 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
43403 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
43404
43405 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
43406 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
43407 through @samp{B31}.
43408
43409 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
43410 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
43411
43412 @node Operating System Information
43413 @appendix Operating System Information
43414 @cindex operating system information
43415
43416 @menu
43417 * Process list::
43418 @end menu
43419
43420 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
43421 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
43422 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
43423 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
43424 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
43425 on a different aspect of target.
43426
43427 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
43428 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
43429 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
43430 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
43431
43432 @node Process list
43433 @appendixsection Process list
43434 @cindex operating system information, process list
43435
43436 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
43437 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
43438 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
43439 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
43440
43441 An example document is:
43442
43443 @smallexample
43444 <?xml version="1.0"?>
43445 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
43446 <osdata type="processes">
43447 <item>
43448 <column name="pid">1</column>
43449 <column name="user">root</column>
43450 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
43451 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
43452 </item>
43453 </osdata>
43454 @end smallexample
43455
43456 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
43457 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
43458 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
43459 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
43460 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
43461 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
43462 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
43463
43464 @node Trace File Format
43465 @appendix Trace File Format
43466 @cindex trace file format
43467
43468 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
43469 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
43470
43471 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
43472 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
43473 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
43474 in the future.
43475
43476 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
43477 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
43478 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
43479 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
43480 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
43481 of this section.
43482
43483 @table @code
43484 @item R @var{size}
43485 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
43486 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
43487 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
43488 a single trace file.
43489
43490 @item status @var{status}
43491 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
43492 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
43493 file.
43494
43495 @item tp @var{payload}
43496 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
43497 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
43498 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
43499 reply packets.
43500
43501 @item tsv @var{payload}
43502 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
43503 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
43504 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
43505 reply packets.
43506
43507 @item tdesc @var{payload}
43508 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
43509 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
43510 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
43511 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
43512 file. Includes are not allowed.
43513
43514 @end table
43515
43516 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
43517 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
43518 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
43519 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
43520 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
43521 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
43522 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
43523 endianness.
43524
43525 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
43526
43527 @table @code
43528 @item R @var{bytes}
43529 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
43530 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
43531 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
43532
43533 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
43534 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
43535 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
43536 @var{length} bytes.
43537
43538 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
43539 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
43540 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
43541
43542 @end table
43543
43544 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
43545 of blocks.
43546
43547 @node Index Section Format
43548 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
43549 @cindex .gdb_index section format
43550 @cindex index section format
43551
43552 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
43553 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
43554 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
43555 description.
43556
43557 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
43558 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
43559 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
43560 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
43561 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
43562 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
43563
43564 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
43565
43566 @enumerate
43567 @item
43568 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
43569 unless otherwise noted:
43570
43571 @enumerate
43572 @item
43573 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
43574 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
43575 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
43576 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
43577 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
43578 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
43579 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
43580
43581 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
43582 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
43583 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
43584 currently not flagged as deprecated.
43585
43586 @item
43587 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
43588
43589 @item
43590 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
43591 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
43592 to the next offset.
43593
43594 @item
43595 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
43596
43597 @item
43598 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
43599
43600 @item
43601 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
43602 @end enumerate
43603
43604 @item
43605 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
43606 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
43607 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
43608 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
43609 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
43610 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
43611 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
43612 CU indices.
43613
43614 @item
43615 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
43616 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
43617 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
43618 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
43619
43620 @item
43621 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
43622 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
43623
43624 @enumerate
43625 @item
43626 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
43627
43628 @item
43629 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
43630 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
43631
43632 @item
43633 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
43634 @end enumerate
43635
43636 @item
43637 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
43638 the hash table is always a power of 2.
43639
43640 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
43641 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
43642 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
43643 constant pool.
43644
43645 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
43646 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
43647 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
43648
43649 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
43650 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
43651 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
43652 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
43653 index version:
43654
43655 @table @asis
43656 @item Version 4
43657 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
43658
43659 @item Versions 5 to 7
43660 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
43661 @end table
43662
43663 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
43664
43665 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
43666 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
43667 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
43668 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
43669 collision.
43670
43671 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
43672 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
43673 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
43674 the code.
43675
43676 @item
43677 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
43678 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
43679 strings.
43680
43681 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
43682 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
43683 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
43684 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
43685 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
43686 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
43687
43688 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
43689 @end enumerate
43690
43691 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
43692 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
43693 CU index+attributes value for each use.
43694
43695 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
43696 (bit 0 = LSB):
43697
43698 @table @asis
43699
43700 @item Bits 0-23
43701 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
43702 @item Bits 24-27
43703 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
43704 @item Bits 28-30
43705 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
43706
43707 @table @asis
43708 @item 0
43709 This value is reserved and should not be used.
43710 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
43711 with previous versions of the index.
43712 @item 1
43713 The symbol is a type.
43714 @item 2
43715 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
43716 @item 3
43717 The symbol is a function.
43718 @item 4
43719 Any other kind of symbol.
43720 @item 5,6,7
43721 These values are reserved.
43722 @end table
43723
43724 @item Bit 31
43725 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
43726
43727 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
43728 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
43729 @value{GDBN} sources.
43730
43731 @end table
43732
43733 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
43734 global/static attributes in the index.
43735
43736 @smallexample
43737 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
43738 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
43739 switch (die->tag)
43740 @{
43741 case DW_TAG_typedef:
43742 case DW_TAG_base_type:
43743 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
43744 kind = TYPE;
43745 is_static = 1;
43746 break;
43747 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
43748 kind = VARIABLE;
43749 is_static = language != CPLUS;
43750 break;
43751 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
43752 kind = FUNCTION;
43753 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
43754 break;
43755 case DW_TAG_constant:
43756 kind = VARIABLE;
43757 is_static = ! is_external;
43758 break;
43759 case DW_TAG_variable:
43760 kind = VARIABLE;
43761 is_static = ! is_external;
43762 break;
43763 case DW_TAG_namespace:
43764 kind = TYPE;
43765 is_static = 0;
43766 break;
43767 case DW_TAG_class_type:
43768 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
43769 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
43770 case DW_TAG_union_type:
43771 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
43772 kind = TYPE;
43773 is_static = language != CPLUS;
43774 break;
43775 default:
43776 assert (0);
43777 @}
43778 @end smallexample
43779
43780 @node Man Pages
43781 @appendix Manual pages
43782 @cindex Man pages
43783
43784 @menu
43785 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
43786 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
43787 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
43788 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
43789 * gdb-add-index man:: Add index files to speed up GDB
43790 @end menu
43791
43792 @node gdb man
43793 @heading gdb man
43794
43795 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
43796
43797 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
43798 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
43799 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
43800 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
43801 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
43802 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
43803 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
43804 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
43805 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
43806 @c man end
43807
43808 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
43809 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
43810 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
43811 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
43812
43813 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
43814 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
43815
43816 @itemize @bullet
43817 @item
43818 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
43819
43820 @item
43821 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
43822
43823 @item
43824 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
43825
43826 @item
43827 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
43828 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
43829 @end itemize
43830
43831 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
43832 Modula-2.
43833
43834 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
43835 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
43836 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
43837 by using the command @code{help}.
43838
43839 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
43840 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
43841 executable program as the argument:
43842
43843 @smallexample
43844 gdb program
43845 @end smallexample
43846
43847 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
43848
43849 @smallexample
43850 gdb program core
43851 @end smallexample
43852
43853 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
43854 to debug a running process:
43855
43856 @smallexample
43857 gdb program 1234
43858 gdb -p 1234
43859 @end smallexample
43860
43861 @noindent
43862 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
43863 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
43864 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
43865
43866 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
43867
43868 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
43869 @table @env
43870 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
43871 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
43872
43873 @item run [@var{arglist}]
43874 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
43875
43876 @item bt
43877 Backtrace: display the program stack.
43878
43879 @item print @var{expr}
43880 Display the value of an expression.
43881
43882 @item c
43883 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
43884
43885 @item next
43886 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
43887 function calls in the line.
43888
43889 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
43890 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
43891
43892 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
43893 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
43894
43895 @item step
43896 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
43897 function calls in the line.
43898
43899 @item help [@var{name}]
43900 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
43901 about using @value{GDBN}.
43902
43903 @item quit
43904 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
43905 @end table
43906
43907 @ifset man
43908 For full details on @value{GDBN},
43909 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43910 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
43911 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
43912 @end ifset
43913 @c man end
43914
43915 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
43916 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
43917 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
43918 encountered with no
43919 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
43920 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
43921 Many options have
43922 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
43923 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
43924 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
43925 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
43926 more usual convention.)
43927
43928 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
43929 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
43930 option is used.
43931
43932 @table @env
43933 @item -help
43934 @itemx -h
43935 List all options, with brief explanations.
43936
43937 @item -symbols=@var{file}
43938 @itemx -s @var{file}
43939 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
43940
43941 @item -write
43942 Enable writing into executable and core files.
43943
43944 @item -exec=@var{file}
43945 @itemx -e @var{file}
43946 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
43947 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
43948 dump.
43949
43950 @item -se=@var{file}
43951 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
43952 file.
43953
43954 @item -core=@var{file}
43955 @itemx -c @var{file}
43956 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
43957
43958 @item -command=@var{file}
43959 @itemx -x @var{file}
43960 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
43961
43962 @item -ex @var{command}
43963 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
43964
43965 @item -directory=@var{directory}
43966 @itemx -d @var{directory}
43967 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
43968
43969 @item -nh
43970 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
43971
43972 @item -nx
43973 @itemx -n
43974 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
43975
43976 @item -quiet
43977 @itemx -q
43978 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
43979 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
43980
43981 @item -batch
43982 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
43983 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
43984 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
43985 commands in the command files.
43986
43987 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
43988 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
43989 more useful, the message
43990
43991 @smallexample
43992 Program exited normally.
43993 @end smallexample
43994
43995 @noindent
43996 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
43997 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
43998
43999 @item -cd=@var{directory}
44000 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
44001 instead of the current directory.
44002
44003 @item -fullname
44004 @itemx -f
44005 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
44006 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
44007 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
44008 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
44009 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
44010 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
44011 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
44012 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
44013
44014 @item -b @var{bps}
44015 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
44016 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
44017
44018 @item -tty=@var{device}
44019 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
44020 @end table
44021 @c man end
44022
44023 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
44024 @ifset man
44025 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44026 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44027 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44028
44029 @smallexample
44030 info gdb
44031 @end smallexample
44032
44033 @noindent
44034 should give you access to the complete manual.
44035
44036 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44037 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44038 @end ifset
44039 @c man end
44040
44041 @node gdbserver man
44042 @heading gdbserver man
44043
44044 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
44045 @format
44046 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
44047 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
44048
44049 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44050
44051 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44052 @c man end
44053 @end format
44054
44055 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
44056 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
44057 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
44058
44059 @ifclear man
44060 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
44061 @end ifclear
44062 @ifset man
44063 Usage (server (target) side):
44064 @end ifset
44065
44066 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
44067 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
44068 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
44069 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
44070
44071 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
44072 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
44073 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
44074
44075 @smallexample
44076 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
44077 @end smallexample
44078
44079 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
44080
44081 @smallexample
44082 @ifset man
44083 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
44084 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
44085 @end ifset
44086 @ifclear man
44087 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
44088 @end ifclear
44089 @end smallexample
44090
44091 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
44092 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
44093 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
44094
44095 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
44096
44097 @smallexample
44098 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
44099 @end smallexample
44100
44101 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
44102 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
44103 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
44104 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
44105 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
44106 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
44107 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
44108 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
44109 print an error message and exit.
44110
44111 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
44112 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
44113
44114 @smallexample
44115 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44116 @end smallexample
44117
44118 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
44119 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
44120
44121 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
44122 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
44123 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
44124 the program you want to debug.
44125
44126 @smallexample
44127 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44128 @end smallexample
44129
44130 @ifclear man
44131 @subheading Usage (host side)
44132 @end ifclear
44133 @ifset man
44134 Usage (host side):
44135 @end ifset
44136
44137 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
44138 @value{GDBN} needs to examine its symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
44139 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
44140 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
44141 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
44142 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
44143 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
44144 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
44145 descriptor. For example:
44146
44147 @smallexample
44148 @ifset man
44149 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
44150 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
44151 @end ifset
44152 @ifclear man
44153 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
44154 @end ifclear
44155 @end smallexample
44156
44157 @noindent
44158 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
44159
44160 @smallexample
44161 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
44162 @end smallexample
44163
44164 @noindent
44165 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
44166 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
44167 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
44168 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
44169 `Connection refused'.
44170
44171 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
44172 described in
44173 @ifset man
44174 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
44175 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
44176 @end ifset
44177 @ifclear man
44178 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
44179 @end ifclear
44180 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
44181
44182 @smallexample
44183 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
44184 @end smallexample
44185
44186 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
44187 case.
44188 @c man end
44189
44190 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
44191 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
44192
44193 @itemize @bullet
44194
44195 @item
44196 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
44197
44198 @smallexample
44199 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
44200 @end smallexample
44201
44202 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
44203 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
44204 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
44205 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
44206 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
44207 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
44208 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
44209
44210 @item
44211 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
44212 program:
44213
44214 @smallexample
44215 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44216 @end smallexample
44217
44218 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
44219 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
44220 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
44221 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
44222
44223 @item
44224 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
44225
44226 @smallexample
44227 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44228 @end smallexample
44229
44230 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
44231 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
44232 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
44233 debug several processes in the same session.
44234 @end itemize
44235
44236 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
44237
44238 @table @env
44239
44240 @item --help
44241 List all options, with brief explanations.
44242
44243 @item --version
44244 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
44245
44246 @item --attach
44247 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
44248
44249 @smallexample
44250 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44251 @end smallexample
44252
44253 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
44254 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
44255
44256 @item --multi
44257 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
44258 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
44259 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
44260 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
44261
44262 @smallexample
44263 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44264 @end smallexample
44265
44266 @item --debug
44267 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
44268 process.
44269 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
44270 the developers.
44271
44272 @item --remote-debug
44273 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
44274 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
44275 the developers.
44276
44277 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
44278 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
44279 of debugging output.
44280 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
44281
44282 @item --wrapper
44283 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
44284 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
44285 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
44286 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
44287
44288 @item --once
44289 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
44290 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
44291 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
44292 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
44293
44294 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
44295
44296 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
44297 @c QDisableRandomization.
44298
44299 @end table
44300 @c man end
44301
44302 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
44303 @ifset man
44304 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44305 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44306 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44307
44308 @smallexample
44309 info gdb
44310 @end smallexample
44311
44312 should give you access to the complete manual.
44313
44314 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44315 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44316 @end ifset
44317 @c man end
44318
44319 @node gcore man
44320 @heading gcore
44321
44322 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
44323
44324 @format
44325 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
44326 gcore [-a] [-o @var{prefix}] @var{pid1} [@var{pid2}...@var{pidN}]
44327 @c man end
44328 @end format
44329
44330 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
44331 Generate core dumps of one or more running programs with process IDs
44332 @var{pid1}, @var{pid2}, etc. A core file produced by @command{gcore}
44333 is equivalent to one produced by the kernel when the process crashes
44334 (and when @kbd{ulimit -c} was used to set up an appropriate core dump
44335 limit). However, unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} finishes
44336 its job the program remains running without any change.
44337 @c man end
44338
44339 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
44340 @table @env
44341 @item -a
44342 Dump all memory mappings. The actual effect of this option depends on
44343 the Operating System. On @sc{gnu}/Linux, it will disable
44344 @code{use-coredump-filter} (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}) and
44345 enable @code{dump-excluded-mappings} (@pxref{set
44346 dump-excluded-mappings}).
44347
44348 @item -o @var{prefix}
44349 The optional argument @var{prefix} specifies the prefix to be used
44350 when composing the file names of the core dumps. The file name is
44351 composed as @file{@var{prefix}.@var{pid}}, where @var{pid} is the
44352 process ID of the running program being analyzed by @command{gcore}.
44353 If not specified, @var{prefix} defaults to @var{gcore}.
44354 @end table
44355 @c man end
44356
44357 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
44358 @ifset man
44359 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44360 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44361 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44362
44363 @smallexample
44364 info gdb
44365 @end smallexample
44366
44367 @noindent
44368 should give you access to the complete manual.
44369
44370 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44371 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44372 @end ifset
44373 @c man end
44374
44375 @node gdbinit man
44376 @heading gdbinit
44377
44378 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
44379
44380 @format
44381 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
44382 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44383 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
44384 @end ifset
44385
44386 ~/.gdbinit
44387
44388 ./.gdbinit
44389 @c man end
44390 @end format
44391
44392 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
44393 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
44394 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
44395 described in
44396 @ifset man
44397 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
44398 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
44399 @end ifset
44400 @ifclear man
44401 @ref{Sequences}.
44402 @end ifclear
44403
44404 Please read more in
44405 @ifset man
44406 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
44407 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
44408 @end ifset
44409 @ifclear man
44410 @ref{Startup}.
44411 @end ifclear
44412
44413 @table @env
44414 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44415 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
44416 @end ifset
44417 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44418 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
44419 @end ifclear
44420 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
44421 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
44422 See more in
44423 @ifset man
44424 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
44425 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
44426 @end ifset
44427 @ifclear man
44428 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
44429 @end ifclear
44430
44431 @item ~/.gdbinit
44432 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
44433 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
44434
44435 @item ./.gdbinit
44436 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
44437 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
44438 See more in
44439 @ifset man
44440 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
44441 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
44442 @end ifset
44443 @ifclear man
44444 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
44445 @end ifclear
44446 @end table
44447 @c man end
44448
44449 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
44450 @ifset man
44451 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
44452
44453 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44454 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44455 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44456
44457 @smallexample
44458 info gdb
44459 @end smallexample
44460
44461 should give you access to the complete manual.
44462
44463 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44464 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44465 @end ifset
44466 @c man end
44467
44468 @node gdb-add-index man
44469 @heading gdb-add-index
44470 @pindex gdb-add-index
44471 @anchor{gdb-add-index}
44472
44473 @c man title gdb-add-index Add index files to speed up GDB
44474
44475 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb-add-index
44476 gdb-add-index @var{filename}
44477 @c man end
44478
44479 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb-add-index
44480 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
44481 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
44482 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly--at the cost of a delay early on.
44483 For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so @value{GDBN}
44484 provides a way to build an index, which speeds up startup.
44485
44486 To determine whether a file contains such an index, use the command
44487 @kbd{readelf -S filename}: the index is stored in a section named
44488 @code{.gdb_index}. The index file can only be produced on systems
44489 which use ELF binaries and DWARF debug information (i.e., sections
44490 named @code{.debug_*}).
44491
44492 @command{gdb-add-index} uses @value{GDBN} and @command{objdump} found
44493 in the @env{PATH} environment variable. If you want to use different
44494 versions of these programs, you can specify them through the
44495 @env{GDB} and @env{OBJDUMP} environment variables.
44496
44497 See more in
44498 @ifset man
44499 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Index Files}
44500 -- shell command @kbd{info -f gdb -n "Index Files"}.
44501 @end ifset
44502 @ifclear man
44503 @ref{Index Files}.
44504 @end ifclear
44505 @c man end
44506
44507 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb-add-index
44508 @ifset man
44509 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44510 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44511 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44512
44513 @smallexample
44514 info gdb
44515 @end smallexample
44516
44517 should give you access to the complete manual.
44518
44519 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44520 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44521 @end ifset
44522 @c man end
44523
44524 @include gpl.texi
44525
44526 @node GNU Free Documentation License
44527 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
44528 @include fdl.texi
44529
44530 @node Concept Index
44531 @unnumbered Concept Index
44532
44533 @printindex cp
44534
44535 @node Command and Variable Index
44536 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
44537
44538 @printindex fn
44539
44540 @tex
44541 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
44542 % meantime:
44543 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
44544 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
44545 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
44546 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
44547 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
44548 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
44549 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
44550 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
44551 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
44552 \page\colophon
44553 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
44554 @end tex
44555
44556 @bye
This page took 0.973782 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.